HX64087778 QP34.F81 1891 A textbook off RECAP '6^p:^ ^ A TEXT BOOK OF PHYSIOLOGY. BY M. FOSTEE, M.A., M.D., LL.D., F.R.S., PROFESSOR OF PHYSIOLOGY IX THE UNIVERSITY OF CAMBRIDGE, AND FELLOW OF TRINITY COLLEGE, CAMBRIDGE. WITH ILLUSTRATIONS. SIXTH EDITION. PART I., COMPRISING BOOK I. BLOOD. THE TISSUES OF MOVEMENT. THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. MACMILLAN AND CO. AND LONDON. 1893. {All rights reserved.'] W3^ Copyright, 1893, By Macmillan and Co. First Edition 1876. Second Edition 1877. TJiird Edition 1879. Four^A .fff/iViOrt 1883. Reprinted 1884, 1886. i^(/?^ Edition 1888. Reprinted 1891. ^''ixiA Edition 1893. Sanibcvsttg Press: John Wilson and Son, Cambkidge, U.S.A. PREFACE. TN the present edition I have been led to modify a good deal the account of the beat of the heart. Otherwise the changes are not great. M. FOSTER. Digitized by tlie Internet Arcliive in 2010 witli funding from Open Knowledge Commons (for the Medical Heritage Library project) http://www.archive.org/details/textbookofphysio18931fost CONTENTS OF PART I. s§ 1- § 4. § 7. § 8. § 9- § 10. § 11. § 12. INTRODUCTION. -3. Distinctive characters of living and dead bodies Living substance, food and waste ..... Protoplasm and the physiological unit ... Histological differentiation and physiological division Tissues and functions The two chief classes of tissues . . . . . Muscular and nervous tissues ..... Tissues of digestion and excretion • . . . Organs. — Muscles and nerves of the organs of nutrition The blood and the vascular system .... The main problems of physiology .... of labour. PAGE 1 3 4 6 6 BOOK I. BLOOD. THE TISSUES OF MOVEMENT. THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. CHAPTER I. Blood. § 13. The general work of the Blood 13 SECTION I. The Clottixg of Blood. § 14. § 15. § 16. The phenomena of clotting . The characters of fibrin The features of serum. Paraglobulin its characters 62 15 17 18 viii CONTENTS. PAGE §17- Serum-albumin; its characters ...... . , 19 § 18. The circumstances which affect the rapidity of clotting ... 20 § 19. The preparation of plasmine and fibrinogen ...... 22 § 20. Fibrin-fermeut . its action. Nature of the process of clotting , . 23 § 21. Why blood clots when shed 26 § 22. The influence on clotting exerted by the living blood vessels . . 27 § 23. The nature of this influence ; the action of the white corpuscles . 29 SECTION II. The Corpuscles of the Blood. The Red Coiyuscles. § 24. The structure of the red corpuscles ; laky blood ; stroma, and haemo- globin .... ... 31 § 25. The number of red corpuscles in human blood ; method of enumeration 34 § 26. The destruction of red corpuscles ,35 § 27. The formation of red corpuscles, in the embryo and in the adult , htematoblasts ......... 36 The White Corpuscles. § 28. The structure of the Avhite corpuscles ; characters of the cell-substance 38 § 29. The chemical bodies present in white corpuscles . . . , .40 § 30. The white corpuscles as a type of living matter , metabolism, katabolic and anabolic changes. The nature and relations of the ' granules ; ' living substance, food and waste , . 41 § 31. The origin of the white corpuscles. Leucocytes ..... 44 § 32. The disappearance of the white corpuscles. Their influence on the plasma. Different kinds of white corpuscles .... 45 Blood Platelets § 33. The characters of blood platelets . , 48 SECTION III. The Chemical Composition of Blood. § 34. General chemical characters 50 § 35. Chemical composition of serum ....... 50 § 36. Chemical composition of red corpuscles ...... 51 § 37. Chemical composition of white corpuscles ...... 52 CONTENTS. ix SECTION IV. The Quantity of Blood and its Distribution in the Body. PAGE § 38. The determination of the quantity of blood in the body, and the main facts of its distribution 53 CHAPTER IT. The Contractile Tissues. § 39. The movements of the body carried out by means of various kinds of contractile tissues 55 SECTION I. The Phenomena of Muscle and Nerve. Muscular and Nervous Irritability. § 40. Irritability; contractility; stimuli 57 § 41. Independent muscular irritability ; action of urari 58 § 42. Simple and tetanic contractions 59 § 43. The muscle-nerve preparation . . .... 59 § 44. Various forms of stimuli. Induction Coil. Key. Magnetic Inter- ruptor. Electrodes. Method of graphic record . . . . 60 The Phenomena of a Simple Muscular Contraction. § 45. The muscle-curve. ^Myographs. Time measurements. Signals . 69' § 46. Analysis of a simple muscle-curve ....... 75- § 47. Variations of the muscle-curve. The shortening accompanied by thickening 78= § 48. Simple muscular contractions rare in the living body .... 79" § 49. Tetanic contractions. Analysis of the curve of tetanus ... 79 § 50. Various degrees of tetanic contractions .83 § 51. Diminution and disappearance of irritability after death ... 84 SECTION II. On the Changes which take place in a Muscle during a Contraction. The Change in Form. § 52. Gross structure of muscle, arrangement of muscular fibres, blood vessels and nerves 86 § 53. The wave of contraction ; its length, velocity, and other characters . 88 X CONTENTS. PAGE § 54. Minute structure of muscular fibre ; nature of striation ... 90 § 55. The visible changes which take place in a muscular fibre during a contraction 93 § 56. The appearances presented when the fibre is examined with polarized light 95 § 57. Nature of the act of contraction . 96 The Chemistry of Muscle. § 58. Contrast of living and dead muscle ; rigor mortis .... 97 § 59. Cliemical bodies present in dead muscle ; myosin, syntonin . . 98 § 60. Chemistry of living muscle ; muscle-plasma, muscle-clot and muscle- serum, myoglobulin, histo-hsematin 100 § 61. Acid reaction of rigid muscle ; development of carbonic acid in rigor mortis ' . 101 § 62. Other constituents of muscle 103 § 63. Chemical changes during contraction ; development of carbonic acid and acid reaction 105 § 64. Summary of the chemistry of muscle 106 Thermal Changes. § 65. Heat given out during a contraction. Comparison of muscle with a steam-engine 106 Electrical Changes. § 66. Non-polarisable electrodes. Muscle currents; their distribution and nature . 108 § 67. Negative variation of the muscle current ; currents of action. The rheoscopic frog 113 The Changes in a Nerve during the passage of a Nervous Impulse. § 68. Structure of a nerve. Primitive sheath or neurilemma, medulla, axis- cylinder, nodes of Eanvier. The axis-cylinder the essential part 115 § 69. Nerve endings in striated muscular fibres. Henle's sheath. End- plates § 70. Non-medullated nerve fibres 122 §71. The chemistry of a nerve ; cholesterin, lecithin, cerebrin, protagon . 123 § 72. The nervous impulse ; the electrical changes accompanying it. These changes travel in both directions along the nerve . • • 125 § 73. Summary of the changes occurring in a muscle and nerve as the result of stimulation ^^^ 120 CONTENTS. xi SECTION III. The Nature of the Changes through which an Electric Current IS ABLE TO generate A NeUVOUS ImPULSE. Action of the Constant Current. PAGE §74. Action of the coustaut current , making and breaking contractions . 128 § 75. Electrotonus. Effect of the constant current on the irritability of the nerve. Katelectrotonus. Anelectrotonus .... 130 § 76, Electrotonic currents . . . 132 § 77. Relation of electrotonus to nervous impulses, and to the effects of the constant current 134 § 78. Action of the constant current on muscle 136 SECTION IV. The Muscle-Nerve preparation as a Machine. § 79. The influence of the nature and mode of application of the stimulus on the magnitude of the contraction. Maximal and minimal stimuli. Influence of abruptness and duration of stimulus. Some parts of a nerve more irritable than others . . . 138 § 80. Frequency of repetition necessary to produce tetanus ; pale and red muscles. The muscular sound 141 § 81. The influence of the load; effect of resistance. The work done . 143 § 82. The influence of the size and form of the muscle .... 144 SECTION V. The Circumstances which determine the Degree of Irritability OF Muscles and Nerves. § 83, Diminution and disappearance of irritability after severance from the body. Effect of division of nerves ; degeneration of nerve fibres. Regeneration . ......... 14.5 § 84. The influence of temperature 148 § 85. The influence of blood supply 149 § 86. The influence of functional activity. Exercise. Fatigue. The causes of exhaustion 150 SECTION YI. The Energy of Muscle and Nerve and the Nature of Muscular AND Nervous Action. § 87. Nature of the act of contraction and the act of relaxation. The relation of the energy of work to the energy of heat. The rela- tion of nitrogenous metabolism to the energy of contraction . 1.53 § 88. The nature of a nervous impulse ....... 156 xii CONTENTS. SECTION VII. On some other Forms of Contractile Tissue. Plain, smooth or unstriated Muscular Tissue. PAGE § 89. Structure of plain muscular tissue ; characters of the fibre cell . 158 § 90. Arrangement and termination of nerves in unstriated muscle . . 160 § 91. The chemistry of unstriated muscle 161 § 92. The characters of the contraction of unstriated muscle. Peristaltic contractions. 'Spontaneous' contractions. Tonic contractions 161 Ciliary Movement. § 93. Structure of a ciliated epithelium cell 164 § 94. Nature of ciliary movement. Circumstances affecting ciliary move- ments 165 Amceboid Movements. § 95. Nature of an amceboid movement ; its relation to a muscular con- traction 168 CHAPTER III. On the more General Features of Nervous Tissues. § 96. The general arrangement of the nervous system. Cerebro-spinal and splanchnic or sympathetic system ; somatic and splanchnic nerves 171 § 97. The structure of spinal ganglia. The ganglionic nerve cell. Bipolar, unipolar and apolar nerve cells . 175 § 98. The structure of ganglia of the splanchnic or sympathetic system. Multipolar cells. Spiral cells 178 § 99. Grey matter and white matter of the central nervous system. Structure of a nerve cell of the spinal cord ; axis-cylinder process 179 § 100. Functions of nerve cells 180 § 101. Reflex actions, the machinery required. The circumstances de- termining the nature of a reflex action. Reflex actions often purposeful 182 § 102. Automatic actions 185 § 103. Inhibitory nerves 186 CHAPTER IV. The Vascular Mechanism. SECTION I. The Structure and Main Features of the Vascular Apparatus. § 104. The chief work of the blood carried on in the capillaries and other minute vessels .......... 188 CONTENTS. The Structure of Arteries^ Veins, and Capillaries, PAGE § 105. On some features of connective tissue. Gelatiniferous fibrilloB. Connective-tissue corpuscles 189 § 106. Elastic fibres 191 § 107. The structure of capillaries ; epitlielioid cells. The size of capillaries and variations in tlieir calibre . . . . • ■ . 192 § 108. The structure of minute arteries 195 § 109. The structure of larger arteries 196 § 110. The structure of the veins 198 § 111. Some points in the structure of the heart 199 § 112. The main features of the vascular apparatus 200 SECTION II. The Main Facts of the Circulation. § 113. Behaviour of arteries contrasted with that of veins .... 203 § 114. Blood pressure in an artery and in a vein ...... 204 § 115. Methods of registering blood pressure; mercurial manometer. Ky- mograph. The blood pressure curve ...... 206 § 116. Characters of the blood pressure in various arteries and veins. Blood pressure in the capillaries. Fall of blood pressure in the minute vessels . 209 § 117. The circulation through the capillaries, and small vessels. Peripheral resistance 211 Hydraulic Principles of the Circulation. § 118. The three main physical facts of the circulation ; the central pump, the peripheral resistance and the elastic tubing .... 213 § 119. The conversion of the intermittent into a continuous flow by means of the elastic reaction of the arteries 214 § 120. Artificial Model. Arterial and venous pressure with great and with little peripheral resistance . . . . . . . • 216 § 121. Additional aids to the circulation in the living body .... 221 Circumstances determining the Rate of the Flow. % 122. Methods of determining the rate of the flow. Hoemadromometer, Eheometer, Hasmatachometer. The plethysmographic method The rate of flow in arteries, veins, and capillaries §123. The rate of flow dependent on the width of the bed .... 226 § 124. The time of the entire circuit 228 § 125. Summary of the main physical facts of the circulation . . . 229 xiv. CONTENTS. SECTIOX IIL The Heart. The Phenomena of the Nonnal Beat. PAGE § 126. The visible movements 231 § 127. The cardiac cycle ; the series of events constituting a beat . . 232 § 128. The change of form 235 § 129. The cardiac impulse . 237 § 130. The sounds of the heart 238 § 131. Endocardiac pressure. Methods of determining this. Cardiac sound and tambour. Piston and membrane manometers. General features of the curve of endocardiac pressure .... 241 § 132. The output of the heart ; the methods of determining this . . 247 The Mechanism of the Beat. § 133. The curves obtained by means of cardiograph and the myocardio- graph. The curve of ventricular pressure compared with these 250 § 134. The pressure in the ventricle compared with that in the aorta. The differential manometer or manometer balance. The teachings of this comparison 253 § 135. Minimum and maximum manometers. The negative pressure in the cardiac cavities 260 § 136. The duration of the several phases of the cardiac cycle . . . 262 § 137. Summary of the events constituting a beat 265 § 138. The work done 267 SECTION IV. The Pulse. § 139. Methods of recording the pulse. The sphygmograph, sphygmoscope and other instruments. The pulse curve 269 § 140. Pulse tracing from an artificial model; the nature of the pulse wave § 141. The characters of the pulse curve; influence of pressure exerted by lever 276 § 142. The changes undergone by the pulse wave along the arterial tract . 277 § 143. The velocity of the pulse wave 278 § 144. The length of the pulse wave 279 § 145. Secondary waves. Katacrotic and anacrotic tracings . . . 280 § 146. The dicrotic wave : its causes 282 § 147. Circumstances determining the prominence of the dicrotic wave . 285 § 148. The predicrotic wave. Anacrotic waves 286 § 149. Venous pulse .287 273 CONTENTS. XV SECTION V. The Regulation and Adaptation ok the Vascular Mechanism. The Regulation of the Beat of the Heart. PAGE § 150. The two great regulators; changes in the heart beat and changes in the peripheral mechanism 289 The Histology of the Heart. §151. Cardiac muscular tissue. The structure of the frog's heart . . 290 § 152. The structure of the mammalian heart 292 §153. The nerves and ganglia of the heart. In the frog. In the mammal 293 The Deoelopment of the Normal Beat. § 154. Graphic record of the heart beat. The beat of the frog's heart. The sequence of events, and the descending scale of rhythmic power . 296 § 155. The causes of the spontaneous rhythmic beat; the relations of the ganglia , the features of the cardiac tissue .... 300 § 156. Some features of the heart beat in the mammal . . . 305 The Government of the Heart Beat by the Nervous System. § 157. Inhibition in the frog by stimulation of vagus nerves. Features of inhibition ........... 305 § 158. Augmentation of the heart beat in the frog. Antagonism of aug- mentation and inhibition Course of augmentor fibres in the frog 307 § 159. Reflex inhibition. Cardio-inhibitory centre 310 § 160. Inhibition in the mammal , effect on blood pressure. Reflex inhibi- tion. Course of augmentor fibres in the dog . • 311 § 161. Nature of augmentor and inhibitory effects. Action of atropin and muscarin . . 318 Other influences regulating or modifying the Beat of the Heart. § 162. Influences of blood, and substances contained in the blood Influence of the distension of the cavities. Relation of heart beat to blood- pressure ... 320 SECTION VI. Changes in the Calibre of the ]\Iinute Arteries. Vaso-motor Actions. § 163. Changes of calibre in arteries as seen in the web of a frog's foot and elsewhere. Vaso-motor nerves ....... 324 § 1 64. The vascular phenomena in a rabbit's ear 325 CONTENTS. § 165. The effects on the vessels of the ear of dividing and stimulating the cervical sympathetic nerve . . . . . . . 326 § 166, Course of vaso-motor fibres of the ear 327 § 167. The effects on the vessels of the submaxillary gland of stimulating the chorda tympaui nerve ; vaso-constrictor and vaso-dilator fibres 329 § 168. Vaso-motor nerves of other parts of the body. Constrictor and dilator fibres in the sciatic and brachial nerves . . . . 331 The Course of Vaso-motor Fibres. § 169. The course of vaso-constrictor fibres . . . . . . 335 § 170. The course of vaso-dilator fibres 337 The Effects of Vaso-motor Actions. § 171. Local and general effects of the constriction and dilation of an artery or set of arteries 338 Vaso-motor Functions of the Central Nervous System. § 172. Vaso-dilator fibres usually employed as part of a reflex action . . 340 § 173. Loss of tone resulting from the division of the spinal chord at various levels. Vaso-motor centre in the spinal bulb . . . . 341 § 174. The Depressor nerve 343 § 175. Rise of blood pressure from stimulation of afferent nerves ; pressor effects 344 § 176. The limits of the bulbar vaso-motor centre 345 § 177. The relation of the bulbar vaso-motor centre to other spinal vaso-motor centres. Nature of dilation, tone, and constriction of blood vessels 346 § 178. Summary of vaso-motor actions 350 § 179. Instances of vaso-motor actions. Blushing. Effect of vi^armth on skin. Vascular changes in kidney and alimentary canal . . 352 § 180. Vaso-motor nerves of the veins 353 SECTION VII. The Capillary Circulation. § 181. The normal capillary circulation. The axial core and the plasmatic layer 355 § 182. Changes in the capillary circulation induced by irritants. The phenomena of inflammation 356 § 183. The migration of white corpuscles. Stasis 358 § 184. Nature of the inflammatory changes 359 § 185. Changes in the peripheral resistance due to changes in the blood . 360 CONTENTS. xvii SECTION VIII. Changes in the Quantity of Blood. PAGE § 186. Effects of increasing and of diminishing tlie total quantity of blood 362 SECTION IX. A Review of some of the Featuues of the Circulation. § 187. The constant and variable factors 366 § 188. The influence of the venous inflow and of the distension of the cavities of the heart ......... 366 § 189. The heart beat influenced by the quantity and quality of the blood flowing through the heart 366 § 190. The causes of an irregular heart beat 368 § 191.. The causes of the sudden cessation of the heart beat and of sudden death 369 § 192. Instances of the working of the vaso-constrictor mechanism . . 371 § 193. The influence of bodily exercise on the vascular mechanism . . 372 § 194. The influence of food on the vascular mechanism .... 374 § 195. The mutual relations of the heart and the vaso-motor system . . 375 Index 377 LIST OF FIGURES IN PART I. FIG. 1. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 22. 23. 24. 25. 26. 27. 28. 29. 30. 31. 32. 33. izmg mpuli Different forms of white corpuscles from Human Blood. A mu.sc]e-uerve preparation ...... Diagram of du Bois-Reymond key ..... Diagram illustrating apparatus arranged for experiments with muscle and nerve ......... Diagram of an Induction Coil ..... The Magnetic Interruptor ...... The Magnetic Interruptor with Helmholtz's arrangement for equal the make and break shocks A muscle-curve from the gastrocnemius of a frog . The same, with the recording surface moving slowly The same, with the recording surface travelling very rapidly The Pendulum Myograph ...... Diagram of an arrangement of a vibrating tuning-fork with a Desprez signal ......... Curves illustrating the measurement of the velocity of a nervous i Tracing of a double muscular contraction .... ^luscle-curve. Single induction-shocks repeated slowly The same, repeated more rapidly The same, repeated still more rapidly Tetanus produced with the ordinary magnetic interruptor Non-polarisable electrodes ....... Diagram illustrating the electric currents of nerve and muscle Diagram illustrative of the progression of electric changes Diagram of ascending and descending constant current . Diagram of the electrotonic changes in irritability . Diagram illustrating electrotonic currents .... Scheme of the nerves of a segment of spinal cord . Apparatus for investigating blood pressure .... Tracing of arterial pressure in dog ..... Tracing of arterial pressure in rabbit Ludwig's Kymograph ........ Diagram of fall of blood pressure in arteries, capillaries and veins Arterial model Tracing from arterial model with little peripheral resistance . The same with increased peripheral resistance PAGE 47 60 62 64 66 67 68 70 70 71 74 77 80 80 81 81 82 109 110 114 130 132 133 172 207 208 209 210 211 217 218 219 XX LIST OF FIGURES IN PART I. FIG. PAGE 34. Ludwig's Stromuhr 223 35. Chauveau and Lortet's HEematachometer 224 36. Diagram illustrating causes determining the velocity of the flow . . 226 37. Tracing from heart of cat 236 38. Marey's Tambour, and cardiac sound 242 39. Tracings from right auricle and ventricle of horse (Chauveau and Marey) 243 40. Curves of endocardiac pressure by means of piston manometer . . 244 41. The membrane manometer of Hiirthle 244 42. Diagram of the same 245 43. Curve of ventricular pressure : membrane manometer .... 246 44. Stolnikow's apparatus for measuring the output of the heart . . 248 45. Cardiometer of Eoy and Adami 249 46. Tracing from the heart of a cat, by means of a light lever . . . 250 47. Cardiograms . 251 48. Myocardiogram 252 49. Diagram of application of aortic and ventricular catheters . . . 253 50. Simultaneous tracings of ventricular and aortic pressures , . . 254 51. Diagram of the differential manometer of Hurthle .... 254 52. Simultaneous curves of ventricular and aortic pressures, and of the differential manometer ; descending systolic plateau . . . 255 53. The same, with the recording surface travelling rapidly . . . 255 54. Simultaneous curves of ventricular and aortic pressures and of the differential manometer ; ascending systolic plateau .... 258 55. Diagram of ventricular and aortic pressures and of the cardiac impulse . 259 56. Maximum and minimum manometer 260 57. rick's spring manometer 270 58. Diagram of a sphygmograph 271 59. Pulse tracing from radial artery 273 60. Diagram of artificial pulse tracings 274 61. Diagram of progression of pulse wave 275 62. Pulse tracing with different pressures 276 63. Pulse tracing from dorsalis pedis artery . . , . . . . 277 64. Pulse tracing from carotid artery 280 65. Anacrotic pulse tracing 281 66. Dicrotic pulse tracing 281 67. A perfusion cannula 297 68. Diagram of apparatus for registering the beat of a frog's heart . . 298 69. Inhibition of heart beat in the frog 306 70. Diagram of the course of cardiac augmentor fibres in the frog . . 308 71. Cardiac inhibition in the mammal . . . . . . . . 311 72. The course of cardiac inhibitory and augmentor fibres in the dog . . 315 73. Diagram of the course of vaso-constrictor fibres 328 74. Diagram of the nerves of the submaxillary gland 329 75. The depressor nerve .......... 344 76. Rise of pressure due to stimulation of the sciatic nerve .... 345 INTRODUCTION. § 1. Dissection, aided by microscopical examination, teaches us that the body of man is made up of certain kinds of material, so differing from each other in optical and other physical characters and so built up together as to give the body certain structural features. Chemical examination further teaches us that these kinds of material are composed of various chemical substances, a large number of which have this characteristic that they possess a considerable amount of potential energy capable of being set free, rendered actual, by oxidation or some other chemical change. Thus the body as a whole may, from a chemical point of view, be considered as a mass of various chemical substances, representing altogether a considerable capital of potential energy. § 2. This body may exist either as a living body or (for a certain time at least) as a dead body, and the living body may at any time become a dead body. At what is generally called the moment of death (but artificially so, for as we shall see the processes of death are numerous and gradual) the dead body so far as structure and chemical composition are concerned is exceed- ingly like the living body ; indeed the differences between the two are such as can be determined only by very careful examination, and are still to a large extent estimated by drawing inferences rather than actually observed. At any rate the dead body at the moment of death resembles the living body in so far as it represents a capital of potential energy. From that moment onwards however the capital is expended ; by processes which are largely those of oxidation, the energy is gradually dissipated, leaving the body chiefly in the form of heat. While these chemi- cal processes are going on the structural features dissappear, and the body, with the loss of nearly all its energy, is at last resolved into " dust and ashes." 2 THE LIVING AND THE DEAD BODY. The characteristic of the dead body then is that, being a mass of substances of considerable potential energy, it is always more or less slowly losing energy never gaining energy ; the capital of energy present at the moment of death is more or less slowly diminished, is never increased or replaced. § 3. When on the other hand we study a living body we are struck with the following salient facts. 1. The living body moves of itself, either moving one part of the body on another or moving the whole body from place to place. These movements are active ; the body is not simply pulled or pushed by external forces, but the motive power is in the body itself, the energy of each movement is supplied by the body itself. 2. These movements are determined and influenced, indeed often seem to be started, by changes in the surroundings of the body. Sudden contact between the surface of the body and some foreign object will often call forth a movement. The body is sensitive to changes in its surroundings, and this sensitiveness is manifested not only by movements but by other changes in the body. 3. It is continually generating heat and giving out heat to surrounding things, the production and loss of heat, in the case of man and certain other animals, being so adjusted that the whole body is warm, — that is, of a temperature higher than that of surrounding things. 4. From time to time it eats, — that is to say, takes into itself supplies of certain substances known as food, these substances being in the main similar to those which compose the body and being like them chemical bodies of considerable potential energy, capable through oxidation or other chemical changes of setting free a considerable quantity of energy. 5. It is continually breathing, — that is, taking in from the surrounding air supplies of oxygen. 6. It is continually, or from time to time, discharging from itself into its surroundings so-called waste matters, which waste matters may be broadly described as products of oxidation of the substances taken in as food, or of the substances composing the body. Hence the living body may be said to be distinguished from the dead body by three main features. The living body like the dead is continually losing energy (and losing it more rapidly than the dead body, the special breathing arrangements permitting a more rapid oxidation of its substance), but unlike the dead body is by means of food contin- ually restoring its substance and replenishing its store of energy. The energy set free in the dead body by the oxidation and other chemical changes of its substance leaves the body almost exclusively in the form of heat, whereas a great deal of energy leaves the living body as mechanical work, the result of various movements of the body ; and as we shall see a great deal of the INTRODUCTION. 3 energy which ultimately leaves the body as heat exists for a while within the living body in other forms than lieat, though eventually transformed into heat. The changes in the surroundings affect the dead body at a slow rate and in a general way only, simply lessening or increasing the amount or rate of chemical change and the quantity of heat thereby set free, but never diverting the energy into some other form, such as that of movement ; whereas changes in the sur- roundings may in the case of the living body rapidly, profoundly, and in special ways affect not only the amount but also the kind of energy set free. The dead body left to itself slowly falls to pieces, slowly dissipates its store of energy, and slowly gives out he^t. A higher or lower temperature, more or less moisture, a free or scanty supply of oxygen, the advent of many or few putrefactive organ- isms, — these may quicken or slacken the rate at which energy is being dissipated but do not divert that energy from heat into motion ; whereas in the living body so slight a change of surround- ings as the mere touch by a hair of some particular surface, may so affect the setting free of energy as to lead to such a discharge of energy in the form of movement that the previously apparently quiescent body 2uay be suddenly thrown into the most violent convulsions. The differences therefore between living substance and dead substance though recondite are very great, and the ultimate object of Physiology is to ascertain how it is that living substance can do what dead substance cannot, — can renew its substance and replen- ish the energy which it is continually losing, and can according to the nature of its surroundings vary not only the amount but also the kind of energy which it sets free. Thus there are two great divisions of Physiology : one having to do with the renewal of substance and the replenishment of energy, the other having to do with the setting free of energy. § 4. Now, the body of man (or one of the higher animals) is a very complicated structure consisting of different kinds of mate- rial which we call tissues, such as muscular, nervous, connective, and the like, variously arranged in organs, such as heart, lungs, muscles, skin, etc., all built up to form the body according to certain morphological laws. But all this complication, though advantageous and indeed necessary for the fuller life of man, is not essential to the existence of life. The amoeba is a living being ; it renews its substance, replenishes its store of energy, and sets free energy now in one form, now in another ; and yet the amoeba may be said to have no tissues and no organs ; at all events this is true of closely allied but not so well-known simple beings. Using the more familiar amoeba as a type, and therefore leaving on one side the nucleus, and any distinction between eudosarc and ectosarc, we may say that its body is homogeneous in the sense that if we divided it into small pieces, each piece would be like all 4- PEOTOPLASM. the others. In another sense it is not homogeneous; for we know that the amcBba receives into its substance material as food, and that this food or part of it remains lodged in the body until it is made use of and built up into the living substance of the body ; and each piece of the living substance of the body must have in or near it some of the material which it is about to build up into itself. Further, we know that the amceba gives out waste matters, such as carbonic acid and other substances ; and each piece of the amceba must contain some of these waste matters about to be, but not yet, discharged from the piece. Each piece of the amoeba will therefore contain these three things : the actual living substance, the food about to become living substance, and the waste matters which have ceased to be living substance. Moreover, we have reasons to think that the living substance does not break down into the waste matters which leave the body at a single bound, but that there are stages in the downward progress between the one and the other. Similarly, though our knowledge on this point is less sure, we have reason to think that the food is not incorporated into the living substance at- a single step, but that there are stages in the upward progress from the dead food to the living substance. Each piece of the body of the amceba will therefore contain substances represent- ing various stages of becoming living, and of ceasing to be living, as well as the living substance itself. And we may safely make this statement though we are quite unable to draw the line where the dead food on its way up becomes living, or the living substance on its way down becomes dead. § 5. Nor is it necessary for our present purpose to be able to point out under the microscope, or to describe from a histological point of view, the parts which are living and the parts which are dead food or dead waste. The body of the amoeba is frequently spoken of as consisting of ' protoplasm.' The name was originally given to the matter forming the primordial utricle of the vegetable cell as distinguished from the cell wall on the one hand, and from the fluid contents of the cell or cell sap on the other, and also we may add from the nucleus. It has since been applied very generally to such parts of animal bodies as resemble, in their general features, the primordial utricle. Thus the body of a white blood corpuscle, or of a gland cell, or of a nerve cell, is said to consist of protoplasm. Such parts of animal bodies as do not in their general features resemble the matter of the primordial utricle are not called protoplasm, or, if they at some earlier stage did bear such resemblance, but no longer do so, are sometimes, as in the case of the substance of a muscular fibre, called ' differentiated proto- plasm.' Protoplasm in this sense sometimes appears, as in the outer part of most amcebse, as a mass of glassy-looking material, either continuous or interrupted by more or less spherical spaces or vacuoles filled with fluid, sometimes as in a gland cell as a more INTRODUCTION. 5 refractive, cloudy-looking, or finely granular material arranged in a more or less irregular network, or spongework, the interstices of which are occupied either by tluid or by some material different from itself. We shall return however to the features of this 'proto- plasm ' when we come to treat of white blood corpuscles and other ' protoplasmic ' structures. Meanwhile it is sufficient for our pres- ent purpose to note that lodged in the protoplasm, discontinuous with it, and forming no part of it, are in the first place collections of fluid, of watery solutions of various substances, occupying the more regular vacuoles or the more irregular spaces of the network, and in the second place discrete granules of one kind or another, also forming no part of the protoplasm itself, but lodged either in the bars or substance of the protoplasm or in the vacuoles or meshes. Now, there can be little doubt that the fluids and the discrete granules are dead food or dead waste, but the present state of our knowledge will not permit us to make any very definite statement about the protoplasm itself. We may probably conclude, indeed we may be almost sure, that protoplasm in the above sense is not all living substance ; that it is made up partly of the real living substance, and partly of material which is becoming living or has ceased to be living ; and in the case where protoplasm is described as forming a network, it is possible that some of the material occupying the meshes of the network may be, like part of the network itself, really alive. ' Protoplasm ' in fact, as in the sense in which we are now using it, and shall continue to use it, is a iiior])]iological term ; but it must be borne in mind that the same word ' protoplasm ' is also frequently used to denote what we have just now called 'the real living substance.' The word then embodies a physiological idea ; so used it may be applied to the living substance of all living structures, whatever the micro- scopical features of those structures ; in this sense it cannot at present, and possibly never will be recognised by the microscope, and our knowledge of its nature must be based on inferences. Keeping then to the phrase ' living substance ' we may say that each piece of the body of the amoeba consists of living substance in which are lodged, or with which are built up in some way or other, food and waste in various stages. Now, an amoeba may divide itself into two, each half exhibiting all the phenomena of the whole ; and we can easily imagine the process to be repeated until the amoeba was divided into a multitude of exceedingly minute amoebiB, each having all the properties of the original. But it is obvious, as in the like division of a mass of a chemical substance, that the division could not be repeated indefinitely. Just as in division of the chemical mass we come to the chemical molecule, further division of which changes the properties of the substance, so in the continued division of the amoeba we should come to a stage in which further division interfered with the physiological actions ; we should come 6 DIVISION or LABOUR. to a physiological unit, corresponding to but greatly more complex than the chemical molecule. ^ This unit to remain a physiologi- cal unit and to continue to live must contain not only a portion of the living substance but also the food for that living substance, in several at least of the stages, from the initial raw food up to the final 'living' stages, and must similarly contain various stages of waste. § 6. Now, the great characteristic of the typical amoeba (leav- ing out the nucleus) is that, as far as we can ascertain, all the physi- ological units are alike ; they all do the same things. Each and every part of the body receives food more or less raw and builds it up into its own living substance ; each and every part of the body may be at one time quiescent and at another in motion ; each and every part is sensitive and responds by movement or otherwise to various changes in its surroundings. The body of man, in its first stage, while it is as yet an ovum, if we leave aside the nucleus and neglect differences caused by the unequal distribution of food material or yolk, may also be said to be composed of like parts or like physiological units. By the act of segmentation however the ovum is divided into parts or cells which early shew differences from each other ; and these differences rapidly increase as development proceeds. Some cells put on certain characters and others other characters ; that is to say, the cells undergo histological differentiation. And this takes place in such a way that a number of cells lying together in a group become eventually converted into a tissue ; and the whole body becomes a collection of such tissues arranged together according to morphological laws, each tissue having a definite structure, its cellular nature being sometimes preserved, sometimes obscured or even lost. This histological differentiation is accompanied by a 2^^i'ysio- logical division of lahotir. Each tissue may be supposed to be composed of physiological units, the units of the same tissue being alike but differing from the units of other tissues ; and corre- sponding to this difference of structure, the units of different tissues behave or act differently. Instead of all the units as in the amceba doing the same things equally well, the units of one tissue are told off as it were to do one thing especially well, or especially fully, and thus the whole labour of the body is divided among the several tissues. § 7. The several tissues may thus be classified according to the work which they have to do ; and the first great distinction is into (1) the tissues which are concerned in the setting free of energy in special ways, and (2) the tissues which are concerned in replenishing the substance and so renewing the energy of the body. Each physiological unit of the amceba while it is engaged in 1 Such a physiological unit might be called a somacule. INTRODUCTION. 7 setting free energy so as to move itself, and by reason of its sensitiveness so directing that energy as to produce a movement suitable to the conditions of its surroundings, has at the same time to bear the labour of taking in raw food, of selecting that part of the raw food which is useful and rejecting that which is useless, and of working up the accepted part through a variety of stages into its own living substance ; that is to say, it has at the same time that it is feeling and moving to carry on the work of digesting and assimilating. It has moreover at the same time to throw out the waste matters arising from the changes taking place in its own substance, having first brought these waste matters into a condition suitable for being thrown out. § 8. In the body of man, movements, as we shall see, are broadly speaking carried out by means of muscular tissue, and the changes in muscular tissue which lead to the setting free of energy in the form of movement are directed, governed, and adapted to the surroundings of man, by means of nervous tissue. Eays of light fall on the nervous substance of the eye called the retina, and set up in the retina changes which induce in the optic nerve other changes, which in turn are propagated to the brain as oiervous impulses, both the excitation and the propagation involving an expenditure of energy. These nervous impulses reaching the brain may induce other nervous impulses which travelling down certain nerves to certain muscles may lead to changes in those muscles by which they suddenly grow short and pull upon the bones or other structures to which they are attached, in which case we say the man starts ; or the nervous impulses reaching the brain may produce some other effects. Similarly, sound falling on the ear, or contact between the skin and some foreign body, or some change in the air or other surroundings of the body, or some change within the body itself may so affect the nervous tissue of the body that nervous impulses are started and travel to this point or to that, to the brain or elsewhere, and eventually may either reach some muscular tissue and so give rise to movements, or may reach other tissues and produce some other effect. The muscular tissue then may be considered as given up to the production of movement, and the nervous tissue as given up to the generation, transformation, and propagation of nervous impulses. In each case there is an expenditure of energy, which in the case of the muscle, as we shall see, leaves the body partly as heat, and partly as work done, but in the case of nervous tissue is wholly or almost wholly transformed into heat before it leaves the body ; and this expenditure necessitates a replenishment of energy and a renewal of substance. § 9. In order that these master tissues — the nervous and muscular tissues — may carry on their important works to the best advantage, they are relieved of much of the labour that falls upon each physiological unit of the amoeba. They are not presented 8 TISSUES AND OEGANS. with raw food ; they are not required to carry out the necessary transformations of their immediate waste matters. The whole of the rest of the body is engaged (1) in so preparing the raw food, and so bringing it to the nervous and muscular tissues that these may build it up into their own substance with the least trouble ; and (2) in receiving the waste matters which arise in muscular and nervous tissues, and preparing them for rapid and easy ejection from the body. Thus to certain tissues, which we may speak of broadly as ' tissues of digestion,' is allotted the duty of acting on the food and preparing it for the use of the muscular and nervous tissues ; and to other tissues, which we may speak of as ' tissues of excretion,' is allotted the duty of clearing the body from the waste matters generated by the muscular and nervous tissues. § 10. These tissues are for the most part arranged in machines or mechanisms called organs, and the working of these organs in- volves movement. The movements of these organs are carried out, like the other movements of the body, chiefly by means of muscular tissue governed by nervous tissue. Hence we may make a dis- tinction between the muscles which are concerned in producing an effect on the world outside man's body — the muscles by which man does his work in the world — and the muscles which are con- cerned in carrying out the movements of the internal organs ; and we may similarly make a distinction between the nervous tissue concerned in carrying out the external work of the body and that concerned in regulating the movements and, as we shall see, the general conduct of the internal organs. But these two classes of muscular and nervous tissue though distinct in work and, as we shall see, often different in structure, are not separated or isolated. On the contrary, while it is the main duty of the nervous tissue as a whole (the nervous system, as we may call it) to carry out, by means of nervous impulses passing hither and thither, what may be spoken of as the work of man, and in this sense is the master tissue, it also serves as a bond of union between itself and the muscles doing external work on the one hand, and the organs of digestion or excretion on the other, so that the activity and con- duct of the latter may be adequately adapted to the needs of the former. § 11. Lastly, the food prepared and elaborated by the digestive organs is carried and presented to the muscular and nervous tissues in the form of a coniplex fluid known as blood, which driven by means of a complicated mechanism known as the vascular system, circulates all over the body, visiting in turn all the tissues of the body, and by a special arrangement known as the respiratory mechanism, carrying in itself to the several tissues a supply of oxygen as well as of food more properly so called. The motive power of this vascular system is supplied as in the case of the digestive system by means of muscular tissue, the INTRODUCTION. 9 activity of which is simihirly governed by the nervous system, and hence the flow of blood to this part or that part is regulated according to the needs of the part. § 12. The above slight sketch will perhaps suffice to shew not only how numerous but how varied are the problems with which Physiology has to deal. In the first place there are what may be called general prob- lems, such as. How the food after its preparation and elaboration into blood is built up into the living substance of the several tissues ? How the living substance breaks down into the dead waste ? How the building up and breaking down differ in the different tissues in such a way that energy is set free in different modes, — the muscular tissue contracting, the nervous tissue thrill- ing with a nervous impulse, the secreting tissue doing chemical work, and the like ? To these general questions the answers which we can at present give can hardly be called answers at all. In the second place there are what may be called special problems, such as. What are the various steps by which the blood is kept replenished with food and oxygen, and kept free from an accumulation of waste, and how is the activity of the digestive, respiratory, and excretory organs, which effect this, regulated and adapted to the stress of circumstances ? What are the details of the working of the vascular mechanism by which each and every tissue is forever bathed with fresh blood, and how is that working delicately adapted to all the varied changes of the body ? And, compared with which all other special problems are insignifi- cant and preparatory only. How do nervous impulses so flit to and fro within the nervous system as to issue in the movements which make up what we sometimes call the life of man ? It is to these special problems that we must chiefly confine our attention, and we may fitly begin with a study of the blood. BOOK I. BLOOD. THE TISSUES OF MOVEMENT. THE VASCULAE MECHANISM. CHAPTER I. BLOOD. § 13. The several tissues are traversed by minute tubes, — the capillary blood vessels, — to which blood is brought by the arteries, and from which blood is carried away by the veins. These capillaries form networks the meshes of which, differing in form and size in the different tissues, are occupied by the elements of the tissue which consequently lie outside the capillaries. The blood flowing through the capillaries consists, under normal conditions, of an almost colourless fluid, the j>/as??ia, in which are carried a number of bodies, the red and the lohite corpuscles. Outside the capillary walls, filling up such spaces as exist between the capillary walls and the cells or fibres of the tissue, or between the elements of the tissue themselves, is found a colourless fluid, resembling in many respects the plasma of blood and called lyriiph. Thus all the elements of the tissue and the outsides of all the capillaries are bathed with lymph, which, as we shall see hereafter, is continually flowing away from the tissue along special channels to pass into lymphatic vessels and thence into the blood. As the blood flows through the capillaries certain constituents of the plasma (together with, at times, white corpuscles, and under exceptional circumstances red corpuscles) pass through the capillary wall into the lymph, and certain constituents of the lymph pass through the capillary wall into the blood within the capillary. There is thus an interchange of material between the blood within the capillary and the lymph outside. A similar interchange of material is at the same time going on between the lymph and the tissue itself. Hence, by means of the lymph acting as middleman, a double interchange of material takes place between the blood within the capillary and the tissue outside the capillary. In every tissue, so long as life lasts and the blood flows through the blood vessels, a double stream, now rapid now slow, is passing from the blood to the tissue and from the tissue to the blood. The stream from the blood to the tissue carries to the tissue the material which the tissue needs for building itself up and for doing its work, including the all-important oxygen. The 14 BLOOD AN INTERNAL MEDIUM. [Book i. stream from the tissue to the blood carries into the blood certain of the products of the chemical changes which have been taking place in the tissue, — products which may be simple waste, to be cast out of the body as soon as possible, or which may be bodies capable of being made use of by some other tissue. A third stream, that from the lymph lying in the chinks and crannies of the tissue along the lymph channels to the larger lymph vessels, carries away from the tissue such parts of the material coming from the blood as are not taken up by the tissue itself and such parts of the material coming from the tissue as do not find their way into the blood vessel. In most tissues, as in muscle for instance, the capillary net- work is so close set and the muscular fibre lies so near to the blood vessel that the lymph between the two exists only as a very thin sheet ; but in some tissues, as in cartilage, the blood vessels lie on the outside of a large mass of tissue, the interchange be- tween the central parts of which and the nearest capillary blood vessel is carried on through a long stretch of lymph passages. But in each case the principle is the same : the tissue, by the help of lymph, lives on the blood ; and when in succeeding pages we speak of changes between the blood and the tissues, it will be understood, whether expressly stated so or no, that the changes are effected by means of the lymph. The blood may thus be regarded as an internal medium bearing the same relations to the constituent tissues that the external medium, the world, does to the whole individual. Just as the whole organism lives on the things around it, its air and its food, so the several tissues live on the complex fluid by which they are all bathed and which is to them their immediate air and food. All the tissues take up oxygen from the blood and give up carbonic acid to the blood, but not always at the same rate or at the same time. Moreover the several tissues take up from the blood and give up to the blood either different things or the same things at different rates or at different times. From this it follows, on the one hand, that the composition and characters of the blood must be for ever varying in different parts of the body and at different times ; and on the other hand, that the united action of all the tissues must tend to establish and maintain an average uniform composition of the whole mass of blood. The special changes which blood is known to undergo while it passes through the several tissues will best be dealt with when the individual tissues and organs come under our considera- tion. At present it will be sufficient to study the main features which are presented by blood, brought, so to speak, into a state of equilibrium by the common action of all the tissues. Of all these main features of blood, the most striking if not the most important is the property it possesses of clotting when shed. SEC. 1. THE CLOTTING OF BLOOD. § 14. Blood, when shed from the blood vessels of a living l3ody, is perfectly fluid. In a short time it becomes viscid : it flows less readily from vessel to vessel. The viscidity increases rapidly until the whole mass of blood under observation becomes a complete jelly. The vessel into which it has been shed can at this stage be inverted without a drop of the blood being spilt. The jelly is of the same bulk as the previously fluid blood, and if carefully shaken out will present a complete mould of the interior of the vessel. If the blood in this jelly stage be left untouched in a glass vessel, a few drops of an almost colourless fluid soon make their appearance on the surface of the jelly. Increasing in number, and running together, the drops after a while form a superficial layer of pale straw-coloured fluid. Later on, similar layers of the same fluid are seen at the sides and finally at the bottom of the jelly, which, shrunk to a smaller size and of firmer consistency, now forms a clot or crassamentum, floating in a perfectly fluid serum. The shrinking and condensation of the clot, and the corresponding increase of the serum, continue for some time. The upper surface of the clot is generally slightly concave. A portion of the clot examined under the microscope is seen to consist of a feltwork of fine granular fibrils, in the meshes of which are entangled the red and white corpuscles of the blood. In the serum nothing can be seen but a few stray corpuscles, chiefly white. The fibrils are composed of a substance called fibrin. Hence we may speak of the clot as consisting of fibrin and corpuscles ; and the act of clotting is obviously a substitution for the plasma of fibrin and serum, followed by a separation of the fibrin and corpuscles from the serum. In man, blood when shed becomes viscid in about two or three minutes, and enters the jelly stage in about five or ten minutes. After the lapse of another few minutes the first drops of serum are seen, and clotting is generally complete in from one 16 PHEI^OMEN"A OF CLOTTING. [Book i. to several hours. The times however will be found to vary accord- ing to circumstances. Among animals the rapidity of clotting varies exceedingly in different species. The blood of the horse clots with remarkable slowness ; so slowly indeed that many of the red and also some of the white corpuscles (both these being speci- fically heavier than the plasma) have time to sink before viscidity sets in. In consequence there appears on the surface of the blood an upper layer of colourless plasma, containing in its deeper por- tions many colourless corpuscles (which are lighter than the red). This layer clots like the other parts of the blood, forming the so- called ' buffy coat.' A similar buffy coat is sometimes seen in the blood of man, in certain abnormal conditions of the body. If a portion of horse's blood be surrounded by a cooling mixture of ice and salt, and thus kept at about 0°C., clotting may be almost indefinitely postponed. Under these circumstances a more complete descent of the corpuscles takes place, and a considerable quantity of colourless transparent plasma free from blood-corpuscles may be obtained. A portion of this plasma removed from the freezing mixture clots in the same manner as does the entire blood. It first becomes viscid and then forms a jelly, which subsequently separates into a colourless shrunken clot and serum. This shews that the corpuscles are not an essential part of the clot. If a few cubic centimetres of this colourless plasma, or of a similar plasma which may be obtained from almost any blood by means which we will presently describe, be diluted with many times its bulk of a 0-6 p.c. solution of sodium chloride^ clotting is much retarded, and the various stages may be more easily watched. As the fluid is becoming viscid, fine fibrils of fibrin will be seen to be developed in it, especially at the sides of the containing vessel. As these fibrils multiply in number, the fluid becomes more and more of the consistence of a jelly and at the same time somewhat opaque. Stirred or pulled about with a needle, the fibrils shrink up into a small, opaque, stringy mass ; and a very considerable bulk of the jelly may by agitation be resolved into a minute fragment of shrunken fibrin floating in a quantity of what is really diluted serum. If a specimen of such diluted plasma be stirred from time to time, as soon as clotting begins, with a needle or glass rod, the fibrin may be removed piecemeal as it forms, and the jelly stage may be altogether done away with. When fresh blood which has not yet had time to clot is stirred or whipped with a bundle of rods (or anything presenting a large amount of rough surface), no jelly-like clotting takes place, but the rods become covered with a mass of shrunken fibrin. Blood thus whipped until fibrin ceases to be deposited, is found to have entirely lost its power of clotting. 1 A solution of sodium chloride of this strength will hereafter be spoken of as 'normal saline solution.' Chap, i.] BLOOD. 17 Putting these facts together, it is very clear that the pheno- mena of the clotting of blood are caused by the appearance in the plasma of fine fibrils of fibrin. So long as these are scanty, the blood is simply viscid. When they become sutticiently numerous, they give the blood the firmness of a jelly. Soon after their formation they begin to shrink, and while shrinking enclose in their meshes the corpuscles but squeeze out the fiuid parts of the blood. Hence the appearance of the shrunken coloured clot and the colourless serum. § 15. Fibrin, whether obtained by whipping freshly-shed blood, or by washing either a normal clot, or a clot obtained from colour- less plasma, exhibits the same general characters. It belongs to that class of complex unstable nitrogenous bodies called proteids which form a large portion of all living bodies and an essential part of all living structures. Our knowledge of proteids is at present too imperfect, and probably none of them have yet been prepared in adequate purity, to justify us in attempting to assign to them any definite formula ; but it is important to remember their general composition. 100 parts of a proteid contain rather more than 50 parts of carbon, rather more than 15 of nitrogen, about 7 of hydrogen, and rather more than 20 of oxygen ; that is to say, they contain about half their weight of carbon, and only about ^th their weight of nitrogen ; and yet as we shall see they are eminently the nitrogenous sub- stances of the body. They usually contain a small quantity (1 or 2 p.c.) of sulphur, and many also have some phosphorus attached to them in some way or other. When burnt they leave a variable quantity of ash, consisting of inorganic salts of which the bases are chiefly sodium and potassium and the acids chiefly hydrochloric, sulphuric, phosphoric, and carbonic. They all give certain reactions, by which their presence may be recognised ; of these the most characteristic are the following : Boiled with nitric acid they give a yellow colour, which deepens into orange upon the addition of ammonia. This is called the xantlioioroteic test ; the colour is due to a product of decomposi- tion. Boiled with the mixture of mercuric and mercurous nitrates known as Millon's reagent they give a pink colour. Mixed with a strong solution of sodic hydrate they give on the addition of a drop or two of a very weak solution of cupric sul- phate a violet colour which deepens on heating. These are artificial reactions, not throwing much if any light on the constitution of proteids ; but they are useful as practical tests enabling us to detect the presence of proteids. The several members of the proteid group are at present dis- tinguished from each other chiefly by their respective solubilities, especially in various saline solutions. Fibrin is one of the least soluble ; it is insoluble in water, almost insoluble in dilute neutral saline solutions, very sparingly soluble in more concentrated 2 18 PROTEIDS OF SERUM. [Book i. neutral saline solutions and in dilute acids and alkalis, but is easily dissolved in strong acids and alkalis. In the process of solution it becomes changed into something which is no longer fibrin. In dilute acids it swells up and becomes transparent, but when the acid is neutralized returns to its previous condition. When suspended in water and heated to 100° C. or even to 75° C, it becomes changed ; it is still less soluble than before. It is said in this case to be coagulated by the heat ; and as we shall see, nearly all proteids have the property of being changed in nature, of undergoing coagulation and so becoming less soluble than before, by being exposed to a certain high temperature. Fibrin then is a proteid distinguished from other proteids by its smaller solubility ; it is further distinguished by its peculiar filamentous structure, the other proteids when obtained in a solid form appearing either in amorphous granules or at most in viscid masses. § 16. We may now return to the serum. This is perfectly fluid, and remains fluid until it decomposes. It is of a faint straw colour, due to the presence of a special pigment substance, differing from the red matter which gives redness to the red corpuscles. Tested by the xanthoproteic and other tests it obviously contains a large quantity of proteid matter, and upon examination we find that at least two distinct proteid substances are present in it. If crystals of magnesium sulphate be added to serum and gently stirred until they dissolve, it will be seen that the serum as it approaches saturation with the salt becomes turbid instead of remaining clear, and eventually a white amorphous granular or flocculent precipitate makes its appearance. This precipitate may be separated by decantation or filtration, washed with saturated •solutions of magnesium sulphate, in which it is insoluble, until it is freed from all other constituents of the serum, and thus obtained fairly pure. It is then found to be a proteid body, distinguished by the following characters among others : — 1. It is (when freed from any adherent magnesium sulphate) insoluble in distilled water ; it is insoluble in concentrated solutions of neutral saline bodies, such as magnesium sulphate, sodium chloride, &c., but readily soluble in dilute (e.g. 1 p.c) solutions of the same neutral saline bodies. Hence from its solutions in the latter it may be precipitated either by adding more neutral saline substance or by removing by dialysis the small quantity of saline substance present. When obtained in a precipitated form, and suspended in distilled water, it readily dissolves into a clear solution upon the addition of a small quan- tity of some neutral saline body. By these various solutions and precipitations it is not really changed in nature. 2. It readily dissolves in very dilute acids (e.g. in hydro- Chap, i.] BLOOD. 19 chloric acid even when dihited to far less than 1 p.c), and it is similarly soluble in dilute alkalis; but in being thus dissolved it is changed in nature, and the solutions of it in dilute acid and dilute alkalis give reactions quite different from those of the solution of the substance in dilute neutral saline solutions. By the acid it is converted into what is called acid-alhumin, by the alkali into alhali-albumin, both of which bodies we shall have to study later on. 3. When it is suspended in water and heated it becomes altered in character, coagulated, and all its reactions are changed. It is no longer soluble in dilute neutral saline solutions, not even in dilute acids and alkalis ; it has become coagulated irrotcid, and is now even less soluble than fresh fibrin. When a solution of it in dilute neutral saline solution is similarly heated, a similar change takes place : a precipitate falls down which on examination is found to be coagulated proteid. The temperature at which this change takes place is somewhere about 75° C, though shift- ing slightly according to the quantity of saline substance present in the solution. The above three reactions are given by a number of proteid bodies forming a group called glolulins, and the particular globulin present in blood-serum, is called jyaraglohidin. One of the proteids present in blood-serum is then para- globulin, characterised by its solubility in dilute neutral saline solutions ; its insolubility in distilled water and concentrated saline solutions ; its ready solubility, and at the same time conversion into other bodies, in dilute acids and alkalis ; and in its becoming converted into coagulated proteid, and so being precipitated from its solutions at 75° C. The amount of it present in blood-serum varies in various animals, and apparently in the same animal at different times. In 100 parts by weight of serum there are generally present about 8 or 9 parts of proteids altogether ; and of these some 3 or 4, more or less, may be taken as paraglobulin. § 17. If the serum from which the paraglobulin has been precipitated by the addition of neutral salt, and removed by fil- tration, be subjected to dialysis, the salt added may be removed, and a clear, somewhat diluted serum free from paraglobulin may be obtained. This still gives abundant proteid reactions, so that the serum still contains a proteid, or some proteids still more soluble than the globulins, since they will remain in solution, and are not precipitated, even when dialysis is continued until the serum is practically freed from both the neutral salt added to it and the diffusible salts previously present in the natural serum. When this serum is heated to 75° C. a precipitate makes its appearance ; the proteids still present are coagulated at this temperature. 20 PROTEIDS OF SERUM. [Book i. We have some reasons for thinking that more than one proteid is present ; but they are all closely allied to each other, and we may for the present speak of them as if they were one, and call the proteid left in serum, after removal of the paraglobulin, by the name of albumin, or, to distinguish it from other albumins found elsewhere, serum-albumin. Serum-albumin is distinguished by being more soluble than the globulins, since it is soluble in dis- tilled water, even in the absence of all neutral salts. Like the globulins, though with much less ease, it is converted by dilute acids and dilute alkalis into acid- or into alkali-albumin. The percentage amount of serum-albumin in serum may be put down as 4 or 5, more or less ; but it varies, and sometimes is less abundant than paraglobulin. In some animals (snakes) it is said to disappear during starvation. The more important characters of the three proteids which we have just studied may be stated as follows : — Soluble in water and in saline solutions of all strengths - . serum-albumin. Insoluble in water, readily soluble in dilute saline solutions, insoluble in concentrated saline solutions paraglobulin. Insoluble in water, hardly soluble at all in dilute saline solutions, and very little solu- ble in more concentrated saline solutions . fibrin. Besides paraglobulin and serum-albumin, serum contains a very large number of substances, generally in small quantity, which, since they have to be extracted by special methods, are called extractives ; of these some are nitrogenous, some non- nitrogenous. Serum contains in addition important inorganic saline substances ; but to these we shall return. § 18. With the knowledge which we have gained of the pro- teids of clotted blood we may go back to the question : Clotting being due to the appearance in blood plasma of a proteid sub- stance, fibrin, which previously did not exist in it as such, what are the causes which lead to the appearance of fibrin ? We learn something by studying the most important external circumstances which affect the rapidity with which the blood of the same individual clots when shed. These are as follows : — A temperature of about 40° C, which is about or slightly above the temperature of the blood of warm-blooded animals, is perhaps the most favourable to clotting. A further rise of a few degrees is apparently also beneficial, or at least not injurious ; but upon a still further rise the effect changes, and when blood is rapidly heated to 56° C. no clotting at all may take place. At this temperature certain proteids of the blood are coagulated and precipitated before clotting can take place, and with this change the power of the blood to clot is wholly lost. If however the heating be not Chap, i.] BLOOD. 21 very rapid, the blood may clot before this change has time to come on. When the temperature instead of being raised is lowered below 40° C. the clotting becomes delayed and prolonged ; and at the temperature of 0° or 1° C. the blood will remain fluid, and yet capable of clotting when withdrawn from the adverse circumstances, for a very long, it might almost be said for an indefinite, time. A small quantity of blood shed into a small vessel clots sooner than a large quantity shed into a larger one ; and in general the greater the amount of foreign surface with which the blood comes in contact the more rapid the clotting. When shed blood is stirred or " whipped " the fibrin makes its appearance sooner than when the blood is left to clot in the ordinary way ; so that here too the accelerating infiuence of contact with foreign bodies makes itself felt. Similarly, movement of shed blood hastens clotting, since it increases the amount of contact with foreign bodies. So also the addition of spongy platinum or of powdered charcoal, or of other inert powders, to tardily clotting blood, will by infiuence of surface, hasten clotting. Conversely, blood brought into contact with pure oil does not clot so rapidly as when in contact with glass or metal ; and blood will continue to flow for a longer time without clotting through a tube smeared inside with oil than through a tube not so smeared. The influence of the oil in such cases is a physical not a chemical one ; any pure, neutral, inert oil will do. As far as we know, these influences affect only the rapidity with which the clotting takes place ; that is, the rapidity with which the fibrin makes its appearance, not the amount of clot, not the quan- tity of fibrin formed, though when clotting is very much retarded by cold changes may ensue whereby the amount of clotting which eventually takes place is indirectly affected. Mere exposure to air exerts apparently little influence on the process of clotting. Blood collected direct from a blood-vessel over mercury so as wholly to exclude the air, clots, in a general way, as readily as blood freely exposed to the air. It is only when blood is much laden with carbonic acid, the presence of which is antagonistic to clotting, that exclusion of air, by hindering the escape of the excess of carbonic acid, delays clotting. These facts teach us that fibrin does not as was once thought make its appearance in shed blood because the blood when shed ceases to share in the movement of the circulation, or because the blood is cooled on leaving the warm body, or because the blood is then more freely exposed to the air ; they further suggest the view that the fibrin is the result of some chemical change, the conversion into fibrin of something which is not fibrin, the change like other chemical changes being most active at an optimum temperature, and like so many other chemical changes being assisted by the influences exerted by the presence of inert bodies. And we have direct experimental evidence that plasma does contain an antecedent of fibrin which by chemical change is converted into fibrin. 22 PLASMA. [Book I. § 19. If blood be received direct from the blood-vessels into one-third its bulk of a saturated solution of some neutral salt such as magnesium sulphate, and the two gently but thoroughly mixed, clotting, especially at a moderately low temperature, will be deferred for a very long time. If the mixture be allowed to stand, the corpuscles will sink, and a colourless plasma will be obtained similar to the plasma gained from horse's blood by cold, except that it contains an excess of the neutral salt. The presence of the neutral salt has acted in the same direction as cold : it has prevented the occurrence of clotting. It has not destroyed the fibrin ; for if some of the plasma be diluted with from five to ten times its bulk of water, it will clot speedily in quite a normal fashion, with the production of quite normal fibrin. The separation of the fluid plasma from the corpuscles and from other bodies heavier than the plasma is much facilitated by the use of the centrifugal machine. This consists essentially of a tireless wheel with several spokes, placed in a horizontal position and made to revolve with great velocity (1000 revolutions per minute for instance) round its axis. Tubes of metal or very strong glass are suspended at the ends of the spokes by carefully adjusted joints. As the wheel rotates with increasing velocity, each tube gradually assumes a horizontal position, bottom outwards, without spilling any of its contents. As the rapid rotation continues the corpuscles and heavier particles are driven to the bottom of the tube, and if a very rapid movement be continued for a long time will form a compact cake at the bottom of the tube. When the rotation is stopped the tubes gradually return to their upright posi- tion again without anything being spilt, and the clear plasma in each tube can then be decanted off. If some of the colourless, transparent plasma, obtained either by the action of neutral salts from any blood, or by the help of cold from horse's blood, be treated with some solid neutral salt, such as sodium chloride, to saturation, a white, flaky, somewhat sticky precipitate will make its appearance. If this precipitate be removed, the fluid no longer possesses the power of clotting (or very slightly so), even though the neutral salt present be removed by dialysis, or its influence lessened by dilution. With the re- moval of the substance precipitated, the plasma has lost its power of clotting. If the precipitate itself, after being washed with a saturated solution of the neutral salt (in which it is insoluble) so as to get rid of all serum and other constituents of the plasma, be treated with a small quantity of water, it readily dissolves,^ and the solution rapidly filtered gives a clear, colourless filtrate, which is at first perfectly fluid. Soon, however, the fluidity gives way to 1 The substance itself is not sohible in distilled water, but a quantity of the neutral salts always clings to the precipitate, and thus the addition of water virtually gives rise to a dilute saline solution, in which the substance is readily soluble. Chap. i.J BLOOD. 23 viscidity, and this in turn to a jelly condition, and finally the jelly shrinks into a clot floating in a clear fluid ; in other words, the filtrate clots like plasma. Thus there is present in cooled plasma, and in plasma kept from clotting by the presence of neutral salts, a something, precipitable by saturation with neutral salts ; a some- thing which, since it is soluble in very dilute saline solutions, cannot be fibrin itself, but which in solution speedily gives rise to the appearance of fibrin. To this substance its discoverer, Denis, gave the name of plasminc. The substance thus precipitated is not however a single body but a mixture of at least two bodies. If sodium chloride be carefully added to plasma to an extent of about 13 per cent, a white, flaky, viscid precipitate is thrown down very much like plasmine. If after the removal of the first precipitate more sodium chloride and especially if magnesium sulphate be added, a second precipitate is thrown down, less viscid and more granular than the first. The second precipitate when examined is found to be identical with the paraglohulin, coagulating at 75° C, which we have already seen to be a constituent of serum. The first precipitate is also a proteid belonging to the globulin group, but differs from paraglobulin not only in being more readily precipitated by sodium chloride, and in being when precipitated more viscid, but also in other respects, and especially in being coagulated at a far lower temperature than paraglobulin, viz. at 56° C. Now, while isolated paraglobulin cannot by any means known to us be converted into fibrin, and its presence in the so-called plasmine does not seem to be essential to the for- mation of fibrin out of plasmine, the presence in plasmine of the body coagulating at 56° C. does seem essential to the conversion of plasmine into fibrin ; and we have reason for thinking that it is itself converted, in part at least, into fibrin. Hence it has received the name of fibrinogen. § 20. The reasons for this view are as follows. Besides blood, which clots naturally when shed, there are certain fluids in the body which do not clot naturally, either in the body or when shed, but which by certain artificial means may be made to clot, and in clotting to yield quite normal fibrin. Thus the so-called serous fluid taken some hours after death^ from the pericardial, pleural, or peritoneal cavities, the fluid found in the enlarged serous sac of the testis, known as hydrocele fluid, and other similar fluids, will in the majority of cases, when obtained free from blood or other admixtures, remain fluid almost indefinitely, shewing no disposition whatever to clot.- Yet in most cases at 1 If it be removed immediately after death it generally clots readily and firmly, giving a colourless clot consisting of fibrin and white corpuscles. - In some specimens, however, a spontaneous coagulation, generally slight, but in exceptional cases massive, may be observed. 24 FIBRm FERMENT. [Book i. all events, these fluids, when a little blood, or a piece of blood clot, or a little serum is added to them, will clot rapidly and firmly,^ giving rise to an unmistakeable clot of normal fibrin, differing only from the clot of blood in that, when serum is used, it is colourless, being free from red corpuscles. Now, blood (or blood clot, or serum) contains many things, to any one of which the clotting power thus seen might be attributed. But it is found that in many cases clotting may be induced in the fluids of which we are speaking by the mere addition and that even in exceedingly small quantity, of a substance which can be extracted from blood, or from serum, or from blood clot, or even from washed fibrin, or indeed from other sources, — a substance whose exact nature is uncertain, it being doubtful whether it is a proteid at all, and whose action is peculiar. If serum, or whipped blood, or a broken-up clot be mixed with a large quantity of alcohol and allowed to stand some days, the proteids present are in time so changed by the alcohol as to become insoluble in water. Hence if the copious precipitate caused by the alcohol, after long standing, be separated by filtration from the alcohol, dried at a low temperature, not exceeding 40° C, and extracte'd with distilled water, the aqueous extract contains very little proteid matter, — indeed very little organic matter at all. Nevertheless even a small quantity of this aqueous extract added alone to certain specimens of hydrocele fluid or other of the fluids spoken of above, will bring about a speedy clotting. The same aqueous extract has also a remarkable effect in hastening the clotting of fluids which, though they will eventually clot, do so very slowly. Thus, plasma may, by the careful addition of a certain quantity of neutral salt and water, be reduced to such a condition that it clots very slowly indeed, taking perhaps days to complete the process. The addition of a small quantity of the aqueous extract we are describing will, however, bring about a clotting which is at once rapid and complete. The active substance, whatever it be, in this aqueous extract exists in small quantity only, and its clotting virtues are at once and for ever lost when the solution is boiled. Further, there is no reason to think that the active substance actually enters into the formation of the fibrin to which it gives rise. It appears to belong to a class of bodies playing an important part in physiological processes and called ferments, of which we shall have more to say hereafter. We may therefore speak of it as the fibrin ferment, the name given to it by its discoverer Alexander Schmidt. This fibrin ferment is present in and may be extracted from clotted or whipped blood, and from both the clot ^ and the serum of clotted blood ; and since in most if not all cases where blood or ■^ In a few cases no coagulation can thus be induced. 2 A powerful solution of fibrin ferment may be readily prepared by simply extracting a washed blood clot with a 10 p.c. solution of sodium chloride. Chap, i.] BLOOD. 26 blood clot or serum produces clotting in hydrocele or pericardial fluid, an exactly similar clotting may be induced by the mere addition of fibrin ferment, we seem justified in concluding that the clotting virtues of the former are due to the ferment which they contain. Now, when fibrinogen is precipitated from plasma as above described by sodium chloride, re-dissolved, and reprecipitated, more than once, it may be obtained in solution, by help of a dilute neutral saline solution, in an approximately pure condition, at all events free from other proteids. Such a solution will not clot spontaneously ; it may remain fluid indefinitely ; and yet on the addition of a little fibrin ferment it will clot readily and firmly, yielding quite normal fibrin. This body fibrinogen is also present and may be separated out from the specimens of hydrocele, pericardial, and other fluids which clot on the addition of fibrin ferment ; and when the fibrinogen has been wholly removed from these fluids they refuse to clot on the addition of fibrin ferment. Paraglobulin, on the other hand, whether prepared from plasmine by separation of the fibrinogen, or from serum, or from other fluids in which it is found, cannot be converted by fibrin ferment or indeed by any other means into fibrin. And fibrinogen isolated as described above, or serous fluids which contain fibrinogen, can be made, by means of fibrin ferment, to yield quite normal fibrin in the complete absence of paraglobulin. A solution of paraglobulin obtained from serum or blood clot will, it is true, clot pericardial or hydrocele fluids containing fibrinogen, or indeed a solution of fibrinogen ; but this is apparently due to the fact that the paraglobulin has in these cases some fibrin ferment mixed with it ; it is also possible that under certain conditions the presence of paraglobulin may be favourable to the action of the ferment. When the so-called plasmine is precipitated as directed in § 19, fibrin ferment is carried down with the fibrinogen and para- globulin ; and when the plasmine is re-dissolved the ferment is present in the solution and ready to act on the fibrinogen. Hence the re-dissolved plasmine clots spontaneously. When fibrinogen is isolated from plasma by repeated precipitation and solution, the ferment is washed away from it, and the pure ferment-free fibrm- ogen, ultimately obtained, does not clot spontaneously. So far it seems clear that there does exist a proteid body, fibrinogen, which may by the action of fibrin ferment be directly, without the intervention of other proteids, converted into the less soluble fibrin. Our knowledge of the constitution of proteid bodies is too imperfect to enable us to make any very definite statement as to the exact nature of the change thus effected ; but we may say this much: Fibrinogen and fibrin have about the same elementary composition, fibrin containing a trifle more 26 FIBEINOGEN AND FIBKIK [Book i. nitrogen. "When fibrinogen is converted into fibrin by means of fibrin ferment, the weight of the fibrin produced is always less than that of the fibrinogen which is consumed, and there is always produced at the same time a certain quantity of another proteid, iDelonging to the globulin family. There are reasons however why we cannot speak of the ferment as splitting up fibrinogen into fibrin and a globulin. It seems more probable that the ferment converts the fibrinogen first into a body which we might call soluble fihrin, and then turns this body into veritable fibrin ; but further inquiries on the subject are needed. The action of the fibrin ferment on fibrinogen is dependent on other conditions besides temperature ; for instance, the presence of a calcium salt seems to be necessary. If blood be shed into a dilute solution of potassium oxalate, the mixture, which need not contain more than l p.c. of the oxalate, remains fluid indefinitely, but clots readily on the addition of a small quantity of a calcium salt. Apparently the oxalate, by precipitating the calcium salts present in the Ijlood, prevents the conversion of the fibrinogen into fibrin. So also a solution of fibrinogen which has been deprived of its calcium salts, by diffusion for instance, will not clot on the addition of fibrin ferment similarly deprived of its calcium salts ; but the mixture clots readily on the addition of a minute quantity of calcium sulphate. We shall have to speak later on of a somewhat analogous part played by calcium salts in the curdling of milk. It may be added that the presence of other neutral salts, such as sodium chloride, appears to influence clotting. § 21.. We may conclude then that the plasma of blood when shecl, or at all events soon after it has been shed, contains fibrino- gen; and it also seems probable that the clotting comes about because the fibrinogen is converted into fibrin by the action of fibrin ferment ; but we are still far from a definite answer to the question, why blood remains fluid in the body and yet clots when shed ? We have already said that blood or blood plasma, brought up to a temperature of 56° C. as soon as possible after its removal from the living blood vessels, gives a proteid precipitate and loses its power of clotting. This may be taken to shew that blood, as it circulates in the living blood vessels, contains fibrinogen as such, and that when the blood is heated to 56° C, which is the coagu- lating point of fibrinogen, the fibrinogen present is coagulated and precipitated, and consequently no fibrin can be formed. Further, while clotted blood undoubtedly contains an abundance of fibrin ferment, no ferment, or a minimal quantity only, is present in blood as it leaves the blood vessels. If blood be received directly from the blood vessels into alcohol, the aqueous extract prepared as directed above contains no ferment, or merely a trace. Appa- rently the ferment makes its appearance in the blood as the result of changes taking place in the blood after it has been shed. CiiAr. I.] BLOOD. 27 We might from this be indmed to conclude that blood clots when shed but not before, because, fibrinogen being always present, the shedding brings about changes which produce fibrin ferment, not previously existing, and this acting on the fibrinogen gives rise to fibrin. But we meet with the following difficulty. A very considerable quantity of very active ferment may be injected into the blood current of a living animal without necessarily producing any clotting at all. Obviously, either blood within the blood vessels does not contain fibrinogen as such, and the fibrinogen detected by heating the blood to 56° 0. is the result of changes which have already ensued before that temperature is reached ; or in the living circulation there are agencies at work which prevent any ferment which may be introduced into the circula- tion from producing its usual effects on fibrinogen ; or there are agencies at work which destroy or do away with the fibrin, little by little, as it is formed. § 22. And indeed when we reflect how complex blood is, and of what many and great changes it is susceptible, we shall not wonder that the question we are putting cannot be answered off hand. The corpuscles with which blood is crowded are living structures, and consequently are continually acting upon and being acted upon by the plasma. The red corpuscles it is true are, as we shall see, peculiar bodies, with a restricted life and a very specialized work, and possibly their influence on the plasma is not very great ; but we have reason to think that the relations between the white corpuscles and the plasma are close and important. Then again the blood is not only acting upon and being acted upon by the several tissues as it flows through the various capillaries, but along the whole of its course, through the heart, arteries, capillaries, and veins, is acting upon and being acted upon by the vascular walls, which like the rest of the body are alive, and being alive are continually undergoing and promoting change. That relations of some kind, having a direct influence on the clotting of blood, do exist between the blood and the vascular walls is shewn by the following facts. After death, when all motion of the blood has ceased, the blood remains for a long time fluid. It is not till some time afterwards, at an epoch when post-mortem changes in the blood and in the blood vessels have had time to develope themselves, that clotting begins. Thus, some hours after death the blood in the great veins may be found still perfectly fluid. Yet such blood has not lost its _ power of clotting ; it still clots when removed from the body, and clots too when received over mercury without exposure to air, shewing that, though the blood, being highly venous, is rich in carbonic acid and contains little or no oxygen, its fluidity is not due to any excess of carbonic acid or absence of oxy- gen. Eventually it does clot even within the vessels, but perhaps 28 INFLUENCE OF BLOOD VESSELS. [Book i. never so firmly and completely as when shed. It clots first in the larger vessels, but remains fluid in the smaller vessels for a very long time, for many hours in fact, since in these the same bulk of blood is exposed to the influence of, and reciprocally exerts an influence on, a larger surface of the vascular walls than in the larger vessels. And if it be urged that the result is here due to influences exerted by the body at large, by the tissues as well as by the vascular walls, this objection will not hold good against the following experiment. If the jugular vein of a large animal, such as an ox or horse, be carefully ligatured when full of blood, and the ligatured portion excised, the blood in many cases remains perfectly fluid, along the greater part of the length of the piece, for twenty-four or even forty-eight hours. The piece so ligatured may be suspended in a framework and opened at the top so as to imitate a living test-tube, and yet the blood will often remain long fluid, though a portion removed at any time into a glass or other vessel will clot in a few minutes. If two such living test-tubes be prepared, the blood may be poured from one to the other without clotting taking place. A similar relation of the fluid to its containing living wall is seen in the case of those serous fluids which clot spontaneously. If, so soon after death as the body is cold and the fat is solidified, the pericardium be carefully removed from a sheep by an incision round the base of the heart, the pericardial fluid (which, as we have already seen, during life, and some little time after death, possesses the power of clotting) may be kept in the pericardial bag as in a living cup for many hours without clotting, and yet a small portion removed with a pipette clots at once. This relation between the blood and the vascular wall may be disturbed or overridden ; clotting may take place or may be induced within the living blood vessel. When the lining membrane is injured, as when an artery or vein is sharply ligatured, or when it is diseased, as for instance in aneurism, a clot is apt to be formed at the injured or diseased spot ; and in certain morbid conditions of the body clots are formed in various vascular tracts. Absence of motion, which in shed blood, as we have seen, is unfavourable to clotting, is apt within the body to lead to clotting. Thus when an artery is ligatured, the blood in the tract of artery on the cardiac side of the ligature, between the ligature and the branch last given off by the artery, ceasing to share in the circulation, remains motionless or nearly so, and along this tract a clot forms, firmest next to the ligature and ending near where the branch is given off; this perhaps may be explained by the fact that the walls of the tract suffer in their nutrition by the stagnation of the blood, and that consequently the normal relation between them and the contained blood is disturbed. That the blood within the living blood vessels, though not actually clotting under normal circumstances, may easily be made to clot, that the blood is in fact so to speak always on the point Chap, i.] BLOOD. 29 of clotting, is shewn by the fact that a foreign body, such as a needle thrust into the interior of a blood vessel or a thread drawn through and left in a blood vessel, is apt to become covered with fibrin. Some influence exerted by the needle or thread, whatever may be the character of that influence, is sufficient to determine a clotting which otherwise would not have taken place. The same instability of the blood as regards clotting is strikingly shewn, in the case of the rabbit at least, by the result of injecting into the blood vessels a small quantity of a solution of a peculiar proteid prepared from certain structures such as the thymus body. Massive clotting of the blood in almost all the blood vessels, small and large, takes place with great rapidity, leading to the sudden death of the animal. In contrast to this effect may be mentioned the result of injecting into the blood vessels of a dog a quantity of a solution of a body called cdhumose, of which we shall hereafter have to treat as a product of the digestion of proteid substances, to the extent of 3 grm. per kilo of body weight. So far from producing clotting, the injected albumose has such an effect on the blood that for several hours after the injection shed blood will refuse to clot of itself and remain quite fluid, though it can be made to clot by special treatment. § 23. All the foregoing facts tend to shew that the blood as it is flowing through the healthy blood vessels is, so far as clotting is concerned, in a state of unstable equilibrium, which may at any moment be upset, even within the blood vessels, and which is upset directly the blood is shed, with clotting as a result. Our present knowledge does not permit us to make an authoritative statement as to the exact nature of this equilibrium. There are reasons how- ever for thinking that the white corpuscles play an important part in the matter. Wherever clotting occurs naturally, white corpuscles are present ; and this is true not only of blood but also of such specimens of pericardial or other serous fluids as clot naturally. When horse's blood is kept fluid by being retained within the jugular vein, as mentioned a little while back, and the vein is hung upright, the corpuscles both red and white sink, leaving an upper layer of plasma almost free from corpuscles. This upper layer will be found to have lost largely its power of clotting spon- taneously, though the power is at once regained if the white corpuscles from the layers beneath be returned to it. And many other arguments, which we cannot enter upon here, may be adduced, all pointing to the same conclusion, that the white corpuscles play an important part in the process of clotting. But it would lead us too far into controversial matters to attempt to define what that part is, or to explain the exact nature of the equilibrium of which we have spoken, or to discuss such questions as, Whether the ordinary white corpuscles, or corpuscles of a special kind, are con- cerned in the matter ? Whether the corpuscles, when clotting takes place, give out something, — e.g., fibrinogen or ferment or both or 30 CLOTTING OF BLOOD. [Book i. something else, — or whether the corpuscles simply in some way or other assist in the transformation of some previously existing con- stituents of the plasma ? Whether the influence exerted by the condition of the vascular wall is exerted directly on the plasma or indirectly on the corpuscles ? Whether, as some have thought, the peculiar bodies of which we shall presently speak under the name of hlood platelets have any share in the matter, and if so what ? These questions are too involved and the discussion of them too long to be entered upon here. What we do know is that in blood soon after it has been shed, the body which we have called fibrinogen is present, as also the body which we have called fibrin ferment ; that the latter acting on the former will produce fibrin ; and that the appearance of fibrin is undoubtedly the cause of what is called clotting. We seem justified in concluding that the clotting of shed blood is due to the conversion by ferment of fibrinogen into fibrin. The further inference that clotting within the body is the same thing as clotting outside the body and similarly due to the transformation of fibrinogen by ferment into fibrin, though probable, is not proved. We do not yet know the exact nature and condition of the blood within the' living blood vessels ; and until we know that we cannot satisfactorily explain why blood in the living blood vessels is usually fluid but can at times clot. SEC. 2. THE CORPUSCLES OF THE BLOOD. The Bed Corpuscles. § 24. The redness of blood is due exclusively to the red corpuscles. The plasma as seen in thin layers within the living blood vessels appears colourless, as does also a thin layer of serum ; but a thick layer of serum (and probably of plasma) has a faint yellowish tinge, due as we have said to the presence of a small quantity of a special pigment. The corpuscles appear under the microscope as fairly homo- geneous, imperfectly translucent biconcave discs with a diameter of 7 to 8 /u, and a thickness of 1 to 2/x. Being discs they are circular in outline when seen on the flat, but rod-shaped when seen in pro- file as they are turning over. Being biconcave, with a thicker rounded rim surrounding a thinner centre, the rays of light in passing through them, when they are examined by transmitted light, are more refracted at the rim than in the centre. The effect of this is that, when viewed at what may be considered the proper focus, the centre of a corpuscle appears clear, while a slight opacity marks out indistinctly the inner margin of the thicker rim ; whereas, when the focus is shifted either up or down, the centre becomes dark and the rest of the corpuscle clear. Any body of the same shape, and composed of substance of the same refractive power, would produce the same optical effects. Otherwise the corpuscle appears homogeneous without distinction of parts and without a nucleus. A single corpuscle seen by itself has a very faint colour, looking yellow rather than red, but when several corpuscles lie one upon the top of the other the mass is distinctly red. The red corpuscle is elastic, in the sense that it may be deformed by pressure or traction, but when the pressure or traction is re- moved regains its previous form. Its shape is also much influenced by the physical conditions of the plasma, serum, or fluid in which for the time being it is. If the plasma or serum be diluted with water, the disc, absorbing water, swells up into a sphere, becoming 32 STEUCTUEE OF EED COEPUSCLE. [Book i. a disc again on the removal of the dilution. If the serum be concentrated, the disc, giving out water, shrinks irregularly and assumes various forms ; one of these forms is that of a number of blunted protuberances projecting all over the surface of the corpuscle, which is then said to be crenate. In a drop of blood examined under the microscope, crenate corpuscles are often seen at the edge of the cover slip where evaporation is leading to concentration of the plasma, or, as it should then perhaps rather be called, serum. In blood just shed the red corpuscles are apt to adhere to each other by their flat surfaces, much more than to the glass or other surface with which the blood is in contact, and hence arrange themselves in rolls. This tendency however to form rolls very soon diminishes after the blood is shed. Though a single corpuscle is somewhat translucent, a compara- tively thin layer of blood is opaque ; type for instance cannot be read through even a thin layer of blood. When a quantity of whipped blood (or blood otherwise de- prived of fibrin) is frozen and thawed several times it changes colour, becoming of a darker hue, and is then found to be much more transparent, so that type can now be easily read through a moderately thin layer. It is then spoken of as laky Mood. The same change may be effected by shaking the blood with ether, or by adding a small quantity of bile salts, and in other ways. Upon examination of laky blood it is found that the red corpuscles are " broken up " or at least altered, and that the redness which pre- viously was confined to them is now diffused through the serum. Normal blood is opaque because each corpuscle, while permitting some rays of light (chiefly red) to pass through, reflects many others ; and the brightness of the hue of normal blood is due to this reflection of light from the surfaces of the several corpuscles. Laky blood is transparent because there are no longer intact corpuscles to present surfaces for the reflection of light, and the darker hue of laky blood is similarly due to the absence of reflection from the several corpuscles. When laky blood is allowed to stand a sediment is formed (and may be separated by the centrifugal machine) which on exami- nation is found to consist of discs, or fragments of discs, of a colourless substance exhibiting under high powers an obscurely spongy or reticular structure. These colourless thin discs seen flat- wise often appear as mere rings. The substance composing them stains with various reagents, and may thus be made more evident. The red corpuscle, then, consists obviously of a colourless frame- work, with which in normal conditions a red colouring matter is associated ; but by various means the colouring matter may be driven from the framework and dissolved in the serum. The framework is spoken of as stroma ; it is a modified or differentiated protoplasm, and upon chemical analysis yields pro- teid substances, some of them at least belonging to the globulin Chap, i.] BLOOD. 33 group, and other matters, among which is the peculiar complex fat called lecithin, of which we shall have to speak in treating of nervous tissue. In the nucleated red corpuscles of the lower vertebrata this differentiated stroma, though forming the chief part of the cell body around the nucleus, is accompanied by a variable amount of undifferentiated protoplasm ; but the latter in the mammalian red corpuscle is either absent altogetlier or reduced to a minimum. Whether any part of this stroma is living, in the sense of being capable of carrying on a continual double chemical change, of continually building itself up as it breaks down, is a question too difficult to be discussed here. The red colouring matter which in normal conditions is asso- ciated with this stroma may by appropriate means be isolated, and, in the case of the blood of many animals, obtained in a crystalline form. It is called Hmmoglohin, and may by proper methods be split up into a proteid belonging to the globulin group, and into a coloured pigment, containing iron, called Hmmatin. Haemoglobin is therefore a very complex body. It is found to have remarkable relations to oxygen, and indeed, as we shall see, the red corpuscles by virtue of their haemoglobin have a special work in respiration ; they carry oxygen from the lungs to the several tissues. We shall therefore defer the further study of haemoglobin until we have to deal with respiration. The red corpuscle, then, consists of a disc of colourless stroma with which is associated in a peculiar way the complex coloured body haemoglobin. Though the haemoglobin, as is seen in laky blood, is readily soluble in serum (and it is also soluble in plasma), in the intact normal blood it remains confined to the corpuscle. Obviously there is some special connection between the stroma and the haemo- globin ; it is not until the stroma is altered, we may perhaps say killed (as by repeated freezing and thawing), that it loses its hold on the haemoglobin, which thus set free passes into solution in the serum. The disc of stroma when separated from the haemoglobin has, as we have just said, an obscurely spongy texture ; but we do not know accurately the exact condition of the stroma in the intact corpuscle or how it holds the haemoglobin. There is certainly no definite membrane or envelope to the corpuscle ; for by exposing blood to a high temperature (60° C.) the corpuscle will break up into more or less spherical pieces, each still consisting of stroma and haemoglobin. The quantity of stroma necessary to hold a quantity of hiemo- globin is exceedingly small. Of the total solid matter of a corpuscle more than 90 p.c. is haemoglobin. A red corpuscle in fact is a quantity of haemoglobin held together in the form of a disc by a minimal amount of stroma. Hence whatever effect the stroma 'per se may have upon the plasma, this, in the case of mammals at all events, must be insignificant : the red corpuscle is practically simply a carrier of hiiemoglobin. 3 34 NUMBER OF RED CORPUSCLES. [Book i. § 25. The average number of red corpuscles in human blood may be probably put down at about 5 millions in a cubic milli- meter (the range in different mammals is said to be from 3 to 18 millions), but the relation of corpuscle to plasma varies a good deal even in health, and very much in disease. Obviously the relation may be affected (1) by an increase or decrease of the plasma, (2) by an actual decrease or increase of red corpuscles. Now, the former must frequently take place. The blood, as we have already urged, is always being acted upon by changes in the tissues, and indeed is an index of those changes ; hence the plasma must be con- tinually changing, though always striving to return to the normal condition. Thus when a large quantity of water is discharged by the kidney, the skin, or the bowels, that water comes really from the blood ; and the drain of water must tend to diminish the bulk of the plasma, and so to increase the relative number of red corpuscles, though the effect is probably soon remedied by the passage of water from the tissues into the blood. So again when a large quantity of water is drunk, this passes into the blood and tends temporarily to dilute the plasma (and so to diminish the relative number of red corpuscles), though this condition is in turn soon remedied by the passage of the superfluous fluid to the tissues and excretory organs. The greater or less number of red corpuscles, then, in a given bulk of blood may be simply due to less or more plasma ; but we have reason to think that the actual number of the corpuscles in the blood does vary from time to time. This is especially seen in certain forms of disease, which may be spoken of under the general term of anaemia (there being several kinds of anaemia), in which the number of red corpuscles is distinctly diminished. The redness of blood may however be influenced not only by the number of red corpuscles in each cubic millimeter of blood but also by the amount of haemoglobin in each corpuscle, and to a less degree by the size of the corpuscles. If we compare, with a common standard, the redness of two specimens of blood unequally red, and then determine the relative number of corpuscles in each, we may find that the less red specimen has as many corpuscles as the redder one, or at least the deficiency in redness is greater than can be accounted for by the paucity of red corpuscles. Obviously in such a case the red corpuscles have too little ha3moglobin. In some cases of anaemia the deficiency of haemoglobin in each cor- puscle is more striking than the scantiness of red corpuscles. The number of corpuscles in a specimen of blood is determined by mixing a small but carefully measured quantity of the blood with a large quantity of some indifferent fluid, — e. p'; a 5 p.c. solution of sodium sulphate, — and then actually counting the corpuscles in a known minimal bulk of the mixture. This perhaps may be most conveniently done by the method generally known as that of Gowers (Haemacytometer) improved by Malassez. A Chap, i.] BLOOD. 35 glass slide, in a metal frame, is ruled into minute rectangles, — ^•^'•i mm. by ^ mm., — so as to give a convenient area of -^^jtli of a square mm. Three small screws in the frame permit a coverslip to be brought to a fixed distance, — e. . of the battery. Over this primary coil, but quite unconnected with it. slides another coil, — the secondary coil, s.c. ; the ends of the wire forming this coil, y" and x", are continued on in the arrangement illustrated in the figure as y' and y, and as x' and x, and terminate in electrodes. If these electrodes are in contact or con- nected with conducting material, the circuit of the secondary coil is said to be closed ; otherwise it is open. In such an arrangement it is found that at the moment when the primary circuit is closed, — i. e. when the primary current is "made," a secondary " induced " current is, for an exceedingly brief period of time, set up in the secondary coil. Thus in F'ig. 3 when, by moving the "key " F, y'" and x'" (previously not in connection with" each other) are put into connection and the primary current thus made, at that instant a current appears in the wires y" x" kc, but almost immediately' disappears. A similar almost instantaneous current is also developed when the primary current is " broken," but not till then. So long as the primary current flows with uniform intensity, no current is induced in the secondary coil. It is only when the primary current is either made or broken, or suddenly varies in intensity, that a current appears in the secondary coil. In each case the current is of very brief duration, gone in an instant almost, and may therefore be spoken of as " a shock," an induction shock, — being called a " making shock " when it is caused by the making, and a "breaking shock" when it is caused by the breaking, of the primary circuit. The direction of the current 64 INDUCTION COIL. [Book i. iiiiii^ Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 65 Fig. 4. Diagram illustrating Apparatus arranged for Experiments AviTii MuscLii and Nerve. A. The moist chamber containino; the muscle-nerve preparation. The muscle m, supported by the clamp r/., which firmly grasps the end of the femur /; is connected by means of the IS hook s and a thread with the lever /, placed below the moist chamber. The nerve n, with the portion of the spinal column n' still attached to it, is placed on tho electrode-holder el, in contact with the wires X, I/. The wiiole of the interior of the ghass case g/. is kept saturated with moisture, and the electrode-holder is so constructed that a piece of moistened blotting-paper may be placed on it without coming into contact with the nerve. B. The revolving cylinder bearing the smoked paper on which the lever writes. C. Du Bois-Reymond's key arranged for short-circuiting. The wires x and y of the electrode-holder are connected through binding screws in the floor of the moist chamber with the wires x', if , and tliese are secured in the kev, one on either side. To the same key are attached the wires x" y" coming "from the secondary coils .s. c. of the induction-coil D. This secondary coil can be made to slide up and down over the primary coil pr. c, with which are connected the two wires x'" and /". x'" is counected directly with one pole, for instance the copper pole c. p. of the battery E. y'" is carried to a binding screw a of the Morse key F, and is continued as //'^ from another binding screw 6 of the key to the zinc pole z. p. of the battery. Supposing everything to be arranged, and the battery charged, on depressing the handle ha, of the Morse key F, a current will be made in the primary coil pr. c, passing from c. p. through x'" to pr. c, and thence through ?/'" to a, thence to b, and so through ?/'^' to z. p. On removing the finger from the handle of F, a spring thrusts up the handle, and the primary circuit is in consequence immediately broken. At the instant that the primary current is either made or broken, an induced current is for the instant developed in the secondary coil s. c. If the cross bar h in the du Bois-Reymond's key be raised (as shewn in the thick line in the figure), the wires x" x' x, the nerve between the electrodes and the wires ?/, tj', y" form the complete secondary circuit, and the nerve consequently experiences a making or breaking induction-shock whenever the primary current is made or broken. If the cross bar of the du Bois-Reymond's key be shut down, as in the dotted line h' in the figure, the resistance of the cross bar is so slight compared with that of the nerve and of the wires going from the key to the nerve, that the whole secondary (induced) current passes from x" to y" (or from y" to x"), along the cross bar, and' practically none passes into the nerve. The nerve being thus " short-circuited." is not affected by any changes in the current. The figure is intended merely to illustrate the general method of studying muscular contraction ; it is not to be supposed that the details here given are universally adopted or indeed the best for all purposes. in the making shock is opposed to that of the primary current ; thus in the figure while the primary current flows from x'" to y'", the induced making shock flows from y to x. The current of the breaking shock on the other hand flows in the same direction as the primary current from X to .y, and is therefore in direction the reverse of the making shock. Compare Fig. 4, where arrangement is shewn in a diagrammatic manner. The current from the battery, upon its first entrance into the primary coil, as it passes along each twist of that coil, gives rise in the neighbouring twists of the same coil to a momentary induced current having a direction opposite to its own, and therefore tending to weaken itself. It is not until this ' self-induction ' has passed ofl" that the 5 66 INDUCTION COIL. [Book current in the primary coil is established in its full strength. Owing to this delay in the full establishment of the current in the primary coil, the induced current in the secondary coil is developed more slowly Fig. 5. Diagram of an Induction Coil. + positive pole, end of negative element; — negative pole, end of positive element of battery ; K, du Bois-Reymond's key ; pr. c. primary coil, current shewn by feathered arrow ; sc. c. secondary coil, current shewn by unfeathered arrow. than it would be were no such ' self-induction ' present. On the other hand, when the current from the battery is ' broken,' or ' shut off ' from the primary coil, no such delay is offered to its disappearance, and consequently the induced current in the secondary coil is developed with unimpeded rapidity. "We shall see later on that a rapidly de- veloped current is more effective as a stimulus than is a more slowly developed current. Hence the making shock, where rapidity of pro- duction is interfered with by the self-induction of the primary coil, is less effective as a stimulus than the breaking shock, whose development is not thus interfered with. The strength of the induced current depends, on the one hand, on the strength of the current passing through the primary coil, — that is, on the strength of the battery. It also depends on the relative position of the two coils. Thus, if a secondary coil is brought nearer and nearer to the primary coil and made to overlap it more and more, the induced current becomes stronger and stronger, though the current from the battery remains the same. With an ordinary battery, the secondary coil may be pushed to some distance away from the primary coil, and yet shocks sufficient to stimulate a muscle will be obtained. For this purpose however the two coils should be in the same line ; when the secondary coil is placed cross-wise, at right angles to the primary, no induced current is developed, and at intermediate angles the induced current has intermediate strengths. When the primary current is repeatedly and rapidly made and broken, the secondary current being developed with each make and with each break, a rapidly recurring series of alternating currents is developed in the secondary coil and passes through its electrodes. We shall frequently speak of this as the intemipted induction current, or more briefly the interrupted current ; it is sometimes spoken of as the Chap, u.] THE CONTKACTILE TISSUES. 67 faradaic current, and the api^lication of it to any tissue is spoken of as faradization. Such a repeated breaking and making of the primary current may be effected in many various ways. In the instrument commonly used for the purpose, the primary current is made and broken by means of a vibrating steel slip working against a magnet ; hence the instrument is called a magnetic interruptor. See Fig. 6. Fig. 6. The Magnetic Interruptor. The two wires x and y from the battery are connected with the two brass pillars a and d hj means of screws. Directly contact is thus made, the current, indicated in the figure by the thicTc interrupted line, passes in the direction of the arrows, up tlie pillar a, along the steel spring h, as far as the screw c, the point of which, armed with platinum, is in contact with a small platinum plate on h. The current passes from h through c and a connecting wire into the primary coil ]). Upon its entering into the primary coil, an induced (making) current is for the instant developed in the secondary coil (not shewn in the figure). From the primary coil p the current passes, b}'- a connecting wire, through the double spiral m, and, did nothing happen, would continue to pass from m by a connecting wire to the pillar d, and so by the wire y to the battery. The whole of this course is indicated by the thick interrupted line with its arrows. As the current however passes through the spirals m, the iron cores of these are made magnetic. They in consequence draw down the iron bar e, fixed at the end of the spring b, the flexibility of the spring allowing this. But when e is drawn down, the platinum plate on the upper surface of b is also drawn away from the screw c, and thus the current is "broken " at b. (Sometimes the screw/ is so arranged that when e is drawn down a platinum ])late on the under surface of b is brought into. contact with the platinum-armed point of the screw /. 68 INDUCTION COIL. [Book i. The current then passes from b not to c but to /, and so down the pillar d, in the direction indicated by the thi7i interrupted line, and out to the battery by the wire y, and is thus cut off from the primary coil. But this arrangement is unnecessary.) At the instant that the cur- rent is thus broken and so cut off from the primary coil, an induced (breaking) current is for the moment developed in the secondary coil. But the current is cut off not only from the primary coil, but also from the spirals m ; in consequence their cores cease to be magnetised, the bar e ceases to be attracted by them, and the spring h, by virtue of its elasticity, resumes its former position in contact with the screw c. This return of the spring however re-establishes the current in the primary coil and in the spirals, and the spring is drawn down, to be released once more in the same manner as before. Thus as long as the current is passing along x, the contact of h with c is alternately being made and broken, and the current is constantly passing into and being shut off from p, the periods of alternation being determined by the periods of vibration of the spring b. With each passage of the current into, or withdrawal from the primary coil, an induced (making and, respectively, breaking) current is developed in a secondary coil. As thus used, each 'making shock,' as explained above, is less powerful than the corresponding ' breaking shock ; ' and indeed it sometimes happens that instead of each make as well as each break acting as a stimulus, giving rise to a contraction, the ' breaks ' only are effective, the several ' makes' giving rise to no contractions. By what is known as Helmholtz's arrangement, Fig. 7, however, Fig. 7. The Magnetic Inteeruptor avith Helmholtz arrangement for equal- izing THE Make and Break Shocks. the making and breaking shocks may be equalized. For this purpose the screw c is raised out of reach of the excursions of the spring b, and CiiAP. Ji.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 69 a moderately thick wire iv, offering a certain amount only of resistance, is interposed between the upper binding screw a' on the pillar a, and the binding screw c' leading to the primary coil. Under these arrange- ments the current from the battery passes through a', along the inter- posed wire to c', through the primary coil and thus as before to vi. As before, by the magnetization of m, e is drawn down and b brought in contact with/. As the result of this contact, the current from the battery can now pass by or, /, and d (shewn by the thin interrupted line) back to the battery ; but not the whole of the current, some of it can still pass along the wire iv to the primary coil, the relative amount being determined by the relative resistances offered by the two courses. Hence at each successive magnetization of vi, the current in the primary coil does not entirely disappear when h is brought in contact with/,- it is only so far diminished that vi ceases to attract e, and hence by the release of 6 from / the whole current once more passes along IV. Since at what corresponds to the ' break ' the current in the primary coil is diminished only, not absolutely done away with, self-induction makes its appearance at the ' break ' as well as at the ' make ; ' thus the ' breaking ' and ' making ' induced currents or shocks in the secondary coil are equalized. They are both reduced to the lower efficiency of the ' making ' shock in the old arrangement ; hence to produce the same strength of stimulus with this arrange- ment a stronger current must be applied or the secondaiy coil pushed over the primary coil to a greater extent than with the other arrange- ment. The Phenomena of a Simple Muscular Contraction. § 45. If the far end of the nerve of a muscle-nerve preparation (Figs. 2 and 4) be laid on electrodes connected with the secondary coil of an induction-machine, the passage of a single induction- shock, which may be taken as a convenient form of an almost mo- mentary stimulus, will produce no visible change in the nerve, but the muscle will give a twitch, a short, sharp contraction, — i. e., will for an instant shorten itself, becoming thicker the while, and then return to its previous condition. If one end of the muscle be attached to a lever, while the other is fixed, the lever will by its movements indicate the extent and duration of the shortening. If the point of the lever be brought to bear on some rapidly travelling surface, on which it leaves a mark (being for this purpose armed with a pen and ink if the surface be plain paper, or with a bristle or finely pointed piece of platinum foil if the surface be smoked glass or paper), so long as the muscle remains at rest the lever will describe an even line, which we may call the base line. If how- ever the muscle shortens, the lever will rise above the base line and thus describe some sort of curve above the base line. Now, 70 A SIMPLE MUSCULAE CONTEACTIOK [Book i. it is found that when a single induction-shock is sent through the nerve the twitch which the muscle gives causes the lever to de- scribe some such curve as that shewn in Fig. 8 ; the lever (after a brief interval immediately succeeding the opening or shutting the key, of which we shall speak presently) rises at first rapidly but afterwards more slowly, shewing that the muscle is correspondingly shortening, then ceases to rise, shewing that the muscle is ceasing Fig. 8. A Muscle-curve from the Gastrocnemius of the Frog. This curve, like all succeeding ones, unless otherwise indicated, is to be read from left to right, — that is to say, while the lever and tuning-fork were stationary the recording surface was travelling from right to left. a indicates the moment at which the induction-shock is sent into the nerve ; b the commencement, c the maximum, and d the close of the contraction. Below the muscle-curve is the curve drawn by a tuning-fork making 100 double vibrations a second, each complete curve representing therefore one-hundredth of a second. to grow shorter ; then descends, shewing that the muscle is length- ening again ; and finally, sooner or later, reaches and joins the base line, shewing that the muscle after the shortening has regained its previous natural length. Such a curve described by a muscle during a twitch or simple muscular contraction, caused by a single induction-shock or by any other stimulus producing the same effect, is called a curve of a simple muscular contraction or, more shortly, a " muscle-curve." It is obvious that the exact form of the curve described by identical contractions of a muscle will depend on the rapidity with which the recording surface is travelling. Thus if the surface be travelling slowly the up-stroke corresponding to the shortening will be very abrupt and the down-stroke also very steep, as in Fig. 9, which is a curve from a gastrocnemius muscle of a frog, taken with a slowly moving drum, the tuning-fork being the same as that used in Fig. 8 ; indeed with a very slow movement, the two may be hardly separable from each other. On the other hand, if the surface travel very rapidly the curve may be immensely long drawn out, as in Fig. 10, which is a curve from a gastro- cnemius muscle of a frog, taken with a very rapidly moving pendulum myograph, the tuning-fork marking about 500 vibrations a second. On examination, however, it will Fig. 9. Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 71 be found that both these extreme curves are funda- mentally the same as the medium one, when account is taken of the different rapidities of the travelling surface in the several cases. In order to make the ' muscle-curve ' complete, it is necessary to mark on the recording surface the exact time at which the induction-shock is sent into ihe nerve, and also to note the speed at which the recording surface is travelling. In the pendulum myograph the rate of move- ment can be calculated from the length of the pendulum ; but even in this it is convenient, and in the case of the spring myograph and revolving cylinder is necessary, to measure the rate of move- ment directly by means of a vibrating tuning-fork or of some body vibrating regularly. Indeed it is best to make such a direct measurement with each curve that is taken. A tuning-fork, as is known, vibrates so many times a second according to its pitch. If a tuning- fork, armed with a light marker on one of its prongs and vibrating say 100 a second, — i.e., executing a double vibration, moving forwards and backwards, 100 times a second, — be brought while vibrating to make a tracing on the recording surface immedi- ately below the lever belonging to the muscle, we can use the curve or rather curves described by the tuning-fork to measure the duration of any part or of the whole of the muscle-curve. It is essential that at starting the point of the marker of the tuning-fork should be exactly underneath the marker of the lever, or rather, since the point of the lever as it moves up and down describes not a straight line but an arc of a circle of which its fulcrum is the centre and itself (from the fulcrum to the tip of the marker) the radius, that the point of the marker of the tuning-fork should be exactly on the arc described by the marker of the lever, either above or below it, as may prove most convenient. If then at starting the tuning-fork marker be thus on the arc of the lever marker, and we note on the curve of the tuning-fork the place where the arc of the lever cuts it at the beginning and at the end of the muscle-curve, as at Fig. 8, we can count the number of vibrations of the tuning-fork which have taken place between the two marks, and so ascer- tain the whole time of the muscle-curve ; if for instance there have been 10 double vibrations, each Fig. 10 12 PENDULUM MYOGRAPH. [Book i. Fig 11. The Pendulum Myograph. The figure is diagrammatic, the essentials onl}'^ of the instrument being shewn. The smoked glass plate A swings with the pendulum B on carefully adjusted Chap. ii.J THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES 73 bearings at C. The contrivances by wliicli the glass plate can be removed and replaced at pleasure are not shewn. A second glass ])late so arranged that the first glass plate may be moved u]) and down without altering the swing of the pendulum is also omitted. Before commencing an ex])erimeiit the pendulum is raised up (in the figure to the right), and is kept in that positi(jn by the tooth a catching ou the spring-catch /;. On depressing the catch b the glass plate is set free, swings into the new position indicated by the dotted lines, and is held in that position by the tooth a' catching on the catch //. In the course of its swing the tooth a' coming into contact with tlie jjrojecting steel rod r, ivnocks it on one side into the position indicated by the dotted line c'. The rod c is in electric continuity with the wire x of the primary coil of an induction-machine. The screw d is similarly in electric continuity with the wire /y of the same primary coil. The screw d and the rod c are armed with platinum at the points in whicli they are in contact, and both are insulated by means of the ebonite block e. As long as c and d are in contact the circuit of the primary coil to which x and y belong is closed. When in its swing the tooth a' knocks c away from d, at that instant the circuit is broken, and a ' breaking ' shock is sent through the electrodes connected with the secondary coil of the machine, and so through the nerve. The lever /, the end only of which is shewn in the figure, is brought to bear on the glass plate, and when at rest describes a straight line, or more exactly an arc of a circle of large radius. The tuning-fork /, the ends only of the two limbs of which are shewn in the figure placed immediately below the lever, serves to mark the time. occupying yj^- sec, the whole curve has taken Jg- sec. to make. In the same way we can measure the duration of the rise of the curve or of the fall, or of any part of it. Though the tuning-fork may, by simply striking it, be set going long enough for the purposes of an observation, it is convenient to keep it going by means of an electric current and a magnet, very much as the spring in the ' magnetic interrupter ' (Fig. 6) is kept going. It is not necessary to use an actual tuning-fork ; any rod, armed with a marker, which can be made to vibrate regularly, and whose time of vibration is known, may be used for the pur- pose ; thus a reed, made to vibrate by a blast of air, is sometimes employed. The exact moment at which the induction-shock is thrown into the nerve may be recorded on the muscle-curve by means of a ' signal,' which may be applied in various ways. A light steel lever armed with a marker is arranged over a small coil by means of a light spring in such a way that wlien the coil by the passage of a current through it becomes a magnet it pulls the lever down to itself; on the current being broken, and the magneti- zation of the coil ceasing, the lever by lielp of the spring flies up. The marker of such a lever is placed immediately under (i.e., at some point on the arc described by) the marker of the muscle (or other) lever. Hence by making a current in the coil and putting the signal lever down, or by breaking an already existing current, and letting the signal lever fly up, we can make at pleasure a mark corresponding to any part we please of the muscle (or other) curve. If in order to magnetize the coil of the signal, we use, as we may do, the primary current which generates the induction-shock, the break- ing or making of the primary current, whichever we use to produce the 74 GRAPHIC RECORD OF A CONTRACTIOK. [Book i. induction-shock, will make the signal lever fly up or come down. Hence we shall have on the recording surface, under the muscle, a mark indicating the exact moment at which the primary current was broken or made. Now, the time taken up hy the generation of the induced current and its passage into the nerve between the electrodes is so infinitesimally small, that we may, without appreciable error, take the moment of the breaking or making of the primary current as the moment of the entrance of the induction-shock into the nerve. Thus we can mark below the muscle-curve, or, by describing the arc of the muscle lever, on the muscle-curve itself, the exact moment at which the induction-shock falls into the nerve between the electrodes, as is done at a in Figs. 8, 9, 10. In the pendulum myograph a separate signal is not needed. If, having placed the muscle lever in the position in which we intend to make it record, we allow the glass plate to descend until the tooth a' just touches the rod c (so that the rod is just about to be knocked down, and so break the primary circuit) and make on the base line, which is meanwhile being described by the lever marker, a mark to indicate where the point pf the marker is under these circumstances, and then bring back the plate to its proper position, the mark which we have made will mark the moment of the breaking of the primary circuit and so of the entrance of the induction-shock into the nerve. For it is just when, as the glass plate swings down, the marker of the lever comes to the mark which we have made that the rod c is knocked back and the primary current is broken. Fig. 12. Diagram of an Arrangement of a Vibrating Tuning-fork WITH A Desprez Signal. The current flows along the wire /connected with the positive (+) pole or end of the negative plate {N) of the battery, through the tuning-fork, down the pin connected with the end of the lower prong, to the mercury in the cup Hg, and so by a wire (shewn in the figure as a black line bent at right angles) to the binding screw e. From this binding screw part of the current flows through the coil a between the prongs of the tuning-fork, and thence by the wire c to the binding screw a, while another part flows through the wire g, through the coil of the Desprez signal back by the wire b, to the binding screw a. From the binding screw a the current passes back to the negative {— ) pole or end of the positive element (P) of the battery. As the current "flows through the coil of the Desprez signal from g to 6, the core of coil becoming magnetized draws to it the marker of the signal. As the current flows through the coil d, the core of that coil, also becoming magnetized, draws up the lower prong of the fork. But the pin is so adjusted that the drawing up of the prong lifts the point of the pin out of the mercury. In consequence, the current, being thus broken at Hg, flows neither through d nor through the Desprez signal. In consequence, the core of the Desprez thus ceasing to be magnetized, the marker flies back, being usually assisted by a Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 75 spring (not shewn in the figure). But, in consequence of the current ceasing to flow throu<4'h (/, the core of d ceases to lift uj) the prong, and the pin, in the descent of tiie prong, makes contact once more with the mercury. The re-establishment of tlie current, however, once more acting on the two coils, again pulls upon the marker of the signal, and again, by magnetizing the core of d, pulls u]) the prong and once more breaks the current. Thus the current is continually made and broken, the rapidity of the interruptions being determined by the vibration jjeriods of tlie tuning-fork, and tlie lever of the signal rising and falling synchronously with the movements of the tuning-fork. A 'signal' like the above, in an improved form known as Desprez's, may be iisecl also to record time, and thus the awkwardness of bringing a large tuning-fork up to the recording surface obviated. For this pur- pose the signal is introduced into a circuit, the current of which is continually being made and broken by a tuning-fork (Fig. 11). The tuning-fork, once set vibrating, continues to make and break the current at each of its vibrations, and, as stated above, is kept vibrating by the current. But each make or break caused by the tuning-fork affects also the small coil of the signal, causing the lever of the signal to fall down or fly up. Thus tlie signal describes vibration curves synchronous with those of the tuning-fork driving it. The signal may similarly be worked by means of vibrating agents other than a tuning-fork. Various recording surfaces may be used. The form most generally useful is a cylinder covered with smoked paper, and made to revolve by clockwork or otherwise ; such a cylinder driven by clockwork is shewn in Fig. 4, B. By using a cylinder of large radius with adequate gear, a high speed, some inches for instance in a second, can be obtained. In the spring myograph a smoked glass plate is thrust rapidly forward along a groove, by means of a spring suddenly thrown into action. In the pendulum myograph, Fig. 10, a smoked glass plate attached to tlie lower end of a long frame, swinging like a pendulum, is suddenly let go at a certain height, and so swings rapidly through an arc of a circle. The disadvantage of the last two methods is that the surface travels at a continually changing rate, whereas, in the revolving cylinder, careful construction and adjustment will secure a very uniform rate. § 46. Having thus obtained a time record, and an indication of the exact moment at which the induction-shock falls into the nerve, we may for present purposes consider the muscle-curve complete. The study of such a curve, as for instance that shewn in Fig. 8, taken from the gastrocnemius of a frog, teaches us the following facts : — 1. That although the passage of the induced current from electrode to electrode is practically instantaneous, its effect, meas- ured from the entrance of the shock into the nerve to the return of the muscle to its natural length after the shortening, takes an appreciable time. In the figure, the whole curve from a to cl takes up about the same time as eleven double vibrations of the tuning-fork. Since each double vibration here represents 100th of a second, the duration of the whole curve is rather more than TO s®^- 76 MUSCLE-CURVE. [Book i. 2. In the first portion of this period, from a to h, there is no visible change, no raising of the lever, no shortening of the muscle. 3. It is not until 5 — that is to say, after the lapse of about ■^-^ sec. — that the shortening begins. The shortening as shewn by the curve is at first slow, but soon becomes more rapid, and then slackens again until it reaches a maximum at c ; the whole shortening occupying rather more than -^^-^ sec. 4. Arrived at the maximum of shortening, the muscle at once begins to relax, the lever descending at first slowly, then more rapidly, and at last more slowly again, until at d the muscle has regained its natural length ; the whole return from the maximum of contraction to the natural length occupying rather more than 10 0 ^®^' Thus a simple muscular contraction, a simple spasm or twitch, produced by a momentary stimulus, such as a single induction- shock, consists of three main phases : — 1. A phase antecedent to any visible alteration in the muscle. This phase, during which invisible preparatory changes are taking place in the nerve and muscle, is called the latent •period.'' 2. A phase of shortening, or, in the more strict meaning of the word, contraction. 3. A phase of relaxation or return to the original length. In the case we are considering, the electrodes are supposed to be applied to the nerve at some distance from the muscle. Consequently the latent period of the curve comprises not only the preparatory actions which may be going on in the muscle itself, but also the changes necessary to conduct the immediate effect of the induction-shock, from the part of the nerve between the electrodes along a considerable length of nerve down to the muscle. It is obvious that these latter changes might be elimi- nated by placing the electrodes on the muscle itself, or on the nerve close to the muscle. If this were done, the muscle and lever being exactly as before, and care were taken that the induction-shock entered into the nerve at the new spot, at the moment when the point of the lever had reached exactly the same point of the travelling surface as before, two curves would be gained having the relations shewn in Fig. 13. The two curves resemble each other in almost all points, except that in the curve taken with the shorter piece of nerve, the latent period, the distance a to & as compared with the distance a to V is shortened : the contraction begins rather earlier. A study of the two curves teaches us the following two facts : — 1. Shifting the electrodes from a point of the nerve at some distance from the muscle to a point of the nerve close to the muscle, has only shortened the latent period a very little. Even when a very long piece of nerve is taken, the difference in the two curves is very small, and, indeed, in order that .it may be clearly recognized or measured, the travelling surface must be made to Chap, ii.] THE CONTIIACTILE TISSUES. 77 travel very rapidly. It is obvicnis, therefore, that by far the greater part of the latent period is taken up liy changes in the muscle Fig. 13. Curves illustrating the Measurement of the Velocity of a Nervous Impulse. The same muscle-nerve preparatiou is stimulated (1) as far as possible from the muscle, (2) as uear as possible to the muscle ; both contractious are registered in exactly the same way. In (I), the stimulus enters the nerve at the time indicated by the line a, the con- traction begins at b' ; the whole latent period therefore is indicated by the distance from a to b'. In (2), the stimulus enters the nerve at exactly the same time a ; the contraction begins at b : the latent period therefore is indicated by the distance between a and b. The time taken up l)y the nervous impulse in passing along the length of nerve between 1 and 2 is therefore indicated by the distance between b and b', which may be measured by the tuning-fork curve below ■ each double vibration of the tuning- fork corresponds to ^^^ or 0083 sec. itself, changes antecedent to the shortening becoming actually visible. Of course, even when the electrodes are placed close to the muscle, the latent period includes the changes going on in the short piece of nerve still lying between the electrodes and the muscular fibres. To eliminate this with a view of determining the latent period in the muscle itself, the electrodes might be placed directly on the muscle poisoned with urari. If this were done, it would be found that the latent period remained about the same, — that is to say, that in all cases the latent period is chiefly taken up by changes in the muscular as distinguished from the nervous elements. 2. Such difference as does exist between the two curves in the figure, indicates the time taken up by the propagation, along the piece of nerve, of the changes set up at the far end of the nerve by the induction-shock. These changes we have already spoken of as constituting a nervous impulse ; and the above experiment shews that it takes a small but yet distinctly apprecialDle time for a nervous impulse to travel along a nerve. In the figure the difference between the two latent periods, the distance between b and h', seems almost too small to measure accurately ; but if a long piece of nerve be used for the experiment, and the recording surface be made to travel very fast, the difference between the duration of the latent period when the induction-shock is sent in at a point close to the muscle, and that when it is sent in at a point as far away as possible from the muscle, may be satisfactorily measured in fractions of a second. If the length of nerve between 78 VELOCITY OF NEEVOUS IMPULSE. [Book i. the two points be accurately measured, the rate at which a nervous impulse travels along the nerve to a muscle can thus be easily calculated. This has been found to be in the frog about 28, and in man about 33 metres per second, but varies considerably, especially in warm-blooded animals. Thus when a momentary stimulus, such as a single induction- shock, is sent into a nerve connected with a muscle, the following events take place : a nervous impulse is started in the nerve, and this travelling down to the muscle produces in the muscle first the invisible changes which occupy the latent period, secondly the changes which bring about the visible shortening or contraction proper, and thirdly the changes which bring about the relaxation and return to the original length. The changes taking place in these several phases are changes of living matter : they vary with the condition of the living substance of the muscle, and only take place so long as the muscle is alive. Though the relaxation which brings back the muscle to its original length is assisted by the muscle being loaded with a weight, or otherwise stretched, this is not essential to the actual relaxation, and with the same load the return will vary according to the condition of the muscle ; the relaxation must be considered as an essential part of the whole contraction, no less than the shortening itself. § 47. Not only, as we shall see later on, does the whole con- traction vary in extent and character according to the condition of the muscle, the strength of the induction-shock, the load which the muscle is bearing, and various attendant circumstances, but the three phases may vary independently. The latent period may be longer or shorter, the shortening may take a longer or shorter time to reach the same height, and especially the relaxation may be slow or rapid, complete or imperfect. Even when the same strength of induction-shock is used, the contraction may be short and sharp, or very long drawn out, so that the curves described on a recording surface, travelling at the same rate in the two cases, appear very different ; and, under certain circumstances, as when a muscle is fatigued, the relaxation, more particularly the last part of it, may be so slow, that it may be several seconds before the muscle really regains its original length. We may add that the latent period, which in an ordinary experiment on a frog's gastro- cnemius is so conspicuous, may, under certain circumstances, be so shortened as almost, if not wholly, to disappear. Indeed, it is maintained by some that the occurrence of the latent period is not an essential feature of the whole act. Hence, if we say that the duration of a simple muscular con- traction of the gastrocnemius of a frog under ordinary circumstances is about Y^Q- sec, of which ^^^ is taken up by the latent period, j^q by the contraction, and -^^q by the relaxation, these must be taken as ' round numbers,' stated so as to be easily remembered. The duration of each phase as well as of the whole contraction varies in Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 79 different animals, in different muscles of the same animal, and in the same muscle under different conditions. The muscle-curve which we have been discussing is a curve of changes in the length only of the muscle ; but if the muscle, instead of being suspended, were laid fiat on a glass plate, and a lever laid over its belly, we should find, upon sending an induction-shock into the nerve, that the lever was raised, shewing that the muscle during the contraction became thicker. And if we took a graphic record of the movements of the lever, we should obtain a curve very similar to the one just discussed; after a latent period the lever would rise, shewing that the muscle was getting thicker, and afterwards would fall, shewing that the muscle was becoming thin again. In other words, in contraction the lessening of the muscle lengthwise is accompanied by an increase crosswise ; indeed, as we shall see later on, the muscle in contracting is not diminisiied in bulk at all (or only to an exceedingly small extent, about -[o-J^-o of its total bulk), but makes up for its diminution in length by increasing in its other diameters. § 48. A single induction-shock is, as we have said, the most convenient form of stimulus for producing a simple muscular con- traction, but this may also be obtained by other stimuli, provided that these are sufficiently sudden and short in their action, as, for instance, by a prick of, or sharp blow on, the nerve or muscle. For the production of a single, simple muscular contraction, the changes in the nerve leading to the muscle must be of such a kind as to constitute what may be called a single nervous impulse, and any stimulus which will evoke a single nervous impulse only may be used to produce a simple muscular contraction. As a rule, however, most stimuli other than single induction- shocks tend to produce in a nerve several nervous impulses, and, as we shall see, the nervous impulses which issue from the central nervous system, and so pass along nerves to muscles, are, as a rule, not single and simple, but complex. Hence, as a matter of fact, a simple muscular contraction is within the living body a com- paratively rare event (at least as far as the skeletal muscles are concerned,) and cannot easily be produced outside the body other- wise than by a single induction-shock. The ordinary form of muscular contraction is not a simple muscular contraction, but the more complex form known as a tetanic contraction, to the study of which we must now turn. Tetanic Contractions. § 49. If a single induction-shock be followed at a certain interval by a second shock of the same strength, the first simple contraction will be followed by a second simple contraction, both 80 TETANUS. [Book contractions being separate and distinct ; and, if the shocks be repeated, a series of rhythmically-recurring, separate, simple con- tractions may be obtained. If, however, the interval between two shocks be made short, — if, for instance, it be made only just long enough to allow the first contraction to have passed its maximum before the latent period of the second is over, — the curves of the two contractions will bear some such relation to each other as that shewn in Fig. 14. It will be observed that the second curve is almost in all respects like the first, except that it starts, so to speak, from the first curve instead of from the base-line. The second nervous impulse has acted on the already contracted muscle, and made it contract again just as it would have done if there had been no first impulse, and the muscle had been at rest. The two contractions are added together, and the lever is raised nearly double the height it would have been by either alone. If in the same way a third shock follows the second at a sufficiently Fig. 14. Tracing of a Double Muscle-curve. While the muscle (gastrocnemius of frog) was engaged in the first contraction (whose complete course, had nothing intervened, is indicated by the dotted line), a second induction-shock was thrown in, at such a time that the secoud contraction began just as the first was beginning to decline. The second curve is seen to start from the first, as does the first from the base-line. short interval, a third curve is piled on the top of the second ; the same with a fourth, and so on. A more or less similar result would occur if the second contraction began at another phase of the first. The combined effect is, of course, greatest when the second contraction begins at the maximum of the first, being less both before and afterwards. Hence, the result of a repetition of shocks will depend largely on the rate of repetition. If, as in Fig. 15, the shocks follow each other so slowly that one contraction is over, or almost over, before the next begins, each contraction will be distinct, or nearly distinct, and there will be little or no combined effect. Fig. 15. Muscle-cubve. Single Induction-shock repeated slowly. ClIAP. II.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 81 If, however, the shocks be repeated more rapidly, as in Fig. 16, each succeeding contraction will start from some part of the preceding one, and the lever will be raised to a greater height at each contraction. Fig. 16. Muscle-curve. Single Induction-shock repeated more rapidly. If the frequency of the shocks be still further increased, as in Fig. 17, the rise due to the combination of contraction will be still more rapid, and a smaller part of each contraction will be visible on the curve. Fig. 17. Muscle-curve. Single Induction-shock repeated still more rapidly. In each of these three curves it will be noticed that the character of the curve changes somewhat during its development. The change is the result of commencing fatigue, caused by the repetition of the contractions, the fatigue manifesting itself by an increasing prolongation of each contraction, shewn especially in a delay of relaxation, and by an increasing diminution in the height of the contraction. Thus in Fig. 15 the contractions, quite distinct at first, become fused later ; the fifth contraction, for instance, is prolonged so that the sixth begins before the lever has reached the base line ; yet the summit of the sixth is hardly higher than the summit of the fifth, since the sixth, though starting at a higher level, is a somewhat weaker contraction. So, also, in Fig. 16, the lever rises rapidly at first, but more slowly afterw%ards, owing to an increasing diminution in the height of the single contractions. In Fig. 17 the increment of rise of the curve due to each contraction diminishes very rapidly, and though the lever does continue to 6 82 TETANUS. [Book i. rise during the whole series, the ascent, after about the sixth contraction, is very gradual indeed, and the indications of the individual contractions are much less marked than at first. Hence, when shocks are repeated with sufficient rapidity, it results that, after a certain number of shocks, the succeeding impulses do not cause any further shortening of the muscle, any further raising of the lever, but merely keep up the contraction already existing. The curve thus reaches a maximum, which it maintains, subject to the depressing effects of exhaustion, so long as the shocks are repeated. When these cease to be given, the muscle returns to its natural length. When the shocks succeed each other still more rapidly than in Fig. 17, the individual contractions, visible at first, may become fused together and wholly lost to view in the latter part of the curve. When the shocks succeed each other still more rapidly (the second contraction beginning in the ascending portion of the first), it becomes difficult or impossible to trace out any of the single contractions.^ The curve then described by the lever is of the kind shewn in Fig. 18, where the primary current of an Fig. 18. Tetanus produced with the ordinary Magnetic Interruptor of an Induction-machine. (Recording surface travelling slowly.) The interrupted current is thrown in at a. induction-machine was rapidly made and broken by the magnetic interruptor. Fig. 5. The lever, it will be observed, rises at a (the recording surface is travelling too slowly to allow the latent period to be distinguished), at first very rapidly, — in fact, in an unbroken and almost a vertical line, — and so very speedily reaches the maxi- mum, which is maintained so long as the shocks continue to be given ; when these cease to be given, the curve descends, at first very rapidly, and then more and more gradually towards the base line, which it reaches just at the end of the figure. This condition of muscle, brought about by rapidly repeated shocks, this fusion of a number of simple twitches into an 1 The ease with which the individual contractions can be made out depends in part, it need hardly be said, on the rapidity with which the recording surface travels. CiiAi'. II.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 83 apparently smooth, continuous effort, is known as tetanus, or tetanic contraction. The above facts are most clearly shewn when induction-shocks, or at least galvanic currents in some form or other, are employed. They are seen, however, what- ever be the form of stimulus employed. Thus, in the case of mechanical stimuli, while a single quick blow may cause a single twitch, a pronounced tetanus may be obtained by rapidly striking successively fresh portions of a nerve. With chemical stimulation, as when a nerve is dipped in acid, it is impossible to secure a momentary application ; hence tetanus, generally irregular in character, is the normal result of this mode of stimulation. In the living body, the contractions of the skeletal muscles, brought about either by the will or otherwise, are generally tetanic in character. Even very short, sharp movements, such as a sudden jerk of a limb, or a wink of the eyelid, are, in reality, examples of tetanus of short duration. If the lever, instead of being fastened to the tendon of a muscle hung vertically, be laid across the belly of a muscle placed in a horizontal position, and the muscle be thrown into tetanus by a repetition of induction-shocks, it will be seen that each shortening of the muscle is accompanied by a corresponding thickening, and that the total shortening of the tetanus is accompanied by a cor- responding total thickening. And, indeed, in tetanus we can observe more easily than in a single contraction that the muscle in contracting changes in form only, not in bulk. If a living muscle, or group of muscles, be placed in a glass jar, or chamber, the closed top of which is prolonged into a narrow glass tube, and the chamber be so filled with water (or, preferably, with a solution of sodium chloride, -6 p. c. in strength, usually called " normal saline solution," which is less injurious to the tissue than simple water) that the water rises up into the narrow tube, it is obvious that any change in the bulk of the muscle will be easily shewn by a rising or falling of the column of fluid in the narrow tube. It is found that when the muscle is made to contract, even in the most forcible manner, the change of level in the height of the column which can be observed is practically insignificant : there appears to be a fall indicating a diminution of bulk to the extent of about one ten-thousandth of the total bulk of the muscle. So that we may fairly say that in a tetanus, and hence in a simple contraction, the lessening of the length of the muscle causes a corresponding increase in the other directions : the substance of the muscle is displaced not diminished. § 50. So far we have spoken simply of an induction-shock, or of induction-shocks, without any reference to their strength, and of a living or irritable muscle, without any reference to the degree or extent of its irritability; but induction-shocks may vary in strength, and the irritability of the muscle may vary. If we slide the secondary coil a long way from the primary 84 VARIATIONS OF IRRITABILITY. [Book i. coil, and thus make use of extremely feeble induction-shocks, we shall probably find that these shocks, applied even to a quite fresh muscle-nerve preparation, produce no contraction. If we then gradually slide the secondary coil nearer and nearer the primary coil, and keep on trying the effects of the shocks, we shall find that, after a while, in a certain position of the coils, a very feeble contraction makes its appearance. As the secondary coil comes still nearer to the primary coil, the contractions grow greater and greater. After a while, however, and that, indeed, in ordinary circumstances very speedily, increasing the strength of the shock no longer increases the height of the contraction; the maximum contraction of which the muscle is capable with such shocks however strong has been reached. If we use a tetanizing or interrupted current, we shall obtain the same general results ; we may, according to the strength of the current, get no contraction at all, or contractions of various extent up to a maximum, which cannot be exceeded. Under favourable conditions the maximum contraction may be very considerable : the shortening in tetanus may amount to three-fifths of the total length of the muscle. The amount of contraction then depends on the strength of the stimulus, whatever be the stimulus ; but this holds good within certain limits only ; to this point however we shall return later on. § 61. If, having ascertained in a perfectly fresh muscle-nerve preparation the amount of contraction produced by this and that strength of stimulus, we leave the preparation by itself for some time, say for a few hours, and then repeat the observations, we shall find that stronger stimuli, stronger shocks, for instance, are required to produce the same amount of contraction as before ; that is to say, the irritability of the preparation, the power to respond to stimuli, has in the meanwhile diminished. After a further interval, we should find the irritability still further diminished : even very strong shocks would be unable to evoke contractions as large as those previously caused by weak shocks. At last we should find that no shocks, no stimuli, however strong, were able to produce any visible contraction whatever. The amount of contraction, in fact, evoked by a stimulus depends not only on the strength of the stimulus but also on the degree of irritability of the muscle-nerve preparation. Immediately upon removal from the body, the preparation possesses a certain amount of irritability, not differing very materially from that which the muscle and nerve possess while within, and forming an integral part of the body ; but after re- moval from the body the preparation loses irritability, the rate of loss being dependent on a variety of circumstances ; and this goes on until, since no stimulus which we can apply will give rise to a contraction, we say the irritability has wholly disappeared. Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 85 We might take this disappearance of irritability as marking the death of the preparation, but it is followed sooner or later by a curious change in the muscle, which is called rigor mortis, and which we shall study presently ; and it is convenient to regard this rigor mortis as marking the death of the muscle. The irritable muscle, then, when stimulated either directly, the stimulus being applied to itself, or indirectly, the stimulus being applied to its nerve, responds to the stimulus by a change of form which is essentially a shortening and thickening. By the shortening (and thickening), the muscle in contracting is able to do work, to move the parts to which it is attached ; it thus sets free energy. We have now to study more in detail how this energy is set free and the laws which regulate its expenditure. SEC. 2. ON THE CHANGES WHICH TAKE PLACE IN A MUSCLE DUKING A CONTEACTION. The Change in Form. § 52. Gross structure of muscle. An ordinary skeletal muscle consists of elementary muscle fibres, bound together in variously arranged bundles by connective tissue, which carries blood vessels, nerves and lymphatics. The same connective tissue, besides sup- plying a more or less distinct wrapping for the whole muscle, forms the two ends of the muscle, being here sometimes scanty, as where the muscle appears to be directly attached to a bone, and a small amount only of connective tissue joins the muscular fibres to the periosteum, sometimes abundant, as when the connective tissue, in which the muscular fibres immediately end, is prolonged into a tendon. Each elementary fibre, which varies even in the mammal in length and breadth (in the frog the dimensions vary very widely), but may be said on an average to be 30 or 40 mm. in length and 20 /a to 30 /x in breadth, consists of an elastic, homogeneous, or faintly fibrillated sheath of peculiar nature, the sarcolemma, which embraces and forms an envelope for the striated muscular substance within. Each fibre, cylindrical in form, giving a more or less circular outline in transverse section, generally tapers off at each end in a conical form. At each end of the fibre the sarcolemma, to which in life the muscular substance is adherent, becomes continuous with fibrillse of connective tissue, the nature and properties of which we shall study in a succeeding chapter. When the end of the fibre lies at the end of the muscle, these connective tissue fibrillte pass directly into the tendon (or into the periosteum, &c.), and in some cases of small muscles, which are no longer than their constituent fibres, each fibre may thus join at each end of itself, by means of its sarcolemma, the tendon or other ending of the muscle. In a very large number of muscles however the muscle is far longer than Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 87 any of its fibres, and there may even be whole bundles of fibres in the middle of the muscle which do not reach to either end. In such case the connective tissue, in which the sarcolemma ends, is continuous with the connective tissue, which, running between the fibres and between the bundles, binds the fibres into small bundles, and the smaller bundles into larger bundles. The contraction of a muscle is the contraction of all, or some, of its elementary fibres, the connective tissue being jjassive ; hence, while those fibres of the muscle which end directly in the tendon, in contracting pull directly on the tendon, those which do not so end pull indirectly on the tendon, by means of the connective tissue between the bundles, which connective tissue is continuous with the tendon. The blood vessels run in the connective tissue between the bundles and between the fibres, and the capillaries form more or less rectangular networks immediately outside the sarcolemma. Lymphatic vessels also run in the connective tissue, in the lymph spaces of which they begin ; the structure and functions of these lymphatic vessels and lymph spaces we shall study later on. Each muscular fibre is thus surrounded by lymph spaces and capillary blood vessels, but the active muscular substance of the fibre is separated from these by the sarcolemma; hence the interchange between the blood and the muscular substance is carried on, backwards and forwards, through the capillary wall, through some of the lymph spaces, and through the sarcolemma. Each muscle is supplied by one or more branches of nerves composed of medullated fibres, with a certain proportion of non- medullated fibres. These branches, running in the connective tissue, divide into smaller branches and twigs between the bundles and fibres. Some of the nerve fibres are distributed to the blood vessels, and others end in a manner of which we shall speak later on in treating of muscular sensations ; but by far the greater part of the medullated fibres end in the muscular fibres, the arrange- ment being such that every muscular fibre is supplied with at least one medullated nerve fibre, which joins the muscular fibre somewhere about the middle, between its two ends, or sometimes nearer one end, in a special nerve ending, of which we shall presently have to speak, called an end-plate. The nerve fibres thus destined to end in the muscular fibres divide as they enter the muscle, so that what, as it enters the muscle, is a single nerve fibre, may, by dividing, end as several nerve fibres in several muscular fibres. Sometimes two nerve fibres join one muscular fibre, but in this case the end-plate of each nerve fibre is still at some distance from the end of the muscular fibre. It follows that when a muscular fibre is stimulated by means of a nerve fibre, the nervous impulse travelling down the nerve fibre falls into the muscular fibre, — not at one end, but at about its middle ; it is the middle of the fibre which is affected first by the nervous impulse, 88 THE WAVE OF CONTRACTION. [Book i. and the changes in the muscular substance, started in the middle of the muscular fibre, travel thence to the two ends of the fibre. In an ordinary skeletal muscle, however, as we have said, the fibres and bundles of fibres begin and end at different distances from the ends of the muscle, and the nerve or nerves going to the muscle divide and spread out in the muscle in such a way that the end-plates, in which the individual fibres of the nerve end, are distributed widely over the muscle at very different distances from the ends of the muscle. Hence, if we suppose a single nervous impulse, such as that generated by a single induction-shock, or a series of such impulses, to be started at the same time at some part of the trunk of the nerve, in each of the fibres of the nerve going to the muscle, these impulses will reach very different parts of the muscle at about the same time, and the contractions which they set going will begin, so to speak, nearly all over the whole muscle at the same time, and will not all start in any particular zone or area of the muscle. § 53. The wave of contraction. We have seen, however, that under the influence of urari the nerve fibre is unable to excite contractions in a muscular fibre, although the irritability of the muscular fibre itself is retained. Hence, in a muscle poisoned by urari, the contraction begins at that part of the muscular substance which is first affected by the stimulus, and we may start a con- traction in what part of the muscle we please by properly placing the electrodes. Some muscles, such, for instance, as the sartorius of the frog, though of some length, are composed of fibres which run parallel to each other from one end of the muscle to the other. If such a muscle be poisoned with urari so as to eliminate the action of the nerves, and stimulated at one end (an induction-shock sent through a pair of electrodes placed at some little distance apart from each other at the end of the muscle may be employed, but better results are obtained if a mode of stimulation, of which we shall have to speak presently, viz. the application of the " constant cur- rent," be adopted), the contraction which ensues starts from the end stimulated, and travels thence along the muscle. If two levers be made to rest on, or be suspended from, two parts of such a muscle placed horizontally, the parts being at a known distance from each other and from the part stimulated, the progress of the contraction may be studied. The movements of the levers indicate in this case the thicken- ing of the fibres which is taking place at the parts on which the levers rest, or to which they are attached ; and if we take a graphic record of these movements, bringing the two levers to mark, one immediately below the other, we shall find that the lever nearer the part stimulated begins to move earlier, reaches its maximum earlier, and returns to rest earlier than does the farther lever. The contraction, started by the stimulus, in travelling along Chap, ii.] THE CONTKACTILE TISSUES. 89 the muscle from the part stimulated, reaches the nearer lever some little time before it reaches the farther lever, and has passed by the nearer lever some little time before it has passed by the farther lever ; and the fartlier apart the two levers are, the greater will be the difference in time between their movements. In other words, the contraction travels along the muscle in the form of a wave, each part of the muscle in succession from the end stimulated swelling out and shortening as the contraction reaches it, and then returning to its original state. And what is true of the collection of parallel fibres, which we call the muscle, is also true of each fibre, for the swelling at any part of the muscle is only the sum of the swelling of the individual fibres ; if we were able to take a single long fibre, and stimulate it at one end, we should be able, under the microscope, to see a swelling or bulging, accompanied by a corresponding shortening, — i. e. to see a con- traction sweep along the fibre from end to end. If, in the graphic record of the two levers just mentioned, we count the number of vibrations of the tuning-fork which intervene between the mark on the record which indicates the beginning of the rise of the near lever (that is, the arrival of the contraction wave at this lever), and the mark which indicates the beginning of the rise of the far lever, this will give us the time which it has taken the contraction wave to travel from the near to the far lever. Let us suppose this to be -005 sec. Let us suppose the distance between the two levers to be 15 mm. The con- traction wave then has taken -005 sec. to travel 15 mm. ; that is to say, it has travelled at the rate of 3 meters per sec. And, indeed, we find by this, or by other methods, that in the frog's muscles the contraction wave does travel at a rate which may be put down as from 3 to 4 meters a second, though it varies under different con- ditions. In the warm blooded mammal the rate is somewhat greater, and may probably be put down at five meters a second in the excised muscle, rising possibly to ten meters in a muscle within the living body. If, again, in the graphic record of the two levers we count, in the case of either lever, the number of vibrations of the tuning- fork which intervene between the mark where the lever begins to rise and the mark where it has finished its fall and returned to the base line, we can measure the time intervening between the contraction wave reaching the lever, and leaving the lever on its way onward ; that is to say, we can measure the time which it has taken the contraction wave to pass over the part of the muscle on which the lever is resting. Let us suppose this time to be, say, •1 sec. But a wave which is travelling at the rate of 3 m. a second and takes 1 sec. to pass over any point must be 300 mm. long. And, indeed, we find that in the frog the length of the contraction wave may be put down as varying from 200 to 400 mm. ; and in the mammal it is not very different. Now, as we have said, the very longest muscular fibre is stated 90 THE WAVE OF CONTEACTION. [Book i. to be at most only about 40 mm. in length ; hence, in an ordinary contraction, during the greater part of the duration of the con- traction the whole length of the fibre will be occupied by the contraction wave. Just at the beginning of the contraction there will be a time when the front of the contraction wave has reached, for instance, only half-way down the fibre (supposing the stimulus to be applied, as in the case we have been discussing, at one end only), and just at the end of the contraction there will be a time, for instance, when the contraction has left the half of the fibre next to the stimulus, but has not yet cleared away from the other half. But nearly all the rest of the time every part of the fibre will be in some phase or other of contraction, though the parts nearer the stimulus will be in more advanced phases than the parts farther from the stimulus. This is true when a muscle of parallel fibres is stimulated artificially at one end of the muscles, and when, therefore, each fibre is stimulated at one end. It is, of course, all the more true when a muscle of ordinary construction is stimulated by means of its nerve. The stimulus of the nervous impulse impinges, in this case, on the muscle fibre at the end-plate which, as we have said, is placed towards the middle of the fibre, and the contraction wave travels from the end-plate in opposite directions toward each end, and has, accordingly, only about half the length of the fibre to run in. All the more, therefore, must the whole fibre be in a state of contraction at the same time. It will be observed that in what has just been said the contraction wave has been taken to include not only the con- traction proper, the thickening and shortening, but also the relaxation and return to the natural form ; the first part of the wave, up to the summit of the crest, corresponds to the shortening and thickening, the decline from the summit onwards corresponds to the relaxation. But we have already insisted that the relax- ation is an essential part of the whole act, — indeed, in a certain sense, as essential as the shortening itself. § 54. Minute structure of muscular fibre. So far we have been dealing with the muscle as a whole and as observed with the naked eye, though we have incidentally spoken of fibres. We have now, confining our attention exclusively to skeletal muscles, to consider what microscopic changes take place during a contraction, what are the relations of the histological features of the muscle fibre to the act of contraction. The long, cylindrical sheath of sarcolemma is occupied by muscle substance. After death the muscle-substance may separate from the sarcolemma, leaving the latter as a distinct sheath, but during life the muscle-substance is adherent to the sarcolemma, so that no line of separation between the two can be made out ; the movements of the one follow exactly all the movements of the other. Scattered in the muscle-substance, but, in the mammal, lying Chap, it.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 91 for the most part close under the sarcolemma, are a number of nuclei, oval in shape with their long axes parallel to the length of the fibre. Around each nucleus is a thin layer of granular looking substance, very similar in appearance to that forming the body of a white blood corpuscle, and like that often spoken of as un- differentiated protoplasm. A small quantity of the same granular substance is prolonged for some distance, as a narrow conical streak from each end of the nucleus, along the length of the fibre. With the exception of these nuclei with their granular looking bed and the end-plate or end-plates, to be presently described, all the rest of the space enclosed by the sarcolemma from one end of the fibre to the other appears to be occupied by a peculiar material, striated muscle-substance. It is called striated because it is marked out, and that along the whole length of the fibre, by transverse bands, stretching right across the fibre, of substance which is very transparent, hright sub- stance, alternating with similar bands of substance which has a dim cloudy appearance, dim substance ; that is to say the fibre is marked out along its whole length by alternative bright bands and dim hands. The bright bands are on an average about 1 yu. or 1'5 /a and the dim bands about 2-5 /x or 3 yn thick. By careful focussing, both bright bands and dim bands may be traced through the whole thickness of the fibre, so that the whole fibre appears to be com- posed of bright discs and dim discs placed alternately, one upon the other, along the whole length of the fibre, the arrangement being broken by the end-plate, and here and there by the nuclei. When a muscular fibre is treated with dilute mineral acids, it is very apt to break up transversely into discs, the sarcolemma being dissolved, or so altered as easily to divide into fragments corresponding to the discs ; and a disc may thus be obtained so thin as to comprise only a single dim or bright band, or a band dim or bright, with a thin layer of bright or dim substance above and below it, the cleavage having taken place along the middle of a band. When treated with certain reagents, alcohol, chromic acid, &c., the fibre is very apt to split up (and the splitting up may be assisted by " teasing ") longitudinally into columns of variable thickness, some of which, however, may be exceedingly thin, and are then sometimes spoken of as ' fibrillar.' Both these discs and fibrillffi are artificial products, the results of a transverse or longitudinal cleavage of the dead, hardened, or otherwise prepared muscle-substance. They may, moreover, be obtained in almost any thickness -or thinness, and these discs and fibrillin do not by themselves prove much beyond the fact that the fibre tends to cleave in the two directions. The living fibre, however, though at times quite glassy looking, the bright bands appearing like transparent glass and the dim bands like ground glass, is at other times marked with longitudinal 92 MINUTE STRUCTUEE OF MUSCLE. [Book i. lines giving rise to a longitudinal striation, sometimes conspicuous and occasionally obscuring the transverse striation. In the muscles of some insects each dim band has a distinct palisade appearance, as if made up of a number of ' fibrillse,' or ' rods,' placed side by side and imbedded in some material of a different nature ; more- over, these fibrill* or rods may, with greater difficulty, be traced through the bright, bands, and that at times along the whole length of the fibre. And there is a great deal of evidence, into which we cannot enter here, which goes to prove that in all striated muscle, mammalian muscle included, the muscle-substance is really composed of longitudinally placed natural fibrillar of a certain nature, imbedded in an interfilrillar substance of a different nature. In mammalian muscle and vertebrate muscle generally, these fibrillse are exceedingly thin, and in most cases are not sharply defined by optical characters from their interfibrillar bed ; in insect muscles, and some other muscles, they are relatively large, well defined and conspicuous. The artificial fibrillae obtained by teasing may, perhaps, in some cases where they are exceedingly thin correspond to these natural fibrilhe, but in the majority of cases they certainly do not. In certain insect muscles each bright band has in it two (or sometimes more) dark lines which are granular in appearance and may be resolved by adequate magnifying power into rows of granules. Since they may by focussing be traced through the whole thickness of the fibre, the lines are the expression of discs. Frequently the lines in the bright bands are so conspicuous as to contribute a greater share to the transverse striation of the fibre than do the dim bands. Similar granular lines (rows or rather discs of granules), may also be seen, though less distinctly, in- vertebrate, including mammalian, muscle. Besides these granular lines whose position in the bright band is near to the dim bands, often appearing to form, as it were, the upper edge of the dim band below and the lower edge of the dim band above, there may be also sometimes traced another transverse thin line, in the very middle of the bright band. This line, like the other lines (or bands), is the expression of a disc, and has been held by some observers to represent a membrane stretched across the whole thickness of the fibre, and adherent at the circumference with the sarcolemma ; in this sense it is spoken of as Krause's TYierrhbrane. The reasons for believing that the line really repre- sents a definite membrane do not, however, appear to be adequate. It may be spoken of as the " intermediate line." When a thin transverse section of frozen muscle is examined quite fresh under a high power, the muscle-substance within the sarcolemma is seen to be marked out into a number of small, more or less polygonal areas, and a similar arrangement into areas may also be seen in transverse sections of prepared muscle, though the features of the areas are somewhat different from those seen in the Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 93 fresh, living fibre. These areas are spoken of as " Cohnheim's areas ; " they are very much Larger than the diameter of a fibrilla as indicated by the h)ngitudinal striation, and, indeed, correspond to a whole bundle of such fibrilhe. Their existence seems to indicate that the fibrilla; are arranged in longitudinal prisms, separated from each other by a larger amount of interfibrillar substance than that uniting together the individual fibrilhe form- ing each prism. Lastly, it may be mentioned that not only are the various granular lines at times visible with difficulty, or quite invisible, but that even the distinction between dim and bright bands is on occasion very faint or obscure, the whole muscle-substance, apart from the nuclei, appearing almost homogeneous. Without attempting to discuss the many and various interpre- tations of the above and other details concerning the minute structure of striated muscular fibre, we may here content ourselves with the following general conclusions. (1) That the muscle-substance is composed of longitudinally disTposedJih'illce (probably cylindrical in general form, and probably arranged in longitudinal prisms) imbedded in an interfibrillar substance, which appears to be less differentiated than the fibrillse themselves, and which is probably continuous with the undifferen- tiated protoplasm round the nuclei. The interfibrillar substance stains more readily with gold chloride than do the fibrillte, and hence, in gold chloride, specimens appear as a sort of meshwork, with longitudinal spaces corresponding to the fibrillae. (2) That the interfibrillar substance is, relatively to the fibrillre, more abundant in the muscles of some animals than in those of others : being, for instance, very conspicuous in the muscles of insects, in which animals we should naturally expect the less differentiated material to be more plentiful than in the muscles of the more highly developed mammal. (3) That the fibrillte and interfibrillar substance having dif- ferent refractive powers, some of the optical features of muscle may be due, on the one hand, to the relative proportion of fibrillar to interfibrillar substance, and on the other hand to the fibrillae not being cylindrical throughout the length of the fibre, but constricted at intervals, and thus becoming beaded or moniliform. For in- stance, the rows of granules spoken of above are by some regarded as corresponding to aggregations of interfibrillar material filling up the spaces where the fibrilhe are most constricted. And, indeed, some authors maintain that the whole striation is simply an optical effect due to the disposition of the surface of the fibre. It does not seem possible at the present time to make any statement which will satisfactorily explain all the various appear- ances met with. § 55. We may now return to the question, What happens when a contraction wave sweeps over the fibre ? 94 MICROSCOPIC CHANGES. [Book i. Muscular fibres may be examined, even under high powers of the microscope, wliile they are yet living and contractile ; the contrac- tion itself may be seen, but the rate at which the wave travels is too rapid to permit satisfactory observations being made as to the minute changes which accompany the contraction. It frequently happens, however, that when living muscle has been treated with certain reagents, as, for instance, with osmic acid vapour, and sub- sequently prepared for examination, fibres are found in which a bulging, a thickening and shortening, over a greater or less part of the length of the fibre, has been fixed by the osmic acid or other reagent. Such a bulging obviously differs from a normal contraction in being confined to a part of the length of the fibre, whereas, as we have said, a normal wave of contraction, being very much longer than any fibre, occupies the whole length of the fibre at once. We may, however, regard this bulging as a very short, a very abbre- viated wave of contraction, and assume that the changes visible in such a short bulging also take place in a normal contraction. Admitting this assumption, we learn from such preparations that in the contracting region of the fibre, while both dim and bright bands become broader across the fibre, and correspondingly thinner along the length of the fibre, a remarkable change takes place between the dim bands, bright bands, and granular lines. We have seen that in the fibre at rest the intermediate line in the bright band is in most cases inconspicuous ; in the contracting fibre, on the contrary, a dark line in the middle of the bright band in the position of the intermediate line becomes very distinct. As we pass along the fibre from the beginning of the contraction wave, to the summit of the wave, where the thickening is greatest, this line becomes more and more striking, until at the height of the contraction, it becomes a very marked dark line, or thin 'dark band. Pari passu with this change, the distinction between the dim and bright bands becomes less and less marked ; these appear to become confused together, until, at the height of the contraction, the whole space between each two now conspicuous dark lines is occupied by a substance which can be called neither dim nor bright, but which, in contrast to the dark line, appears more or less bright and transparent. So that in the contracting part there is, at the height of the contraction, a reversal of the state of things proper to the part at rest. The place occupied by the bright band, in the state of rest, is now largely filled by a conspicuous dark line, which previously was represented by the inconspicuous intermediate line, and the place occupied by the conspicuous dim band of the fibre, at rest, now seems by com- parison with the dark line the brighter part of the fibre. The contracting fibre is like the fibre at rest striated, but its striation is different in its nature from the natural striation of the resting fibre ; and it is held by some that in the earlier phases of the contraction, while the old natural striation is being replaced Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 95 by the new striation, there is a stage in which all striation is lost. We may add that the outline of the sarcolemnia, which in the fibre at rest is quite even, becomes, during the contraction, indented opposite the intermediate line, and bulges out in the interval between each two intermediate lines, the bulging and indentation becoming more marked the greater the contraction. § 56. We can learn something further about this remarkable change by examining the fibre under polarized light. When ordinary light is sent through a Nicol prism (which is a rhomb of Iceland spar divided into two in a certain directioji, tlie halves being subsequently cemented together in a special way), it undergoes a change in passing through the prism and is said to be polarized. One effect of this polarization is that a ray of light which has passed througli one Nicol prism will or will not pass through a second Nicol, according to the relative position of the two prisms. Thus, if the second Nicol be so placed that what is called its " optic axis" be in a line with or parallel to the optic axis of the first Nicol, the light passing through the first Nicol will also pass through the second. But if the second Nicol be rotated until its optic axis is at right angles with the optic axis of the first Nicol, none of the light passing through the former will pass through the latter ; the prisms in this position are said to be ' crossed.' In intermediate positions more or less light passes through the second Nicol, according to the angle between the two optic axes. Hence when one Nicol is placed beneath the stage of a microscope so that the light from the mirror is sent through it, and another Nicol is placed in the eye-piece, the field of the microscope will appear dark when the eye-piece Nicol is rotated so that its optic axis is at right angles to the optic axis of the lower Nicol, and, consequently, the light passing through the lower Nicol is stopped by it. If, however, the optic axis of the eye-piece Nicol be parallel to that of the lower Nicol, the light from the latter will pass through the former, and the field will be bright; and, as the eye-piece is gradually rotated from one position to the other, the brightness of the field will diminish or increase. Both the Nicols are composed of doubly refractive material. If now a third doubly refractive material be placed on the stage, and, therefore, between the two Nicols, the light passing through the lower Nicol will (in a certain position of the doubly refractive material on the stage, that is to say, when its optic axes have a certain position) pass through it, and also through the crossed Nicol in the eye-piei-e. Hence the doubly refractive material on the stage (or such parts of it as are in the proper position in respect to their optic axes) will, when the eye-piece Nicol is crossed, ap[)ear illuminated and bright on a dark field. In this way the existence of doubly . refractive material in a preparation may be detected. When muscle prepared and mounted in Canada balsam is examined in the microscope between Nicol prisms, one on the 96 MUSCLE UNDER POLAEIZED LIGHT. [Book i. stage below the object, and the other in the eye-piece, the fibres stand out as bright objects on the dark ground of the field when the axes of the prisms are crossed. On closer examination it is seen that the parts which are bright are chiefly the dim bands. This indicates that it is the dim bands which are doubly refractive, anisotropic, or are chiefly made up of anisotropic substance ; there seems, however, to be some slight amount of anisotropic substance in the bright bands though these as a whole appear singly refrac- tive or isotropic. The fibre accordingly appears banded or striated with alternate bands of anisotropic and isotropic material. Accord- ing to most authors, such an alternation of anisotropic and (chiefly) isotropic bands which is obvious in a dead and prepared fibre exists also in the living fibre ; but some maintain that the living fibre is uniformly anisotropic. ISTow, when a fibre contracts, in spite of the confusion previously mentioned between dim and bright bands, there is no confusion between the anisotropic and isotropic material. The anisotropic, doubly refractive bands, bright under crossed Nicols, occupying the position of the dim band in the resting fibre, remain doubly refractive, bright under crossed Nicols, even at the very height of the contraction. The isotropic, singly refractive, bands, dark under crossed Nicols, occupying the position of the bright bands in the fibre at rest, remain isotropic and dark under crossed Nicols, at the very height of the contraction. All that can be seen is that the singly refractive isotropic bands become very thin indeed during the contraction, while the anisotropic bands, though, of course, becoming thinner and broader in the contraction, do not become so thin as do the isotropic bands ; in other words, while both bands become thinner and broader, the doubly refractive anisotropic band seems to increase at the expense of the singly refractive isotropic band. § 57. We call attention to these facts because they shew how complex is the act of contraction. The mere broadening and shortening of each section of the fibre is, at bottom, a translocation of the molecules of the muscle-substance. If we imagine a com- pany of 100 soldiers ten ranks deep, with ten men in each rank, rapidly, and yet by a series of gradations, to extend out into a double line with 50 men in each line, we shall have a rough image of the movement of the molecules during a muscular contraction. But, from what has been said, it is obvious that the movement, in striated muscle at least, is a very complicated one ; in other forms of contractile tissue it may be, as we shall see, more simple. Why the movement is so complicated in striated muscle, what purposes it serves, why the skeletal muscles are striated, we do not at present know. Apparently, where swift and rapid contraction is required, the contractile tissue is striated muscle ; but how the striation helps, so to speak, the contraction we do not know. We cannot say what share in the act of contraction is to be allotted to the several Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 97 parts. Since during a contraction the fibre bulges out more opposite to each dim disc, and is indented opposite to each bright disc, since the dim disc is more largely composed of anisotropic material than the rest of the fibre, and since the anisotropic material in the position of the dim disc increases during a contraction, we might, perhaps, infer that the dim disc rather than the bright disc is the essentially active part. Assuming that the fibrillar substance is more abundant in the dim discs, while the interfibrillar substance is more abundant in the bright discs, and that the fibrillar sub- stance is anisotropic (and hence the dim discs largely anisotropic), while the interfibrillar substance is isotropic, we might also be inclined to infer it is the fibrillar and not the interfibrillar sub- stance which really carries out the contraction; but even this much is not yet definitely proved. One thing must be remembered. The muscle-substance, though it possesses the complicated structure, and goes through the re- markable changes which we have described, is, while it is living and intact, in a condition which we are driven to speak of as semifluid. The whole of it is essentially mobile. The very act of contraction indeed shews this ; but it is mobile in the sense that no part of it, except, of course, the nuclei and sarcolemma, neither dim nor bright substance, neither fibrillar nor interfibrillar substance can be regarded as a hard and fast structure. A minute nema- toid worm has been seen wandering in the midst of the substance of a living contractile fibre ; as it moved along, the muscle sub- stance gave way before it, and closed up again behind it, dim bands and bright bands all falling back into their proper places. We may suppose that in this case the worm threaded its way in a fluid interfibrillar substance between and among highly extensible and elastic fibrillae. But even on such a view, and still more on the view that the fibrillar substance also was broken and closed up again, the maintenance of such definite histological features, as those which we have described, in material so mobile can only be effected, even in the fibre at rest, at some considerable expenditure of energy ; which energy, it may be expected, has a chemical source. During the contraction there is a still further expenditure of energy, some of which, as we have seen, may leave the muscle as ' work done ; ' this energy likewise may be expected to have a chemical source. We must therefore now turn to the chemistry of muscle. Tlie Chemistry of Muscle. § 58. We said, in the Introduction, that it was difiicult to make out with certainty the exact chemical differences between dead and living substance. Muscle, however, in dying, undergoes a remarkable chemical change, which may be studied with com- parative ease. We have already said that all muscles, within a certain time after removal from the body, or, if still remaining part ^8 CHEMISTRY OF MUSCLE. [Book i. ■of the body, within a certain time after ' general ' death of the body, lose their irritability, and that the loss of irritability, which, ■even when rapid, is gradual, is succeeded by an event which is somewhat more sudden, viz. the entrance into the condition known as rigor mortis. The occurrence of rigor mortis, or cadaveric rigidity, as it is sometimes called, which may be considered as the token of the death of the muscle, is marked by the following features. The living muscle possesses a certain translucency, the rigid muscle is distinctly more opaque. The living muscle is very extensible and elastic, it stretches readily and to a considerable extent when a weight is hung upon it, or when any traction is applied to it, but speedily and, under normal circumstances, completely returns to its original length when the weight or traction is removed ; as we shall see, however, the rapidity and completeness of the return depends on the condition of the muscle, a well-nourished, active muscle regaining its normal length much more rapidly and com- pletely than a tired and exhausted muscle. A dead, rigid muscle is much less extensible, and at the same time much less elastic ; the muscle now requires considerable force to stretch it, and when the force is removed, does not, as before, return to its former length. To the touch the rigid muscle has lost much of its former softness, and has become firmer and more resistant. The entrance into rigor mortis is, moreover, accompanied by a shortening or contraction, which may, under certain circumstances, be con- siderable. The energy of this contraction is not great, so that any actual shortening is easily prevented by the presence of even a slight opposing force. Now, the chemical features of the dead, rigid muscle are also strikingly different from those of the living muscle. § 59. If a dead muscle, from which all fat, tendon, fascia, and connective tissue have been as much as possible removed, and which has been freed from blood by the injection of 'normal' saline solution, be minced and repeatedly washed with water, the washings will contain certain forms of albumin, and certain extractive bodies, of which we shall speak directly. When the washing has been continued until the wash-water gives no proteid reaction, a large portion of muscle will still remain undissolved. ■ If this be treated with a 10 p.c. solution of a neutral salt, ammonium chloride being the best, a large portion of it will become dissolved ; the solution, however, is more or less imperfect, and filters with difficulty. If the filtrate be allowed to fall, drop by drop, into a large quantity of distilled water, a white, flocculent matter will be precipitated. ^This flocculent precipitate is myosin. Myosin is a proteid, giving the ordinary proteid reactions, and having the same general elementary composition as other proteids. It is soluble in dilute saline solutions, especially those of ammonium chloride, and may be classed in the globulin family, though it is not so soluble as paraglobulin, requiring a stronger solution of a neutral salt to Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 99 dissolve it; thus while soluble in a 5 or 10 p.c. solution of such a salt, it is far less soluble in a 1 p.c. solution, which, as we have seen, readily dissolves paraglobulin. From its solutions in neutral saline solution it is precipitated by saturation with a neutral salt, preferably sodium chloride, and may be purified by being washed with a saturated solution, dissolved again in a weaker solution, and reprecipitated by saturation. Dissolved in saline solutions, it readily coagulates when heated, i.e. is converted into coagulated proteid, and it is worthy of notice that it coagulates at a comparatively low temperature, viz. about 56° C. ; this, it will be remembered, is the temperature at which fibrinogen is co- agulated, whereas paraglobulin, serum albumin, and many other proteids do not coagulate until a higher temperature, 75° C, is reached. Solutions of myosin are precipitated by alcohol, and the precipitate, as in the case of other proteids, becomes, by continued action of the alcohol, altered into coagulated insoluble proteid. We have seen that paraglobulin, and, indeed, any member of the globulin group, is very readily changed by the action of dilute acids into a body called acid albumin, characterised by not being soluble either in water or in dilute saline solutions, but readily soluble in dilute acids and alkalis, from its solutions in either of which it is precipitated by neutralisation, and by the fact that the solutions in dilute acids and alkalis are not coagulated by heat. When, therefore, a globulin is dissolved in dilute acid, what takes place is not a mere solution but a chemical change ; the globulin cannot be got back fronl the solution, it has been changed into acid-albumin. Similarly, when globulin is dissolved in dilute alkalis it is changed into alkali albumin ; and, broadly speaking, alkali albumin precipitated by neutralisation can be changed by solution with dilute acids into acid albumin, and acid albumin by dilute alkalis into alkali albumin. Now, myosin is similarly, and even more readily than is globulin, converted into acid albumin, and by treating a muscle, either washed or not, directly with dilute hydrochloric acid, the myosin may be converted into acid albumin and dissolved out. Acid albumin obtained by dissolving muscle in dilute acid used to be called syntonin, and it used to be said that a muscle contained syntonin ; the muscle, however, contains myosin, not syntonin, hut it may be useful to retain the word syntonin to denote acid albumin obtained by the action of dilute acid on myosin. By the action of dilute alkalis, myosin may similarly be converted into alkali albumin. From what has been stated above, it is obvious that myosin has many analogies with fibrin, and we have yet to mention other striking analogies ; it is, however, much more soluble than fibrin, and, speaking generally, it may be said to be intermediate in its character between fibrin and globulin. On keeping, and especially on drying, its solubility is much diminished. 100 MUSCLE PLASMA. [Book i. Of the substances which are left in washed muscle, from which all the myosin has been extracted by ammonium chloride solution, little is known. If washed muscle be treated directly with dilute hydrochloric acid, a large part of the material of the muscle passes, as we have said, at once into syntonin. The quantity of syntonin thus obtained may be taken as roughly representing the quantity of myosin previously existing, in the muscle. A more prolonged action of the acid may dissolve out other proteids, besides myosin, left after the washing. The portion insoluble in dilute hydro- chloric acid consists, in part, of the gelatine yielding and other substances of the sarcolemma, and of the connective and other tissues between the bundles, of the nuclei of these tissues, and of the fibres themselves, and, in part, possibly, of some portions of the muscle substance itself. We are not, however, at present in a position to make any very definite statement as to the relation of the myosin to the structural features of muscle. Since the dim bands are rendered very indistinct by the action of 10 p.c. sodium chloride solution, we may perhaps infer that myosin enters largely into the composition of the dim bands, and, therefore, of the fibrillse ; but it would be hazardous to say much more than this. § 60. Living muscle may be frozen, and yet, after certain precautions will, on being thawed, regain its irritability, or, at all events, will for a time be found to be still living in the sense that it has not yet passed into rigor mortis. We may, therefore, take living muscle which has been frozen as still living. If living contractile mtcscle, freed as much as possible from blood, be frozen, and, while frozen, minced, and rubbed up in a mortar with four times its weight of snow, containing 1 p.c. of sodium chloride, a mixture is obtained which at a temperature just below 0° C. is sufficiently fluid to be filtered, though with difficulty. The slightly opalescent filtrate, or muscle plasma, as it is called, is at first quite fluid, but will, when exposed to the ordinary temperature, become a solid jelly, and afterwards separate into a clot and serum. It will, in fact, clot like blood plasma, with this difference, that the clot is not firm and fibrillar, but loose, granular and flocculent. During the clotting, the fluid, which before was neutral or slightly alkaline, becomes distinctly acid. The clot is myosin. It gives all the reactions of myosin obtained from dead muscle. The serum contains an albumin very similar to, if not identical with, serum albumin, a globulin differing somewhat from, and coagulating at a lower temperature than paraglobulin, and which, to distinguish it from the globulin of blood, has been called myo- glohulin, some other proteids which need not be described here, and various ' extractives ' of which we shall speak directly. Such muscles as are red also contain a small quantity of haemoglobin, and of another allied pigment, called histohcematin, to which pigments, indeed, their redness is due. Chap. II,] THE CONTKACTILE TISSUES. 101 Thus, while dead muscle contains myosin, albumin, and other proteids, extractives, and certain insoluble matters, together with gelatinous and other substances not referable to the muscle substance itself, living muscle contains no myosin, but some substance or substances which bear somewhat the same relation to myosin that the antecedents of fibrin do to fibrin, and which give rise to myosin upon the death of the muscle. There are indeed reasons for thinking that the myosin arises from the conversion of a previously existing body, which may be called myosinogen, and that the conversion takes place, or may take place, by the action of a special ferment, the conversion of myosinogen into myosin being very analogous to the conversion of fibrinogen into fibrin. We may, in fact, speak of rigor mortis as characterised by a clotting of the muscle plasma, comparable to the clotting of blood plasma, but differing from it inasmuch as the product is not fibrin but myosin. The rigidity, the loss of suppleness, and the diminished translucency appear to be, at all events, largely, though probably not wholly, due to the change from the fluid plasma to the solid myosin. We might compare a living muscle to a number of fine, transparent, membranous tubes containing blood plasma. When this blood plasma entered into the ' jelly ' stage of clotting, the system of tubes would present many of the phenomena of rigor mortis. They would lose much of their suppleness and translucency, and acquire a certain amount of rigidity. § 61. There is, however, one very marked and important difference between the rigor mortis of muscle and the clotting of blood. Blood during its clotting undergoes a slight change only in its reaction ; but muscle during the onset of rigor mortis becomes distinctly acid. A living muscle at rest is in reaction neutral, or, possibly from some remains of lymph adhering to it, faintly alkaline. If, on the other hand, the reaction of a thoroughly rigid muscle be tested, it will be found to be most distinctly acid. This development of an acid reaction is witnessed not only in the solid, untouched fibre, but also in expressed muscle plasma ; it seems to be associated in some way with the appearance of the myosin. The exact causation of this acid reaction has not at present been clearly worked out. Since the coloration of the litmus pro- duced is permanent, carbonic acid, which, as we shall immediately state, is set free at the same time, cannot be regarded as the active acid, for the reddening of litmus produced by carbonic acid speedily disappears on exposure. On the other hand, it is possible to ex- tract from rigid muscle a certain quantity of lactic acid, or rather of a variety of lactic acid known as sarcolactic acid ^ ; and we may probably regard the acid reaction of rigid muscle as due to a new 1 There are many varieties of lactic acid, which are isomeric, having the same composition C3H5O3, but differ in their reactions and especially in the solubility of their zinc salts. The variety present in muscle is distinguished as sarcolactic acid. 102 EIGOE MOETIS. [Book i. formation, or to an increased formation of this sarcolactic acid. There is reason, however, to think that the establishment of the acid reaction is not a perfectly simple process, but a more or less complex one, other substances besides sarcolactic acid intervening. Coincident with the appearance of this acid reaction, though as we have said, not the direct cause of it, a large development of carbonic acid takes place when muscle becomes rigid. Irritable living muscular substance, like all living substance, is continually respiring, that is to say, is continually consuming oxygen and giving out carbonic acid. In the body, the arterial blood going to the muscle gives up some of its oxygen, and gains a quantity of carbonic acid, thus becoming venous as it passes through the muscle capillaries. Even after removal from the body, the living muscle continues to take up from the surrounding atmosphere a certain quantity of oxygen, and to give out a certain quantity of carbonic acid. At the onset of rigor mortis there is a very large and sudden increase in this production of carbonic acid, in fact an outburst, as it were, of that gas. This is a phenomenon deserving special attention, Knowing that the carbonic acid, which is the outcome of the re- spiration of the whole body, is the result of the oxidation of carbon- holding substances, we might very naturally suppose that the increased production of carbonic acid attendant on the development of rigor mortis is due to the fact that during that event a certain quantity of the carbon-holding constituents of the muscle are suddenly oxidized. But such a view is negatived by the following facts. In the first place, the increased production of carbonic acid during rigor mortis is not accompanied by a corresponding in- crease in the consumption of oxygen. In the second place, a muscle (of a frog for instance) contains in itself no free or loosely attached oxygen ; when subjected to the action of a mercurial air- pump it gives off no oxygen to a vacuum, offering in this respect a marked contrast to blood ; and yet, when placed in an atmosphere free from oxygen, it will not only continue to give off carbonic acid while it remains alive, but will also exhibit, at the onset of rigor mortis, the same increased production of carbonic acid that is shewn by a muscle placed in an atmosphere containing oxygen. It is obvious that in such a case the carbonic acid does nob arise from the direct oxidation of the muscle substance, for there is no oxygen present at the tiTne to carry on that oxidation. We are driven to suppose that, during rigor mortis, some complex body, containing in itself ready formed carbonic acid, so to speak, is split up, and thus carbonic acid is set free, the process of oxidation by which that carbonic acid was formed out of the carbon-holding constituents of the muscle having taken place at some anterior date. Living, resting muscle, then, is alkaline or neutral in reaction, and the substance of its fibres contains a plasma capable of clotting. Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 103 Dead, rigid muscle on the other hand is acid in reaction, and no longer contains a plasma capable of clotting, but is laden witli the solid myosin. Further, the change from the living irritable con- dition to that of rigor mortis is accompanied by a large and sudden development of carbonic acid. It is found, moreover, that there is a certain amount of parallel- ism between the intensity of the rigor mortis, the degree of acid reaction, and the quantity of carbonic acid given out. If we suppose, as we fairly may do, that the intensity of the rigidity is dependent on the quantity of myosin deposited in the fibres, and the acid reaction to the development, if not of lactic acid, at least of some other substance, the parallelism between the three products, myosin, acid-producing substance, and carbonic acid, would suggest the idea that all three are the results of the splitting-up of the same highly complex substance. No one has at present, however, succeeded in isolating or in otherwise definitely proving the exist- ence of such a body, and though the idea seems tempting, it may in the end prove totally erroneous. § 62. As to the other proteids of muscle, such as the albumin and the globulin, we know as yet nothing definite concerning the parts which they play, and the changes which they undergo in the living muscle or in rigor mortis. Besides the fat which is found, and that not unfrequently in abundance, in the connective tissue between the fibres, there is also present in the muscular substance within the sarcolemma, always some, and at times a great deal, of fat, chiefly ordinary fat, viz. stearin, palmitin, and olein, in variable proportion, but also the more complex fat lecithin. As to the function of these several fats in the life of the muscle we know little or nothing. Carbohydrates, the third of the three great classes in which we may group the energy-holding substances of which the animal body and its food are alike composed, viz. proteids, fat and carbo- hydrates, are represented in muscle by a peculiar body, glycogen, which we shall have to study in detail later on. We must here merely say that glycogen is a body closely allied to starch, having a formula, which may be included under the general formula for starches x (Ce H lo O5), and may like it be converted by the action of acids, or, by the action of particular ferments known as amyluly tic ferments, into some form of sugar, dextrose (CeHioOo), or some allied sugar. Many, if not all, living muscles contain a certain amount, and some, under certain circumstances, a considerable amount of glycogen. During or after rigor mortis this glycogen is very apt to be converted into dextrose, or an allied sugar. The muscles of the embryo at an early stage contain a relatively enormous quantity of glycogen, a fact which suggests that the glycogen of muscle is carbohydrate food of the muscle about to be wrought up into the living muscular substance. The bodies which we have called extractives are numerous and 104 CHEMICAL CHANGES. [Book i. varied. They are especially interesting since it seems probable that they are waste products of the metabolism of the muscular substance, and the study of them may be expected to throw light on the chemical change which muscular substance undergoes during life. Since, as we shall see, muscular substance forms by far the greater part of the nitrogenous — that is, proteid — portion of the body, the nitrogenous extractives of muscle demand peculiar atten- tion. Now, the body urea, which we shall have to study in detail later on, far exceeds in importance all the other nitrogenous extrac- tives of the body as a whole, since it is practically the one form in which nitrogenous waste leaves the body ; if we include with urea, the closely allied uric acid (which for present purposes may simply be regarded as a variety of urea), we may say broadly that all the nitrogen taken in as food sooner or later leaves the body as urea ; compared with this all other nitrogenous waste thrown out from the body is insignificant. Of the urea which thus leaves the body, a considerable portion must at some time or other have existed, or, to speak more exactly, its nitrogen must have existed as the nitrogen of the proteids of muscular substance. Nevertheless, no urea at all is, in normal conditions, present in muscular substance either living and irritable, or dead and rigid ; urea does not arise in muscular substance itself as one of the immediate waste products of muscular substance. There is, however, always present, in relatively considerable amount, on an average about '25 p.c. of wet muscle, a remarkable body, kreatin. This is in one sense a compound of urea : it may be split up into urea and sarcosin. This latter body is a methyl glycin, that is to say, a glycin in which methyl has been sub- stituted for hydrogen, and glycin itself is amido-acetic acid, a compound of amidogen, that is a representative of ammonia, and acetic acid. Hence kreatin contains urea, which has close relations with ammonia, together with another representative of ammonia, and a surplus of carbon and hydrogen arranged as a body belonging to the fatty acid series. We shall have to return to this kreatin, and to consider its relations to urea and to muscle, when we come to deal with urine. The other nitrogenous extractives, such as karnin, hypoxanthin (or sarkin), xanthin, taurin, &c., occur in small quantity, and need not be dwelt on here. Among non-nitrogenous extractives, the most important is the sarcolactic acid, of which we have already spoken ; to this may be added sugar in some form or other, either coming from glycogen or from some other source. The ash of muscle, like the ash of the blood corpuscles, and, indeed, the ash of the tissues in general, as distinguished from the blood, or plasma, or lymph on which the tissues live, is character- ised by the preponderance of potassium salts and of phosphates ; these form in fact nearly 80 p.c. of the whole ash. CiiAP. II.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 105 § 63. We may now pass on to the question, What are the chemical changes which take place when a living, resting muscle enters into a contraction ? These changes are most evident after the muscle has been subjected to a prolonged tetanus ; but there can be no doubt that the chemical events of a tetanus are, like the physical events, simply the sum of the results of the consti- tuent single contractions. In the first place, the muscle becomes acid, not so acid as in rigor mortis, but still sufficiently so, after a vigorous tetanus, to turn blue litmus distinctly red. The cause of the acid reaction, like that of rigor mortis, is not quite clear, but is in all probability the same in both cases. In the second place, a considerable quantity of carbonic acid is set free ; and the production of carbonic acid in muscular contrac- tion resembles the production of carbonic acid during rigor mortis in that it is not accompanied by a corresponding increase in the consumption of oxygen. This is evident even in a muscle through which the circulation of blood is still going on ; for though the blood passing through a contracting muscle gives up more oxygen than the blood passing through a resting muscle, the increase in the amount of oxygen taken up falls below the increase in the carbonic acid given out. But it is still more markedly shewn in a muscle removed from the body ; for in such a muscle both the contraction and the increase in the production of carbonic acid will go on in the absence of oxygen. A frog's muscle, suspended in an atmosphere of nitrogen, will remain irritable for some considerable time, and at each vigorous tetanus an increase in the production of carbonic acid may be readily ascertained. Moreover, there seems to be a correspondence between the energy of the contraction and the amount of carbonic acid and the degree of acid reaction produced, so that, though we are now treading on somewhat uncertain ground, we are naturally led to the view that the essential chemical process, lying at the bottom of a muscular contraction as of rigor mortis, is the splitting-up of some highly complex substance. But here the resemblance between rigor mortis and contraction ends. We have no satisfactory evidence of the formation during a contraction of any body like myosin. And this difference in chemical results tallies with an important physical difference between rigid muscle and contracting muscle. The rigid muscle, as we have seen, becomes less extensible, less elastic, less translucent ; the contracting muscle remains no less trans- lucent, elastic, and extensible than the resting muscle, — indeed, there are reasons for thinking that the muscle in contracting becomes actually more extensible for the time being. But if, during a contraction, mvosin is not formed, what changes of proteid or nitrogenous matter do take place ? We do not know. We have no evidence that kreatin, or any other nitrogenous extractive, is increased by the contraction of muscle ; we have no 106 THERMAL CHANGES. [Book i. satisfactory evidence of any nitrogen waste at all as the result of a contraction ; and, indeed, as we shall see later on, the study of the waste products of the body as a whole leads us to believe that the energy of the work done by the muscles of the body comes from the potential energy of carbon compounds, and not of nitrogen compounds at all. But to this point we shall have to return. § 64. We may sum up the chemistry of muscle somewhat as follows : — During life the muscular substance is continually taking up from the blood, that is from the lymph, proteid, fatty and carbo- hydrate material, saline matters and oxygen ; these it builds up into itself, how, we do not know, and so forms the peculiar complex living muscular substance. The exact nature of this living sub- stance is unknown to us. What we do know is that it is largely composed of proteid material, and that such bodies as myosinogen, myoglobulin, and albumin, being always present in it, have probably something to do with the building of it up. During rest this muscular substance, while taking in and build- ing itself up out of, or by means of, the above-mentioned materials, is continually giving off carbonic acid, and continually forming nitrogenous waste, such as kreatin. It also probably gives off some amount of sarcolactic acid, and possibly other non-nitrogenous waste matters. During a contraction there is a great increase in the amount of carbonic acid given off, an increased formation of lactic acid, and possibly other changes giving rise to an acid reaction, a greater consumption of oxygen, though the increase is not equal to the increase of carbonic acid, but, as far as we can learn, no increase of nitrogenous waste. During rigor mortis, there is a similar increased production of carbonic acid and of some other acid-producing substance, ac- companied by a remarkable conversion of myosinogen into myosin, by which the rigidity of the dead fibre is brought about. Thermal Changes. § 65. The chemical changes during a contraction set free a quantity of energy, but only a portion of this energy appears in the ' work done ; ' a considerable portion takes on the form of heat. Though we shall have hereafter to treat this subject more fully, the leading facts may be given here. Whenever a muscle contracts, its temperature rises, indicating that heat is given out. When a mercury thermometer is plunged into a mass of muscles, such as those of the thigh of the dog, a rise of the mercury is observed upon the muscles being thrown into a prolonged contraction. More exact results however are obtained by means of a thermopile, by the help of which the rise of tempera- Chap. ii.J THE GONTKACTILE TISSUES. 107 ture caused by a few repeated single contractions, or, indeed, by a single contraction, may be observed, and the amount of heat given out approximatively measured. The thermopile may consist either of a single junction, in the form of a needle plunged into the substance of the muscle ; or of several junctions either in the shape of a flat surface carefully opposed to the surface of muscle (the pile being balanced so as to move with the contracting muscle, and thus to keep the contact exact), or in the shape of a thin wedge, the edge of which, comprising the actual junctions, is thrust into a mass of muscles and held in position by them. In all cases the fellow junction 'or junctions must be kept at a constant temperature. Another delicate method of determining the changes of temperature of a tissue is based upon the measurement of alterations in electric resistance which a fine wire, in contact with or plunged into the tissue, undergoes as the temperature of the tissue changes. It has been calculated that the heat given out by the muscles of the thigh of a frog in a single contraction amounts to 3'1 micro-units of heat ^ for each gramme of muscle, the result being obtained by dividing by five the total amount of heat given out in five succes- sive single contractions. It will, however, be safer to regard these figures as illustrative of the fact that the heat given out is consider- able rather than as data for elaborate calculations. Moreover, we have no satisfactory quantitative determinations of the heat given out by the muscles of warm blooded animals, though there can be no doubt that it is much greater than that given out by the muscles of the frog. There can hardly be any doubt that the heat thus set free is the product of chemical changes within the muscle, changes, which, though they cannot, for the reasons given above (§ 63), be regarded as simple and direct oxidations, yet, since they are processes dependent on the antecedent entrance of oxygen into the muscle, may be spoken of in general terms as a combustion. So that the muscle may be likened to a steam-engine, in which the combus- tion of a certain amount of material gives rise to the development of energy in two forms, as heat and as movement, there being certain quantitative relations between the amount of energy set free as heat and that giving rise to movement. We must, however, carefully guard ourselves against pressing this analogy too closely. In the steam-engine, we can distinguish clearly between the fuel which, through its combustion, is the sole source of energy, and the machinery, which is not consumed to provide energy, and only suffers wear and tear. In the muscle we cannot with certainty at present make such a distinction. It may be that the chemical changes at the bottom of a contraction do not involve the real living material of the fibre, but only some substance, manufactured by the living material and lodged in some way, we do not know ^ The micro-unit lieiuc; a jnilliirramnio of water raised one de2;ree eentiffrade. 108 THERMAL CHANGES. [Book i. how, in the living material ; it may be that when a fibre contracts it is this substance within the fibre which explodes, and not the fibre itself. If we further suppose that this substance is some complex compound of carbon and hydrogen, into which no nitrogen enters, we shall have an explanation of the difficulty referred to above (§ 68), namely, that nitrogenous waste is not increased by a contraction. The special contractile, carbon-hydrogen substance may then be compared to the charge of a gun, the products of its explosion being carbonic and sarcolactic acids, while the real, living material of the fibre may be compared to the gun itself ; but to a gun which itself is continually undergoing change, far beyond mere wear and tear, among the products of which change nitrogenous bodies like kreatin are conspicuous. This view will certainly explain why kreatin is not increased during the contraction while the carbonic and lactic acids are. But it must be remembered that such a view is not yet proved ; it may be the living material of the fibre as a whole which is continually breaking down in an explosive decom- position, and as continually building itself up again out of the material supplied by the blood. In a steam-engine only a certain amount of the total potential energy of the fuel issues as work, the rest being lo'st as heat, the proportion varying, but the work rarely, if ever, exceeding one- ' tenth of the total energy, and generally being less. In the case of the muscle we are not at present in a position to draw up an exact equation between the latent energy on the one hand and the two forms of actual energy on the other. We have reason to think that the proportion between heat and work varies considerably under different circumstances, the work sometimes rising as high as one-fifth, or, according to some, as high even as one-half, some- times possibly sinking as low as one twenty-fourth of the total energy ; and observations seem to shew that the greater the re- sistance which the muscle has to overcome, the larger the proportion of the total energy expended, which goes out as work done. The muscle, in fact, seems to be so far self-regulatilig, that ^the more work it has to do, the greater, within certain limits, is the economy with which it works. Lastly, it must be remembered that .the giving out of heat by the muscle is not confined to the occasions when it is actually con- tracting. When, at a later period, we treat of the heat of the body generally, evidence will be brought forward that the muscles, even when at rest, are giving rise to heat, so that the heat given out at a contraction is not some wholly new phenomenon, but a temporary exaggeration of what is continually going on at a more feeble rate. Electrical Changes. § 66. Besides chemical and thermal changes a remarkable electric change takes place whenever a muscle contracts. Guar II.] THE CONTKACTILE TISSUES. lO'J Musc/e-currcnts. If a muscle be removed in an ordinary manner from the body, and two non-polarisable electrodes/ con- nected with a delicate galvanometer of many convolutions and Fig. 19 Non-polarisable Electrodes. a, the glass tube ; z, the amalgamated zinc slips connected with their respective wires; s. s., the zinc sulphate solution; ch. c, the plug of china clay; c', the portion of the china-clay plug projecting from the end of the tube this can be moulded into any required form. high resistance, be placed on two points of the surface of the muscle, a deflection of the galvanometer will take place, indicating the existence of a current passing through the galvanometer from the one point of the muscle to the other, the direction and amount of the deflection varying according to the position of the points. The ' muscle-currents ' thus revealed are seen to the best advantage when the muscle chosen is a cylindrical or prismatic one with parallel fibres, and when the two tendinous ends are cut off by clean incisions at right angles to the long axis of the muscle. The muscle then presents a transverse section (artificial) at each end, and a longitudinal surface. We may speak of the latter as being divided into two equal parts by an imaginary transverse line on its surface called the ' equator,' containing all the points of the surface midway between the two ends. Fig. 20 is a diagrammatic representation of such a muscle, the line ab being the equator. In such a muscle the development of the muscle-currents is found to be as follows. ' These (Fig. 19) consist essentially of a slip of tlmroughli/ amalgamated zinc dipping into a saturated solution of zinc sulphate, wliicli, in turn, is brought into connection with the nerve or muscle by means of a plug or bridge of cliina-clay, moistened with normal sodium chloride solution , it is important that the zinc should be thoroughly amalgamated. This form of electrodes gives rise to less polarisation than do simple platinum or copper electrodes. The clay affords a connection be- tween the zinc and the tissue which neither acts on tlie tissue nor is acted on by the tissue. Contact of any tissue with copper or jdntinum is in itself sufficient to develope a current. 110 MUSCLE CURRENTS. [Book The greatest deflection is observed when one electrode is placed at the mid-point or equator of the muscle, and the other at either cut end ; and the deflection is of such a kind as to shew that posi- tive currents are continually passing from the equator through the galvanometer to the cut end : that is to say, the cut end is negative relatively to the equator. The currents outside the muscle may be considered as completed by currents in the muscle from the cut end to the equator. In the diagram Fig. 20, the arrows indicate the Fig. 20. Diagram illustrating the Electric Currents of Nerve and Muscle. Being purely diagrammatic, it may serve for a piece either of nerve or of muscle, except that the currents at the transverse section cannot be shewn in a nerve. The arrows shew the direction of the current through the galvanometer. ab the equator. The strongest currents are those shewn by the dark lines, as from a, at equator, to x or to y at the cut ends. The current from a to c is weaker than from a to y, though both, as shewn by the arrows, have the same direction. A current is shewn from e, which is near the equator, tof, which is farther from the equator. The current (in muscle) from a point in the circumference to a point nearer the centre of the transverse section is shewn at gh. From a to 6 or from X to y there is no current, as indicated by the dotted lines. direction of the currents. If the one electrode be placed at the equator ab, the effect is the same at whichever of the two cut ends x or y the other is placed. If, one electrode remaining at the equator, the other be shifted from the cut end to a spot c nearer to the equator, the current continues to have the same direction, but is of less intensity in proportion to the nearness of the electrodes to each other. If the two electrodes be placed at unequal distances e and /, one on either side of the equator, there will be a feeble current from the one nearer the equator to the one farther off, and the current will be the feebler, the more nearly they are equidistant from the equator. If they are quite equidistant, as, for instance, when one is placed on one cut end x, and the other on the other cut end y, there will be no current at all. If one electrode be placed at the circumference of the transverse section and the other at the centre of the transverse section, there Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. Ill will be a current through the galvanometer from the former to the latter ; there will be a current of similar direction but of less intensity when one electrode is at the circumference g of the trans- verse section, and the other at some point li nearer the centre of the transverse section. In fact, the points which are relatively most positive and most negative to each other are points on the equator and the two centres of the transverse sections ; and the intensity of the current between any two points will depend on the respective distances of those points from the equator and from the centre of the transverse section. Similar currents may be observed when the longitudinal surface is not the natural but an artificial one ; indeed they may be wit- nessed in even a piece of muscle provided it be of cylindrical shape and composed of parallel fibres. These ' muscle-currents ' are not mere transitory currents dis- appearing as soon as the circuit is closed ; on the contrary, they last a very considerable time. They must, therefore, be maintained by some changes going on in the muscle, by continued chemical action in fact. They disappear as the irritability of the muscle vanishes, and are connected with those nutritive, so-called vital changes which maintain the irritability of the muscle. Muscle-currents, such as have just been described, may, we re- peat, be observed in any cylindrical muscle suitably prepared, and similar currents, with variations which need not be discussed here, may be seen in muscles of irregular shape with obliquely or other- wise arranged fibres. And Du Bois-Eeymond, to whom chiefly we are indebted for our knowledge of these currents, has been led to regard them as essential and important properties of living muscle. He has moreover advanced the theory that muscle may be con- sidered as composed of electro-motive particles or molecules, each of which, like the muscle at large, has a positive equator and nega- tive ends, the whole muscle being made up of these molecules in somewhat the same way (to use an illustration which must not, however, be strained or considered as an exact one) as a magnet may be supposed to be made up of magnetic particles, each with its north and south pole. There are reasons, however, for thinking that these muscle- currents have no such fundamental origin, that they are in fact of surface and indeed of artificial origin. Without entering into the controversy on this question, the following important facts maybe mentioned : — 1. When a muscle is examined while it still retains uninjured its natural tendinous terminations, the currents are much weaker than when artificial transverse sections have been made ; the natural tendinous end is less negative than the cut surface. But the tendinous end becomes at once negative when it is dipped in water or acid, indeed, when it is in any way injured. The less roughly, in fact, a muscle is treated the less evident are the 112 MUSCLE CUEEENTS. [Book i. muscle-currents ; and it is maintained that if adequate care be taken to maintain a muscle in an absolutely natural condition, no such currents as those we have been describing exist at all, that natural living muscle is isoelectric, as it is called. 2. The surface of the uninjured inactive ^ ventricle of the frog's heart, which is practically a mass of muscle, is isoelectric, no current is obtained when the electrodes are placed on any two points of the surface. If, however, any part of the surface be injured, or if the ventricle be cut across so as to expose a cut surface, the injured spot or the cut surface becomes at once powerfully negative towards the uninjured surface, a strong current being developed which passes through the galvanometer from the uninjured surface to the cut surface or to the injured spot. The negativity thus developed in a cut surface passes off in the course of some hours, but may be restored by making a fresh cut and exposing a fresh surface. The temporary duration of the negativity after injury, and its renewal upon fresh injury, in the case of the ventricle, in contrast to the more permanent negativity of injured skeletal muscle, is explained by the different structure of the two kinds of muscle. The cardiac muscle, as we shall hereafter see, is composed of short fibre-cells ; when a cut is made a certain number of these fibre- cells are injured, giving rise to negativity, but the injury done to them stops with them, and is not propagated to the cells with which they are in contact ; hence, upon their death the negativity and the current disappear. A fresh cut involving new cells, pro- duces fresh negativity and a new current. In the long fibres of the skeletal muscle, on the other hand, the effects of the injury are slowly propagated along the fibre from the spot injured. Now, when a muscle is cut or injured, the substance of the fibres dies at the cut or injured surface. And many physiologists, among whom the most prominent is Hermann, have been led, by the above and other facts, to the conclusion that muscle-currents do not exist naturally in untouched, uninjured muscles, that the muscular substance is naturally, when living, isoelectric, but that whenever a portion of the muscular substance dies, it becomes while dying negative to the living substance, and thus gives rise to currents. They explain the typical currents (as they might be called) manifested by a muscle with a natural longitudinal surface and artificial transverse sections, by the fact that the dying cut ends are negative relatively to the rest of the muscle. Du Bois-Eeymond and those with him offer special explanations of the above facts and of other objections which have been urged against the theory of naturally existing electro-motive molecules. Into these we cannot enter here. We must rest content with the statement that in an ordinary muscle currents, such as have been described, may be witnessed, but that strong arguments may be ^ The necessity of its being inactive will be seen subsequently. Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 113 adduced in favour of the view that these currents are not ' natural ' phenomena, but essentially of artificial origin. It will therefore be best to speak of them as currents of rest. § 67. Currents of action. Negative variation of the Muscle- current. The controversy whether the ' currents of rest ' observable in a muscle be of natural origin or not, does not affect the truth or the importance of the fact that an electrical change takes place, and a current is developed in a muscle whenever it enters into a contraction. When currents of rest are observable in a muscle, these are found to undergo a diminution upon the occurrence of a contraction, and this diminution is spoken of as ' the negative variation ' of the currents of rest. The negative variation may be seen when a muscle is thrown into a single contraction, but is most readily shewn when the muscle is tetanized. Thus, if a pair of electrodes be placed on a muscle, one at the equator, and the other at or near the transverse section, so that a considerable deflection of the galvanometer needle, indicating a considerable current of rest, be gained, the needle of the galvanometer will, when the muscle is tetanized by an interrupted current sent through its nerve (at a point too far from the muscle to allow of any escape of the current into the electrodes connected with the galvanometer), swing back towards zero ; it returns to its original deflection when the tetanizing current is shut off. Not only may this negative variation be shewn by the galvano- meter, but it, as well as the current of rest, may be used as a galvanic shock, and so employed to stimulate a muscle, as in the experiment known as ' the rheoscopic frog.' For this purpose the muscles and nerves need to be in thoroughly good condition, and very irritable. Two muscle-nerve preparations, A and B, having been made, and each placed on a glass plate for the sake of insula- tion, the nerve of the one, B, is allowed to fall on the muscle of the other. A, in such a way that one point of the nerve comes in contact with the equator of the muscle, and another point with one end of the muscle or with a point at some distance from the equator. At the moment the nerve is let fall and contact made, a current, viz. the ' current of rest ' of the muscle A, passes through the nerve ; this acts as a stimulus to the nerve, and so causes a contraction in the muscle connected with a nerve. Thus the muscle A acts as a battery, the completion of the circuit of which by means of the nerve of B serves as a stimvilus, causing the muscle B to contract. If, while the nerve of B is still in contact with the muscl(^ of A, the nerve of the latter is tetanized with an interrupted current, not only is the muscle of A thrown into tetanus, but also that of B ; the reason being as follows. At each spasm of which the tetanus of A is made up, there is a negative variation of the muscle current of A. Each negative variation of the muscle current of A serves as a stimulus to the nerve of B, and is hence 114 MUSCLE CUEEENTS. [Book i. the cause of a spasm in the muscle of B; and the stimuli following each other rapidly, as being produced by the tetanus of A, they must do, the spasms in B to which they give rise are also fused into a tetanus in B. B, in fact, contracts in harmony with A. This experiment shews that the negative variation accompanying the tetanus of a muscle, though it causes only a single swing of the galvanometer, is really made up of a series of negative variations, each single negative variation corresponding to the single spasms ■of which the tetanus is made up. But an electrical change may be manifested even in cases when no currents of rest exist. We have stated (§ 66) that the surface of the uninjured inactive ventricle of the frog's heart is isoelectric, no currents being observed when the electrodes of a galvanometer are placed on two points of the surface. Nevertheless, a most •distinct current is developed whenever the ventricle contracts. This may be shewn either by the galvanometer or by the rheo- scopic frog. If the nerve of an irritable muscle-nerve preparation be laid over a pulsating ventricle, each beat is responded to by a twitch of the muscle of the preparation. In the case of ordinary muscles, too, instances occur in which it seems impossible to regard the electrical change manifested during the contraction as the mere diminution of a preexisting current. Accordingly those who deny the existence of ' natural ' muscle- currents speak of a muscle as developing during a contraction a ' current of action,' occasioned as they believe by the muscular sub- stance as it is entering into the state of contraction, becoming negative towards the muscular substance which is still at rest, or has returned to a state of rest. In fact, they regard the negativity of muscular substance as characteristic alike of beginning death and of a beginning contraction. So that in a muscular contraction a wave of negativity, starting from the end-plate when indirect, or from the point stimulated when direct stimulation is used, passes along the muscular substance to the ends or end of the fibre. If, for instance, we suppose two electrodes placed on two points (Fig. 21), A and B, of a fibre about to be stimulated by a single induc- tion-shock at one end. Before the stimulation the fibre is isoelectric, and the needle of the galvanometer stands at zero. At a certain time after the shock has been sent through the stimulating electrodes {x), as the wave of contraction is travelling down the fibre, the sec- tion of the fibre beneath A will become negative towards the rest of the fibre, and so negative towards Fig. 21. the portion of the fibre under B, Chap, ii.] THE CONTKACTILE TISSUES. 115 i.e. A will be negative relatively to B, and this will be shewn by a deflection of the needle. A little later, B will be entering into contraction, and will be becoming negative towards the rest of the fibre, including the part under A, whose negativity by this time •is passing off; that is to say, B will now be negative towards A, and this will be shewn by a deflection of the needle in a direction opposite to that of the deflection which has just previously taken place. Hence, between two electrodes placed along a fibre, a single wave of contraction will give rise to two currents of different phases, to a diphasic change ; and this, indeed, is found to be the case. This being so, it is obvious that the electrical result of tetanizing a muscle when wave after wave follows along each fibre, is a com- plex matter ; but it is maintained that the apparent negative variation of tetanus can be explained as the net result of a series of currents of action, due to the individual contractions, the second phase of the current in each contraction being less marked than the first phase. We cannot, however, enter more fully here into a discussion of this difficult subject. When we study, as we may do with the help of appropriate apparatus, the rapidity with which the electrical change accompany- ing a muscular contraction travels, we find it to be the same as that of the contraction wave itself. The older observations seemed to shew that the electrical change fell entirely within the latent period, and might, therefore, be regarded as an outward token of invisible molecular processes, occupying the latent period, and sweeping along the muscular fibre ahead of and preparing for the visible change of form. And, indeed, since we are led to regard the change of form as the result of chemical processes taking place in the muscular substance, we must suppose that the change of form is preceded by molecular chemical changes. But, as we have said, a latent period of measurable length does not appear to be an essential feature of a muscular contraction ; we may, under certain circumstances, fail to detect a latent period. And some recent observations seem to shew that the electrical change and the change of form may begin at the same time. Indeed, some have maintained that the former is the result of the latter, and not, as suggested above, of the forerunning molecular events. The question however is one which cannot at present be regarded as settled. The Changes in a Nerve during the passage of a Nei^vous Imjndse. § 68. The change in the form of a muscle during its contrac- tion is a thing which can be seen and felt ; hut the changes in a nerve during its activity are invisible and impalpable. We stimu- late one end of a nerve going to a muscle, and we see this followed 116 STRUCTURE OF A NERVE. [Book i, by a contraction of the muscle attached to the other end ; or we stimulate a nerve still connected with the central nervous system, and we see this followed by certain movements, or by other tokens which shew that disturbances have been set up in the central nervous system. We know, therefore, that some changes or other,' constituting what we have called a nervous impulse, have been propagated along the nerve ; but the changes are such as we cannot see. It is possible, however, to learn something about them. Structure of a Nerve. An ordinary nerve going to a muscle is composed of elementary nerve fibres, analogous to the elementary muscle fibres, running lengthwise along the nerve, and bound up together by connective tissues carrying blood vessels and lym- phatics. Each fibre is a long rod or cylinder, varying in diameter from less than 2/i to 20/a or even more, and the several fibres are arranged by the connective tissue into bundles or cords running along the length of the nerve. A large nerve, such as the sciatic, contains many cords of various sizes ; in such a case the connective tissue between the fibres in each cord is more delicate than that which binds the cords together ; each cord has a more or less distinct sheath of connective tissue, and a similar but stouter sheath protects the whole nerve. In smaller nerves the cords are less in number, and a very small nerve may consist, so to speak, of one cord only ; that is to say, it has one sheath for the whole nerve and fine connective tissue binding together all the fibres within the sheath. When a large nerve divides or sends off branches, one or more cords leave the trunk to form the branch ; when nerves are joined to form a plexus, one or more cords leaving one nerve join another nerve ; it is, as a rule, only when a very small nerve is dividing near its end into delicate twigs, that division or branching of the nerve is effected or assisted by division of the nerve fibres themselves. Nearly all the nerve fibres composing an ordinary nerve, such as that going to a muscle, though varying very much in thickness, have the same features, which are as follows. Seen under the microscope in a perfectly fresh condition, without the use of any reagents, each fibre appears as a transparent but somewhat re- fractive, and therefore bright-looking, rod, with a sharply defined outline, which is characteristically double ; that is to say, the sharp line which marks the outside of the fibre is on each side of the fibre accompanied by a second line parallel to itself, and following such gentle curves as it shews, but rather nearer the axis of the fibre. This is spoken of as the doiible contour, and is naturally more conspicuous and more easily seen in the thicker than in the thinner fibres. The substance of the fibre between the two inner contour lines appears, in the perfectly fresh fibre, homogeneous. If the fibre be traced along its course for some little distance, there will be seen at intervals an appearance as if the fibre had been Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 117 strangled by a ligature tied tightly round it ; its transverse diameter is suddenly narrowed, and the double contour lost, the jfibre above and below being united by a narrow, short isthmus only. This is called a node, a node of Kanvier, and upon exami- nation it will be found that each fibre is marked regularly along its length by nodes at intervals of about a millimeter. If the fibre be examined with further care, there will be seen, or may be seen, about midway between every two nodes, an oval nucleus lying embedded, as it were, in the outline of the fibre, with its long axis parallel, or nearly so, to the axis of the fibre. If some of the fibres be torn across, it may sometimes be seen that at the torn end of a fibre, though the double contour ceases, the outline of the fibre is continued as a delicate, transparent, membranous tubular sheath ; this is the primitive sheath, or neurilemma} Lying in the axis of this sheath, and sometimes projecting for some distance from the torn end of a fibre, whether the sheath be displayed or no, may, in some cases, be seen a dim or very faintly granular band, or thread, about one-third or half the diameter of the fibre. This is the axis-cylinder ; it becomes lost to view as we trace it back to where the fibre assumes a double contour. This axis-cylinder stains readily with ordinary staining reagents, and being in this and in other respects allied in nature to the cell-substance of a leucocyte or to the muscle-substance of a muscular fibre, has often been spoken of as protoplasmic. Lying about the torn ends of the fibres may be seen drops, or minute irregular masses, remarkable for exhibiting a double contour like that of the nerve fibre itself ; and, indeed, drops of this double contoured substance may be seen issuing from the torn ends of the fibres. Treated with osmic acid, these drops and masses are stained black ; they act as powerful reducing reagents, and the reduced osmium gives the black colour. Treated with ether or other solvents of fat they, moreover, more or less readily dissolve. Obviously they are largely composed of fat, and we shall see that the fat composing them is of a very complex nature. Now, a nerve fibre, shewing a double contour, stains black with osmic acid ; but the staining is absent or very slight where the double contour ceases, as at a torn end or at the nodes of Eanvier ; the axis- cylinder stains very slightly indeed with osmic acid and the sheath hardly at all. So, also, when a transverse section is made through a nerve, or a nerve cord, each fibre appears in section as a dark, black ring, surrounding a much more faintly stained central area. Further, when a double contoured nerve fibre is treated with ether, or other solvents of fat, the double contour vanishes, and the ^ 'I'his word was formerly used to denote the connective tissue sheath wrapping round the whole nerve. It seemed undesirable, however, to use two such analogous terms as sarcolemma and neurilemma for two things obviously without analogy, and hence neurilemma is now used for that part of "the nerve "which is obviouslj- analogous to the sarcolemma in muscle, viz. the sheath of the fibre. 118 STRUCTUEE OF A NERVE FIBRE. [Book i. whole fibre becomes more transparent ; and if such a fibre, eithei before or after the treatment with ether, be stained with carmine or other dye, the axis-cylinder will be seen as a stained band or thread lying in the axis of a tubular space, defined by the neurilemma, which stains only slightly except at and around the nuclei, which, as we have seen, are embedded in it at intervals. In the entire fibre the tubular space between the axis-cylinder and the sheath is filled with a fatty material, the medulla, which from its fatty nature has such a refractive power as to exhibit a double contour when seen with transmitted light, on which account the fibre itself has a double contour. It is this refractive power of the medulla which gives to a nerve fibre, and still more so to a bundle of nerve fibres or to a whole nerve, a characteristic opaque, white colour when viewed by reflected light. As we shall see, all nerve fibres do not possess a medulla, and hence such a fibre as we are describing is called a medullated fibre. A typical medullated fibre consists, then, of the following parts. 1. The axis-cylinder, a central cylindrical core of so called ' protoplasmic ' material, delicate in nature and readily undergoing change, sometimes swelling out, sometimes shrinking, and hence in various specimens appearing now as a thick band, now as a thin streak in the axis of the tubular sheath, and giving in cross section sometimes a circular, sometimes an oval, and not unfrequently a quite irregular outline. Probably in a perfectly natural condition it occupies about one-half the diameter of the nerve, but even its natural size varies in different nerve fibres. When seen quite fresh, it has simply a dim, cloudy or at most a faintly granular appearance ; under the influence of reagents it is apt to become fibrillated longitudinally, and has been supposed to be in reality composed of a number of delicate, longitudinal fibrillse united by an interfibrillar substance, but this is not certain. It is further said to be protected on its outside by a transparent sheath, the axis-cylinder sheath, but this also is disputed. The axis-cylinder passes unbroken through successive nodes of Eanvier, the constriction of the node not affecting it otherwise than perhaps to narrow it. Now, the fibres of a spinal nerve (omitting for the present the fibres coming from the sympathetic nerves) may be traced back either to the spinal ganglion on the posterior root, or along the anterior root to the anterior cornua of the spinal cord ; and, as we shall see, the axis-cylinders of the fibres are, in both cases, prolongations of processes of nerve cells, in the former case of cells of the ganglion, in the latter case of cells of the anterior cornua. In each case a process of a cell becoming the axis-cylinder of a nerve fibre runs an unbroken course, passes as a continuous band of peculiar living matter, through node after node right down to the termination of the fibre in the tissue in which the fibre ends ; the only obvious change which Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 119 it undergoes is that, in many if not all cases, it divides near its termination in the tissue, and in some cases the divisions are numerous, and join or anastomose freely. Obviously the axis- cylinder is the essential part of the nerve fibre. 2. The primitive sheath or neurilemmci, a tubular sheath of transparent, apparently homogeneous, material, not unlike that of a sarcolemma in nature. At each node the neurilemma is con- stricted so as to embrace the axis-cylinder closely, but is at the same time thickened by some kind of cement material. Staining reagents, especially silver nitrate, appear to enter the nerve fibre from without more readily at a node than elsewhere, staining the fibre most at the node, and creeping upwards and downwards from the node along the axis-cylinder ; hence it has been supposed that the nutritive fluid, the lymph, enters into the fibre and so gets access to the axis-cylinder more readily at the nodes than else- where. About midway between every two nodes is placed a long oval nucleus, on the inside of the neurilemma, pushing the medulla, as it were, inwards, and so lying in a shallow bay of that substance. Immediately surrounding the nucleus is a thin layer of granular substance, of the kind which we have spoken of as undifferentiated protoplasm ; in young, newly formed fibres at all events, and possibly in all fibres, a very thin layer of this same substance is continued all over the segment between the nodes, on the inner surface of the neurilemma between it and the medulla. 3. The medtdla. This is a hollow cylinder of fatty material of a peculiar nature, filling all the space between the neurilemma on the outside and the axis-cylinder within, and suddenly ceasing at each node. It thus forms a close-fitting hollow jacket for the axis-cylinder between every two nodes. The fatty material is fluid, at least at the temperature of the body, but appears to be held in its place as it were by a network of a substance called neurokeratin, allied to the substance keratin, which is the basis of the horny scales of the epidermis and of other horny structures ; this network is most marked towards the outside of the medulla. So long as the nerve is in a fresh, living, perfectly normal condition, the medulla appears smooth and continuous, shewing no marks beyond the double contour ; but in nerves removed from the body for examination (and according to some observers, at times in nerves still within the body) clefts make their appearance in the medulla running obliquely inwards from the neurilemma to the axis-cylinder, and frequently splitting up the medulla in such a way that it appears to be composed of a number of hollow cones, partially slid one over the other along the axis-cylinder. These clefts are spoken of as indentations. At a later stage of alteration the medulla may divide into a number of small, irregular masses separated by fluid ; and since each small piece thus separated has a double contour, like a drop of medulla exuded from the end of a fibre, the whole fibre has an irregular, ' curdy ' appearance. 120 STRUCTUEE OF A NERVE FIBRE. [Book i. The essential part, then, of a medullated nerve fibre (of a spinal nerve) is the axis-cylinder, which is really a prolongation of a process from a nerve cell in a spinal ganglion or in the spinal cord, running an unbroken course through node after node, never in its course, as far as we know, joining another axis-cylinder, and very rarely dividing until it approaches its end, where it may divide freely, the divisions in some cases anastomosing freely. We may conclude, and all we know supports the conclusion that the changes, making up what we have called a nervous impulse, take place, primarily and chiefly at all events, in this essential part of the nerve fibre, the axis-cylinder. The neurilemma and medulla together form a wrapping for the nourishment and protec- tion of the axis-cylinder, the fatty medulla probably serving partly as prepared food for the axis-cylinder, partly as a mechanical support ; possibly it may also play a part as an insulator in the electric phenomena. It is easy, moreover, to see that while the axis-cylinder along its whole length is practically (whatever be the exact manner of its formation in the embryo) a part of the cell of which it is an elongated process, each segment between every two nodes repre- sents a cell wrapping round the axis-cylinder process, of which cell the nucleus between the nodes is the nucleus, the neurilemma the envelope or cell wall, and (though this is perhaps not quite so clear) the medulla the cell-substance largely converted into fatty material, a cell in fact which is really outside the axis-cylinder or nerve fibre proper. It is along the axis-cylinder that the nervous impulses sweep, and each wrapping cell only serves to nourish and protect the segment of the axis-cylinder between its two nodes. And we accordingly find that both at the beginning of the nerve fibre in the ganglion cell or spinal cord, and at its end in the tissue, both neurilemma and medulla disappear, the axis-cylinder only being left. A nerve going to a muscle is chiefly composed of medullated fibres, as just described, the majority of which, ending in end- plates in the muscular fibres, are the fibres which conduct the nervous impulses to the muscle, causing it to contract, and may hence be spoken of as motor nerve fibres. Some of the fibres, however, end in other parts, such as the tendon, or the connective tissue between the bundles, and some in the blood vessels. There are reasons for thinking that some of these convey impulses from the muscle to the central nervous system, and are conse- quently spoken of as sensory or afferent fibres , concerning those connected with the blood vessels we shall speak in dealing with the vascular system. § 69. Nerve-endings in striated muscular fibres. A nerve on entering a muscle divides into a number of branches which, running in the connective tissue of the muscle, form a plexus round the bundles of muscle fibres, the smaller branches forming a plexus Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 121 round the muscle fibres themselves. From this plexus are given off a number of nerve fibres, running singly, each of which, joining a muscle fibre, ends in an end-plate. In forming these plexuses the individual nerve fibres divide repeatedly, the division always taking place at a node of Ranvier ; so that what is a single nerve fibre as the nerve enters the muscle may give rise to several nerve fibres ending in several muscle fibres. The nerve fibre joins the muscle fibre at about its middle, or somewhat nearer one end, and occasionally two nerve fibres may join one muscle fibre and form two end-plates. The general distribution of the bundles of nerve fibres and single nerve fibres is such that some portion of the muscle is left free from nerve fibres ; thus at the lower and at the upper end of the sartorius of the frog there is a portion of muscle quite free from nerve fibres. A single nerve fibre, running by itself, has outside the neuri- lemma an additional delicate sheath of fine, connective tissue known as HcnWs s/^e«^A, which appears to be a continuation of the connective tissue forming the sheath of the nerve branch from which the fibre sprang, or uniting the fibres together in the branch. The actual ending of the nerve fibre in the muscle fibre differs in different classes of animals. In mammals and some other animals the single nerve fibre joins the muscle fibre in a swelling or projection having a more or less oval base, and appearing, when seen sideways, as a low, conical, or rounded eminence. At the summit of this eminence the nerve fibre loses both its sheath of Henle and its neurilemma, one or other or both (for on this point, observers do not agree) becoming continuous with the sarcolemma of the muscle fibre. At the summit of the eminence, where the sheaths fuse, the fibre, now consisting only of axis-cylinder and medulla, loses its medulla abruptly (in the muscles of the tongue the nerve fibre in many cases loses its medulla at some considerable distance before it joins the muscle fibre to form the end-plate), while the axis- cylinder branches out in all directions, tlie somewhat varicose branches, which sometimes anastomose, forming a low, conical mass, which, when viewed from above, has an arborescent or labyrinthine appearance. On the branches of this arborescence may lie one or more somewhat granular oval nuclei. The arborescence itself has, like the axis-cylinder of which it is a development, a very faintly granular or cloudy appearance, but lying between it and the actual muscle substance is a disc or bed of somewhat coarsely granular material, called the sole of the end-plate, on which the ramified arborescent axis-cylinder rests, more or less overlapping it at the edge, but with which it appears not to be actually continuous. Lying in the midst of this ' sole ' are a number of clear, oval, transparent nuclei. The end-plate then beneath the sarcolemma consists of two 122 END PLATES. [Book i. parts, the ramified axis-cylinder, and the granular nucleated sole, the two apparently, though in juxtaposition, not being continuous. According to some observers, the sole is continuous with, and, indeed, is a specialized part of that substance pervading the whole muscu- lar fibre, which we spoke of as interfibrillar substance. We cannot enter here into a discussion of the probable meaning and use of these structures, or how they effect what seems obviously their function, the transformation of the changes con- stituting a nervous impulse into the changes which constitute a muscle contraction. It is of interest to observe that certain analogies may be drawn between an end-plate and the histological elements of the so-called electrical organs of certain animals. The element of the electric organ of the torpedo, for instance, may be regarded as a muscle fibre in which the nerve ending has become highly developed, while the muscle substance has been arrested in its development and has not become striated. In amphibia {e.g. in frogs), the ending of a nerve fibre in a muscle fibre is somewhat different. A nerve fibre about to end in a muscle fibre divides into a brush of several nerve fibres, each of which, losing its sheath of Henle and neurilemma, enters the same muscle fibre, and then, losing its medulla, runs longitudinally along the fibre for some distance, it and its branches dividing several, times in a characteristically forked manner, and bearing at intervals oval nuclei. In other animals, forms of nerve ending are met with more or less intermediate between that seen in the mammal and that seen in the frog. § 70. Besides the medullated nerve fibres described in § 68, there are, in most nerves going to muscles, a few and in some nerves, going to other parts, a large number of nerve fibres which do not possess a medulla, and hence are called non-meduUated fibres ; these are especially abundant in the so-called sympathetic nerves. A non-medullated fibre which, like a medullated fibre, may have any diameter from 2yu, or less to 20yLfc or more, is practically a naked axis-cylinder, not covered with medulla, but bearing on its outside at intervals oval nuclei disposed longitudinally. These nuclei appear wholly analogous to the nuclei of the neurilemma of a medullated fibre, and probably belong to a sheath enclosing each fibre, though it is not easy to demonstrate the independent exist- ence of such a sheath in the case of most non-medullated fibres. In the similar fibres, constituting the olfactory nerve, a sheath is quite conspicuous. Unlike the medullated fibres these non-medul- lated divide and also join freely ; like them each may be regarded as a process of a nerve cell. Of such non-medullated fibres, a scanty number are found in nerves going to muscles scattered among the medullated fibres, and bound up with them by connective tissue. They appear to have no connection with the muscular fibres, but to be distributed Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 123 chiefly to the blood vessels ; and the function of non-medullated fibres had better be considered in connection with nerves of which they form a large part, such as certain nerves going to blood vessels and to secreting organs. But it may be stated that, though they possess no medulla, they are capable of propagating nervous impulses in the same way as medullated nerves ; and this fact may be taken as indicating that the medulla cannot serve any very important function as an electric insulator. § 71. The chemistry of a nerve. We have spoken of the medulla as fatty, and yet it is in reality very largely composed of a substance which is not (in the strict sense of the word) a fat. When we examine chemically a quantity of nerve (or, what is practically the same thing, a quantity of that part of the central nervous system which is called white matter, and which, as we shall see, is chiefly composed, like a nerve, of medullated nerves, and is to be preferred for chemical examination because it contains a relatively small quantity of connective tissue), we find that a very large proportion, according to some observers about half, of the dried matter consists of the peculiar • body cholesterin. Now, cholesterin is not a fat, but an alcohol ; like glycerine, however, which is also an alcohol, it forms compounds with fatty acids ; and though we do not know definitely the chemical condition in which cholesterin exists during life in the medulla, it is more than probable that it exists in some combination with some of the really fatty bodies also present in the medulla, and not in a free, isolated state. It is singular that besides being present in such large quantities in nervous tissue, and to a small extent in other tissues and in blood, cholesterin is a normal constituent of bile, and forms the greater part of gall stones, when these are present ; in gall stones it is undoubtedly present in a free state. Besides cholesterin, ' white ' nervous matter contains a less but still considerable quantity of a complex fat, whose nature is disputed. According to some authorities, rather less than half this complex fat consists of the peculiar body lecithin, which we have already seen to be present also in blood corpuscles and in muscle. Lecithin contains the radicle of stearic acid (or of oleic, or of palmitic acid) associated not, as in ordinary fats, with simple glycerin, but with the more complex glycerin-phosphoric acid, and further combined with a nitrogenous body, neurin, an am- monia compound of some considerable complexity ; it is, therefore, of remarkable nature, since, though a fat, it contains both nitrogen and phosphorus. According to the same authorities, the remainder of the complex fat consists of another fatty body, also apparently containing nitrogen but no phosphorus, called cerehrin. Other authorities regard both these bodies, lecithin and cerebrin, as products of decomposition of a still more complex fat, called jsrotagon. Obviously the fat of the white matter of the central nervous system and of spinal nerves (of which fat by far the 124 THE CHEMISTRY OF NERVES. [Book i, greater part must exist in the medulla, and form nearly the whole of the medulla) is a very complex body indeed, especially so if the cholesterin exists in combination with the lecithin, or cerebrin (or protagon). Being so complex, it is naturally very unstable, and, in- deed, in its instability resembles proteid matter. Hence, probably the reason why the medulla changes so rapidly and so profoundly after the death of the nerve. It seems, moreover, that a certain though small quantity of proteid matter forms part of the medulla, and it is possible that this exists in some kind of combination with the complex fat ; but our knowledge on this point is imperfect. The presence in such large quantity of this complex fatty medulla renders the chemical examination of the other consti- tuents of a nerve very difficult, and our knowledge of the chemical nature of, and of the chemical changes going on in the axis-cylinder, is very limited. Examined under the microscope the axis-cylinder gives the xanthoproteic reaction and other indications that it is proteid in nature ; beyond this we are largely confined to inferences. We infer that its chemical nature is in a general way similar to that of the cell-substance of the nerve cell of which it is a process. We infer that the chemical nature of the cell-substance of a nerve cell, being of the kind which is frequently called ' protoplasmic,' is, in a general way, similar to that of other ' protoplasmic ' cells, for instance of a leucocyte. Now, where we can examine con- veniently such cells we find, as we have said, § 30, the proteid basis of the kind of cell-substance which is frequently spoken of as ' undifferentiated protoplasm,' though it has certain special features, resembles, in a broad way, the proteid basis of that • dif- ferentiated protoplasm,' which we have called muscle substance. Hence, we infer that in their broad chemical features the axis- cylinder of a nerve fibre and the cell-body of a nerve cell resemble the substance of a muscle fibre ; and this view is supported by the fact that both kreatin and lactic acid are present as ' extractives,' certainly in the central nervous system, and probably in nerves. The resemblance is, of course, only a general one ; there must be differences in chemical nature between the axis-cylinder which propagates a nervous impulse without change of outward form and the muscle fibre which contracts ; but we cannot at present state exactly what these differences really are. After the fats of the medulla (and the much smaller quantity of fat presented in the axis-cylinder), the proteids of the axis-cylinder, and the other soluble substances present in one or the other, or gathered round the nuclei of the neurilemma, have by various means been dissolved out of a nerve fibre, certain substances still remain. One of these in small quantity is the nuclein of the nuclei : another in larger quantity is the substance neurokeratin which forms, as we have seen, a supporting framework for the medulla, and whose most marked characteristic is perhaps its resistance to solution. Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 125 In the ash of nerves there is a preponderance of potassium, salts and phosphates, but not so marked as in the case of muscle. § 72. The nervous impulse. The chemical analogy between the substance of the muscle and that of the axis-cylinder would naturally lead us to suppose that the progress of a nervous impulse along a nerve fibre was accompanied by chemical changes similar to those taking place in a muscle fibre. Whatever changes, how- ever, do or may take place, are too slight to be recognized by the means at our disposal. We have no satisfactory evidence that in a nerve even repeated nervous impulses can give rise to an acid reaction, or that the death of a nerve fibre leads to such a reaction. The grey matter of the central nervous system, it is true, is said to be faintly alkaline during life, and to become acid after death; but in this grey matter nerve cells are relatively abundant ; the white matter, composed chiefly of nerve fibres, is and remains, during action as well as rest, and even after death, neutral or slightly alkaline. Nor have we satisfactory evidence that the progress of a nervous impulse is accompanied by any setting free of energy in the form of heat. In fact, beyond the terminal results, such as a muscular con- traction in the case of a nerve going to a muscle, or some affection of the central nervous system in the case of a nerve still in connec- tion with its nervous centre, there is one event and one event only which we are able to recognize as the objective token of a nervous impulse, and that is an electric change. For a piece of nerve removed from the body exhibits nearly the same electric pheno- mena as a piece of muscle. It has an equator which is electrically positive relatively to the two cut ends. In fact, the diagram, Fig. 20, and the description which was given in § 66 of the electric changes in muscle, may be applied almost as well to a nerve, except that the currents are in all cases much more feeble in the case of nerves than of muscles, and the special currents from the circumference to the centre of the transverse sections cannot well be shewn in a slender nerve ; indeed, it is doubtful if they exist at all. During the passage of a nervous impulse, the ' natural nerve current ' undergoes a negative variation, just as the ' natural muscle current ' undergoes a negative variation during a con- traction. There are, moreover, reasons in the case of the nerve, as in the case of the muscle, which lead us to doubt the pre-existence of any such ' natural ' currents. A nerve in an absolutely natural condition appears to be, like a muscle, isoelectric ; hence we may say that in a nerve during the passage of a nervous impulse, as in a muscle during a muscular contraction, a ' current of action ' is developed. This ' current of action,' or ' negative variation,' may be shewn either by the galvanometer or by the rheoscopic frog. If the nerve of the ' muscle nerve preparation ' B (see § 67), be placed in an 126 ELECTRIC CURRENTS IN NERVES. [Book i. appropriate manner on a thoroughly irritable nerve A (to which of course no muscle need be attached), touching for instance the equator and one end of the nerve, then single induction-shocks sent into the far end of A will cause single spasms in the muscle of B, while tetanization of A, i.e. rapidly repeated shocks sent into A, will cause tetanus of the muscle of B. That this current, whether it be regarded as an independent ' current of action,' or as a negative variation of a ' pre-existing ' current, is an essential feature of a nervous impulse, is shewn by the fact that the degree or intensity of the one varies with that of the other. They both travel, too, at the same rate. In describing the muscle-curve, and the method of measuring the muscular latent period, we have incidentally shewn (§ 46) how at the same time the velocity of the nervous impulse may be measured, and stated that the rate in the nerves of a frog is about 28 meters a second. By means of a special and somewhat complicated apparatus, it is ascertained that the current of action travels along an isolated piece of nerve at the same rate. It also, like the contraction, travels in the form of a wave, rising rapidly to a maximum at each point of the nerve, and then more gradually declining again. The length of the wave may by special means be measured, and is found to be about 18 mm. When an isolated piece of nerve is stimulated in the middle, the current of action is propagated equally well in both directions, and that whether the nerve be a chiefly sensory or a chiefly motor nerve, or, indeed, if it be a nerve-root composed exclusively of motor or of sensory fibres. Taking the current of action as the token of a nervous impulse, we infer from this that when a nerve fibre is stimulated artificially at any part of its course, the nervous impulse set going travels in both directions. We used just now the phrase ' tetanization of a nerve,' meaning the application to a nerve of rapidly repeated shocks such as would produce tetanus in the muscle to which the nerve was attached, and we shall have frequent occasion to employ the phrase. It must, however, be understood that there is in the nerve, in an ordinary way, no summation of nervous impulses comparable to the summation of muscular contractions. Putting aside certain cases which we cannot discuss here, we may say that the series of shocks sent in at the far end of the nerve start a series of impulses ; these travel down the nerve, and reach the muscle as a series of distinct impulses ; and the first changes in the muscle, the molecular changes, which, sweeping along the fibre, initiate the change of form, and which we may perhaps speak of as constituting a muscle impulse, also probably form a series the members of which are distinct. It is not until these molecular changes become trans- formed into visible changes of form that any fusion or summation takes place. § 73. Putting together the facts contained in this and the pre- Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 127 ceding sections, the following may be taken as a brief approximate history of what takes place in a muscle and nerve when the latter is subjected to a single induction-shock. At the instant that the induced current passes into the nerve, changes occur, of whose nature we know nothing certain except that they cause a ' current of action,' or ' negative variation,' of the ' natural ' nerve current. These changes propagate themselves along the nerve in both directions as a nervous impulse in the form of a wave, having a wave-length of about 18 mm., and a velocity (in frog's nerve) of about 28 m. per sec. Passing down the nerve fibres to the muscle, flowing along the branching and narrowing tracts, the wave at last breaks on the end-plates of the fibres of the muscle. Here it is transmuted into what we have called a muscle impulse, which, with a greatly diminished velocity (about 3 ]n. per sec), travels from each end-plate in both directions to the end of the fibre, where it appears to be lost ; at all events we do not know what becomes of it. As this impulse wave sweeps along the fibre, it initiates an explosive decomposition of material, leading to a discharge of carbonic acid, to the appearance of some substance or substances with an acid reaction, and probably of other unknown things, with a considerable development of heat. This explosive decomposition gives rise to the visible contraction wave ; the fibre, as tlie wave passes over it, swells and shortens, and thus brings its two ends nearer together. When repeated shocks are given, wave follows wave of nervous impulse, muscle impulse, and visible contraction ; but the last do not keep distinct : they are fused into the continued shortening which we call tetanus. SEC. 3. THE NATUEE OF THE CHANGES THEOUGH WHICH AN ELECTEIC CUEEENT IS ABLE TO GENE- EATE A NEEVOUS IMPULSE. Action of the Constant Current. § 74. In the preceding account, the stimulus applied in order to give rise to a nervous impulse has always been supposed to be an induction-shock, single or repeated. This choice of stimulus has been made on account of the almost momentary duration of the induced current. Had we used a current lasting for some consider- able time, the problems before us would have become more com- plex, in consequence of our having to distinguish between the events taking place while the current was passing through the nerve, from those which occurred at the moment when the current was thrown into the nerve, or at the moment when it was shut off from the nerve. These complications do arise when, instead of employing the induced current as a stimulus, we use a constant current, i.e. when we pass through the nerve (or muscle) a current direct from the battery, without the intervention of any induc- tion-coil. Before making the actual experiment, we might, perhaps, naturally suppose that the constant current would act as a stimu- lus throughout the whole time during which it was applied ; that, so long as the current passed along the nerve, nervous impulses would be generated, and that these would throw the muscle into some- thing at all events like tetanus. And under certain conditions this does take place ; occasionally it does happen that at the moment the current is thrown into the nerve the muscle of the muscle- nerve preparation falls into a tetanus, which is continued until the current is shut off ; but such a result is exceptional. In the vast majority of cases what happens is as follows. At the moment that the circuit is made, the moment that the current is thrown into the nerve, a single twitch, a simple contraction, the so-called making contraction,, is, witnessed ; but after this has passed away Chap. ii.J THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 129 the muscle remains absolutely quiescent in spite of the current continuing to pass through the nerve, and this quiescence is maintained until the circuit is broken, until the current is shut off from the nerve, when another simple contraction, the so- called breaking contraction, is observed. The mere passage of a constant current of uniform intensity through a nerve does not, under ordinary circumstances, act as a stimulus generating a nervous impulse ; such an impulse is only set up when the current either falls into or is shut off from the nerve. It is the entrance or the exit of the current, and not the continuance of the current, which is the stimulus. The quiescence of the nerve and muscle during the passage of the current is, however, dependent on the current remaining uniform in intensity or at least not being suddenly increased or diminished. Any sufficiently sudden and large increase or diminution of the intensity of the current will act like the entrance or exit of a current, and, by generating a nervous impulse, give rise to a contraction. If the intensity of the current, however, be very slowly and gradually increased or di- minished, a very wide range of intensity may be passed through without any contraction being seen. It is the sudden change from one condition to another, and not the condition itself, which causes the nervous impulse. In many cases, both a ' making ' and a ' breaking ' contraction, each a simple twitch, are observed, and this is perhaps the commonest event ; but when the current is very weak, and again when the current is very strong, either the breaking or the making contraction may be absent, i.e. there may be a contraction only when the current is thrown into the nerve, or only when it is shut off from the nerve. Under ordinary circumstances the contractions witnessed with the constant current, either at the make or at the break, are of the nature of a ' simple' contraction, but, as has already been said, the application of the current may give rise to a very pronounced tetanus. Such a tetanus is seen sometimes when the current is made, lasting during the application of the current, sometimes when the current is broken, lasting some time after the current has been wholly removed from the nerve. The former is spoken of as a ' making,' the latter as a ' breaking ' tetanus. But these excep- tional results of the application of the constant current need not detain us now. The great interest attached to the action of the constant current lies in the fact that during the passage of the current, in spite of the absence of all nervous impulses, and, therefore, of all muscular contractions, the nerve is for the time both between and on each side of the electrodes profoundly modified in a most peculiar manner. This modification, important both for the light it throws on the generation of nervous impulses and for its practical applications, is known under the name of clcctrotonus. 130 ELECTR0T0:N^US. [Book i. § 75. Mectrotonus. The marked feature of the electrotonic condition is that the nerve, though apparently quiescent, is changed in respect to its irritabihty ; and that in a different way in the neighbourhood of the two electrodes respectively. Suppose that on the nerve of a muscle-nerve preparation are placed two (non-polarizable) electrodes (Fig. 22, a, k), connected with a battery and arranged with a key so that a constant current can at pleasure be thrown into or shut off from the nerve. This constant current, whose effects we are about to study, may be called the ' polarizing current.' Let a be the positive electrode or anode, and k the negative electrode or kathode, both placed at some distance from the muscle, and also with a certain interval between each other. At the point x let there be applied a pair of electrodes connected with an induction-coil. Let the muscle further be connected with a lever, so that its contractions can be recorded, and their amount measured. Before the polarizing current is thrown into the nerve, let a single induction-shock of known intensity (a weak one being chosen, or at least not one which would cause in the muscle a maximum contraction) be thrown in at x. A contraction of a certain amount will follow. 11 ^~z a B. a Fig. 22. MuscLE-NEKVE Pkepaeations, with the nerve exposed in J. to a descending and in B to an ascending constant current. In each a is the anode, h the kathode of the constant current, x represents the spot where the induction-shocks used to test the irritability of the nerve are sent in. That contraction may be taken as a measure of the irritability of the nerve at the point x. Now, let the polarizing current be thrown in, and let the kathode or negative pole be nearest the muscle, as in Fig. 22 A, so that the current passes along the nerve in a direction from the central nervous system towards the muscle ; such a current is spoken of as a descending one. The entrance of the polarizing current into the nerve will produce Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 131 a 'making' contraction; this we may neglect. If while the current is passing, the same induction-shock as before be sent through X, the contraction which results will be found to be greater than on the former occasion. If the polarizing current be now shut off, a ' breaking ' contraction will probably be produced ; this also we may neglect. If now the point x, after a short interval, be again tested with the same induction-shock as Ijefore, the contraction will be no longer greater, but of the same amount, or perhaps not so great, as at first. During the passage of the polarizing current, therefore, the irritability of the nerve at the point x has been temporarily increased, since the same shock applied to it causes a greater contraction during the presence than in the absence of the current. But this is only true so long as the polarizing current is a descending one, so long as the point x lies ■on the side of the kathode. On the other hand, if the polarizing current had been an ascending one, with the anode or positive pole nearest the muscle, as in Fig. 22 B, the irritability of the nerve at X would have been found to be diminished instead of increased by the polarizing current ; the contraction obtained during the passage •of the constant current would be less than before the passage of the current, or might be absent altogether, and the contraction after the current had been shut off would be as great or perhaps greater than before. That is to say, when a constant current is applied to a nerve, the irritability of the nerve between the polar- izing electrodes and the muscle is, during the passage of the current, increased when the kathode is nearest the muscle (and the polarizing current descending), and diminished when the anode is nearest the muscle (and the polarizing current ascending). The same result, mutatis mutandis, and with some qualifications which we need not discuss, would be gained if x were placed not between the muscle and the polarizing current, but on the far side of the latter. Hence, it may be stated generally that during the passage of a constant current through a nerve, the irritability of the nerve is increased in the region of the kathode, and diminished in the region of the anode. The changes in the nerve which give rise to this increase of irritability in the region of the kathode are spoken of as katelectrotonus, and the nerve is said to be in a katelectrotonic condition. Similarly the changes in the region of the anode are spoken of as anelectrotonus, and the nerve is said to be in an anelectrotonic condition. It is also often usual to speak of the katelectrotonic increase, and anelectrotonic decrease of irritability. This law remains true whatever be the mode adopted for determining the irritability. The result holds good not only with a single induction-shock, but also with a tetanizing inter- rupted current, with chemical and with mechanical stimuli. It further appears to hold good not only in a dissected nerve-muscle preparation, but also in the intact nerves of the living body. The 132 ELECTEOTONUS. [Book i. increase and decrease of irritability are most marked in the immediate neighbourliood of the electrodes, but spread for a considerable distance in each direction in the extrapolar regions. The same modification is not confined to the extrapolar region, but exists also in the intrapolar region. In the intrapolar region there must be of course a neutral or indifferent point, where the katelectrotonic increase merges into the anelectrotonic decrease, and where, therefore, the irritability is unchanged. When the polarizing current is a weak one, this indifferent point is nearer the anode than the kathode, but as the polarizing current increases in intensity, draws nearer and nearer the kathode (see Eig. 23). The amount of increase and decrease is dependent : (1) On the strength of the current, the stronger current up to a certain limit producing the greater effect. (2) On the irritability of the nerve, the more irritable, better conditioned nerve being the more affected by a current of the same intensity. In the experiments just described the increase or decrease of irritability is taken to mean that the same stimulus starts in the one case a larger or more powerful, and in the other case a smaller or less energetic impulse ; but we have reason to think that the mere propagation or conduction of impulses started elsewhere is also affected by the electrotonic condition. At all events anelectrotonus appears to offer an obstacle to the passage of a nervous impulse. •3 IB Fig. 23. Diagram illustrating the Variations of Irritability during Electro- TONUS, WITH Polarizing Currents of Increasing Intensity (from Pfliiger). The anode is supposed to be placed at A, the kathode at B ; AB is consequently the intrapolar district. In each of the three curves, the portion of the curve below the base line represents diminished irritability, that above, increased irritability. yi represents the effect of a weak current ; the indifferent point x^ is near the anode A. In ?/2, a stronger current, the indifferent point X2 is nearer the kathode B, the diminution of irritability in anelectrotonus and the increase in katelectro- tonus being greater than in y^ ;" the effect also spreads for a greater distance along the extrapolar regions in both directions. In 3/3 the same events are seen to be still more marked. § 76. Electrotonic Currents. During the passage of a constant current through a nerve, variations in the electric currents belonging to the nerve itself may be observed ; and these variations have certain relations to the variations of the irritability of the nerve. Thus, if a constant current, supplied by the battery P (Fig. 24), be applied Chap, ii.] THE CONTHACTILE TISSUES. 133 to a piece of nerve by means of two non-polarizable electrodes p, /)', the *' currents of rest " obtainable from various points of the nerve will be different during the passage of the polarizing current from those which were manifest before or after the current was applied ; and, moreover, the changes in the nerve-currents produced by the polarizing current will not be the same in the neiglibourhood of the anode (^>) as those in the neiglibourhood of the kathode (/»')• Thus let G and H be two galvanometers so connected with the two ends of the nerve as to afford good and clear evidence of the " currents of rest." Before the polarizing current is thrown into the nerve, the needle of // will occupy a position indicating the passage of a current of a certain intensity from h to h' through the galvanometer (from the positive longitudinal surface to the negative cut end of the nerve), the circuit being completed by a current in the nerve from h' to h, i.e. the current -4- llh -* .^ // ^ // Fig. 24. Diagram illustrating Electeotonic Currents. P the.polarizing battery, with k a key,p the anode, and p' the kathode. At the left end of the piece of nerve the natural current flows through the galvanometer G from (J to g', in the direction of the arrows ; its direction", thereifore, is tlie same as that of the polarizing current ; consequently it appears increased, as indicated by the sign +. The current at tlie other end of tlie piece of nerve, from /( to /(', through the galvanometer H, flows in a contrary direction to the polarizing current; it consequently appears to be diminished, as indicated by the sign—. N. B. For simplicity's sake, the polarizing current is here supposed to be thrown in at the middle of a piece of nerve, and the galvanometer placed at the two ends. Of course it will be understood that the former may be thrown in anvwhere, and the latter connected with any two pairs of jioints which' will give currents". 134 ELECTEOTONUS. [Book i. will flow in the direction of the arrow. Similarly the needle of G will by its deflection indicate the existence of a current flowing from g to g^ through the galvanometer, and from ^' to g through the nerve, in the direction of the arrow. At the instant that the polarizing current is thrown into the nervo at jop', the currents at gg^ , hh' will undergo a " negative variation ; " that is, the nerve at each point will exhibit a " current of action " correspond- ing to the nervous impulse, which, at the making of the polarizing current, passes in both directions along the nerve, and may cause a contractiou in the attached muscle. The current of action is, as we- have seen, of extremely short duration : it is over and gone in a small fraction of a second. It therefore must not be confounded with a permanent effect, which, in the case we are dealing with, is observed in both galvanometers. This effect, which is dependent on the direction of the polarizing current, is as follows : Supposing that the polarizing current is flowing in the direction of the arrow in the figure, that is, passes in the nerve from the positive electrode or anode p to the negative electrode or kathode jo', it is found that the current through the galvanometer G is increased, while that through ^is diminished. The polarizing current has caused the appearance in the nerve outside the electrodes of a current, having the same direction as itself, called the ' electrotonic ' current ; and this electrotonic current adds to, or takes away from, the natural nerve-current or " current of rest," according as it is flowing in the same direction as that, or in an opposite direction. The strength of the electrotonic current is dependent on the strength of the polarizing current, and on the length of the intrapolar region,, which is exposed to the polarizing current. When a strong polarizing current is used, the electromotive force of the electrotonic current may be much greater than that of the natural nerve-current. The strength of the electrotonic current varies with the irritability,, or vital condition of the nerve, being greater with the more irritable nerve ; and a dead nerve will not manifest electrotonic currents. More- over, the propagation of the current is stopped by a ligature, or by crushing the nerve. We may speak of the conditions which give rise to this electrotonic current as a physical electrotonus analogous to that filiysiological electro- tonus, which is made known by variations in irritability. The physical electrotonic current is probably due to the escape of the polarizing current along the nerve under the jDeculiar conditions of the living nerve ; but we must not attempt to enter here into this difficult subject,, or into the allied question as to the exact connection between the physical and the physiological electrotonus, though there can be little doubt that the latter is dependent on the former. § 77. These variations of irritability at the kathode and anode respectively, thus brought about by the action of the constant current, are interesting theoretically, because we may trace a con- nection between them and the nervous impulse which is the result of the making or breaking of a constant current. For we have evidence that a nervous impulse is generated when a portion of the nerve passes suddenly from a normal Chap, ii.] THE CONTKACTILE TISSUES. 135 condition to a state of katolectrotoniis, or from a state of anelec- trotonus back to a normal condition; but that the passage from a normal condition to anelectrotonus or from katelectrotonus back to a normal condition is unable to generate an impulse. Hence, when a constant current is ' made,' the impulse is gen- erated only at the kathode where the nerve passes suddenly into katelectrotonus ; when the current, on the other hand, is ' broken,' the impulse is generated only at the anode where the nerve passes suddenly back from anelectrotonus into a normal condition. We have an indirect proof of this in the facts to which we drew attention a little while back, viz. that a contraction sometimes occurs at the ' breaking ' only, sometimes at the ' making ' only of the constant current, sometimes at both. For it is found that this depends partly on the strength of the current in relation to the irritability of the nerve, partly on the direction of the current, whether ascending or descending ; and the results obtained with strong, medium and weak descending and ascending currents have been stated in the form of a ' law of contraction.' We need not enter into the details of this ' law,' but will merely say that the results which it formulates are best explained by the hypothesis just stated. We may add that when the constant current is applied to certain structures composed of plain muscular fibres, whose rate of contraction we have seen to be slow, the making contraction may be actually seen to begin at the kathode and travel towards the anode, and the breaking contraction to begin at the anode and travel thence towards the kathode. Since in katelectrotonus the irritability is increased, and in anelectrotonus decreased, both the entrance from the normal condition into katelectrotonus, and the return from anelectrotonus to the normal condition, are instances of a passage from a lower stage of irritability to a higher stage of irritability. Hence, the phenomena of electrotonus would lead ns to the conception that a stimulus in provoking a nervous impulse produces its effect by, in some way or other, suddenly raising the irritability to a higher pitch. But what we are exactly to understand by raising the irritability, what molecular change is the cause of the rise, and how either electric or other stimuli can produce this change, are matters which we cannot discuss here. Besides their theoretical importance, the phenomena of electro- tonus have also a practical interest. When an ascending current is passed along a nerve going to a muscle or group of muscles, the region between the electrodes and the muscle is thrown into anelectrotonus, and its irritability is diminished. If the current be of adequate strength, the irritability may be so much lessened that nervous impulses cannot be generated in that part of the nerve, or cannot pass along it. Hence, by this means the irregular contractions of muscles known as ' cramp ' may be abolished. Similarly, by bringing into a condition of anelectrotonus a portion 136 EFFECTS OF CONSTANT CUEEENT. [Book i. of a sensory nerve in which violent impulses are being generated, giving rise in the central nervous system to sensations of pain, the impulses are toned down or wholly abolished, and the pain ceases. So, on the other hand, we may at pleasure heighten the irritability of a part by throwing it into katelectrotonus. In this way the constant current, properly applied, becomes a powerful remedial means. We said just now that probably every stimulus produces its effect on a nerve by doing what the constant current does when it acts as a stimulus, viz., suddenly raising the irritability of the nerve to a higher pitch. At any rate, the stimulus so often employed in experiments, the induction-shock, acts exactly in the same way as the constant current. The induction-shock is a current of short duration, developed very suddenly, but disappear- ing more gradually, and this is true both of a making induction- shock, a shock due to the making of the primary current, and of a breaking shock, a shock due to the breaking of the primary current. The two differ in direction (hence if the making shock be ascending, the breaking shock will be descending and vice versa), and in the fact that the breaking shock is more suddenly developed, and hence more potent than the making shock ; but otherwise they act in the same way. In each case, since the induced current is developed rapidly, but disappears more slowly, there is a sudden development of electrotonus, of katelectrotonus at the kathode and of anelectrotonus at the anode, and a more grad- ual return to the normal condition. Now, there are many reasons for thinking that in all cases the passing from the normal condition to katelectrotonus at the kathode is a more potent stimulus than the return from anelectrotonus to the normal condition at the anode, and this will be still more so if the return to the normal condition be much slower than the entrance into electrotonus, as is the case in an induction-shock. And it would appear that in an induction-shock, which, as we have said, disappears much more slowly than it is developed, we have to deal not with two stimuli, one at the shock passing into a nerve and one at the shock leaving the nerve, but with one only, — that produced at the shock passing into the nerve. Hence, when an induction-shock is sent into a nerve, one stimulus only is developed, and that at the kathode only, the establishment of katelectrotonus. This is true whether the shock be a making or a breaking shock, i.e. due to the making or breaking of the primary current, though of course, owing to the change of direction in the induced current, what was the kathode at the making shock becomes the anode at the breaking shock. Lastly, though we are dealing now with nerves going to muscles, that is to say, with motor nerves only, we may add that what we have said about electrotonus, and the development of nervous impulses by it, appears to apply equally well to sensory nerves. § 78. In a general way, muscular fibres behave towards an Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 137 electric current very much as do nerve fibres ; but there are certain important ditferences. In the first place, muscular fibres, devoid of nerve fibres, are much more readily thrown into contractions by the breaking and making of a constant current than by the more transient induction-shock ; the muscular substance seems to be more sluggish than the nervous substance, and requires to be acted upon for a longer time. This fact may be made use of, and, indeed, is in medical practice made use of, to determine the condition of the nerves supplying a muscle. If the intramuscular nerves be still in good condition, the muscle as a whole responds readily to single induction-shocks, because these can act upon the intramuscular nerves. If these nerves on the other hand have lost their irrita- bility, the muscle does not respond readily to single induction- shocks, or to the interrupted current, but can still,easily be thrown into contractions by the constant current. In the second place, while in a nerve no impulses are, as a rule, generated during the passage of a constant current, between the break and the make, provided that it is not too strong, and that it remains uniform in strength, in an urarized muscle on the other hand, even with moderate and perfectly uniform currents, a kind of tetanus, or, apparently, a series of rhythmically repeated contractions is very frequently witnessed during the passage of the current. The exact nature and cause of these phenomena in muscle, we must not, however, discuss here. SEC. 4. THE MUSCLE-NERVE PEEPARATION AS A MACHINE. § 79. The facts described in the foregoing sections shew that a muscle with its nerve may be justly regarded as a machine which, when stimulated, will do a certain amount of work. But the actual amount of work which a muscle-nerve preparation will do is found to depend on a large number of circumstances, and conse- quently to vary within very wide limits. These variations will be largely determined by the condition of the muscle and nerve in repect to their nutrition ; in other words, by the degree of irrita- bility manifested by the muscle or by the nerve or by both. But quite apart from the general influences affecting its nutrition and thus its irritability, a muscle-nerve preparation is affected, as regards the amount of its work, by a variety of other circumstances, which we may briefly consider here, reserving to a succeeding section the study of variations in irritability. We may here remark that a muscle may be thrown into contraction under two different conditions. In the one case it may be free to shorten : by the lifting of the weight or otherwise, the one end of the muscle may approach the other ; and this is the kind of contraction which we have taken, and may take as the ordinary one. But the muscle may be placed under such circum- stances that, when it contracts, the one end is not brought nearer to the other, the muscle remains of the same length, and the effect of the contraction is manifested only as an increased strain. In this latter case, the contraction is spoken of as an "isometric," in the former case as an " isotonic " contraction. The influence of the nature and mode of application of the stimulus. When we apply a weak stimulus, a weak induction- shock, to a nerve, we get a small contraction, a slight shortening of the muscle ; when we apply a stronger stimulus, a stronger in- duction-shock, we get a larger contraction, a greater shortening of the muscle. We take, other things being equal, the amount of contraction of the muscle as a measure of the nervous impulse, and say that in the former case a weak or slight, in the latter case a stronger or larger nervous impulse has been generated. Now the muscle of the muscle-nerve preparation consists of many muscular fibres and the nerve of many nerve fibres ; and we may Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 139 fairly suppose that in two experiments we may in the one experiment bring the induction-shock or other stimulus to bear on a few nerve fibres only, and in the other experiment on many or even all the fibres of the nerve. In the former case, only those muscular fibres in which the few nerve fibres stimulated end will be thrown into contraction, the others remaining quiet, and the shortening of the muscle as a whole, since only a few fibres take part in it, will necessarily be less than when all the fibres of the nerve are stimulated, and all the fibres of the muscle contract. That is to say, the amount of contraction will depend on the number of fibres stimulated. For simplicity's sake, however, we will, in what follows, except when otherwise indicated, suppose that when a nerve is stimulated, all the fibres are stimulated and all the muscular fibres contract. In such a case the stronger or larger nervous impulse, leading to the greater contraction, will mean the greater disturbance in each of the nerve fibres. What we exactly mean by the greater disturbance we must not discuss here ; we must be content with regarding the greater, or more powerful, or more intense, nervous impulse as that in which, by some mode or other, more energy is set free. So far as we know at present this difference in amount or in- tensity, of the energy set free, is the chief difference between various nervous impulses. Nervous impulses may differ in the velocity with which they travel, in the length and possibly in the form of the impulse wave, but the chief difi'erence is in strength, in, so to speak, the height of the wave. And our present knowledge will not permit us to point out any other differences, any differences in fundamental nature, for instance, between nervous impulses generated by different stimuli, between, for example, the nervous impulses generated by electric currents, and those generated by chemical or mechanical stimuli ; nor can we, in the present state of our knowledge, at least, recognise any essential difference between what may be called natural motor nervous impulses ; that is to say, those set going by changes in the central nervous system, and those produced l3y the artificial stimulation of the motor nerves.^ This being premised, we may say that, other things being equal, the magnitude of a nervous impulse, and so the magnitude of the ensuing contraction, is directly dependent on what we may call the strength of the stimulus. Thus taking a single induction- shock as the most manageable stimulus, we find that if, before we begin, we place the secondary coil (Fig. 5, sc.) a long way off the primary coil j:)?-. c, no visible effect at all follows upon the 1 It will be observed that we are speaking now exclusively of tlie nerve of a muscle-nerve preparation, /. e. of what we shall hereafter term a motor nerve. Whether sensory impulses differ essentially from motor impulses will be considered later on. 140 CHAEACTEES OF STIMULI. [Book i. discharge of the induction-shock. The passage of the momentary weak current is either unable to produce any nervous impulse at all, or the weak nervous impulse to which it gives rise is unable to stir the sluggish muscular substance to a visible contraction. As we slide the secondary coil towards the primary, sending in an induction-shock at each new position, we find that, at a certain distance between the secondary and primary coils, the muscle responds to each induction-shock ^ with a contraction which makes itself visible by the slightest possible rise of the attached lever. This position of the coils, the battery remaining the same and other things being equal, marks the minimal stimulus, giving rise to the minimal contraction. As the secondary coil is brought nearer to the primary, the contractions increase in height corre- sponding to the increase in the intensity of the stimulus. Very soon, however, an increase in the stimulus, caused by further sliding the secondary coil over the primary, fails to cause any increase in the contraction. This indicates that the maximal stimulus, giving rise to the maximal contraction, has been reached ; though the shocks increase in intensity as the secondary coil is pushed further and further over the primary, the contractions remain of the same height, until fatigue lowers them. With single induction-shocks, then, the muscular contraction, and by inference the nervous impulse, increases with an increase in the intensity of the stimulus, between the limits of the minimal and maximal stimuli ; and this dependence of the nervous impulse, and so of the contraction, on the strength of the stimulus, may be observed not only in electric but in all kinds of stimuli. It may here be remarked that in order for a stimulus to be effective, a certain abruptness in its action is necessary. Thus, as we have seen, the constant current when it is passing through a nerve with uniform intensity does not give rise to a nervous impulse, and, indeed, it may be increased or diminished to almost any extent without generating nervous impulses, provided that the change be made gradually enough ; it is only when there is a sudden change that the current becomes effective as a stimulus. And the reason why the breaking induction-shock is more potent as a stimulus than the making shock, is because as we have seen (§ 44) the current, which is induced in the secondary coil of an induction-machine at the breaking of the primary circuit, is more rapidly developed, and has a sharper rise than the current which appears when the primary circuit is made. Similarly, a sharp tap on a nerve will produce a contraction, when a gradually increasing pressure will fail to do so ; and, in general, the efficiency of a stimulus of any kind will depend in part on the suddenness or abruptness of its action. ^ In these experiments either the breaking or making shock must be used, not sometimes one and sometimes the other ; for, as we have stated, the two kinds of shock differ in efficiency, the breaking being the most potent. Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 141 A stimulus, in order that it may be effective, must have an action of a certain duration, the time necessary to produce an effect varying according to the strength of the stimulus and being different in the case of a nerve from what it is in the case of a muscle. It would appear that an electric current applied to a nerve must have a duration of at least about 0015 sec. to cause any contraction at all, and needs a longer time than this to produce its full effect. A muscle fibre, apart from its nerve fibre, requires a still longer duration of the stimulus, and hence, as we have already stated, a muscle poisoned by urari, or which has otherwise lost the action of its nerves, will not respond as readily to induction-shocks as to the more slowly acting, breaking and making of a constant current. In the case of electric stimuli, the same current will produce a stronger contraction when it is sent along the nerve than when it is sent across the nerve ; indeed, it is maintained that a current which passes through a nerve in an absolutely transverse direction is powerless to generate impulses. It would also appear, at all events up to certain limits, that the longer the piece of nerve through which the current passes, the greater is the effect of the stimulus. When two pairs of electrodes are placed on the nerve of a long and perfectly fresh and successful nerve-preparation, one near to the cut end, and the other nearer the muscle, it is found that the same stimulus produces a greater contraction when applied through the former pair of electrodes than through the latter. This has been interpreted as meaning that the impulse started at the farther electrodes gathers strength, like an avalanche, in its progress to the muscle. It is more probable, however, that the larger contraction produced by stimulation of the part of the nerve near the cut end, is due to the stimulus setting free a larger impulse, i.e. to this part of the nerve being more irritable. The mere section, possibly by developing nerve currents, increases for a time the irritability at the cut end. A similar greater irritability may, however, also be observed in the part of the nerve nearer the spinal cord while it is still in connection with the spinal cord ; and it is possible that the irritability of a nerve may vary considerably at different points of its course. § 80. We have seen that when single stimuli are repeated with sufficient frequency, the individual contractions are fused into tetanus ; as the frequency of the repetition is increased, the individual contractions are less obvious on the curve, until at last we get a curve on which -they seem to be entirely lost, and which we may speak of as a complete tetanus. By such a tetanus a much greater contraction, a much greater shortening of the muscle is, of course, obtained than by single contractions. The exact frequency of repetition required to produce complete tetanus will depend chiefly on the length of the individual contractions, and this varies in different animals, in different 142 REPETITION OF CONTEACTIONS IN TETANUS. [Book i. muscles of the same animal, and in the same muscle under different ' conditions. In a cold blooded animal a single contraction is as a , rule more prolonged than in a warm blooded animal, and tetanus ' is consequently produced in the former by a less frequent repe- tition of the stimulus. A tired muscle has a longer contraction than a fresh muscle, and hence in many tetanus curves the individual contractions, easily recognised at first, disappear later on, owing to the individual contractions being lengthened out by the exhaustion caused by the tetanus itself. In many animals, e.g. the rabbit, some muscles (such as the adductor magnus femoris) are pale, while others (such as the semitendinosus) are red. The red muscles are not only more richly supplied with blood vessels, but the muscle substance of the fibres contains more haemoglobin than the pale, and there are other structural differ- ences. Now, the single contraction of one of these red muscles is more prolonged than the single contraction of one of the pale muscles produced by the same stimulus. Hence the red muscles are thrown into complete tetanus with a repetition of much less frequency than that required for the pale muscles. Thus, ten stimuli in a second are quite sufficient to throw the red muscles of the rabbit into complete tetanus, while the pale muscles require •at least twenty stimuli in a second. So long as signs of the individual contractions are visible on the curve of tetanus, it is easy to recognise that each stimulation produces one of the constituent single contractions, and that the number, so to speak, of the vibrations of the muscle making up the tetanus, corresponds to the number of stimulations ; but the question whether, when we increase the number of stimulations heyond that necessary to produce a complete tetanus, we still increase the number of constituent single contractions, is one not so easy to answer. And connected with this question is another difficult one. What is the rate of repetition of single contractions making up those tetanic contractions which as we have said are the kind of contractions by which the voluntary, and, indeed, other natural movements of the body are carried out ? What is the evidence that these are really tetanic in character ? When a muscle is thrown into tetanus, a more or less musical sound is produced. This may be heard by applying a stethoscope directly over a contracting muscle, and a similar sound but of a more mixed origin and less trustworthy may be heard when the masseter muscles are forcibly contracted, or when a finger is placed in the ear, and the muscles of the same arm are contracted. When the stethoscope is placed over a muscle, the nerve of which is stimulated by induction-shocks repeated with varying frequency, the note heard will vary with the frequency of the shocks, being of higher pitch with the more frequent shocks. Now, it has been thought that the vibrations of the muscle giving rise to the " muscle sound " are identical with the single contractions Chap, ii.] THE CONTEACTILE TISSUES. 143 making up the tetanus of the muscle. And since, in the human body, when a muscle is thrown into contraction in a voluntary effort, or, indeed, in any of the ordinary natural movements of the body, the fundamental tone of the sound corresponds to about 19 or 20 vibrations a second, it has been concluded that the con- traction taking place in such cases is a tetanus of which the individual contractions follow each other about 19 or 20 times a second. But investigations seem to shew that the vibrations giving rise to the muscle sound do not really correspond to the shortenings and relaxations of the individual contractions, and that the pitch of the note cannot therefore be taken as an indication of the number of single contractions making up the tetanus ; indeed, as we shall see in speaking of the sounds of the heart, a single muscular contraction may produce a sound which though differing from the sound given out during tetanus has, to a certain extent, musical characters. Nevertheless, the special characters of the muscle sound given out by muscles in the natural movements of the body may be taken as shewing at least that the contractions of the muscle in these movements are tetanic in nature, and the similarity of the note in all the voluntary efforts of the body and indeed in all movements carried out by the central nervous system is at least consonant with the view that the repetition of single contractions is of about the same frequency in all these movements. What that frequency is, and whether it is exactly identical in all these movements, is not at present perhaps absolutely determined ; but certain markings on the myrographic tracings of these movements, and other facts, seem to indicate that it is about 12 a second. §81. The Infiuence of the Load, It might be imagined that a muscle, which, when loaded with a given weight, and stimulated by a current of a given intensity, had contracted to a certain extent, would only contract to half that extent when loaded with twice the weight, and stimulated with the same stimulus. Such, however, is not necessarily the case ; the height to which the weight is raised may be in the second instance as great, or even greater, than in the first. That is to say, the resistance offered to the contraction actually augments the contraction, the tension of the muscular fibre increases the facility with which the explosive changes resulting in a contraction take place. And we have other evidence that anything which tends to stretch the muscular fibres, that any tension of the muscular fibres, whether during rest or during contraction, increases the metabolism of the muscle. There is, of course, a limit to this favourable action of the resistance. As the load continues to be increased, the height of the contraction is diminished, and at last a point is reached at which the muscle is unable (even when the stimulus chosen is the strongest possible) to lift the load at all. In a muscle viewed as a machine, we have to deal not merely 144 THE WOEK DONE. [Book i, with the height of the contraction, — that is with the amount of shortening, — but with the work done ; and this is measured by multiplying the number of units of height to which the load is raised into the number of units of weight of the load. Hence it is obvious from the foregoing observations that the work done must be largely dependent on the weight itself. Thus there is a certain weight of load with which in any given muscle, stimu- lated by a given stimulus, the most work will be done ; as may be seen from the following example: Load, in grammes , 0 50 100 150 200 250 Height of contractions in millimeters 14 9 7 5 2 0 Work done, in gram-millimeters ... 0 450 700 750 400 0 § 82. The Infiuence of the Size and Form of the Muscle. Since all known muscular fibres are much shorter than the wave-length of a contraction, it is obvious that the longer the fibre, the greater will be the shortening caused by the same contraction wave, the greater will be the height of the contraction with the same stimulus. Hence, in a muscle of parallel fibres, the height to which the load is raised as the result of a given stimulus applied to its nerve, will depend on the length of the fibres, while the maximum weight of load capable of being lifted will depend on the number of the fibres, since the load is distributed among them. Of two muscles, therefore, of equal length (and of the same quality), the most work will be done by that which has the larger number of fibres, that is to say, the fibres being of equal width, which has the greater sectional area ; and of two muscles with equal sectional areas, the most work will be done by that which is the longer. If the two muscles are unequal both in length and sectional area, the work done will be the greater in the one which has the larger bulk, which contains the greater number of cubic units. In speaking, therefore, of the work which can be done by a muscle, we may use as a standard a cubic unit of bulk, or, the specific gravity of the muscle being the same, a unit of weight. We learn, then, from the foregoing paragraphs that the work done by a muscle-nerve preparation will depend not only on the activity of the nerve and muscle as determined by their own irritability, but also on the character and mode of application of the stimulus, on the kind of contraction (whether a single spasm, or a slowly repeated tetanus or a rapidly repeated tetanus) on the load itself, and on the size and form of the muscle. Taking the most favourable circumstances, viz. a well-nourished, lively preparation, a maximum stimulus causing a rapid tetanus and an appropriate load, we may determine the maximum work done by a given weight of muscle, say one gramme. This in the case of the muscles of the frog has been estimated at about four gram-meters for one gramme of muscle. SEC. 5. THE CIECUMSTANCES WHICH DETEEMINE THE DEGEEE OF lEEITABlLlTY OF MUSCLES AND NEEVES. § 83. A muscle-nerve preparation, at the time that it is re- moved from the body, possesses a certain degree of irritability, it responds by a contraction of a certain amount to a stimulus of a certain strength, applied to the nerve or to the muscle. After a w^hile, the exact period depending on a variety of circumstances, the same stimulus produces a smaller contraction, i.e. the irritability of the preparation has diminished. In other words, the muscle, or nerve, or both, have become partially ' exhausted ; ' and the exhaustion subsequently increases, the same stimulus producing smaller contractions, until at last all irritability is lost, no stimulus however strong producing any contraction, whether applied to the nerve or directly to the muscle ; and eventually the muscle, as we have seen, becomes rigid. The progress of this exhaustion is more rapid in the nerves than in the muscles ; for some time after the nerve trunk has ceased to respond to even the strongest stimulus, contractions may be obtained by applying the stimulus directly to the muscle. It is much more rapid in the warm blooded than in the cold blooded animals. The muscles and nerves of the former lose their irritability, when removed from the body, after a period varying according to circumstances from a few minutes to two or three hours ; those of cold blooded animals (or at least of an amphibian or a reptile) may, under favourable conditions, remain irritable for two, three, or even more days. The duration of irritability in warm blooded animals may, however, be considerably prolonged by reducing the temperature of the body before death. If with some thin body a sharp blow be struck across a muscle which has entered into the later stages of exhaustion, a wheal lasting for several seconds is developed. This wheal appears to be a contraction wave limited to the part struck, and disappearing very slowly, without extending to the neighbouring muscular substance. It has been called 10 146 DEGENEEATION OF NERVES. [Book i, an ' idio-muscula?' ' contraction, because it may be brought out even when ordinary stimuli have ceased to produce any effect. It may, however, be accompanied at its beginning by an ordinary contraction. It is readily produced in the living body on the pectoral and other muscles of persons suffering from phthisis and other exhausting diseases. This natural exhaustion and diminution of irritability in muscles and nerves removed from the body, may be modified, both in the case of the muscle and of the nerve, by a variety of circum- stances. Similarly, while the nerve and muscle still remain in the body, the irritability of the one or of the other may be modified either in the way of increase or of decrease by certain general influences, of which the most important are, severance from the central nervous system, and variations in temperature, in blood supply, and in functional activity. The Effects of Severance from the Central Nervous System. When a nerve, such, for instance, as the sciatic, is divided tn situ, in the living body, there is first of all observed a slight increase of irritability, noticeable especially near the cut end ; but after a while the irritability diminishes, and gradually disappears. Both the slight initial increase and the subsequent decrease begin at the cut end, and advance centrifugally towards the peripheral terminations. This centrifugal feature of the loss of irritability is often spoken of as the Eitter-Valli law. In a mammal, it may be two or three days, in a frog, as many, or even more weeks, before irritability has disappeared from the nerve trunk. It is maintained in the small (and especially in the intramuscular) branches for still longer periods. This centrifugal loss of irritability is the forerunner in the peripheral portion of the divided nerve of structural changes, which proceed in a similar centrifugal manner. The medulla first suffers changes similar to those seen in nerve fibres after removal from the body ; its double contour and its characteristic indentations be- come more marked. It then breaks up into small, irregular frag- ments, or drops, and, as shewn by the behaviour towards staining reagents, becomes somewhat altered in its chemical nature. The axis cylinder also breaks up into fragments. Meanwhile, the nuclei of the neurilemma divide and multiply, and with their multiplica- tion, a great increase of the protoplasmic material surrounding them appears to take place ; this, at least, seems to be the origin of a conspicuous bed of protoplasmic-looking substance in which the fragments of the medulla and of the axis-cylinder are imbedded. These fragments, becoming more and more altered in chemical nature, are now absorbed, the protoplasmic-looking material in- creasing or not diminishing. The neurilemma collapses, and so the nerve fibre is reduced to a strand of protoplasmic material studded with nuclei, and con- taining drops or globules of fat which are the remains of the medulla, the fragments of the axis-cylinder having wholly dis- Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 147 appeared. If no regeneration takes place, these nuclei with their bed eventually disappear. In the central portion of the divided nerve similar changes may be traced as far only as the next node of lianvier. Beyond this the nerve usually remains in a normal condition. Eegeneration, when it occurs, is apparently carried out by the peripheral growth of the axis-cylinders of the intact central portion. It would seem that when the cut ends of the nerve are close together, the axis-cylinders growing out from the central portion run into and between the shrunken neurilemmas of the peripheral portion, and new medulla, at first delicate and inter- rupted, but subsequently becoming continuous and complete, makes its appearance in the protoplasmic strands in a centrifugal order. But the complete history has not as yet been clearly made out, and much uncertainty still exists as to the exact parts which the proliferated nuclei and the protoplasmic material referred to above respectively play in giving rise to the new structures of the regenerated fibre. Such a degeneration may be observed to extend down to the very endings of the nerve in the muscle, including the end-plates, but •does not at first affect the muscular substance itself. The muscle, though it has lost all its nervous elements, still remains irritable towards stimuli applied directly to itself : an additional proof of the existence of an independent muscular irritability. For some time the irritabihty of the muscle, as well towards stimuli applied directly to itself as towards those applied through the impaired nerve, seems to be diminished ; but after a while a peculiar condition (to which we have already alluded, § 78) sets in, in which the muscle is found to be not easily stimulated by single induction-shocks, but to respond readily to the make or break of a constant current. In fact, it is said to become even more sensitive to the latter mode of stimulation than it was when its nerve was intact and functionally active. At the same time it also becomes more irritable towards direct mechanical stimuli, and very frequently fibrillar contractions, more or less rhythmic and apparently of spontaneous origin, though their causation is ob- scure, make their appearance. This phase of heightened sensitiveness of a muscle, especially to the constant current, appears to reach its maximum, in man at about the seventh week after nervous impulses have ceased, owing to injury to the nerves or nervous centre, to reach the muscle. If the muscle thus deprived of its nervous elements be left to itself, its irritability, however tested, sooner or later diminishes ; but if the muscle be periodically thrown into contractions by artificial stimulation with the constant current, the decline of irritability and attendant loss of nutritive power may be postponed for some considerable time. But, as far as our experience goes at present, the artificial stimulation cannot fully replace the natural one, and sooner or later the muscle, like the nerve, suffers degeneration, loses 148 INFLUENCE OF TEMPERATUEE. [Book i. all irritability, and ultimately its place is taken by connective tissue. § 84. The influence of temperature. We have already seen that sudden heat (and the same might be said of cold when sufficiently intense), applied to a limited part of a nerve or muscle, as when the nerve or muscle is touched with a hot wire, will act as a stimulus. It is, however, much more difficult to gene- rate nervous or muscular impulses by exposing a whole nerve or muscle to a gradual rise of temperature. Thus, according to most observers, a nerve belonging to a muscle ^ may be either cooled to 0° C. or below, or heated to 50° or even 100° C, without dis- charging any nervous impulses, as shewn by the absence of con- traction in the attached muscle. The contractions, moreover, may be absent even when the heating has not been very gradual. A muscle may be gradually cooled to 0° C, or below, without any contraction being caused ; but when it is heated to a limit, which in the case of frog's muscles is about 45°, of mammalian muscles about 50°, a sudden change takes place : the muscle falls, at the limiting temperature, into a rigor mortis, which is initiated by a forcible contraction or at least shortening. Moderate warmth, e.g. in the frog an increase of temperature up to somewhat below 45° C, favours both muscular and nervous irritability. All the molecular processes are hastened and facili-^ tated : the contraction is for a given stimulus greater and more rapid, i.e. of shorter duration, and nervous impulses are generated more readily by slight stimuli. Owing to the quickening of the chemical changes, the supply of new material may prove insuffi- cient ; hence muscles and nerves removed from the body lose their irritability more rapidly at a high than at a low temperature. The gradual application of cold to a nerve produces effects which differ according to the kind of stimulus employed in testing the condition of the nerve ; but it may be stated in general that a low temperature, especially one near to 0°, slackens all the molecu- lar processes, so that the wave of nervous impulse is lessened and prolonged, the velocity of its passage being much diminished, e.g. from 28 meters to 1 metre per sec. At about 0° the irritability of the nerve disappears altogether. When a muscle is exposed to similar cold, e.g. to a tempera- ture very little above zero, the contractions are remarkably pro- longed ; they are diminished in height at the same time, but not in proportion to the increase of their duration. Exposed to a temperature of zero or below, muscles soon lose their irritability, without, however, undergoing rigor mortis. After an exposure of not more than a few seconds to a temperature not much below zero, they may be restored, by gradual warmth, to an irritable con- dition, even though they may appear to have been frozen. When 1 The action of cold and heat on sensory nerves will be considered in the later portion of the work. Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 149 kept frozen, however, for some few minutes, or when exposed for a less time to temperatures of several degrees below zero, their irritability is permanently destroyed. When after this they are thawed, they are at first supple and, as we have seen, may be made to yield muscle plasma ; but they very speedily enter into rigor mortis of a most pronounced character. § 85. The injiucnce of Mood sujpply. When a muscle still within the body is deprived by any means of its proper blood supply, as when the blood vessels going to it are ligatured, the same gradual loss of irritability and final appearance of rigor mortis are observed as in muscles removed from the body. Thus, if the abdominal aorta be ligatured, the muscles of the lower limbs lose their irritability, and finally become rigid. So, also, in systemic death, when the blood supply to the muscles is cut off by the cessation of the circulation, loss of irritability ensues, and rigor mortis eventually follows. In a human corpse the muscles of the body enter into rigor mortis in a fixed order : first those of the jaw and neck, then those of the trunk, next those of the arms, and lastly those of the legs. The rapidity with which rigor mortis comes on after death varies considerably, being determined both by external circumstances and by the internal conditions of the body. Thus external warmth hastens and cold retards the onset. After great muscular exertion, as in hunted animals, and when death closes wasting diseases, rigor mortis in most cases comes on rapidly. As a general rule, it may be said that the later it is in making its appearance, the more pronounced it is, and the longer it lasts ; but there are many exceptions, and when the state is recognized as being fundamentally due to a clotting of the muscle substance, it is easy to understand that the amount of rigidity, i.e. the amount of the clot, and the rapidity of the onset, i.e. the quickness with which clotting takes place, may vary independently. The rapidity of onset after muscular exercise and wasting disease may perhaps be, in part, dependent on an increase of acid reaction, which is produced under those circumstances in the muscle, for this seems to be favourable to the clotting of the muscle plasma. When rigor mortis has once become thoroughly established in a muscle through deprivation of blood, it cannot be removed by any sub- sequent supply of blood. Thus, when the abdominal aorta has remained ligatured until the lower limbs have become completely rigid, untying the ligature will not restore the muscles to an irritable condition ; the return of the blood stream simply hastens the decomposition of the dead tissues by supplying them with oxygen, and, in the case of the mammal, with warmth also. A muscle, however, may acquire as a whole a certain amount of rigidity on account of some of the fibres becoming rigid, while the remainder, though they have lost their irritability, have not yet advanced into rigor mortis. At such a juncture a renewal of the blood stream may restore the irritability of those fibres which 150 INFLUENCE OF ACTIVITY. [Book i. were not yet rigid, and thus appear to do away with rigor mortis ;. yet it appears that in such cases the fibres which have actually become rigid never regain their irritability, but undergo degenera- tion. Mere loss of irritability, even though complete, if stopping short of the actual clotting of the muscle substance, may be with care removed. Thus if a stream of blood be sent artificially through the vessels of a separated (mammalian) muscle, the irrita- bility may be maintained for a very considerable time. On stopping the artificial circulation, the irritability diminishes, and in time entirely disappears ; if, however, the stream be at once resumed,, the irritability will be recovered. By regulating the flow, the irritability may be lowered and (up to a certain limit) raised at pleasure. From the epoch, however, of interference with the normal blood stream, there is a gradual diminution in the responses to stimuli, and ultimately the muscle loses all its irritability and becomes rigid, however well the artificial circulation be kept up. This failure is probably in great part due to the blood sent through the tissues not being in a perfectly normal condition ; but we have at present very little information on this point. Indeed, with respect to the quality of blood thus essential to the maintenance or restoration of irritability, our knowledge is definite with regard to one factor only, viz. the oxygen. If blood deprived of its oxygen be sent through a muscle removed from the body, irritability, so far from being maintained, seems rather to have its disappearance hastened. In fact, if venous blood continues to be driven through a muscle, the irritability of the muscle is lost even more rapidly than in the entire absence of blood. It would seem that venous blood is more injurious than none at all. If exhaustion be not carried too far, the muscle may, however, be revived by a proper supply of oxygenated blood. The influence of blood supply cannot be so satisfactorily studied in the case of nerves as in the case of muscles ; there can, however, be little doubt that the effects are analogous. § 86. The influence of functional activity. This, too, is more easily studied in the case of muscles than of nerves. When a muscle within the body is unused, it wastes ; when used, it (within certain limits) grows. Both these facts shew that the nutrition of a muscle is favourably affected by its functional activity. Part of this may be an indirect effect of the increased blood supply, which occurs when a muscle contracts. When a nerve going to a muscle is stimulated, the blood vessels of the muscle dilate. Hence, at the time of the contraction more blood flows through the muscle, and this increased flow continues for some little while after the contraction of the muscle has ceased. But, apart from the blood supply, it is probable that the ex- haustion caused by a contraction is immediately followed by a reaction favourable to the nutrition of the muscle : and this is a CiiAi'. II.] THE CUNTKACTILE TISSUES. 151 reason, possibly the chief reason, why a muscle is increased by use ; that is to say, the loss of substance and energy caused by the contraction is subsequently more than made up for by increased metabolism during the following period (jf rest. Whether there be a third factor, whether muscles, for instance, are governed by so-called trophic nerves, which affect their nutri- tion directly in some other way than by influencing either their blood supply or their activity, must at present be left undecided. A muscle, even within the body, after prolonged action is fatigued, i.e. a stronger stimulus is required to produce the same contraction ; in other words, its irritability may be lessened by functional activity. Whether functional activity, therefore, is in- jurious or beneficial depends on its amount in relation to the condition of the muscle. It may be here remarked that as a muscle becomes more and more fatigued, stimuli of short duration, such as induction-shocks, sooner lose their efficacy than do stimuli of longer duration, such as the break and make of the constant current. It is worthy of notice that a motor nerve is far less susceptible of being fatigued by artificial stimulation than is a muscle ; in fact, it seems extremely difficult to tire a nerve by mere stimula- tion. In an animal poisoned by urari, the sciatic nerve may be stimulated continuously with powerful currents for even several hours, and yet remain irritable. So long as the urari is produc- ing its usual effect, the muscles sheltered by it are not thrown into contraction by the stimulation of the nerve, and so are not fatigued ; as the effect of the urari passes off, contractions make their appearance in response to the stimulation of the sciatic nerve, shewing that this, in spite of its having been stimulated for so long a time, has not been exhausted ; and other experi- ments point to a similar conclusion. It would seem that the molecular processes constituting a nervous impulse, uiilike those constituting a muscular contraction, are of such a nature, or take place in such a way; that after the development of one impulse the substance of the nerve fibre is at once ready for the develop- ment of a second impulse. The sense of fatigue of which, after prolonged or unusual exer- tion, we are conscious in our own bodies, is probably of complex origin, and its nature, like that of the normal muscular sense, of which we shall have to speak hereafter, is at present not thoroughly understood. It seems to be, in the first place, the result of changes in the muscles themselves, but is possibly also caused by changes in the nervous apparatus concerned in muscular action, and especially in those parts of the central nervous system which are concerned in the production of voluntary impulses. In any case, it cannot be taken as an adequate measure of the actual fatigue of the muscles ; for a man who says he is absolutely exhausted may, under excite- ment, perform a very large amount of work with his already weary muscles. The will, in fact, rarely if ever calls forth the greatest contractions of which the muscles are capable. 152 CAUSES OF EXHAUSTION. [Book i. . Absolute (temporary) exhaustion of the muscles, so that the strongest stimuli produce no contraction, may be produced even within the body by artificial stimulation : recovery takes place on rest. Out of the body absolute exhaustion takes place readily. Here also recovery may take place. Whether in any given case it does occur or not, is determined by the amount of contraction causing the exhaustion, and by the previous condition of the muscle. In all cases, recovery is hastened by renewal (natural or artificial) of the blood stream. The more rapidly the contractions follow each other, the less the interval between any two contractions, the more rapid the exhaustion. A certain number of single induction-shocks repeated rapidly, say every second or oftener, bring about exhaustive loss of irritability more rapidly than the same number of shocks repeated less rapidly, for instance every 5 or 10 seconds. Hence tetanus is a ready means of producing exhaustion. In exhausted muscles the elasticity is much diminished ; the tired muscle returns less readily to its natural length than does the fresh one. The exhaustion due to contraction may be the result : — Either of the consumption of the store of really contractile material present in the muscle ; or of the accumulation in the tissue of the products of the act of contraction ; or of both of these causes. The restorative influence of rest, in the case of a muscle removed from the circulation, may be explained by supposing that, during the repose, either the internal changes of the tissue manufacture new explosive material out of the comparatively raw material already present in the fibres, or the directly hurtful pro- ducts of the act of contraction undergo changes by which they are converted into comparatively inert bodies. A stream of fresh blood may exert its restorative influence not only by quickening the above two events, but also by carrying off the immediate waste products, while at the same time it brings new raw material. It is not known to what extent each of these parts is played. That the products of contraction are exhausting in their effects, is shewn by the facts that the injection of a solution of the muscle-extractives into the vessels of a muscle produces exhaustion, and that exhausted muscles are recovered by the simple injection of inert saline solutions into their blood vessels. But the matter has not yet been fully worked out. One important element brought by fresh blood is oxygen. This, as we have seen, is not necessary for the carrying out of the actual contraction, and yet is essential to the maintenance of irritability. The oxygen absorbed by the muscle apparently enters in some peculiar way into the formation of that complex explosive material the decomposition of which in the act of contraction, though it gives rise to carbonic acid and other products of oxidation, is not in itself a process of direct oxidation. SEC. 6. THE ENERGY OF MUSCLE AND NERVE, AND THE NATURE OF MUSCULAR AND NERVOUS ACTION. § 87. We may briefly recapitulate some of the chief results arrived at in the preceding pages as follows. A muscular contraction itself is essentially a translocation of molecules, a change of form not of bulk. We cannot, however, say anything definite as to the nature of this translocation or as to the way in which it is brought about. For instance, we cannot satisfactorily explain the connection between the striation of a mus- cular fibre and a muscular contraction. Nearly all rapidly contract- ing muscles are striated, and we must suppose that the striation is of some use ; but it is not essential to the carrying out of a contraction, for, as we shall see, the contraction of a non-striated muscle is fundamentally the same as that of a striated muscle. But whatever be the exact way in which the translocation is effected, it is in some way or other the result of a chemical change, of an explosive decomposition of certain parts of the muscle substance. The energy which is expended in the mechanical work done by the muscle has its source in the energy latent in the muscle substance, and set free by that explosion. Concerning the nature of that ex- plosion we only know at present that it results in the production of carbonic acid and in an increase of the acid reaction, and that heat is set free as well as the specific muscular energy. There is a general parallelism between the extent of metabolism taking place, and the amount of energy set free ; the greater the de- velopment of carbonic acid, the larger is the contraction and the higher the temperature. It is important to remember that, as we have already urged, relaxation, the return to the original length, is an essential part of the whole contraction no less than the shortening itself. It is true that the return to the original length is assisted by the stretching exerted by the load, and, in the case of muscles within the living body, is secured by the action of antagonistic muscles or 154 THE ENERGY OF MUSCLE. [Book i. by various anatomical relations ; but the fact that the completeness, and rapidity of the return are dependent on the condition of the muscle, — that is, on the complex changes within the muscle, mak- ing up what we call its nutrition, the tired muscle relaxing much more slowly than the untired muscle, — shews that the relaxation is due in the main to intrinsic processes going on in the muscle itself, processes which we might characterize as the reverse of those of contraction. In fact, to put the matter forcibly, adopt- ing the illustration used in § 57, and regarding relaxation as a change of molecules from a ' formation ' of one hundred in two lines of fifty each, to a formation of ten columns each ten deep, it would be possible to support the thesis that the really active forces in muscle are those striving to maintain the latter formation in columns, and that the falling into double lines, that is to say the contraction, is the result of these forces ceasing to act ; in other words, that the contracted state of the muscular fibre is what may be called the natural state, that the relaxed condition is only brought about at the expense of changes counteracting the natural tendencies of the fibre. Without going so far as this, how- ever, we may still recognize that both contraction and relaxation are the result of changes which, since they seem to be of a chemical nature in the one case, are probably so in the other also. And though in the absence of exact knowledge it is dangerous to specu- late, we may imagine, that these chemical events, leading tO' relaxation or elongation, are of an opposite or antagonistic character to those whose issue is contraction. It has not been possible hitherto to draw up a complete equa- tion between the latent energy of the material, and the two forms of actual energy set free, heat and movement. The proportion of energy given out as heat to that taking on the form of work varies under different circumstances ; and it would appear that on the whole a muscle would not be much more efficient than a steam-engine in respect to the conversion of chemical action into mechanical work, were it not that in warm blooded animals the heat given out is not, as in the steam-engine, mere loss, but, by keep- ing up the animal temperature, serves many subsidiary purposes. It might be supposed that in a contraction by which work is actually done, as compared with the same contraction when no work is done, there is a diminution of the increase of temperature corre- sponding to the amount of work done ; that is to say, that the mechanical work is done at the expense of energy which other- wise would go out as heat. Probable as this may seem it has not. yet been experimentally verified. Of the exact nature of the chemical changes which underlie a muscular contraction we know very little, the most important fact being that the contraction is not the outcome of a direct oxidation, but the splitting up or explosive decomposition of some complex substance or substances. The muscle does consume oxygen, and Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 155 the products of muscular metabolism are, in the ends, products of oxidation, but the oxygen appears to be introduced not at the moment of explosion, but at some earlier date. As to the real nature of this explosive material, we are as yet in the dark ; we do not know for certain whether we ought to regard it as a single substance (in the chemical sense), or as a mixture of more substances than one. We may, however, perhaps be allowed pro- visionally to speak of it at all events as a single substance and to call it ' contractile material,' or we may adopt a term which has been suggested, and call it ino(/cn. We shall have occasion to point out, later on, that the living substance of certain cells is able to manufacture and to lodge in the substance of the cell relatively considerable quantities of fat, where- by the cell becomes a fat cell, the fat so formed and lodged being subsequently, by some means or other, discharged from the cell. We shall also have occasion to point out that, in a somewhat similar way, the living material of certain gland cells manufactures and lodges in itself certain substances which, when the cell ' secretes,' undergo more or less change and are ejected from the cell. These substances appear to be products of the activity of the living sub- stance of the cell, and to be so related to that living substance that, though discontinuous with it, and merely lodged in it, they are still capable of being so influenced by it as to undergo change more or less sudden, more or less profound. And we may, resting on the analogy of these fat cells and gland cells, suppose that the living substance of the muscle manufactures and lodges in itself this contractile material, or inogen, which is capable of being so in- fluenced by the living substance as to undergo an explosive decomposition. But we here meet with a difficulty. The muscular fibre as a whole is eminently a nitrogenous proteid body ; the muscular fil^res of the body form the greater part of the whole proteid mass of the body. Moreover, the ordinary continued metabolism of the muscular fibre as a whole is essentially a nitro- genous metabolism; as we shall have to point out later on, the muscles undoubtedly supply a great part of that large nitrogenous waste which appears in the urine as urea ; the nitrogenous meta- bolism of the muscle during the twenty-four hours must, therefore, be considerable, and under certain circumstances, as for instance during fever, this nitrogenous metabolism may be still further largely increased On the other hand, as we have already said, the evidence so far goes to shew that the act of contraction, the explosive decom- position of the inogen, does not increase the nitrogenous metabolism of the muscle. Shall we conclude, then, that the inogen is essen- tially a non-nitrogenous body lodged in the nitrogenous muscle substance ? Not only have we no positive evidence "of this, but the analogy between contraction and rigor mortis is directly opposed to such a view ; for it is almost impossible to resist the conclusion that 156 THE ENEEGY OF MUSCLE AND NEEVE. [Book i. the stuff which gives rise to the myosin clot, the carbonic acid, and lactic acid, or other acid-producing substances of rigor mortis, is the same stuff which gives rise to the carbonic acid and lactic acid, or other acid-producing substances of a contraction. The difference between the two seems to be that in the contraction the nitrogenous product of the decomposition of the inogen does not appear as solid myosin, but assumes the form of some soluble proteid. The important fact concerning the two acts, rigor mortis and contraction, is that, while the great non-nitrogenous product of the decomposition of the inogen, viz. carbonic acid, is simple waste matter containing no energy, fit only to be cast out of the body at once (and the same is nearly true of the other non-nitro- genous product, lactic acid), the nitrogenous product, being a proteid, is still a body containing much energy, which in the case of the living muscle may, after the contraction, be utilized by the muscle itself or, being carried away into the blood stream, by some other parts of the body. But if this view be correct, the ordinary metabolism going on while the muscle is at rest must differ in kind as well as, and per- haps more than, in degree from the metabolism of contraction ; for the former, as we have just said, is essentially a nitrogenous meta- bolism, largely contributing to the nitrogenous waste of the body at large. Whether in the muscle at rest this nitrogenous metabolism is confined to that part of the muscle in which the inogen is lodged, and does not involve the inogen itself, or whether the inogen as well as the rest of the fibre undergoes metabolism when the muscle is at rest, going off in puffs, so to speak, instead of in a large explosion, its nitrogenous factors being at the same time involved in the change, are questions which we cannot at present settle. § 88. While in muscle the chemical events are so prominent that we cannot help considering a muscular contraction to be essentially a chemical process, with electrical changes as attendant phenomena only, the case is different with nerves. Here the electrical pheno- mena completely overshadowed the chemical. Our knowledge of the chemistry of nerves is at present of the scantiest, and the little we know as to the chemical changes of nervous substance is gained by the study of the central nervous organs rather than of the nerves. We find that the irritability of the former is closely dependent on an adequate supply of oxygen, and we may infer from this that in nervous as in muscular substance a metabolism, of in the main an oxidative character, is the real cause of the development of energy ; and the axis-cylinder, which, as we have seen, is most probably the active element of a nerve-fibre, undoubtedly resembles in many of its chemical features the substance of a muscular fibre. But we have as yet no satisfactory experimental evidence that the passage of a nervous impulse along a nerve is the result, like the contraction of a muscular fibre, of chemical changes,- and like it accompanied by an Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 157 evolution of heat. On the other hand, the electric phenomena are so prominent that some have been tempted to regard a nervous impulse as essentially an electrical change ; and this view is supported by the facts mentioned above (§ 86) as to the nerve not being fatigued by work. But it must be remembered that the actual energy set free in a nervous impulse is, so to speak, insignificant, so that chemical changes too slight to be recognized by the means at present at our disposal would amply suffice to provide all the energy set free. On the other hand, the rate of transmission of a nervous impulse, putting aside other features, is alone sufficient to prove that it is something quite different from an ordinary electric current. The curious disposition of the end-plates, and their remarkable analogy with the electric organs which are found in certain animals, has suggested the view that the passage of a nervous impulse from the nerve fibre into the muscular substance, is of the nature of an electric discharge. But these matters are too difficult and too abstruse to be discussed here. It may, however, be worth while to remind the reader that in every contraction of a muscular fibre, the actual change of form is preceded by invisible changes propagated all over the fibre, and that these changes resemble in their features the nervous impulse of which they are, so to speak, the continuation rather than the contraction of which they are the forerunners, and to which they give rise. So that a muscle, even putting aside the visible termi- nations of the nerve, is fundamentally a muscle and a nerve besides. SEC. 7. ON SOME OTHEE FORMS OF CONTRACTILE TISSUE. Plain, Smooth, or Unstriated Muscular Tissue. § 89. This, in vertebrates at all events, rarely occurs in isolated masses or muscles, as does striated muscular tissue, but is usually- found taking part in the structure of complex organs, such, for instance, as the intestines ; hence the investigation of its proper- ties is beset with many difficulties. It is usually arranged in sheets, composed of flattened bundles or bands bound together by connective tissue carrying blood vessels, lymphatics and nerves. Some of these bundles or bands may be split up into smaller bands, similarly united to each other by con- nective tissue, but in many cases the whole sheet being thin is made up directly of small bands. Each small band is composed of a number of elementary fibres or fibre cells, which, in a certain sense, are analogous to the striated elementary fibres, but in many respects differ widely from them. Each unstriated elementary fibre is a minute object, from 50 fx to 200 /x in length, and from 5 /x to 10 yu, in breadth ; it is, therefore, in size, of a wholly different order from a striated fibre. It is fusi- form or spindle-shaped, somewhat flattened in the middle, and tapering to a point at the ends, which in some cases are branched ; but the exact form of the fibre will differ according as the muscle is in a state of contraction or relaxation. Midway between the two ends and in the centre of the fusiform Taody lies a nucleus, which, in a normal condition, is elliptical in out- line, with its long axis lying lengthwise, but which under the influence of reagents is very apt to become rod-shaped ; hence in prepared specimens the presence of these rod-shaped nuclei is very characteristic of plain muscular tissue. The nucleus has the ordinary characters of a nacleus, and very frequently two nucleoli are conspicuous. Around the nucleus is gathered a small quantity of granular protoplasm, like that around the nuclei of a striated fibre, and this is continued along the axis of the fibre for some distance from each pole of the Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 159 nucleus, gradually tapering away, and so forming a slender granular core in the median portion of the fibre. The rest of the fibre, forming its chief part, is composed of a transparent but somewhat refractive substance, wliich is either homogeneous or exhibits a delicate longitudinal fibrillation ; this is the muscle substance of the fibre, and corresponds to the muscle substance of the striated fibre, but is not striated. Sometimes the whole fibre is thrown into a series of transverse wrinkles, which give it a striated appearance, but this is a very different striation from that produced by an alternation of dim and bright Ijands. No such alternation of bands is to be seen in the plain muscular fibre; the whole of the substance of the fibre around the nucleus and core is homogeneous, or at least exhibits no differentation be- yond that into fibrilhe and interfibrillar substance, and even this distinction is doubtful. The fibre has a sharp, clear outline, but is not limited by any distinct sheath corresponding to the sarcolemma, at least according to most observers. It is obvious that the plain muscular fibre is a nucleated cell, the cell-substance of which has become differentiated into con- tractile substance, the cell otherwise being but slightly changed ; whereas the much larger striated fibre is either a number of cells fused together, or a cell which has undergone multiplication in so far that its nucleus has given rise to several nuclei, but in which no division of cell-substance has taken place. A number of such fusiform nucleated cells or fibres or fibre cells are united together, not by connective tissue but by a peculiar proteid cement substance, into a flat band or bundle, the tapering end of one fibre dovetailing in between the bodies of other fibres. So long as this cement substance is intact, it is very difficult to isolate an individual fibre, but various reagents will dissolve or lessen this cement, and then the fibres separate. Sometimes the surface of the cell is not smooth, but thrown lengthwise into ridges, the ridges of one cell abutting on those of its neighbours ; in such cases, the amount of cement substance seems scanty. Small, flat bands, thus formed of fibres cemented together, are variously arranged by means of connective tissue, sometimes into a plexus, sometimes into thicker, larger bands, which in turn may be bound up, as we have said, into sheets of varying thickness. In the plexus, of course, the bands run in various directions, but in the sheets, or membranes, they follow for the most part the same direction, and a thin, transverse section of a somewhat thick sheet presents a number of smaller or larger areas, corresponding to the smaller or larger bands which are cut across. The limits of each area are more or less clearly defined by the connective tissue, in which blood vessels may be seen, the area itself being composed of a number of oval outlines, the sections of the flattened individual fibres ; in hardened specimens, the outlines may from 160 STEUCTURE OF PLAIN MUSCLE. [Book i. mutual pressure appear polygonal. In the centre of some of these sections of fibres the nucleus may be seen, but it will, of course, be absent from those fibres in the which plane of section has passed either above or below the nucleus. When a thin sheet of plain muscle is spread out or teased out under the microscope, the bands may also be recognised, and at the torn ends of some of the bands the individual fibres may be seen projecting after the fashion of a palisade. Blood vessels and lymphatics are carried by the connective tissue, and form capillary networks and lymphatic plexuses round the smaller bands. § 90. The arrangement of the nerves in unstriated muscle differs from that in striated muscle. Whereas in striated muscle me- dullated fibres coming direct from the anterior roots of spinal nerves predominate, in plain muscle non-medullated fibres are most abundant ; in fact, the nerves going to plain muscles are not only small, but are almost exclusively composed of non-medullated fibres, and come to the muscle from the so-called sympathetic system. Passing into the connective tissue between the bundles, the nerves divide, and, joining again, form a plexus around the bundles ; that is to say, a small twig, consisting of a few or perhaps only one axis-cylinder, coming from one branch, will run alongside of or join a similar small twig coming from another branch ; the indivi- dual axis-cylinders, however, do not themselves coalesce. From such primary plexuses, in which a few meduUated fibres are present among the non-medullated fibres, are given off still finer, ' inter- mediate ' plexuses, consisting exclusively of non-medullated fibres ; these embrace the smaller bundles of muscular fibres. The branches of these plexuses may consist of a single axis-cylinder, or may even be filaments corresponding to several, or to a few only, of the fibrillse of which an axis-cylinder is supposed to be composed. Prom these intermediate plexuses are given off single fibrillse, or very small bundles of fibrillse, which, running in the cement substance between the individual fibres, form a fine net- work around the individual fibres, which network differs from the plexuses just spoken of inasmuch as some of the filaments com- posing it appear to coalesce. The ultimate ending of this network has not yet been conclusively traced ; but it seems probable that fibrils from the network terminate in small knobs, or swellings, lying on the substance of the muscular fibres, somewhat after the fashion of minute end-plates. A similar termination of nerves in a plexus, or network, is met with in other tissues, and is not confined to non-medullated fibres. A medullated fibre may end in a plexus, and when it does so loses first its medulla and subsequently its neurilemma, the plexus becoming ultimately like that formed by a non-medullated fibre, and consisting of attenuated axis -cylinders with thickenings, and some- times with nuclei, at the nodal points. Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. IGl § 91- So far as we know, plain muscular tissue in its chemical features resembles striated muscular tissue. It contains albumin, some forms of globulin, and antecedents of myosin which upon the death of the fibres become myosin; for plain muscular tissue after death becomes rigid, losing its extensibility, and probably becoming acid, though the acidity is not so marked as in striated muscle. Kreatin has also been found, as well as glycogen, and, indeed, it seems probable that the whole metabolism of plain muscular tissue is fundamentally the same as that of the striated muscles. § 92. In their general physical features plain muscular fibres also resemble striated fibres, and like them they are irritable and contractile ; when stimulated they contract. The fibres vary in natural length in different situations, those of the blood vessels, for instance, being shorter and stouter than those of the intestine ; but in the same situation the fibres may also be found in one of two different conditions. In the one case the fibres are long and thin ; in the other case they are reduced in length, it may be to one half or even to one third, and are correspondingly thicker, broader and less pointed at the ends, their total bulk remaining unaltered. In the former case they are relaxed or elongated ; in the latter case they are contracted. The facts of the contraction of plain muscular tissue may be studied in the intestine, the muscular coat of which consists of an outer thin sheet, composed of fibres and bundles of fibres disposed longitudinally, and of an inner, much thicker sheet of fibres disposed circularly; in the ureter a similar arrangement of two coats obtains. If a mechanical or electrical (or indeed any other) stimulus be brought to bear on a part of a fresh, living, still warm intestine (the small intestine is the best to work with), a circular contraction is seen to take place at the spot stimulated ; the intestine seems nipped in ringwise, as if tied round with an invisible cord ; and the part so constricted, previously vascular and red, becomes pale and l3loodless. The individual filDres of the circular coat in the region stimulated have each become shorter, and the total effect of the shortening of the multitude of fibres, all having the same circular disposition, is to constrict or narrow the lumen or tube of the in- testine. The longitudinally disposed fibres of the outer longitudinal coat in a similar manner contract or shorten in a longitudinal direction, but this coat being relatively much thinner than the circular coat, the longitudinal contraction is altogether over- shadowed by the circular contraction. A similar mode of contrac- tion is also seen when the ureter is similarly stimulated. The contraction thus induced is preceded by a very long latent period, and lasts a very considerable time, — in fact several seconds, after which relaxation slowly takes place. We may say, then, that over the circularly dispersed fibres of the intestine (or ureter) at the spot in question there has passed a contraction-wave remarkable for its long latent period, and for the slowness of its development, 11 162 CONTRACTION OF PLAIN MUSCLES. [Book i. the wave being propagated from fibre to fibre. From the spot so directly stimulated, the contraction may pass also as a wave (with a length of 1 cm. and a velocity of from 20 to 30 millimetres a second in the ureter) along the circular coat both upwards and downwards. The longitudinal fibres at the spot stimulated are, as we have said, also thrown into contractions of altogether similar character, and a wave of contraction may thus also travel longitudi- nally along the longitudinal coat both upwards and downwards. It is evident, however, that the wave of contraction of which we are now speaking is in one respect different from the wave of contrac- tion treated of in dealing with striated muscle. In the latter case the contraction-wave is a simple wave, propagated along the in- dividual fibre and starting from the end-plate, or, in the case of direct stimulation, from the part of the fibre first affected by the stimulus ; we have no evidence that the contraction of one fibre can communicate contraction to neighbouring fibres, or, indeed, in any way influence neighbouring fibres. In the case of the intestine or ureter, the wave is complex, being the sum of the contraction- waves of several fibres engaged in different phases, and is propagated from fibre to fibre, both in the direction of the fibres, as when the whole circumference of the intestine is engaged in the contraction, or when the wave travels longitudinally along the longitudinal coat, and also in a direction at right angles to the axes of the fibres, as when the contraction-wave travels lengthways along the circular coat of the intestine, or when it passes across a breadth of the longitudinal coat ; that is to say, the changes leading to contraction are communicated not only in a direct manner across the cement substance, uniting the fibres of a bundle, but also in an indirect manner, probably by means of nerve fibres, from bundle to bundle across the connective tissue between them. Moreover, it is obvious that even the contraction-wave which passes along a single un- striated fibre differs from that passing along a striated fibre, in the very great length both of its latent period, and of the duration of its contraction. Hence, much more even than in the case of a striated muscle, the whole of each fibre must be occupied by the contraction-wave, and, indeed, be in nearly the same phase of the contraction at the same time. Waves of contraction thus passing along the circular and longi- tudinal coats of the intestine constitute what is called peristaltic action. Like the contractions of striated muscle, the contractions of plain muscles may be started by stimulation of nerves going to the part, the nerves supplying plain muscular tissue, running for the most part, as we have said, in the so-called sympathetic system, but being, as we shall see, ultimately connected with the spinal cord or brain. Here, however, we come upon an im- portant distinction between the striated skeletal muscles, and the plain muscles of the viscera. As a general rule the skeletal Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 163 muscles are thrown into contraction only ])y nervous impulses reaching them along their nerves ; spontaneous movements of the skeletal muscles, that is, contractions arising out of changes in the muscles themselves are extremely rare, and when they occur are abnormal ; so-called ' cramps,' for instance, which are prolonged tetanic contractions of skeletal muscles independent of the will, though their occurrence is largely due to the condition of the muscle itself, generally the result of overwork, are probably actually started by nervous impulses reaching them from without. On the other hand, the plain muscles of the viscera, of the intestine, uterus and ureter, for instance, and of the blood vessels, very fre- quently fall into contractions, and so carry out movements of the organs to which they belong quite independently of the central nervous system. These organs exhibit ' spontaneous ' movements quite apart from the will, quite apart from the central nervous system, and under favourable circumstances continue to do this for some time after they have been entirely isolated and removed from the body. So slight indeed is the connection between the move- ments of organs and parts supplied with plain muscular fibres, and the will, that these muscular fibres have sometimes been called involuntary muscles ; but this name is undesirable since some muscles, consisting entirely of plain muscular fibres {e.g. the ciliary muscles by which the eye is accommodated for viewing objects at different distances), are directly under the influence of the will, and some muscles composed of striated fibres, (e.g. those of the heart) are wholly removed from the influence of the will. We shall best study, however, the facts relating to the move- ments of parts provided with plain muscular fibres when we come to consider the parts themselves. Like the skeletal muscles, whose nervous elements have been rendered functionally incapable (§ 78), plain muscles are much more sensitive to the making and breaking of a constant current than to induction-shocks ; a current, when very brief, like that of an induction-shock, produces little or no effect. The plain muscles seem to be remarkably susceptible to the influences of temperature. When exposed to low temperatures they readily lose the power of contracting ; thus the movements of the intestine are said to cease at a temperature below 19° C. Variations in temperature have also very marked effect on the duration and extent of the contractions. Associated probably with this susceptibility is the rapidity with which plain muscular fibres, even in cold blooded vertebrates, lose their irritability after removal from the body and severance from their blood- supply. Thus while, as we have seen, the skeletal muscles of a frog can be experimented upon for many hours (or even for two or three days) after removal from the body, and the skeletal muscles of a mammal for a much less but still considerable time, it is matter of very great difficulty to secure the continuance of 164 CILIARY MOVEMENT. [Book i. movements of the intestine or of other organs supplied with plain muscular fibres, even in the case of the frog, for any long period after removal from the body. The contraction of plain muscular fibres is, as we said, very slow in its development and very long in its duration, even when started by a momentary stimulus, such as a single induction-shock. The contraction after a stimulation often lasts so long as to raise the question, whether what has been produced is not a single contrac- tion but a tetanus. Tetanus, however, that is, the fusion of a series of contractions, seems to be of rare occurrence, though probably it may be induced, in plain muscular tissue ; but the ends of tetanus are gained by a kind of contraction which, rare or at least not prominent in skeletal muscle, becomes of great importance in plain muscular tissue, by a kind of contraction called a tonic contraction. The subject is one not without difficulties, but it would appear that a plain muscular fibre may remain for a very considerable time in a state of contraction, the amount of shortening thus maintained being either small or great : it is then said to be in a state of tonic contraction. This is especially seen in the case of the plain muscular tissue of the arteries, and we shall have to return to this matter in dealing with the circulation. The muscular tissue which enters into the construction of the heart is of a peculiar nature, being on the one hand striated, and on the other in some respects similar to plain muscular tissue ; but this we shall consider in dealing with the heart itself. Ciliary Movement. § 93. Nearly all the movements of the body which are not due to physical causes, such as gravity, the diffusion of liquids &c., are carried out by muscles, either striated or plain ; but some small and yet important effects in the way of movement are produced by the action of cilia, and by those changes of form which are called amoeboid. Cilia are generally appendages of epithelial cells. An epithelium consists of a number of cells, arranged in a layer, one, two or more cells deep, the cell-bodies of the constituent cells being in contact with each other, or united merely by a minimal amount of cement substance, not separated by an appreciable quantity of intercellular material. As a rule no connective tissue or blood vessel passes between the cells, but the layer of cells rests on a basis of vascular connective tissue, from which it is usually separated by a more or less definite basement membrane, and from the blood vessels of which its cells draw their nourishment. The cells vary in form, and the cell body round the nucleus may be protoplasmic in appearance, or may be differentiated in various ways. An epithe- lium bearing cilia is called a ciliated epithelium. Various passages of the body, such as, in the mammal, parts of the nasal chambers CiiAr. II.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 1G5 and of the respiratory and generative passages, are lined with ciliated epithelium, and by the action of cilia, fluid containing various particles and generally more or less viscid is driven outwards along the passages towards the exterior of the body. A typical epithelium cell, such as may be found in the trachea, is generally somewhat wedge-shaped with its broad end circular or, rather, polygonal in outline, forming part of the free surface of the epithelium, and with its narrow end, which may be a blunt point or may be somewhat branched and irregular, plunged among smaller subjacent cells of the epithelium, or reaching to the con- nective tissue below. The cell-body is, over the greater part of its extent, composed of protoplasmic substance with the usual granular appearance. At about the lower third of the cell is placed, with its long axis vertical, an oval nucleus, having the ordinary characters of a nucleus. So far the ciliated cell resembles an ordinary epithelium cell ; but the free surface of the cell is formed by a layer of hyaline transparent somewhat refractive substance, which, when the cell is seen, as usual, in profile, appears as a hyaline refrac- tive band or border. From this border there project outward a variable number, 10 to 30, delicate, tapering, hair-like filaments, varying in length, but generally about a quarter or a third as long as the cell itself ; these are the cilia. Immediately below this hyaline border the cell-substance often exhibits more or less distinctly a longitudinal striation, fine lines passing down from the hyaline border towards the lower part of the cell-substance round the nucleus. The hyaline border itself usually exhibits a striation as if it were split up into blocks, each block correspond- ing to one of the cilia, and careful examination leads to the conclusion that the hyaline border is really composed of the fused thicker basal parts of the cilia. The cell-body has no distinct external membrane or envelope, and its substance is in close contact with that of its neighbours, being united to them either by a thin layer of some cement substance, or by the simple cohesion of their respective surfaces. At all events, the cells do cohere largely together, and it is difficult to obtain an isolated living cell, though the cells may be easily separated from each other when dead by the help of dissociating fluids. When a cell is obtained isolated in a living state, it is very frequently found to have lost its wedge shape and to have become more or less hemispherical or even spherical ; under the unusual conditions, and freed from the support of its neighbours, the cell-body changes its form. The general characters just described are common to all ciliated epithelium cells, but the cells in different situations vary in certain particulars, such as the exact form of the cell-body, the number and length of the cilia, &c. § 94. Ciliary action, in the form in which it is most common 166 CILIARY MOVEMENT. [Book i. in mammals and, indeed, vertebrates, consists in the cilium {i.e. the tapering filament spoken of above) being at one moment straight or vertical, at the next moment being bent down suddenly into a hook or sickle form, and then more slowly returning to the straight erect position. When the cilia are vigorous, this double move- ment is repeated with very great rapidity, so rapidly that the individual movements cannot be seen ; it is only when, by reason of fatigue, the action becomes slow that the movement itself can be seen ; what is seen otherwise is simply the effect of the movement. The movements when slow have been counted at about eight (double movements) in a second ; probably when vigorous they are repeated from twelve to twenty times a second. The flexion takes place in one direction only, and all the cilia of each cell, and, indeed, of all the cells of the same epithelium move in the same direction. Moreover, the same direction is maintained during the whole life of the epithelium ; thus the cilia of the epithelium of the trachea and bronchial passages move during the whole of life in such a way as to drive the fluid lying upon them upwards towards the mouth ; so far as we know in vertebrates, or at least in mammals, the direction is not and cannot by any means be reversed. The flexion is very rapid but the return to the erect position is much slower ; hence the total eflect of the blow, supposing the cilium and the cell to be fixed, is to drive the thin layer of fluid in which the cilium is working, and which always exists over the epithelium, and any particles which may be floating in that fluid in the same direction as that in which the blow is given. If the cell be not attached, but floating free, the effect of the blow may be to drive the cell itself backward ; and when perfectly fresh ciliated epithelium is teased out and examined in an inert fluid such as normal saline solution, isolated cells or small groups of cells may be seen rowing themselves about as it were by the action of their cilia. All the cilia of a cell move, as we have just said, in the same direction, but not quite at the same time. If we call the side of the cell towards which the cilia bend the front of the cell and the opposite side the back, the cilia at the back move a trifle before those at the front so that the movement runs over the cell in the direction of the movement itself. Similarly, taking any one cell, the cilia of the cells behind it move slightly before, and the cilia of the cells in front of it slightly after, its own cilia move. Hence, in this way along a whole stretch of epithelium the movement or bending of the cilia sweeps over the surface in ripples or waves, very much as, when the wind blows, similar waves of bending sweep over a field of corn or tall grass. By this arrangement the efficacy of the movement is secured, and a steady stream of fluid carrying particles is driven over the surface in a uniform continued direction ; if the cilia of separate cells, and still more if the Chap, ii.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 1G7 separate cilia of each cell, moved independently of the others, all that would be produced would be a series of minute ' wobbles,' of as little use for driving the fluid definitely onwards as the efforts of a boat's crew all rowing out of time are for propelling the boat. Swift bending and slower straightening is the form of ciliary movement generally met with in the ciliated epithelium of mam- mals and, indeed, of vertebrates ; but among the invertebrates we find other kinds of movement, such as a to and fro movement, equally rapid in both directions, a cork-screw movement, a simple undulatory movement, and many others. In each case the kind of movement seems adapted to secure a special end. Thus even in the mammal while the one-sided blow of the cilia of the epithelial cells secures a flow of fluid over the epithelium, the tail of the spermatozoon, which is practically a single cilium, by moving to and fro in an undulatory fashion drives the head of the sperma- tozoon onwards in a straight line, like a boat driven by a single oar worked at the stern. Why and exactly how the cilium of the epithelial cells bends swiftly and straightens slowly, always acting in the same direction, is a problem difficult at present to answer fully. Some have thought that the body of the cell is contractile, or contains contractile mechanisms pulling upon the cilia, which are thus simple passive puppets in the hands of the cells. But there is no satisfactory evidence for such a view. On the whole, the evidence is in favour of the view that the action is carried out by the cilium itself, that the bending is a contraction of the cilium, and that the straight- ening corresponds to the relaxation of a muscular fibre. But even then the exact manner in which the contraction bends and the relaxation straightens the filament is not fully explained. "We have no positive evidence that a longitudinal half, the inside we might say, of the filament is contractile, and the other half, the outside, elastic, a supposition which has been made to explain the bending and straightening. In fact, no adequate explanation of the matter has as yet been given, and it is really only on general grounds we conclude that the action is an effect of contractility. In the vertebrate animal, cilia are, so far as we know, wholly independent of the nervous system, and their movement is pro- bably ceaseless. In such animals, however, as Infusoria, Hydrozoa, &c. the movements in a ciliary tract may often be seen to stop and to go on again, to be now fast, now slow, according to the needs of the economy, and, as it almost seems, according to the will of the creature ; indeed, in some of these animals the ciliary move- ments are clearly under the influence of the nervous system. Observations with galvanic currents, constant and interrupted, have not led to any satisfactory results, and, so far as we know at present, ciliary action is most affected by changes of temperature and chemical media. Moderate heat quickens the movements, but a rise of temperature beyond a certain limit (about 40"C. in the case 168 AMOEBOID MOVEMENTS. [Book i. of the pharyngeal membrane of the frog) becomes injurious ; cold retards. Very dilute alkalis are favourable, acids are injurious. An excess of carbonic acid or an absence of oxygen diminishes or arrests the movements, either temporarily or permanently, accord- ing to the length of the exposure. Chloroform or ether in slight doses diminishes or suspends the action temporarily ; in excess kills and disorganises the cells. Amoeboid Movements. § 95. The white blood corpuscles, as we have said (§ 28), are able of themselves to change their form, and by repeated changes of form to move from place to place. Such movements of the substance of the corpuscles are called amoeboid, since they closely resemble and appear to be identical in nature with the movements executed by the amoeba and similar organisms. The movement of the endoplasm of the vegetable cell seems also to be of the same kind. The amoeba changes its form (and shifts its place) by throwing out projections of its substance, called pseudopodia, which may be blunt and short, broad bulgings, as it were, or may be so long and thin as to be mere filaments, or may be of an intermediate character. As we watch the outline of the hyaline ectosarc, we may see a pseudopodium beginning by a slight bulging of the outline ; the bulging increases by the neighbouring portions of the ectosarc moving into it, the movement under the microscope reminding one of the flowing of melted glass. As the pseudo- podium grows larger, and engages the whole thickness of the ectosarc at the spot, the granules of the endosarc may be seen streaming into it, forming a core of endosarc in the middle of the bulging of ectosarc. The pseudopodium may continue to grow larger and larger at the expense of the rest of the body, and eventually the whole of the amoeba, including the nucleus, may, as it were, have passed into the pseudopodium ; the body of the amoeba will now occupy the place of the pseudopodium instead of its old place : in other words it will in changing its form have also changed its place. During all these movements, and during all similar amoeboid movements, the bulk of the organism will, as far as can be ascertained, have remained unchanged ; the throwing out a pseu- dopodium in one direction is accompanied by a corresponding re- traction of the body in other directions. If, as sometimes happens, the organism throws out pseudopodia in various directions at the same time, the main body from which the pseudopodia project is reduced in thickness ; from being a spherical lump, for instance, it becomes a branched film. The movement is brought about not by increase or decrease of substance, but by mere translocation of particles ; a particle which at one moment was in one position Chap, it.] THE CONTRACTILE TISSUES. 169 moves into a new position, several particles thus moving towards the same point cause a bulging at that point, and several particles moving away from the same point cause a retraction at that point ; but no two particles get nearer to each other so as to occupy together less space, and thus lead to condensation of sub- stance, or get farther from each other so as to occupy more space, and thus lead to increase of bulk. In this respect, in that there is no change of bulk, but only a shifting of particles in their relative position to each other, the amoeboid movement resembles a muscular contraction ; but in other respects the two kinds of movement seem different, and the question arises, have we the right to speak of the substance, which can only execute amoeboid movements, as being contractile ? We may, if we admit that contractility is at bottom simply the power of shifting the relative position of particles, and that muscular contraction is a specialized form of contraction. In a plain muscular fibre (which we may take as simpler than the striated muscle) the shifting of particles is specialized in the sense that it has always a definite relation to the long axis of the fibre ; when the fibre contracts, a certain number of particles assume a new position by moving at right angles to the long axis of the fibre, and the fibre in consequence becomes shorter and broader. In a white blood corpuscle, amoeba, or other organism executing amoeboid movements, the shifting of the particles is not limited to any axis of the body of the organism ; at the same moment one particle or one set of particles may be moving in one direction, and another particle or another set of particles in another direction. A pseudopodium, short and broad, or long thin and filamentous, may be thrust out from any part of the surface of the body, and in any direction ; and a previously existing pseudopodium may be shortened, or be wholly drawn back into the substance of the body. In the plain muscle fibre the fact that the shifting is specialized in relation to the long axis of the fibre, necessitates that in a contraction the shortening, due to the particles moving at right angles to the long axis of the fibre, should be followed by what we have called relaxation due to the particles moving back to take up a position in the long axis ; and we have several times insisted on relaxation being an essential part of the total act of contraction. If no such movement in the direction of relaxation took place, the fibre would by repeated contractions be flattened out into a broad, thin film at right angles to its original long axis, and would thus become useless. A spherical white blood corpuscle may, by repeated contractions, i.e. amoeboid movements, transform itself into such a broad, thin film ; but in such a condition it is not useless. It may remain in that condition for some time, and by further contractions, i.e. amoeboid movements, may assume other shapes or revert to the spherical form. 170 AMCEBOID MOVEMENTS. [Book i. So long as we narrow our idea of contractility to what we see in a muscular fibre, and understand by contraction a movement of particles in relation to a definite axis, necessarily followed by a reversal of the movement in the form of relaxation, we shall find a difficulty in speaking of the substance of the amoeba or of the white blood corpuscle as being contractile. If, however, we conceive of contractility as being essentially the power of shifting the position of particles in any direction, without change of bulk (the shifting being due to intrinsic molecular changes about which we know little save that chemical decompositions are concerned in the matter), we may speak of the substance of the amoeba and white blood corpuscle as being contractile, and of muscular con- traction as being a specialized kind of contraction. The protoplasm of the amoeba or of a white corpuscle is, as we have said, of a consistency which we for want of better terms call semi-solid or semi-fluid. Consequently, when no internal changes are prompting its particles to move in this or that direction, the influences of the surroundings will tend to give the body, as they will other fluid or semi-fluid drops, a spherical form. Hence the natural form of the white corpuscle is more or less spherical. If, under the influence of some stimulus internal or external, some of the particles are stirred to shift their place, amoeboid move- ments follow, and the spherical form is lost. If, however, all the particles were stirred to move with equal energy, they would neutralize each other's action, no protrusion or retraction would take place at any point of the surface and the body would remain a sphere. Hence, in extreme stimulation, in what in the muscle corresponds to complete tetanus, the form of the body is the same as in rest ; and the tetanized sphere would not be appreciably smaller than the sphere at rest, for that would imply change of bulk, but this, as we have seen, does not take place. This result shews strikingly the difference between the general contractility of the amoeba, and the special contractility of the muscle. CHAPTER HI. ON THE MORE GENERAL FEATURES OF NERVOUS TISSUES. § 96. In the preceding chapter we have dealt with the pro- perties of nerves going to muscles, the nerves which we called motor, and have incidentally spoken of other nerves which we called sensory. Both these kinds of nerves are connected with the brain and spinal cord and form part of the General Nervous System. We shall have to study hereafter in detail the brain and spinal cord ; but the nervous system intervenes so repeatedly in the processes carried out by other tissues that it will be desirable, before pro- ceeding further, to discuss some of its more general features. The Nervous System consists (1) of the Brain and Spinal Cord forming together the cerebrospinal axis, or central nervous system ; (2) of the nerves passing from that axis to nearly all parts of the body, those which are connected with the spinal cord being called spinal, and those which are connected with the brain, within the cranium, being called cranial ; and (3) of ganglia distributed along the nerves in various parts of the body. The spinal cord obviously consists of a number of segments or metameres, following in succession along its axis, each metamere giving off on each side a pair of spinal nerves ; and a similar division into metameres may be traced in the brain, though less distinctly, since the cranial nerves are arranged in manner some- what different from that of the spinal nerves. "We may take a single spinal metamere, represented diagrammatically in Fig. 25, as illustrating the general features of the nervous system ; and since the half on one side of the median line resembles the half on the other side, we may deal with one lateral half only. Each spinal nerve arises by two roots. The metamere of the central nervous system C consists, as we shall hereafter see, of grey 172 A NEURAL METAMERE. [Book i. EiG. 25. Scheme of the Nerves of a Segment of the Spinal Cord. Gr grey, TF white matter of sphial cord. A anterior, P posterior root. 6' ganglion on the posterior root. N whole nerve, N' spinal nerve proper ending in 71/ skeletal or somatic muscle, S somatic sensory cell or surface, A m other ways. / viscemi nerve (white ramus communicans) passing tea ganghon of the sympathetic chain 2, and passing on as V to supply the more distant ganglion (t, then as V to the peripheral ganglion a' and ending in m splanchnic muscle, s splanchnic sensory cell or surface, x other possible splanchnic endings. _ From 2 is given off the revehent nerve r. v (grey ramus communicans), which partly passes backward towards the spinal cord, and partly runs as v. m, in connection CiiAiMii.] FEATURES OF NERVOUS TISSUES. 173 with the spinal nerve, to supply vasomotor (constrictor) fibres to the muscles (w') of blood vessels in certain parts, for example, in the limlis. S/j, the sympathetic chain uniting the ganglia of the series 2. The termiuati(jns of the other nerves arising from 2, a, a arc not siiewn. The figure is necessarily schematic, and must not be taken to shew that the visceral branch joins only tlie ganglion beloiigiug to the same segment as the spinal nerve ; the visceral brancli joins the sympathetic chum, passing to otiier ganglia besides the one of tiie same segment, indeed in some cases does not join tliis ac all. matter Gr in the interior, and white matter W on the outside. From the anterior part of grey matter is given off the anterior nerve root A, and from the posterior part the posterior nerve root P. The latter passes into a swelling or ganglion G, " the ganglion of the posterior root," or more shortly " the spinal gan- glion ; " the anterior root does not pass into this ganglion. Beyond the ganglion the roots join to form the nerve trunk N. We shall later on give the evidence that the nerve fibres composing the posterior root P are, so far as we know at present, exclusively occupied in carrying nervous impulses from the tissues of the body to the central nervous system, and that the fibres composing the anterior root A are similarly occupied in carrying impulses from the central nervous system to the several tissues ; that is to say, the former is made up of sensory fibres, or (since the impulses passing along them to the central system may give rise to effects other than sensations) afferent fibres, while the latter is made up of motor, or (since the impulses passing along them from the central nervous system may produce effects other than movements) efferent fibres. The nerve trunk N is consequently a mixed nerve, composed of afferent and efferent fibres. By far the greater part of this mixed nerve, dividing into various branches, is distributed {N') to the skin and the skeletal muscles, some of the fibres (motor) ending in muscular fibres {M), others (sensory) ending in epithelial cells {S) connected with the skin, which we shall consider hereafter under the name of sen- sory epithelial cells, while others, X, after dividing into minute branches and forming plexuses end, in ways not yet definitely determined, in tissues associated with the skin or skeletal muscles. Morphologists distinguish the parts which go to form the skin, skeletal muscles, &c. as somatic, from the splanchnic parts which go to form the viscera. We may accordingly call this main part of the spinal nerve the somatic division of the nerve. Soon after the mixed nerve N leaves the spinal canal, it gives off a small branch V, which, under the name of (white) ramus communicans, runs into the longitudinal series of ganglia (2*) conspicuous in the thorax as the main sympathetic chain. This branch is destined to supply the viscera, and might, therefore, be called the splanchnic division of the spinal nerve. We may say at once, without entering into details, that the whole of the sympathetic system with its ganglia, plexuses and nerves is to be regarded as a development or expansion of the visceral or splanchnic divisions of certain spinal nerves. By means of this 174 SOMATIC AND SPLANCHNIC NEEVES. [Book i. system, splanchnic fibres from the central nervous system are distributed to the tissues of the viscera, some of them on their way passing through secondary ganglia a, and, it may be, tertiary ganglia. There are, however, as we shall see, certain nerves or fibres which do not run in the sympathetic system, and yet are distributed to the viscera and are ' splanchnic ' in nature. We cannot, therefore, use the word sympathetic to denote all the fibres which are splanchnic in nature. On the other hand, the ' splanchnic nerves ' of the anatomist form a part only of the splanchnic system in the above sense : the term thus used is limited to particular nerves of the splanchnic system distributed to the abdomen, and the double use of the term splanchnic might lead to confusion. The difficulty may perhaps be avoided by calling the splanchnic nerves of the anatomist " abdominal splanchnic." The majority of these splanchnic fibres seem to be efferent in nature, carrying impulses from the central nervous system to the tissues, some ending in plain muscular fibres (m), others in other ways ix) ; but some of the fibres are afferent (s), and convey impulses from the viscera to the central nervous system, and it is possible that some of these begin or end in epithelial cells of the viscera. We shall have occasion in the next chapter to speak of nerves which govern the blood vessels of the body, the so-called vaso- motor nerves. A certain class of these, namely the vaso-constrictor nerves or fibres are branches of the splanchnic division of the cerebrospinal nerves, and as we shall see the vaso-constrictor nerves of the skeletal muscles, skin, and other parts supplied by somatic nerves, after running for some distance in the splanchnic division ( V), turn back {r. v) and join the somatic division, the fibres of which they accompany (v. m) on their way to the tissues whose blood vessels (m') they supply ; some of these fibres, however, run not peripherally towards the skin but centrally towards the spinal cord, and probably supply the membranes of the cord. Where the communicating branch from the spinal nerve to the sympathetic ganglia consists of two parts, the white ramus com- municans and the grey ramus communicans, these revehent, backward turning splanchnic fibres run in the grey ramus ; but, in the case of some of the spinal nerves, it is not possible to distinguish a grey ramus as separate from a white ramus. Besides these vaso-constrictor fibres, other fibres of different function, of which we shall have to speak later on, run from the spinal nerves into the splanchnic system, and then back again to the somatic system. We have seen (§ 68) that a nerve going to a muscle is com- posed of nerve fibres, chiefly meduUated, some, however, being non-medullated, bound together by connective tissue. The same description holds good for the whole somatic division of each of the spinal nerves. The splanchnic division also consists of me- Chap, hi.] FEATURES OF NERVOUS TISSUES. 175 dullated and non-iuedulloted fibix'S bound toii,ether Ijy connective tissue, but in it, as a whole, the non-nieduUated fijjres preponderate, some branches appearing to contain hardly any niedullated fibres at all. The non-medullated fibres, which are found in the somatic division, appear to be fibres which have joined that division from the splanchnic division. So prominent are non-medullated fibres in splanchnic nerves and hence in the sympathetic system that they are sometimes called sympathetic fibres. We have said that the axis-cylinder, whether of a niedullated or non-medullated fibre, is to be considered as a long drawn out process of a nerve cell. Nerve cells are found in three main situations. 1. In the central nervous system, the brain and spinal cord. 2. In the several ganglia placed aloi,ig the course of the nerves, both the spinal ganglia, and the ganglia of the splanchnic or sympathetic system. 3. At the terminations of nerves in certain tissues. Some of these latter are to be regarded as small, more or less terminal, ganglia, and similar minute ganglia consisting of two or three cells only are found frequently along the course of splanchnic nerves ; such cells really, therefore, belong to the second group. But besides this, in certain situations, as for instance in certain organs of the skin, and in the organs of special sense, nerves, generally afferent or sensory in nature, either actually end in, or at their termination are connected with, cells which appear to be of a nervous nature ; such cells form a distinct category by themselves. Hence, along its whole course a nerve consists exclusively of nerve fibres (and the connective tissue supporting them), except in the central nervous system from which it springs, in the ganglia, great and small, through which it passes or which are attached to it at one part or another of its course, in both of which situations nerve cells are found, and at its termination where its fibres may end in nerve cells. The features of these nerve cells differ in these several situa- tions. The characters of the terminal cells wdiich, as we have said, are chiefly sensory, and the structure of the brain and spinal cord we shall study in detail later on. We may here confine our attention to the nerve cells of the ganglia, and to some of the broad features of the nerve cells of the spinal cord. § 97. Spinal ganglia. AVhen a longitudinal section of a spinal ganglion is examined under a low power, the fibres of the posterior root as they enter the ganglion are observed to spread out and pass between relatively large and conspicuous nucleated cells which are to a large extent arranged in groups, somewhat after the fashion of a bunch of grapes. These are the nerve cells ; they have frequently a diameter of about 100 /a, but may be still larger, or may be much smaller. In a transverse section it will be observed that a large compact mass of these cells lies on the outer side of the ganglion, and that the racemose groups on the 176 SPINAL GANGLIA. [Book i. inner side are smaller. A qimntity of connective tissue, carrying blood vessels and lymphatics, runs between the groups, and, passing into each group, runs between the cells and fibres ; and a thick wrapping of connective tissue continuous with the sheath of the nerve surrounds and forms a sheath for the whole ganglion. Each of the nerve cells, ganglionic cells as they are called, examined under a higher power, either after having been isolated, or in an adequately thin and prepared section, will present the following features. The cell consists of a cell-hody which is, normally, pear-shaped, having a broad end in which is placed the nucleus and a narrow end, which thins out into a stalk and is eventually continued on as a nerve fibre. The substance of the cell-body is of the kind which we call finely granular protoplasm ; sometimes there is an appearance of fibrillation, the fibrillar passing in various direc- tions in the body of the cell, and being gathered together in a longitudinal direction in the stalk. Sometimes the cell-body immediately around the nucleus appears of a different grain from that nearer the stalk, and not unfrequently near the nucleus is an aggregation of discrete pigment granules imbedded in the proto- plasm. The several cells of the same ganglion frequently differ as to the appearances of the cell-body, this being in some more distinctly or coarsely granular than in others, and also staining differently. The nucleus, like the nuclei of nearly all nerve cells, is large and conspicuous, and when in a normal condition is remarkably clear and refractive, though it appears to consist like other nuclei of a nuclear membrane and network and nuclear interstitial ma- terial. Even more conspicuous perhaps is a very large, spherical, highly refractive nucleolus; occasionally more than one nucleolus is present. Surrounding the cell-body is a distinct sheath or capsule con- sisting of a transparent, hyaline, or faintly fibrillated membrane, lined on the inside by one layer or by two layers of flat, polygonal, nucleated epithelioid cells or plates ; that is to say, cells which resemble epithelium cells, but differ not only in being extremely flattened, but also in the cell body being transformed from ordinary granular protoplasm into a more transparent differen- tiated material. In stained specimens the nuclei of these plates are very conspicuous. Under normal conditions this sheath is in close contact with the whole body of the cell, but in hardened and prepared specimens the cell body is sometimes seen shrunk away from the sheath, leaving a space between them. Occasionally the cell body, while remaining attached to the sheath at three or four or more points, is retracted elsewhere, and accordingly assumes a more or less stellate form ; but this artificial condition must not be confounded with the natural branched form, which as we shall see other kinds of nerve cells possess. Chap, hi.] FEATURES OF NERVOUS TISSUES. 177 When a section is made through a hardened ganglion, the plane of the section passes through the stalks of a few only of the cells, and that rarely for any great distance along the stalk, since in the case of many of the cells the stalk is more or less curved, and consequently runs out of the plane of section ; but in properly isolated cells we can see that in many cases the stalk of the cell is, as we have said, continued on into a nerve fibre, and we have reason to believe that it is so in all cases. As the cell-body narrows into the stalk, several nuclei make their appearance, lodged on it ; these are small granular nuclei, wholly unlike the nucleus of the cell-body itself, and more like, though not quite like, the nuclei of the neurilemma of a nerve. They are probably of the same nature as the latter ; and, indeed, as we trace the narrowing stalk downwards, a tine, delicate sheath which, if present, is at least not obvious over the cell-body, makes its appearance, and a little farther on between this sheath, which is now clearly a neurilemma, and the stalk of the cell-body, which has by this time become a cylinder of uniform width, and is now obviously an axis-cylinder, a layer of medulla, very fine at first but rapidly thickening, is established. The stalk of the nerve cell thus becomes an ordinary medullated nerve fibre. The sheath of the cell is continued, also,, on to the nerve fibre, not as was once thought as the neurilemma, but as that special sheath of connective tissue, of which we have already spoken (§ 69) as Henle's sheath, and which ultimately becomes fused with the connective tissue of the nerve. At some variable distance from the cell the nerve fibre bears the first node, and either at this or some early succeeding node the fibre divides into two ; as we have seen, division of a medullated nerve fibre always takes place at a node. The two divisions thus arising run in opposite directions, forming in this way a \- piece ; and while one division runs in one direction towards the posterior root, the other runs in an opposite direction towards the nerve trunk. The nerve cell is thus, as it were, a side piece, attached to a fibre passing through the ganglion on its way from the posterior root to the nerve trunk. It cannot be said that in any one ganglion this connection has been traced in the case of every nerve cell of the ganglion; but the more care is taken, and the more successful the preparation, the greater is the number of cells which may be isolated with their respective I- pieces ; so that we may conclude that, normally, every cell of a ganglion is connected on the one hand with a fibre of the posterior root, and on the other hand with a fibre of the nerve trunk. We have reasons further to believe that every fibre of the posterior root in passing through the ganglion on its way to the mixed nerve trunk is thus connected with a nerve cell ; but this has been called in question. In certain animals, for instance certain fishes, the cells of the spinal ganglia are not pear-shaped, but oval or fusiform, and each narrow end is pro- 12 178 SYMPATHETIC GANGLIA. [Book i. longed into a nerve fibre, one end thus being connected with the posterior root and the other with the nerve trunk. In such a case the nerve cell is simply a direct enlargement of the axis-cylinder, with a nucleus placed in the enlargement. The nerve cells above described are similar enlargements, also bearing nuclei, placed not directly in the course of the axis-cylinder, but on one side and connected with the axis-cylinder by the cross limb of the |- piece. Hence the ordinary ganglion cell is spoken of as being unipolar, those of fishes being called Mpolar. The former seems to be a special modification of the latter ; and, indeed, when the de- velopment of a unipolar cell is traced in the embryo it is found to be bipolar first, and subsequently to become unipolar. In examining spinal ganglia a cell is sometimes found which bears no trace of any process connecting it with a nerve fibre. It is possible that such a cell, which is spoken of as apolar, may be a young cell which has not yet developed its nerve process or an old cell which has by degeneration lost the process which it formerly possessed. § 98. The ganglia of the splanchnic system, like the spinal ganglia, consist of nerve cells and nerve fibres imbedded in connective tissue, which, however, is of a looser and less compact nature in them than in the spinal ganglia. So far as the characters of their nuclei, the nature of their cell-substance, and the possession of a sheath are concerned, what has been said concerning the nerve cells of spinal ganglia holds, in general, good for those of splanchnic ganglia ; and, indeed, in certain ganglia of the splanchnic system connected with the cranial nerves, the nerve cells appear to be wholly like those of spinal ganglia. In most splanchnic ganglia, however, in those which are generally called sympathetic ganglia, two important differences may be observed between what we may call the characteristic nerve cell of the splanchnic ganglion, and the cell of the spinal ganglion. In the first place, while the nerve cell of the spinal ganglia has one process only, the nerve cell of the splanchnic ganglia has at least two and may have three or even four or five processes ; it is a bipolar or a multipolar cell. In the second place, while these processes of the splanchnic ganglion cell may be continued on as nerve fibres, as is the single process of the spinal ganglion cell, the nerve fibres so formed are, in the case of most of the processes of a cell, and sometimes in the case of all the processes, non-medullated fibres, and remain non-meduUated so far as they can be traced. In some instances, one process becomes at a little distance from the cell a medullated fibre, while the other processes become non-medullated fibres ; and we are led to believe that in this case the medullated fibre is proceeding to the cell on its way from the central nervous system, and that the non-medullated fibres are proceeding from the cell on their way to more peripherally placed parts ; the nerve cell Chap, hi.] FEATURES OF NERVOUS TISSUES. 179 seems to serve as a centre for the division of nerve fibres, and also for the change from medullated to non-medullated fibres. All the processes of a splanchnic ganglion cell, however, are not continued on as nerve fibres ; sometimes the process divides rapidly into a number of fine branches, which are then found to twine closely round the bodies of neighbouring cells. In consequence of its thus possessing more than one process, the splanchnic ganglion cell is more or less irregular in form, in contrast to the pear shape of the spinal ganglion cell. But in certain situations in certain animals, for instance in the frog, in many of the ganglia of the abdomen, and in the small ganglia in the heart, pear-shaped splanchnic ganglion cells are met with. In such cases the nucleated sheath is distinctly pear-shaped or balloon-shaped, and the large, conspicuous nucleus is placed, as in the spinal ganglion cell, near the broad end, but the stalk of the cell is made up not of a single fibre but of two fibres ; one of these is straight, and seems to be the direct continuation of the cell- substance, while the other, which seems to be gathered up from a network on the surface of the cell, is twisted spirally round the straifrht one. The two fibres run for some distance together in the same funnel-shaped prolongation of the nucleated sheath of the cell, but eventually separate, each fibre acquiring a sheath (sheath of Henle) of its own. Generally, if not always, one fibre, usually the straight one, becomes a medullated fibre, while the other, usually the twisted or spiral one, is continued as a non- medullated fibre. While within the common nucleated sheath both fibres, especially the spiral one, bear nuclei of the same character as those seen in a corresponding situation in the spinal ganglion cell. In the walls of the intestine, in connection with splanchnic nerves, are found peculiar nerve cells forming what are known as the plexuses of Meissner and Auerbach, but we shall postpone for the present any description of these or of other peculiar splanchnic cells. § 99. In the central nervous system nerve cells are found in the so-called grey matter only, they are absent from the %vhite matter. In the grey matter of the spinal cord, in the parts spoken of as the anterior cornua, we meet with remarkable nerve cells of the follow- ing characters. The cells are large, varying in diameter from 50|U. to 140/x, and each consists of a cell-body surrounding a large, con- spicuous, refractive nucleus, in which is placed an even still more conspicuous nucleolus. The nucleus resembles the nuclei of the ganglion cells already described, and the cell-body, like the cell- body of the ganglion cells, is composed of a finely granular sub- stance, often fibrillated, though generally obscurely so ; frequently a yellowish brown pigment is deposited in a part of the cell- body, not far from the nucleus. The cell-body is prolonged sometimes into two or three only, but generally into several 180 NERVE CELLS OF SPINAL CORD. [Book i. processes, which appear more distinctly fibrillated than the more central parts of the cell-body. These processes are of two kinds. One process and, apparently, one only, but, in the case at least of the cells of the anterior cornu, always one, is prolonged as a thin, un- branched band, which retains a fairly uniform diameter for a considerable distance from the cell, and, when successfully traced, is found sooner or later to acquire a medulla, and to become the axis-cylinder of a nerve fibre ; the processes which thus pass out from the grey matter of the anterior cornu through the white matter form the anterior roots of the spinal nerve. Such a process is accordingly called the axis-cylinder process. The other processes of the cell rapidly branch, and so divide into very delicate filaments, which are soon lost to view in the substance of the grey matter. Indeed, the grey matter is partly made up of a plexus of delicate filaments, arising on the one hand from the division of processes of the nerve cells, and on the other from the division of the axis-cylinders of fibres running in the grey matter. The cell is not surrounded, like the ganglion cell, by a distinct sheath. As we shall see later on, while treating in detail of the central nervous system, all the nervous elements of the spinal cord are supported by a network or spongework of delicate peculiar tissue called neuroglia, analogous to and serving much the same function as, but different in origin and nature from connective tissue. This neuroglia forms a sheath to the nerve cell and to its processes, as well as to the nerve fibres running both in the white and the grey matter ; hence within the central nervous system the fibres, whether medullated or no, possess no separate neurilemma ; tubular sheaths of the neuroglia give the axis-cylinder and medulla all the support they need. All the nerve cells of the anterior cornu probably possess an axis-cylinder process, and other cells similarly provided with an axis-cylinder process are found in other parts of the grey matter. But in certain parts, as for instance in the posterior cornu, cells are met with which appear to possess no axis-cylinder process ; all the processes seem to branch out into fine filaments. Except for this absence, which is probably apparent rather than real, of an axis- cylinder process, such cells resemble in their general features the cells of the anterior cornu, though they are generally somewhat smaller. Speaking generally, the great feature of the nerve cells of the central nervous system as distinguished from the ganglion cells is the remarkable way in which their processes branch off into a number of delicate filaments, corresponding to the delicate fila- ments or fibrillse in which at its termination in the tissues the axis- cylinder of a nerve often ends. § 100. From the above descriptions it is obvious that in the spinal cord (to which as representing the central nervous system we may at present confine ourselves, leaving the brain for later Chap, iti.] FEATURES OF NERVOUS TISSUES. 181 study) afferent fibres (fibres of the posterior root) are in some way by means of the grey matter brought into connection with efferent fibres (fibres of the anterior root) ; in other words the spinal cord is a centre uniting afferent and efferent fibres. The spinal ganglia are not centres in this sense ; the nerve cells composing the ganglia are simply relays on the afferent fibres of the posterior root, they have no connection whatever with efferent fibres, they are connected with fibres of one kind only. Concerning the ganglia of the splanchnic system, we cannot in all cases make at present a positive statement, but the evidence so far at our disposal points to the conclusion that in them, as in the spinal ganglia, each nerve cell belongs to fibres of one function only, that where several processes of a cell are prolonged into nerve fibres, these fibres have all the same function, the nerve cell being as in the spinal ganglia a mere relay. We have no satisfactory evidence that in a ganglion the fibres springing from, or connected with, one cell join another cell so as to convert the ganglion into a centre joining together cells, whose nerve fibres have different functions. We shall have later on to bring forward evidence that the nucleated cell-body of a nerve cell in a ganglion or elsewhere is in some way or other connected with the nutrition, the growth and repair of the nerve fibres springing from it. Besides this nutritive function, the multipolar cells of the splanchnic ganglia appear to serve the purpose of multiplying the tracts along which nervous impulses may pass. An impulse, for instance, reaching a multipolar cell in one of the proximal (sympathetic) ganglia along one fibre or process (the fibre in very many cases being a medullated fibre) can pass out of the cell in various directions along several processes or fibres, which, in the majority of cases if not always, are non-meduUated fibres. Thus these nerve cells are organs of dis- tribution for impulses of the same kind. What further modifica- tions of the impulses thus passing through them these ganglia may bring about, we do not know. It is only in some few instances that we have any indications, and those of a very doubtful character, that the ganglia of the splanchnic system can carry out either of the two great functions belonging to what is physiologically called a nerve centre, namely, the function of starting nervous impulses anew from within itself, the function of an automatic centre so-called, and the function of being so affected by the advent of afferent impulses as to send forth in response efferent impulses, of converting, as it were, afferent into efferent impulses, the function of a rejiex centre so-called. It is the central nervous system, the brain with the spinal cord, which supplies the nervous centres for automatic actions and for reflex actions ; indeed, all the processes taking place in the central nervous system (at least all such as come within tlie province of physiology) fall into or may be considered as forming part of one or the other of these two categories. 182 EEFLEX ACTIONS. [Book i. § 101. Befiex actions. In a reflex action afferent impulses reaching the nervous centre give rise to the discharge of efferent impulses, the discharge following so rapidly and in such a way as to leave no doubt that it is caused by the advent at the centre of the afferent impulses. Thus a frog, from which the brain has been removed while the rest of the body has been left intact, will frequently remain quite motionless (as far at least as the skeletal muscles are concerned) for an almost indefinite time ; but if its skin be pricked, or if in other ways afferent impulses be generated in afferent fibres by adequate stimulation, movements of the limbs or body will immediately follow. Obviously in this instance the stimulation of afferent fibres has been the cause of the discharge of impulses along efferent fibres. The machinery involved in such a reflex act consists of three parts : (1) the afferent fibres, (2) the nerve centre, in this case the spinal cord, and (3) the efferent fibres. If any one of these three parts be missing, the reflex act cannot take place ; if, for instance, the afferent nerves or the efferent nerves be cut across in their course, or if the centre, the spinal cord, be destroyed, the reflex action cannot take place. Eeflex actions can be carried out by means of the brain, as we shall see while studying that organ in detail, but the best and clearest examples of reflex action are manifested by the spinal cord ; in fact, reflex action is one of the most important functions of the spinal cord. We shall have to study the various reflex actions of the spinal cord in detail hereafter, but it will be desirable to point out here some of their general features. When we stimulate the nerve of a muscle-nerve preparation the result, though modified in part by the condition of the muscle and nerve, whether fresh and irritable or exhausted, for instance, is directly dependent on the nature and strength of the stimulus. If we use a single induction-shock we get a simple contraction, if the interrupted current we get a tetanus, if we use a weak shock we get a slight contraction, if a strong shock a large contraction, and so on ; and throughout our study of muscular contractions we assumed that the amount of contraction might be taken as a measure of the magnitude of the nervous impulses generated by the stimulus. And it need hardly be said that when we stimulate certain fibres only of a motor nerve, it is only the muscular fibres in which those nerve fibres end, which are thrown into con- traction. In a reflex action, on the other hand, the movements called forth by the same stimulus may be in one case insignificant, and in another violent and excessive, the result depending on the arrange- ments and condition of the central portion of the reflex mechanism. Thus the mere contact of a hair with the mucous membrane lining the larynx, a contact which can originate only the very slightest afferent impulses, may call forth a convulsive fit of coughing, in which a very large number of muscles are thrown into violent con- Chap, hi.] FEATURES OF NERVOUS TISSUES. 183 tractions ; whereas the same contact of the hair with other surfaces of the body may produce no obvious effect at all. Similarly, while in the brainless but otherwise normal frog, a slight touch on the skin of the flank will produce nothing but a faint flicker of the under- lying muscles ; the same touch on the same part of a frog poisoned with strychnia will produce violent lasting tetanic contractions of nearly all the muscles of the body. Motor impulses, as we have seen, travel along motor nerves without any great expenditure of energy, and probably without increasing that expenditure as they proceed ; and the same is apparently the case with afferent impulses passing along afferent nerves. When, however, in a reflex action afferent impulses reach the nerve centre, a change in the nature and magnitude of the impulses takes place. It is not that in the nerve centre the afferent impulses are simply turned aside or reflected into efferent impulses ; and hence the term " reflex " action is a bad one. It is rather that the afferent impulses act afresh, as it were, as a stimulus to the nerve centre, producing according to circumstances and conditions either a few weak efferent impulses or a multitude of strong ones. The nerve centre may be regarded as a collection of explosive charges ready to be discharged and so to start efferent impulses along certain efferent nerves, and these charges are so arranged and so related to certain afferent nerves, that afferent impulses reaching the centre along those nerves may in one case discharge a few only of the charges and so give rise to feeble movements, and in another case discharge a very large number and so give rise to large and violent movements. In a reflex action, then, the number, intensity, character and distribution of the effe- rent impulses, and so the kind and amount of movement, will depend chiefly on what takes place in the centre, and this will in turn depend on the one hand on the condition of the centre, and, on the other, on the special relations of the centre to the afferent impulses. At the same time we are able to recognise in most reflex actions a certain relation between the strength of the stimulus, that is to say, the magnitude of the afferent impulses and the extent of the movement, that is to say the magnitude of the efferent impulses. The nerve centre remaining in the same condition, the stronger or more numerous afferent impulses will give rise to the more forcible or more comprehensive movements. Thus, if a flank of a brainless frog be very lightly touched, the only reflex move- ment which is visible is a slight twitching of the muscles lying immediately underneath the spot of skin stimulated. If the stimulus be increased, the movements will spread to the hind-leg of the same side, which frequently will execute a movement calculated to push or wipe away the stimulus. By foreilily pinching the same spot of skin, or otherwise increasing the stimulus, the resulting movements may be led to embrace the fore-leg of the same side, then the opposite side, and, finally, 184 EEFLEX ACTIONS. [Book i. almost all the muscles of the body. In other words, the dis- turbance set going in the centre, confined when the stimulus is slight to a small part of the centre, overflows, so to speak, when the stimulus is increased, to other parts of the centre, and thus throws impulses into a larger and larger number of efferent nerves. We may add, without going more fully into the subject here, that in most reflex actions a special relation may be observed between the part stimulated and the resulting movement. In the simplest cases of reflex action, this relation is merely of such a kind that the muscles thrown into action are those governed by a motor nerve which is the fellow of the sensory nerve, the stimula- tion of which calls forth the movement. In the more complex reflex actions of the brainless frog, and in other cases, the relation is of such a kind that the resulting movement bears an adaptation to the stimulus : the foot is withdrawn from the stimulus, or the movement is calculated to push or wipe away the stimulus. In other words, a certain purpose is evident in the reflex action. Thus in all cases, except perhaps the very simplest, the move- ments called forth by a reflex action are exceedingly complex compared with those which result from the direct stimulation of a motor trunk. When the peripheral stump of a divided sciatic nerve is stimulated with the interrupted current, the muscles of the leg are at once thrown into tetanus, continue in the same rigid condition during the passage of the current, and relax immediately on the current being shut off. When the same current is applied, for a second only, to the skin of the flank of a brainless frog, the leg is drawn up and the foot rapidly swept over the spot irritated, as if to wipe away the irritation ; but this movement is a complex one, requiring the contraction of particular muscles in a definite sequence, with a carefully adjusted proportion between the amounts of contraction of the individual muscles. And this complex move- ment, this balanced and arranged series of contractions, may be repeated more than once as the result of a single stimulation of the skin. When a deep breath is caused by a dash of cold water, the same co-ordinated and carefully arranged series of contractions is also seen to result, as part of a reflex action, from a simple stimulus. And many more examples might be given. In such cases as these the complexity may be in part due to the fact that the stimulus is applied to terminal sensory organs, and not directly to a nerve trunk. As we shall see in speaking of the senses, the impulses which are generated by the application of a stimulus to a sensory organ are more complex than those which result from the direct artificial stimulation of a sensory nerve trunk. Nevertheless, reflex actions of great if not of equal com- plexity may be induced by stimuli applied directly to a nerve trunk. We are, therefore, obliged to conclude that in a reflex action, the processes which are originated in the centre by the arrival of even simple impulses along afferent nerves may be Chap, hi.] FEATUKES OF NERVOUS TISSUES. 185 highly complex ; and that it is the constitution and condition of the centre which determines the complexity and character of the movements which are effected. In other words, a centre concerned in a reflex action is to be regarded as constituting a sort of molecular machinery, the character of the resulting movements being determined by the nature of the machinery set going and its condition at the time being, the character and amount of the afferent impulses determining exactly what parts of and how far the central machinery is thrown into action. Throughout the above we have purposely used the word centre, avoiding the mention of nerve cells. But undoubtedly the part of the spinal cord acting as centres of reflex action is situated in the grey matter, which grey matter is characterised by the presence of nerve cells ; undoubtedly, also, the efferent fibres are connected with the afferent fibres by means of cells, certainly by the cells of the anterior cornu described in § 99, and probably also by other cells in the posterior cornu or elsewhere. So that a reflex action is carried on undoubtedly through cells. But it does not follow that a cellular mechanism is essential, in the sense, at all events, that the nuclei of the cells have anything to do with the matter, or even that the most important of the molecular processes constituting the changes taking place in a centre during a reflex action are carried out only by the cell-substance immediately surrounding the nuclei. The power of carrying out a reflex action is probably contingent on the nature and arrangement of axis- cylinders, and of the branching material by which, in a nerve centre, the afferent and efferent axis-cylinders are joined together, the nuclei intervening only so far as they have to do with the growth and repair of the nervous material. § 102. Automatic actions. Efferent impulses frequently issue from the brain and spinal cord, and so give rise to movements without being obviously preceded by any stimulation. Such move- ments are spoken of as automatic or spontaneous. The efferent impulses in such cases are started by changes in the nerve centre which are not the immediate result of the arrival at the nerve centre of afferent impulses from without, but which appear to arise in the nerve centre itself. Changes of this kind may recur rhythmically ; thus, as we shall see, we have reason to think that in a certain part of the central nervous system called the spinal bulb, or medulla oblongata, changes of the nervous material, re- curring rhythmically, lead to the rhythmic discharge along certain nerves of efferent impulses whereby muscles connected with the chest are rhythmically thrown into action and a rhythmically repeated breathing is brouglit about. And other similar rhythmic automatic movements may be carried out by various parts of the spinal cord. From the brain itself a much more varied and apparently irregular discharge of efferent impulses, not the obvious result of 186 INHIBITORY NERVE. [Book i. any immediately foregoing afferent impulses, and therefore not forming part of reflex actions, is very common, constituting what we speak of as volition, efferent impulses thus arising being called volitional or voluntary impulses. The spinal cord, apart from the brain, does not appear capable of executing these voluntary move- ments ; but to this subject we shall return when we come to speak of the central nervous system in detail. We said just now that there is no satisfactory evidence that the ganglia of the splanchnic system ever act as centres of reflex action. The evidence, however, that these ganglia may serve as centres of rhythmic automatic action seems at first sight of some strength. Several organs of the body containing muscular tissue, the most notable being the heart, are during life engaged in rhythmic automatic movements, and in many cases continue these movements after removal from the body. In nearly all these cases ganglia are present in connection with the muscular tissue ; and the presence and intact condition of these ganglia seem at all events in many cases in some way essential to the due performance of the rhythmic automatic movements. Indeed it has been thought that the movements in question are really due to the rhythmic automatic generation in the cells of these ganglia of efferent impulses, which, passing down to the appropriate muscular fibres, call forth the rhythmic movement. When we come to study these movements in detail, we shall find reasons for coming to the conclusion that this view is not supported by adequate evidence ; and, indeed, though it is perhaps immature to make a dogmatic statement, all the evidence goes, as we have already said, to shew that the great use of the ganglia of the splanchnic system, like that of the spinal ganglia, is connected with the nutrition of the nerves, and that these structures do not like the central nervous system act as centres either automatic or reflex. § 103. Inhibitory nerves. We have said that the fibres of the anterior root should be called efferent rather than motor, because, though they all carry impulses outward from the central nervous system to the tissues, the impulses which they carry do not in all cases lead to the contraction of muscular fibres. Some of these efferent fibres are distributed to glandular structures, for instance, to the salivary glands, and impulses passing along these lead to changes in epithelial cells and their surroundings whereby, without any muscular contraction necessarily intervening, secretion is brought about : the action of these fibres of secretion we shall study in connection with digestion. Besides this, there are efferent fibres going to muscular tissue, or, at all events, to muscular organs, the impulses passing along which, so far from bringing about muscular contraction, diminish, hinder, or stop movements already in progress. Thus if when the heart is beating regularly, that is to say, when the muscular fibres Chap, in.] FEATURES OF NERVOUS TISSUES. 187 which make up tlie greater part of the heart are rhythmically contracting, the branches of the pneumogastric nerve going to the heart be adequately stimulated, for instance with the interrupted current, the heart will stop beating ; and that not because the muscles of the heart are thrown into a continued tetanus, the rhythmic alternation of contraction and relaxation being rejjlaced by sustained contraction, but because contraction disappears alto- gether, all the muscular fibres of the heart remaining for a considerable time in complete relaxation, and the whole heart being quite flaccid. If a weaker stimulus be employed, the beat may not be actually stopped but slowed or weakened. And, as we shall see, there are many other cases where the stimulation of efferent fibres hinders, weakens, or altogether stops a movement already in progress. Such an effect is called an inhibition, and the fibres, stimulation of which produces the effect, are called ' inhibitory ' fibres. The phenomena of inhibition are not, however, confined to such cases as the heart, where the efferent nerves are connected with muscular tissues. Thus the activity of a secreting gland may be inhibited, as, for instance, when emotion stops the secretion of saliva, and the mouth becomes dry from fear. In this instance, however, it is probable that inhibition is brought about not by inhibitory impulses passing to the gland, and arresting secretion in the gland itself, but rather by an arrest, in the central nervous system, of the nervous impulses which, normally, passing down to the gland, excite it as we shall see to action. And, indeed, as we shall see later on, there are many illustrations of the fact that afferent impulses reaching a nervous centre, instead of stimulating it to activity, may stop or inhibit an activity previously going on. In fact it is probable, though not actually proved in every case, that wherever in any tissue energy is being set free, nervous impulses brought to bear on the tissue may affect the rate or amount of the energy set free in two different ways ; on the one hand, they may increase or quicken the setting free of energy, and on the other hand they may slacken, hinder, or inhibit the setting free of energy. And in, at all events, a large number of cases, it is possible to produce the one effect by means of one set of nerve fibres, and the other effect by another set of nerve fibres. We shall have occasion, however, to study the several instances of this double action in the appropriate places. It is sufficient for us at the present to recognize that a nervous impulse passing along a nerve fibre need not always set free energy when it reaches its goal, it may hinder or stop the setting free of energy, and is then called an inhibitory impulse. CHAPTER ly. THE VASCULAE MECHANISM. SEC. 1. THE STRUCTUEE AND MAIN FEATUEES OF THE VASCULAE APPAEATUS. § 104. The blood, as we have said, is the internal medium on which the tissues live ; from it these draw their food and oxygen, to it they give up the products or waste matters which they form. The tissues, with some few exceptions, are traversed by, and thus the elements of the tissues surrounded by, networks of minute, thin- walled tubes, the capillary hlood vessels. The elementary striated muscle fibre, for instance, is surrounded by capillaries, running in the connective tissue outside but close to the sarcolemma, arranged in a network with more or less rectangular meshes. These capil- laries are closed tubes with continuous walls, and the blood, which, as we shall see, is continually streaming through them, is as a whole confined to their channels, and does not escape from them. The elements of the tissues lie outside the capillaries, and form extra-vascular islets of different form and size in the different tissues, surrounded by capillary networks. But the walls of the capillaries are so thin and of such a nature that certain of the constituents of the blood pass from the interior of the capillary through the capillary wall to the elements of the tissue outside the capillary, and, similarly, certain of the constituents of the tissue, to wit, certain substances, the result of the metabolism continually going on in the tissue, pass from the tissue outside the capillary through the capillary wall into the blood flowing through the capillary. Thus, as we have already said, § 13, there Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 189 is a continual interchange of material between the blood in the capillary, and the elements of the tissue outside the capillary, the lymph acting as middle man. By this interchange the tissue lives on the blood, and the blood is affected by its passage through the tissue. In the small arteries which end in, and in the small veins which begin in the capillaries, a similar interchange takes place ; but the amount of interchange diminishes as, passing in each direction from the capillaries, the walls of the arteries and veins become thicker ; and, indeed, in all but the minute veins and arteries, the interchange is so small that it may practically be neglected. It is in the capillaries (and minute arteries and veins) that the business of the blood is done ; it is in these that the interchange takes place ; and the object of the vascular mechanism is to cause the blood to flow through these in a manner best adapted for carrying on this interchange under varying circumstances. The use of the arteries is, in the main, simply to carry the blood in a suitable manner from the heart to the capillaries ; the use of the veins is, in the main, simply to carry the blood from the capillaries back to the heart ; and the use of the heart is, in the main, simply to drive the blood in a suitable manner through the arteries into the capillaries, and from the capillaries back along the veins to itself again. The structure of these several parts is adapted to these several uses. The structure of arteries, capillaries and veins. § 105. On some features of connective tissue. The heart and blood vessels are, broadly speaking, made up partly of muscular tissue with its appropriate nervous elements, and partly of certain varieties of the tissue known as connective tissue. We shall have to speak of some of the features of connective tissue of phy- siological importance when we come to deal with the lymphatic system, for this system is intimately associated with connective tissue. But an association only less close exists between the blood vessels and connective tissue ; for connective tissue not only enters largely, in one or other of its forms, into the structure of the blood vessels, but also forms a sort of bed, both for the larger vessels on their way to and from the several tissues and organs and for the smaller vessels, including the capillaries, within each tissue and organ ; indeed, a capillary may be regarded as a minute tubular passage, hollowed out in the connective tissue which binds together the elements of a tissue. It will be desirable, therefore, to point out at once a few of the characters of connective tissue. The connective tissue of the adult body is derived from certain mesoblastic cells of the embryo, and consists essentially of certain cells, which do not lie in close contact with each other as do the cells of epithelium, but are separated by more or less intercellular material, which may in certain cases be fluid or semi-fluid, but 190 CONNECTIVE TISSUES. [Book i. which is generally solid, and is commonly spoken of as matrix. In most forms of connective tissue, the matrix is relatively so abund- ant and prominent, that the cells or connective tissue corpuscles as they are called, become inconspicuous ; and, speaking generally, the value of connective tissue to the body depends much more on the qualities of the matrix than on the activity of the connective tissue corpuscles. The kind of connective tissue, sometimes called ' loose connec- tive tissue,' which wraps round and forms a bed for the blood vessels, consists of an irregular meshwork formed by interlacing bundles of various sizes, which leave between them spaces of very variable form and size, some being mere chinks or clefts, others being larger, but generally flattened passages, all containing lymph, and having, as we shall see, special connections with the lymphatic vessels. The larger spaces are sometimes called ' areolae,' and this kind of connective tissue is sometimes spoken of as ' areolar tissue.' When a small portion of this tissue is teased out carefully under the microscope, the larger bundles may be separated into finer bundles, and each bundle, which generally pursues a wavy course, has a fibrillated appearance, as if made up of exceedingly fine fibrillae ; treated with lime water or baryta water, the bundles do actually split up into fine, wavy fibrillse of less than 1 yu, in diameter, a substance of a peculiar nature which previously cemented the fibrillse together being dissolved out from between them. When a mass of such fibrillte is boiled with water, they become converted into gelatine, a substance containing, like proteid material, carbon, nitrogen, hydrogen and oxygen, with a small quantity of sulphur, but differing from proteid material both in its percentage compo- sition and in its properties. A remarkable and well-known feature of gelatine is that its solutions while fluid at a temperature of boiling water or somewhat less, become solid or a ' jelly ' at lower temperatures. The untouched fibrillse, in their natural condition, behave, as we shall see in speaking of the digestion of connective tissue, somewhat differently from prepared gelatine ; the natural fibrilla, therefore, does not consist of gelatine, but of a substance which by boiling is readily converted into gelatine. The sub- stance soluble in lime or baryta water, which cements a number of fibrillar into a bundle, appears to be allied to a body, of which we shall speak later on, called mucin. Since the fibrillse form by far the greater part of the matrix of connective tissue, a quantity of this tissue when boiled seems almost entirely converted into gelatine. In connective tissue, then, a number of exceedingly fine, gelati- niferous fibrillse are cemented together into a fine, microscopic bundle, and a number of these finer bundles may be similarly cemented together, or simply apposed together to form larger bundles ; some of the bundles at least appear, moreover, to be defined by a delicate, transparent sheath of a somewhat peculiar nature. Chap. IV.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 191 A number c\ c'[ cL\ , 'Eld. 37. Tracing from Heart of Cat, obtained by placing a light lever ON THE VENTRICLE, THE CHEST HAVING BEEN OPENED.' ThE TUNING-FORK CURVE MARKS 50 VIBRATIONS PER SEC. interpretation of the curve be correct, it is obvious that the front-to-back diameter is greater during the whole of the systole than it is during diastole, since the lever is raised up all this time. It may, however, be argued that the heart thus exposed is subject to abnormal conditions and is, in diastole, somewhat flattened by the weight of its contents, that this flattening is increased by even slight pressure, and that therefore the above conclusion is not 1 The vertical or rather curved lines (segments of circles) introduced into this and many other curves are of use for the purpose of measuring parts of the curve. A complete curve should exhibit an 'abscissa' line. This may be drawn by allowino- the lever, arranged for the experiment but remaining at rest, to mark with its point on the recording surface set in motion ; a straight line, the abscissa line, is thus described, and may be drawn before or after the curve itself is made, and may be placed above or, preferably, below the curve. When a tuning-fork or other time marker is used, the line of the time marker or a line drawn through the curves of the tuning-fork will serve as an abscissa line. After a tracing has been made, the recording surface should be brought back to such a position that the point of the lever coincides with some point of the curve which it is desired to mark; if the lever be then gently moved up and down, the point of the lever will describe a segment of a circle (the centre of which lies at the axis of the lever), which segment should be made l^ng enough to cut both the curve and the abscissa line' (the tuning-fork curves or other time-marking line) where this is drawn. By moving the recording surface backwards and forwards, similar seg- ments of circles may be drawn through other points of the curve. The lines a, b, c in Fig 37 were thus drawn. The distance between any two of these points may thus be measured on the tuning-fork curve or other time curve, or on the abscissa line. Similar lines mav be drawn on the tracing after its removal from the recording instrument in the following wav, Take a pair of compasses, the two pomts of which are fixed just as far apart as the length of the lever used in the experiment, measured from its axis to its writing point. Bv means of the compasses find the position on the tracing of the centre of the circle of which any one of the previously drawn curved lines forms a segment. Through this centre draw a line parallel to the abscissa. By keeping one point of the compass on this line but moving it along the line backwards or forwards, a segment of a circle may be drawn so as to cut anv point of the curve that mav be desired, and also the abscissa hne or the time line. Such a segment of a circle may be used for the same purposes as the original one and any number of such segments may be drawn. Chap. IV.] THE VASCULAE MECHANISM. 237 valid. And, indeed, it is maintained by some that the front-to- back diameter does actually diminish during systole. But it is at least clear that the front-to-back diameter, even if it does not increase, diminishes far less than does the side-to-side diameter; and hence during the systole there is a change in the form of the section of the base of the ventricles. During the diastole this has somewhat the form of an ellipse with the long axis from side to side, but with the front part of the ellipse much more convex than the back, since the back surface of the ventricles is somewhat flattened. During the systole this ellipse is converted into a figure much more nearly resembling a circle. It is urged, moreover, that the whole of the base is constricted, and that the greater efficiency of the auriculo-ventricular valves is thereby secured. As to the behaviour of the long diameter from base to apex, observers are not agreed ; some maintain that it is shortened, and others that it is practically unchanged. And, in any case, a change in this diameter plays little or no part in the expulsion of the contents of the ventricle ; this expulsion is effected by the contrac- tion of the more transversely disposed fibres, whereby the cavity is reduced to an elongated slit. Moreover, if any shortening does take place it must be compensated by the elongation of the great vessels, which, as stated above, may be seen in an inspection of the beating heart. For there is evidence that the apex, though, as we have seen, it is somewhat twisted round during the systole, and at the same time brought closer to the chest-wall, does not change its position up or down, i.e. in the long axis of the body. If in a rabbit or dog a needle be thrust through the chest-wall so that its point plunges into the apex of the heart, though the needle quivers, its head moves neither up nor down, as it would do if its point in the apex moved down or up. During systole, broadly speaking, the ventricles undergo a diminution of total volume, equal to the volume of contents discharged into the great vessels (for the walls themselves like all muscular structures retain their volume during contraction save for changes which may take place in the quantity of blood contained in their blood vessels, or of lymph in the intermuscular spaces), while they undergo a change of form which may be described as that from a roughly hemispherical figure with an irregularly elliptical section to a more regular cone with a more nearly circular base. § 129. Cardiac Impulse. If the hand be placed on the chest, a shock or impulse will be felt at each beat, and on examination this impulse, ' cardiac impulse,' will be found to be synchronous with the systole of the ventricle. In man, the cardiac impulse may be most distinctly felt in tlie fifth costal interspace, about an inch below and a little to the median side of the left nipple. In an animal the same impulse may also be felt in another way, viz. 238 THE CAEDIAC IMPULSE. [Book i. by making an incision through the diaphragm from the abdo- men, and placing the finger between the chest-wall and the apex. It then can be distinctly recognized as the result of the hardening of the ventricle during the systole. And the impulse which is felt on the outside of the chest is chiefly the effect of the same hardening of the stationary portion of the ventricle in contact with the chest-wall, transmitted through the chest- wall to the finger. In its flaccid state, during diastole, the apex is (in a standing position at least) at this point in contact with the chest-wall, lying, somewhat flattened, between it and the tolerably resistant diaphragm. During the systole, while being brought even closer to the chest-wall, by the tilting of the ventricle and by the movement to the front and to the right of which we have already spoken, it suddenly grows tense and hard, and becomes rounder. The ventricles, in executing their systole, have to contract against resistance. They have to produce within their cavities, pressures greater than those in the aorta and pulmonary arteries, respectively. This is, in fact, the object of the systole. Hence, during the swift systole, the ventricular portion of the heart becomes suddenly tense, somewhat in the same way as a bladder full of fluid would become tense and hard when forcibly squeezed. The sudden pressure exerted by the ventricle thus rendered sud- denly tense and hard, aided by the closer contact of the apex with the chest-wall (which, however, by itself, without the hardening of contraction, would be insufficient to produce the effect), gives an impulse or shock both to the chest-wall and to the diaphragm. If the modification of the sphygmograph (an instrument of which we shall speak later on, in dealing with the pulse), called the cardio- graph, be placed on the spot where the impulse is felt most strongly, the lever is seen to be raised during the systole of the ventricles, and to fall again as the systole passes away, very much as if it were placed on the heart directly. A tracing may thus be obtained, see Fig. 47, of which we shall have to speak more fully later on, see § 133. If the button of the lever be placed, not on the exact spot of the impulse, but at a little distance from it, the lever will be depressed during the systole. While at the spot of impulse itself the contact of the ventricle is increased during systole, away from the spot the ventricle (owing to its change of form and subsequently to its diminution in volume) retires from the chest-wall, and hence, by the mediastinal attachments of the pericardium, draws the chest-wall after it. § 130. The, Sounds of the Heart. When the ear is applied to the chest, either directly or by means of a stethoscope, two sounds are heard, — the first a comparatively long, dull, booming sound, the second a short, sharp, sudden one. Between the first and second sounds the interval of time is very short, too short to be easily measured, but between the second and the succeeding first sound there is a distinct pause. The sounds have been likened Chap, ivj THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 239 to the pronunciation of the syllables lubb diip, so that the cardiac cycle, as far as the sounds are concerned, might be represented by : ■ — lubb, dup, pause. The second sound, which is short and sharp, presents no diffi- culties. It is coincident in point of time with the closure of the semilunar valves, and is heard to the best advantage over the second right costal cartilage, close to its junction with the sternum, i. e. at the point where the aortic arch comes nearest to the surface, and to which sounds generated at the aortic orifice would be best conducted. Its characters are such as would belong to a sound generated by membranes like the semilunar valves being suddenly made tense, and so thrown into vibrations. It is obscured and altered, or replaced by ' a murmur,' when the semilunar valves are affected by disease, and may be artificially obliterated, a murmur taking its place, by passing a wire down the arteries, and hooking up the aortic valves. There can be no doubt, in fact, that the second sound is due to the semilunar valves being thrown into vibrations at their sudden closure. The sound heard at the second right costal cartilage is chiefly that generated by the aortic valves, and murmurs or other alterations in the sound caused by changes in the aortic valves are heard most clearly at this spot. Eut even here the sound is not exclusively of aortic origin, for in certain cases, in which the semilunar valves on the two sides of the heart are not wholly synchronous in action, the sound heard here is double (" reduplicated second sound " ), one being due to the aorta, and one to the pulmonary artery. When the sound is listened to on the left side of the sternum at the same level, the pulmonary artery is supposed to have the chief share in producing what is heard, and changes in the sound heard more clearly here than on the right side are taken as indications of mischief in the pulmonary valves. The first sound, longer, duller, and of a more ' booming ' character than the second, heard with greatest distinctness at the spot where the cardiac impulse is felt, presents many difficulties in the way of a complete explanation. It is heard distinctly when the chest-walls are removed. The cardiac impulse, therefore, can have little or nothing to do with it. In point of time, it is coincident with the systole of the ventricles, and may be heard to the greatest advantage at the spot of the cardiac impulse ; that is to say, at the place where the ventricles come nearest to the surface, and to which sounds generated in the ventricles would be best conducted. It is more closely coincident with the closure and consequent vibrations of the auriculo-ventricular valves than with the entire systole; for on the one hand it dies away before the second sound begins, whereas, as we shall see, the actual systole lasts at least up to the closure of the semilunar valves, and on the other hand the auriculo-ventricular valves cease to be tense 240 THE SOUNDS OF THE HEART. [Book i. and to vibrate so soon as the contents of the ventricle are driven out. This suggests that the sound is caused by the sudden tension of the auriculo-ventricular valves, and this view is sup- ported by the facts that the sound is obscured, altered or replaced by murmurs when the tricuspid or mitral valves are diseased, and that the sound is also altered or, according to some observers, wholly done away with when blood is prevented from entering the ventricles by ligature of the vense cavse. On the other hand, the sound has not that sharp character which one would expect in a sound generated by the vibration of membranes such as the valves in question, but in its booming qualities rather suggests a muscular sound. Further, according to some observers, the sound, though somewhat modified, may still be heard when the large veins are clamped so that no blood enters the ventricle, and, indeed, may be recognized in the few beats given by a mammalian ventricle rapidly cut out of the living body by an incision carried below the auriculo-ventricular ring. Hence the view has been adopted that this first sound is a muscular sound. In discussing the muscular sound of skeletal muscle (see § 80), we saw reasons to distrust the view that this sound is generated by the repeated, individual, simple contrac- tions which make up the tetanus, and hence corresponds in tone to the number of those simple contractions repeated in a second, and to adopt the view that the sound is really due to a repetition of unequal tensions occurring in a muscle during the contraction. Now, the ventricular systole is undoubtedly a simple contraction, a prolonged simple contraction, not a tetanus, and, therefore, under the old view of the nature of a muscular sound, could not produce such a sound ,- but accepting the other view, and reflecting how complex must be the course of the systolic wave of contraction over the twisted fibres of the ventricle, we shall not find great difficulty in supposing that that wave is capable in its progress of producing such repetitions of unequal tensions as might give rise to a ' muscular sound,' and, consequently, in regarding the first sound as mainly so caused. Accepting such a view of the origin of the sound we should expect to find the tension of the muscular fibres, and so the nature of sound, dependent on the quantity of fluid present in the ventricular cavities and hence modified by liga- ture of the great veins, and still more by the total removal of the auricles with the auriculo-ventricular valves. We may add that we should expect to find it modified by the escape of blood from the ventricles into the arteries during the systole itself, and might regard this as explaining why it dies away before the ventricle has ceased to contract. Moreover, seeing that the auriculo-ventricular valves must be thrown into sudden tension at the onset of the ventricular systole, which, as we have seen, is developed with considerable rapidity, not far removed at all events from the rapidity with which the Chap. iv.J THE VASCULAR MECHANISM, 241 semilunar valves are closed, a rapidity, therefore, capable of giving rise to vibrations of the valves adequate to produce a sound, it is difficult to escape the conclusion that the closure of these valves must also generate a sound, which in a normally beating heart is mingled with the sound of muscular origin. If we accept this view that the sound is of double origin, partly ' muscular,' partly ' valvular,' both causes being dependent on the tension of the ventricular cavities, we can perhaps more easily understand how it is that the normal first sound is at times so largely, indeed, we may say so completely altered and obscured in diseases of the auriculo-ventricular valves, and how it may also be modified in character by changes, such as hypertrophy, of the muscular walls. Since the left ventricle forms the entire left apex of the heart, the murmurs or other changes of the first sound heard most distinctly at the spot of cardiac impulse belong to the mitral valve of the left ventricle. Murmurs generated in the tricuspid valve of the right ventricle are heard more distinctly in the median line below the end of the sternum. § 131. Endo cardiac Pressure. Since it is the pressure exerted upon the contents of the ventricle by the contraction of the ventricular walls which drives the blood from the heart into the aorta, and so maintains the circulation, the study of this pressure, endocardiac pressure, is of great importance. The mercurial manometer, so useful in a general way in the study of arterial pressure, is unsuited for the study of endocardiac pressure, since the great inertia of the mercury prevents the instrument respond- ing properly to the exceedingly rapid changes of pressure which take place in the heart. We are obliged to have recourse to other instruments. One method, having been used by Chauveau and Marey in researches which have become ' classic,' deserves to be noticed, though it is not now employed. It consists in introducing, in a large animal, such as a horse, through a blood vessel into a cavity of the heart, a tube ending in an elastic bag. Fig. 38 A, both tube and bag being filled with air, and the tube being connected with a recording ' tambour.' A tube of appropriate curvature, A. b. Fig. 38, is furnished at its end with an elastic bag or ' ampulla ' a. When it is desired to explore simultaneously both auricle and ventricle, the sound is furnished with two ampullffi, with two small, elastic bags, one at the extreme end and the other at such a distance that when the former is within the cavity of the ventricle the latter is within the cavity of the auricle. Such an instrument is spoken of as a ' cardiac sound.' Each ' ampulla ' com- municates by a separate, air-tight tube with an air-tight tambour (Fig. 38 B) on which a lever rests, so that any pressure on the ampulla is communicated to the cavity of its respective tambour, the lever of 16 242 ENDOCAEDIAC PRESSUEE. [Book i. which is raised in proportion When two ampullce are used, the writing points of both levers are brought to bear on the same re- cording surface exactly underneath each other. The tube is carefully introduced through the right jugular vein into the right side of the heart until the lower (ventricular) ampulla is fairly in the cavity of the right ventricle, and, consequently, the upper (auricular) ampulla in the cavity of the right auricle. Changes of pressure on either ampulla, then, cause movements of the corresponding lever. When the pressure, for instance, on the ampulla in the auricle is increased, the auricular lever is raised and describes on the recording surface an Fig. 38, Marey's Tambouk, with Cardiac Sound. A. A simple cardiac sound such as may be used for exploration of the left ventricle. The portion a of the ampulla at the end is of thin india rubber, stretched over an open framework with metallic supports above and below. The long tube 6 serves to introduce it into the cavity which it is desired to explore. B. The Tambour. The metal chamber m is covered in an air-tight manner with the india rubber c, bearing a thin, metal plate m', to which is attached the lever /, moving on the hinge h. The whole tambour can be placed by means of the clamp cl Sit any height on the upright s'. The india rubber tube t serves to connect the interior of the tambour either with the cavity of the ampulla of A or with any other cavity. Supposing that the tube t were connected with b, any pressure exerted on a would cause the roof of the tambour to rise and the point of the lever would be proportionately raised. ascending curve ; when the pressure is taken off, the curve descends, — and so also with the ventricle. The ' sound ' may in a similar manner be introduced through the carotid artery into the left ventricle, being slipped past the aortic valves, and thus the changes taking place in that chamber also may be explored. CiiAr. J V.J THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 243 When this instrument is applied to the right auricle and ventricle some such record is obtained as that shewn in Fig. 39, where the upper curve is a tracing taken from the right auricle, and the lower curve from the rioht ventricle of the horse, both curves being taken simultaneously on the same recording surface. In these curves the rise of the lever indicates pressure exerted upon the corresponding ampulla, and the upper curve, from the right auricle, shews the sudden, brief pressure b exerted by the sudden and brief auricular systole. The lower curve, from the right ventricle, shews that the pressure exerted by the ventric- ular systole begins almost immediately after the auricular systole, increases very rapidly indeed, so that the lever rises in almost a straight line up to c', is continued for some considerable time, and then falls very rapidly to reach the base line. The figure, it must be understood, does not, by itself, 'give any information as to the relative amounts of pressure ■exerted by the auricle and ventricle respectively ; indeed, the movements of the auricular lever are much too great compared with those of the ventricular lever. The figure is chiefly useful for giving a graphic general view of the series of events within the cardiac cavi- ties during a cardiac cycle, the short auricular pressure, the long-continued ventricular pressure, lasting nearly half the whole period, and the subsequent pause when both parts are at rest or in ■diastole. Among the more trustworthy methods of recording the changes of endocardiac pressure, we may first mention that of Roy and Rolleston. Fig. 39. Simultaneous tracings FROM THE Right Auricle, and Ventricle, of the Horse. (After Chauveau and Marey.) By means of a short cannula introduced through a large vessel^ or •directly, as a trocar, through the walls of the ventricle (or auricle), the blood in the cavity is brought to bear on an easily moving piston. The movements of the piston are recorded by a lever, and the evils of inertia are met by making the piston and lever work against the torsion of a steel ribbon, the length of which, and consequently the resistance offered by which, and hence the excursions of the piston, can be varied at pleasure. We give as examples of curves obtained by this method two curves from the left ventricle, one (Fig. 40 A) of a rapidly beating, and the other (Fig. 40 B) of a slowly beating heart. 244 ENDOCARDIAC PRESSUEE. [Book i. Fig. 40. CuKVES of Endocaediac Pressure. From Left Ventricle of Dog. (Roy and RoUeston.) A. a quickly beating, B. a more slowly beating heart. An instrument which has been much used of late, and the use of which has given very valuable results is the " membrane-mano- meter" of Hlirthle. Fig. 41. The Membrane-manometer of Hurthle.^ 1 For this figure I am indebted to Mr. Albrecht, the University Instrument- maker at Tubingen. Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 245 This consists essentially of a very small metal drum or tambour (Fig. 42 a) somewhat like that of Marey, but hemispherical and not more than 15 mm. in diameter. In Fig. 41 the instrument, with its holder, is seen from above. The second lever, which is motionless, is for the purpose of de- scribing the base line. The screw-tap on the tube leading, in the figure, up to the tambour, is for the purpose of diminishing the calibre of the tube, and so of " damping " the instru- ment. On the right of the tambour in the figure are seen the arrangements for adjusting the levers. In Fig. 42 the tube b by which the catheter is connected with the tambour, is, for convenience of illustration, shewn as Fig. 42. Diagram to il- directed parallel to the lever, instead of, as i^^strate the essen- , • S. 4. -i. 1^ X • u^- 1 i -J- tial parts of Hur- m the instrument itself, at right angles to it. xhle's membrane ma- The roof of the tambour is supplied by a care- nometer. fully chosen, delicate, elastic membrane e, which bears at its centre a thin metal disc d, connected by a short upright e with a lever l. Below, the tambour ends in a tube b. A catheter, open at the end or with a lateral ' eye,' and filled with a solution of magnesium sulphate or with some fluid tending to check the clotting of blood, is introduced into the cavity of the heart which it is desired to explore. It may be introduced by the jugular vein into the right auricle, and past the auricle into the right venti'icle, or through the carotid artery into the aorta, and so, between the semilunar valves, or through one of the flaps (the perforation seems to introduce no error) into the cavity of the left ventricle ; or the end of the catheter may be left in the aorta above the semilunar valves when it is desired to investigate the pressure at the root of the aorta. The cavity of the tambour also is filled, not witli air, as in Marey's tambour, but with the same fluid as is the catheter, or with water; and the tube of the tambour is connected witli the catheter. Variations of pressure within the cavity of the heart are transmitted through the fluid of the catheter to the fluid in the tambour, and thus put into movement the elastic roof of the tambour ; the movements of the elastic roof are, in turn, transmitted to the lever, which records, in the usual manner, on some recording surface. For measuring the amount of the changes of pressure, the instrument must be graduated experi- mentally. There are many details in the instrument which need not be described liere ; but we may state that the instrument may be ' damped,' rendered less sensitive, and thus the features of the curves due to inertia lessened, by narrowing, through a screw-tap, the communication between the catheter and the cavity of the tambour. Tlie membrane of the tambour may, by means of an ivory button, be brouglit to bear on one end of a slip of steel, placed horizontally and fastened at the other end, so as to act as a spring. The instrument then becomes a " spring-manometer." The small movements of the spring caused by the movements of the membrane of the tambour are magnified by a recording lever. 246 ENDOCARDIAC PRESSURE. [Book i. Fig. 43 gives a curve of endocardiac pressure of the left ventricle of the dog obtained by this method. The recording surface is travelling quickly, and the movements, of the lever are not great. The manometer of Gad differs Fig. 43. Curve of Pressure from that of Hiirthle in the membrane IN THE Left Ventricle of being replaced by a thin, elastic disc THE Dog, Hurthle's Mem- c metal BRANE-MANOMETER. ■ . n Ti in the instrument oi Irey and Krehl, which is a modification of one by Tick, the transmission is effected partly by fluid and partly by an air tambour, the button of which presses against a horizontal steel spring. A catheter, filled with fluid to prevent clotting and introduced into- a cavity of the heart, is connected with a glass cylinder, maintained carefully in a vertical position, the lower half of which is tilled with the same fluid as is the catheter. The upper half of the cylinder, con- taining air only, is connected by a very narrow, in fact a capillary tube, with a small tambour. The changes of pressure within tl)e heart are transmitted through the fluid of the catheter to the air in the cylinder, and so to the air in the tambour, the membrane of which moves accordingly in aud out. A button on the membrane presses on % hori- zontal steel spring, and the small movements of the membrane thus transmitted to the spring are recorded by means of a magnifying lever. Other instruments have been employed by other observers. When we examine the curves which we have given (Figs. 39, 40, 43), obtained by three several methods, we find that they agree in the following main features. The curve of pressure in the ventricle, whether right or left, rises at the very beginning of the systole with very great rapidity, very soon reaches its maximum or nearly its maximum, maintains nearly the same height for some time, and then very rapidly descends to the base line (which in these figures indicates the pressure of the atmosphere) or even falls, for a brief space, slightly below it, and remains at or near the base line, until, at the next beat, it repeats the same changes. This means that the contraction of the ventricular walls in the systole acts in such a manner as very suddenly to raise up to a certain height the pressure within the ventricle, which during the diastole was at, or not far removed from that of the atmosphere, that the pressure is maintained without any very great change for a considerable time, and that it then falls back to its original level with great suddenness, almost, if not quite, as suddenly as it was. raised. These are the important features of the pressure within the ventricle ; in these features all the three curves agree. We may add that the same features are shewn also in curves of pres- Chap. iv.J THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 247 sure taken by other methods ; and, indeed, as shewn in Fig. 37 and in others which we shall give, corresponding features occur in curves of other changes in the heart. All these curves shew a flattening maintained, with smaller variations, during the con- tinuance of the systole ; this is so characteristic that it has been called the ' systolic plateau.' It is true that curves of ventri- cular pressure taken by certain methods, that of Frey and Krehl's for instance, do not shew this ' plateau,' the curve in such cases rising gradually to a maximum and immediately beginning to fall, so that the summit is a simple peak. And it is argued that such a curve is the true curve of ventricular pressure always obtained so long as the blood in the ventricle has free access to the interior of the catheter, and that the plateau is only seen when the end of the catheter is too near the apex, and its opening closed, at the height of the systole, by the ventricular walls coming together ; the top of the true curve is thus, as it were, cut off. But the evidence is, on the whole, opposed to this view, and we shall accept the plateau as being a true representation. Though the curves given above agree in these main features, they differ in many minor features, and other features also of minor value appear in curves of endocardiac pressure according to the various circumstances in* which the heart finds itself. Some of these minor features we shall presently find useful in discussing the mechanism of the beat. § 132. The output. Since the use of the pressure exerted by the ventricle is to drive a quantity of blood out of the ventricle into the aorta (or pulmonary artery) it is important to study the 'output' or quantity of blood so driven out; and since, under normal circumstances, the quantity ejected by the right ventricle is the same as that ejected by the left ventricle, we may confine our attention to the latter. The normal or average output has been calculated in various ways, by help of certain assumptions ; but these we may put on one side since the matter has now been made the subject of direct experimental determination. Methods. Method of Stolnikow. This consists in allowing the blood to flow from the carotid into a vessel until a certain measured quantity has escaped, and then returning this blood to tlie right auricle while the blood from the carotid is flowing into a second similar vessel to be similarly returned, and in repeating this manoeuvre a certain number of times. One canjtid is tied (the animal being a dog), and the arch of the aorta plugged beyond (Fig. 44 ^;). The circulation is thus confined to the lungs and the coronary system. Into the other carotid is tied a tube connected by a forked branching la and 2« with two vessels I. and II., which also communicate by a similar forked branching Iv and 1v with tlie right auricle. The blood is allowed to flow through la into I. until a certain quantity has escaped. Then la is closed, while 2a and \v are opened. The blood 248 THE OUTPUT OF THE HEART. [Book i. from I. flows back by Iw to the right auricle, while the blood from the carotid flows into H. by 2ffl. When a certain quantity has escaped into n., the action is reversed, and I, is once more filled ; and so on. Fig. 44. Diagram of Stolnikow's Appaeatus. In this way the quantity of blood which the heart delivers, its ' output ' during a given time can be measured ; the quantity discharged at a single beat can similarly be determined. By means of recording floats in I. and II., a graphic record of the output may also be obtained. The other methods are plethysmographic (§ 122) in nature. The volume of the heart changes only with the volume of its contents, for we may neglect, in the first instance at least, as insignificant the changes of volume due to changes in the amount of blood held by the coronary system, and we may wholly neglect the changes of volume due to changes in the quantity of lymph present in the cardiac tissues. An increase in the volume of the heart means that more blood is flowing into it than is leaving it, a decrease that more is leaving it than is flowing into it. Hence, if we measure the diminution of volume which takes place during the systole, this gives us the volume of blood dis- charged by the two ventricles during that systole, the effect of changes in the auricles being neglected ; and since the two ventricles discharge equal quantities, half this will give us the quantity of blood discharged by the left ventricle during the systole. In the method of Tigerstedt and others the pericardial cavity is Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 249 employed as the pletliysmographic chamber, the changes of volume in it being transmitted by air to the recording apparatus. A cannula is introduced into the pericardium, a little air entering at the same time, and is connected by an air tube with a delicate piston, the movements of which are recorded in the usual way. ■}.. .r Fig. 45. Cardiometer of Roy and Adami. In the method of Roy and Adami the heart is placed in a ri^id metal box, Fig. 45 b, the cavity of which, fiUed with warmed oil,^ is connected with a light piston c and so with a recording lever. The pericardium being laid open, the two halves of the box are placed round the ^ heart, are securely fixed by means of an India rubber ring a, to the parietal pericardium round the roots of the great vessels, and'are brought together. The cavity is then filled with oil, and the piston, also filled with oil, is brought into connection with the box, the lever 250 THE OUTPUT OF THE HEART. [Book i. and rod of the piston being placed by means of the india rubber spring d^ in such a position that the pressure within the box is some few mm, Hg below that of the atmosphere. By these methods it has been determined that the diminntion of the volume of the heart at a systole, the " contraction volume " as it has inconveniently been called, that is to say, the quantity of blood discharged at a systole, the output of a systole, or the " pulse-volume " as we may call it, for it is this which causes the pulse, varies very much under various circumstances. We shall have to discuss later on some of the influences bearing on its amount. Meanwhile we merely call attention to the fact that it does vary largely, and that any numerical statement as to a normal pulse-volume has relatively little value. Another fact of considerable importance brought to light by these methods is that under certain circumstances, at all events, the output by the left ventricle during a number of beats may be less than the intake through the right auricle. This means that under these circumstances the ventricle does not at the systole discharge the whole of its contents ; some of the blood remains behind in the cavity of the ventricle at the close of the systole. Hence the assumption that the ventricle, in its systole, always discharges the whole of its contents, so as to be quite empty at the onset of diastole, is not true ; the ventricle may completely empty itself but it by no means always does so. The Mechanism of the Beat. § 133. We may now attempt to consider in rather more detail what we may call the mechanism of the beat, that is to say^ the exact manner in which the heart receives and ejects the blood. For this purpose we shall need certain data in addition to those on which we have already dwelt. In addition to the curve obtained by placing a light lever on the exposed heart (Fig. 46), a method which though useful is open Fig. 46. (Eepeated from Fig. 37.) Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAK MECHANISM. 251 to objection, we may obtain what is very nearly the same thing, viz. a cardiograph ic tracing (Fig. 47) or cardiogram, that is to say, a tracing of the cardiac impulse, a curve of the changes in the pressure exerted by the apex of the heart on the chest-wall. Various forms of canUograph have been used to record the cardiac impulse. In some the pressure of the impulse is transruitted directly to a lever which writes upon a travelling surface. In others the hiipulse is, by means of an ivory button, brought to bear on an air- chamber, connected by a tube with a tambour like that in Fig. 38 ; the pressure of the cardiac impulse compresses the air in the air-chamber, and through this the air in tlie chamber of the tambour, whereupon the lever is raised. In others tlie impulse, being received by a small^ elastic bag filled with fluid and introduced through an opening made in the chest-wall, the pleura being left intact, is transmitted through fluid along a tube to a membrane-manometer. Or, to avoid opening tlie chest-wall, the tube may be made to begin in a small, .trumpet- shaped opening or " receiver " covered with an elastic membrane, bearing a central button of cork or other material ; the button being lightly pressed on the spot where the impulse is felt, the impulse is transmitted along the fluid of the tube from the elastic menibrane of the receiver to that of the manometer. In Fig. 47 we give two such cardiograms obtained by different methods, in Fig. 55 a more diagrammatic curve. Fig. 47. Cardiograms. The left-hand figure is from Roy and Adarai. Since it is the contraction of the ventricular filires which is the actual propelling force, an exact record of this contraction, after the manner of a muscle-curve, would serve, could it be obtained, as the basis of discussion. Owing to the intricate arrangement of the cardiac muscular fibres, such a simple record cannot be obtained ; the nearest approach to it is the record of the changes in the distance between two points on the surface of the heart brought about durinsr a beat. 252 THE MECHANISM OF THE BEAT. [Book i. In the instrument of Roy and Adami, by an ingenious arrangement into the details of which we need not go, a delicate rod placed horizon- tally in connection with two points of the surface of the heart, of the ventricles, for instance, as it glides to and fro, according as the two points approach or recede from each other, records its movements by means of a light lever. We give in Fig. 48 such a myocardiographic tracing, as it is called ; the rise of the lever indicates an approach, the fall a receding of two points taken transversely across the ventricle of a dog. What conclusions can we draw from the features of the various curves which we have given ? We have reproduced in some cases more than one curve representing the same event, for the important reason that certain Fig. 48. Mtocakdio- of the features of almost every curve are Eot'^AND'ADAm.^''''' d^e, to some extent at least, to the instru- ment itself, and must not be taken as exact records of what is actually taking place in the heart ; the inertia of one or other part of this or that instrument used plays a more or less important part in determining the form of the curve. It will therefore be readily understood that the interpretation of various heart curves is attended with great difficulties, and has led to much discussion. We must content ourselves here with confining our attention to the more important points, leaving many details, however interesting, on one side. Let us begin with the beginning of the ventricular systole. All the curves, curve of endocardiac pressure, cardiogram, myocar- diogram, and others, shew the important fact that the systole begins suddenly and increases swiftly until it reaches the beginning of what we have called the " systolic plateau," c in Figs. 39, 40, 46, 3 in Fig. 47, d in Fig. 48. In some curves, as in Figs. 39, 40 B, 43, the rise is unbroken ; in others, as in Figs. 40 A, 46, the rise is marked with a shoulder. In 'Fig. 48, this shoulder h has been interpreted, by those who maintain that papillary muscles begin their contraction later than the main ventricular wall, as indicating that event. We will not discuss the question here. In some of the pressure curves,as in Fig. 39, the rise of pressure in the ventricle due to the actual systole is preceded by a slight temporary rise. This has been interpreted as indicating a slight rise of pressure in the ventricle due to the auricular systole just preceding the ventricular systole ; but this interpretation has been debated, and indeed the slight rise in question is not always seen. Similarly, some curves shew a gradual but very slight increase of pressure in the ventricle during the preceding diastole ; this has been interpreted as indicating a rise of pressure due to the gradual Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAIi MECHANISM. 253 inflow of blood from the auricle and veins , but it, too, is not always present. Both the steady- though slight rise of the lever throughout the diastole, with a sudden increase at the end, coin- cident with the aviricular systole, are often seen in cardiograms ; see the diagrammatic curve in Fig. 55. The ventricle as a whole enlarges under the venous inflow, and is more suddenly enlarged by the auricular systole. The feature on which we wish to insist is the rapid rise of the intra- ventricular pressure, and the sudden change at the commencement of the systolic plateau. What does this sudden change mean ? To answer this question we must ascertain what is taking place at the same time in the aorta, § 134. If two catheters be in- troduced at the same time into the left side of the heart of a dog, being so arranged that while the end of one catheter lies in the left ventricle, Fig. 49, V, that of the other lies in the aorta A*^ above the semilunar valves, and if each catheter be con- nected with a membrane-manometer, the two manometers recording on the same surface, one below the other, we obtain some such result as that shewn in Fig. 50. An examination of the two curves thus obtained shews us the following. At 0, the beginning of the ventricular systole, or rather the time when the contraction of the ventricular fibres is beginning to raise the pressure within the ventricle, no effect is being produced in the aorta ; the blood in the aorta is completely sheltered by the closed aortic valves. A little later, however, at 1, the pressure in the aorta begins to rise. This means that the semilunar valves are now opened, so that the force of the ventricular systole can make itself felt in the aorta. Up to 1, the pressure in the ventricle, though increasing, is still less than that remaining in the aorta after the last beat, but at 1 the pressure in the ventricle becomes equal to or rather slightly greater than that in the aorta, and the valves are thrown open. This is also shewn by comparing, as may be done by means Fig. 49. Diageam illustrating the method of recording si- MULTANEOUSLY THE Pressure in THE Left Ventricle and at the ROOT OF THE AORTA. HiJRTHLE. 254 THE MECHANISM OF THE BEAT. [Book i. of the " differential manometer," the changes of pressure m the ventricle and in the aorta at the same time. 0 1 2 34 5 0 12 34 5 Fig. 50. Simultaneous Tracings of Ventriculae and Aortic Pressure. HURTHLE. On the left side the recording surface is travelling slowly, on the right more ■swiftly, the tuning-fork vibrations, t, being 100 a second. A'^. aortic. V. ventricular curve, x — x base line to each. The vertical lines 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, cut each curve at exactly the same time. In the differential manometer, Fig. 51, the two tambours of two membrane manometers T and Tj (the mouths of the tubes opening into each are seen in section) are arranged so that the central discs of both, T T, Fig. 51. Diagram of the Differential Manometer of Hurthle. d and c?„ work on a balance above them. When the pressure in the two tambours is equal, the balance is horizontal ; any difference of pressure between the two leads to an upward or downward movement of one or other arm, and this working against the light steel spring s, by- means of e and e' moves the lever I. In Figs. 52, 53 we give simultaneous tracings of the pressure in the left ventricle V, and in the aorta A^, and of the movements of the lever of the balance indicating differences of pressure D between the ventricle and the aorta. At the base line x — x of D the two pressures are equal. The course of the curve below this base line indicates that the pressure in the ventricle is below that of the aorta ; as the curve approaches towards the base line the pressure in the ventricle becomes more and more nearly equal to that in the aorta ; and such part of the curve as lies above the base line indicates (except in so far as it may be due to the inertia of the Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAE MECHANISM. 255 instrument) that the pressure in the ventricle is for the time being above that in the aorta. t t ;jxjxjx' Fig. 52. Simultaneous Curves of Aortic and Ventricular Pressure and OF THE Differential Manometer. Hurthle. A*^. aorta. V. ventricle. D. differential manometer, x — x, the base line in each respectively. The recording surface is travelling slowly, the time marker t, t mark- ing seconds. 3 4 'ml!i'^mmMmm'\ 0 1 3 A- Fig. 53. The same. 3 4 The recording surface is travelling quickly ; the vibrations of the tuning-fork t, t, are 100 (double vibrations) a second. An examination of the figures shews that the pressures in the ventricle and the aorta become equal at the mark (1). Before this though the pressure in the ventricle is rising rapidly that in the aorta is not rising, indeed is continuing to sink -, the closed 256 THE MECHANISM OF THE BEAT. [Book i. semilunar valves shelter the blood in the aorta from the ventricu- lar pressure. But immediately after (1) the pressure in the aorta also begins to rise ; this shews that the semilunar valves are now open, the blood in the ventricle and that in the aorta now forming a continuous column, and allowing the pressure of the ventricle to be felt in the aorta. A very slight excess of pressure on the ventricular side of the valves is sufficient to push aside the flaps of the valve ; so that we may fairly say that the valves open immediately after (1), which marks the point at which the curve of difference of pressure between the ventricle and the aorta has reached the base line x — x ; that is to say, at which the difference between the two has become nil. It will be observed, however, that the mark (1) cuts the ventri- cular curve not at the summit of its rise but short of this ; the pressure in the ventricle continues to rise after the valves are open, the curve continues after this to ascend rapidly up to (2),. which marks the beginning of the systolic plateau. During the interval between (I) and (2) the pressure is rising in the aorta also. During this interval the pressure in the ventricle, continuing to rise, becomes greater than that in the aorta, the curve of difference rises above the base line ; but the excess of pressure in the ventricle does not become very great, the curve of difference does not rise to any great height, because that very excess of pressure is used up in driving the contents of the ventricle into the aorta through the open semilunar valves. During this interval the pressure in the aorta continues to rise because, until the height of pressure at (2) is reached, the pressure is not yet sufficient to drive the blood on along the arterial system with adequate rapidity. With the point (2) the systolic plateau begins. During this plateau the exact course taken by the curve of ventricular pressure differs in different cases. We will take first the perhaps more ordinary case in which the curve with intermediate variations which we may at present pass over gradually declines until the point (3) is reached, when the plateau comes to an end by reason of the sudden fall of the ventricular pressure. There can be no doubt that the sudden fall after (3) is due to the sudden cessation of the contraction of the ventricular walls, to their sudden relaxation. But what is taking place during the systolic plateau before this point is reached? It used to be argued, taking count of the distension only of the aorta as indicated by the sphygmograph, an instrument of which we shall speak later on, that the ventricular contents escape into the aorta during the period of the distension of the aorta and during this only, having ceased to flow by the time that this distension passes away giving place to a sequent shrinking of the aorta. Now when this period of distension is carefully measured it is found to be much shorter than the systole of the Chap, iv.] TILE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 257 ventricle, as measured by the length of the systolic plateau. Hence, it being further assumed that the whole of the contents- of the ventricle were ejected at each systole, it was inferred that the ventricle remained empty and yet contracted for an appreciable period after the discharge of its contents. And this led, in turn, to a great divergence of opinion as to the exact time at which the semilunar valves were closed. But when we carefully explore the pressure in the aorta and in the ventricle at the same time, making use of the differential manometer, we come upon facts which seem to disprove this view. Examining Fig. 53 we find that, while during the systolic plateau the pressure is falling in both aorta and ventricle, the curve of dif!erence of pressure D remains above the base line, though not far above it and continually approaching it, up to the mark (.3) at the very end of the plateau. At this point, however, at the end of the plateau, at the beginning of relaxation, a very great difference of pressure is established ; while the ventricular pressure falls suddenly and soon reaches or even passes the base line (becoming in the latter case negative, i.e. below that of the atmosphere), the pressure in the aorta undergoes relatively little change, — indeed, immediately afterwards receives an increase of which we shall have to speak later on as the dicrotic crest of the pulse wave ; and the curve of difference D falls with very great abruptness. The interpretation of this seems to be as follows. During the whole of the systolic . plateau up to the mark (3) the semi- lunar valves are open, the cavity of the ventricle and the root of the aorta form a common cavity which is occupied by a continuous column of blood. Hence the curves of ventricular and aortic pressure, of the pressure at the one end and at the other end of this column, follow the same general course, and, indeed, shew the same secondary variations ; this general course is, in the case which we are studying, a descending one by reason, as we have said, of the relatively free escape of blood from the arterial system through the peripheral resistance. But the column of blood in question is a column in motion, the ventricular pressure is driving the blood from the ventricle into the aorta ; to effect this the pressure in the ventricle must continue to be higher than that which it is itself generating in the aorta, the curve of difference must remain above the base line. And, since the curve of difference does remain above the base line right up to the mark (3), we may infer that up to this point blood does pass from the ventricle into the aorta. At (3), however, there is a sudden change. The systole suddenly ceases, and with that the curve of difference suddenly sinks below the base line ; the flow from ventricle ceases not because there is no more blood to come, but becaiise the pressure in the ventricle now becomes lower than that in the aorta ; and, indeed, the blood would flow back from the aorta to the region of lower pressure, to the ventricle, were it not that the very first effect 17 258 THE MECHANISM OF THE BEAT. [Book i. of the reflux is to close the semilunar valves. So soon as these are closed, the pressures in the ventricle and the aorta, which were previously following similar courses, now take separate courses ; the latter falls suddenly, the former decreases gradually, and continues to decrease until the next systole once more opens the semilunar valves. We may add that this view is consistent with the conclu- sion mentioned in § 132, that not only the pulse-volume may vary, but also, at times at least, the whole contents are not driven out at the systole, some blood remaining behind. Moreover, the pressure does not always gradually decline during the systolic plateau ; sometimes it gradually rises during the whole of the period of the plateau, reaching its highest point just before the final sudden fall. This is shewn in Fig. 54. Fig. 54. Curve of Aortic and Ventricular Pressure, with an ASCENDING SySTOLIC PlATEAU. HuRTHLE. In this figure the general features are the same as in Fig. 53, save that the curve of ventricular pressure rises during the whole of the systolic plateau. But the curve of aortic pressure also rises in a corresponding manner, and the curve of difference, if shewn, would be the same as in Fig. 53. The explanation of the difference between the two cases is that in Fig. 53 the peripheral resistance in the arterial flow (§ 117) is not very great, and the ventricular systole soon overcomes it to such an extent as to lead at once to some fall of pressure in the aorta (and in the ventricle). In Fig. 54 the peripheral resistance is very great ; it is not overcome at first, the ventricle does its best working against it, and produces the most effect, raising the pressure to the highest point, just before its systole comes to an end. We may add that a similar course of the curve may be seen even when the pressure in the aorta is not very high, provided that the pulse-volume, the quantity discharged at the systole is very great ; the form of the curve depends on the relative amounts which are entering the arterial system from the heart, and leaving it by the peripheral vessels. It is possible that under some circumstances the whole of the Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 259 contents may be discharged before the actual systole ends ; but the observations and arguments which we have just related, shew that such an event must be regarded as of exceptional, and not, as has been contended, of normal occurrence. Of the smaller secondary variations visible on the systolic plateau, conspicuous in some curves (4, 5, 6, 7 in Fig. 47), various explanations have been given. Into the discussion of these we cannot enter here ; we may however say that in many observations, which we may probably regard as correct, these secondary markings are identical in the curves of ventricular pressure, of aortic pressure and of the cardiac impulse, or of the change in the outward form of the heart ; the events which cause them tell in the same way on all three. Systole Diastole Fig 55 Diagram of Ventricular and Aortic Pressure and of the Cardiac Impulse. Huktiile. We give in Fig. 55 a diagram of the cardiac events according to the exposition which we have just made. The curves previously given were copies of actual curves obtained by experiment ; this is a constructed diagram. The upper curve is the curve of the cardiac impulse. The middle curve is the curve of pressure in the 260 NEGATIVE PRESS UEE. [Book i. left ventricle ; the unbroken line represents the course of the curve when, the peripheral resistance being small, the pressure needed to drive onward the blood is not very high, in the figure less than 150 mm. Hg. The dotted line represents the course of the curve when, the peripheral resistance being great, the pressure is high, in the figure nearly 200 mm. Hg. The lower curve is the curve of pressure at the root of the aorta, the unbroken and the dotted lines having the same significance as in the ventricular curve. The line 0 marks the commencement of the ventricular systole, the line 1 the opening of the semilunar valves, and 3 the end of the systole. The line 4 marks the beginning of what in dealing with the pulse, we shall speak of as the dicrotic wave. The semi- lunar valves are closed between 3 and 4 ; the closure is the result at 3 of the cessation of the systole and as we shall see the cause at 4 of the dicrotic wave of the pulse. The time is given in tenths of a second. § 135. In many curves, as in some of those given above, the pressure in the ventricle at the beginning of diastole falls not only to the base line, which is the line of atmospheric pressure, but even below it ; that is to say, becomes negative. Such a negative pressure may be shewn by means of a minimum manometer, that is, a mano- meter arranged so as to shew the lowest pressure which has been reached in a series of events. The mercury manometer, which as we Fig. .56. The Maximum Manometer of Goltz and Gaule. At e a connection is made with the tube leading to the heart. When the screw clamp k is closed, the valve v conies into action, and the instrument, in the position of the valve shewn in the figure, is a maximum manometer. By reversing the direction of v it is converted into a minimum manometer. When k is opened, the variations of pressure are conveyed along a, and the instrument then acts like an ordinary manometer. Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAE MECHANISM. 261 have said, is unsuitable for following the rapid changes constituting a single beat, may be used as a maximum or minimum instrument for determining the highest or lowest pressure reached in one or other of the heart's cavities during a series of beats. The principle of one fonu of maximum manometer, Fig. 56, consists in the introduction into the tul)e leading from the heart to the mercury column, of a (modified eup-and-ball) valve, opening, like the aortic semilunar valves, easily from the heart, but closing firmly when fluid attempts to return to the heart. The highest pressure is that which drives the longest column of fluid past the valve, raising the mercury column to a corresponding height. Since this column, once past the valve, cannot return, the mercury remains at the height to which it was raised by it, and thus records the maximum pressure. By reversing the direction of the valve, the manometer is converted from a maximum into a minimum instrument. A simpler form of maximum and minimum manometer is that of Hilrthle, which consists of a small chamber connected with two mano- meters, the opening of each manometer into the chamber being armed with a valve of thin membrane, so arranged that it permits in the case of one manometer, the maximum one, the entrance only of the mercury, in the case of the other, the minimum one, the exit only. By means of the maximum manometer the pressure in the left ventricle in the dog has been observed to reach a maximum of about 140 mm. (mercury), in the right ventricle of about 60 mm. and in the right auricle of about 20 mm. These figures, however, are given as examples, and not as averages. Simi- larly negative pressures of from — 50 mm. to — 20 in the left ventricle of the dog, of about — 15 mm. in the right ventricle, and of from — 12 mm. to — 7 mm. in the right auricle, have been observed by the minimum manometer. Part of this diminution of pressure in the cardiac cavities is due, as will be explained in a later part of this work, to the aspiration of the thorax in the respiratory movements. But even when the thorax is opened, and artificial respiration kept up, under which circumstances no such aspiration takes place, a negative pressure may be still observed, the pressure in the left ventricle sinking according to some obser- vations as low as — 24 mm. Now, what the instrument actually shews is that at some time or other during the number of beats which took place while the instrument was applied (and these may have been very few), the pressure in the ventricle sank so many mm. below that of the atmosphere. Since, however, the negative pressure may be observed when the heart is beating quite regularly, each beat being exactly like the others, we may infer tliat the negative pressure is repeated at some period or other of each cardiaccycle. The instrument itself gives us no information as to the exact phase of the beat in which the negative pressure occurs ; but it is clear from what we have already seen that when it occurs, it must take place at the end of the systole, at the beginning of the 262 DUEATION OF CAEDIAC PHASES. [Book i. diastole. It is obvious, moreover, from what has gone before, that the semilunar valves are closed before it occurs, and we may dismiss the view which has been put forward that it is of the same nature as the negative pressure which makes its appearance behind a column of fluid moving rapidly and suddenly ceasing, as when a rapid flow of water through a tube is suddenly stopped by turning a tap. We may probably attribute it to the relaxation of the ventricular walls. This, as all the curves shew, is a rapid process, something quite distinct from the mere filling of the ventricular cavities with blood by the venous inflow; and, though some have objected to the view, it may be urged that this return of tlie ventricle from its contracted condition to its normal form would develop a negative pressure. This return we may probably regard as simply the total result of the return of each fibre to its natural condition, though some have urged that the extra quantity of blood thrown into the coronary arteries at the systole helps to unfold the ventricles somewhat in the way that fluid driven between the two walls of a double-walled collapsed ball or cup will unfold it. We may further conclude that such a negative pressure, when it occurs, will assist the circulation (and it may be remarked that the return of the thick-walled left ventricle naturally exerts a greater negative pressure than the thin-walled right ventricle) by sucking the blood which has meanwhile been accumulated in the auricle from that cavity into the ventricle, the auriculo-ventricular valves easily giving way. At the same time this very flow from the auricle will at once put an end to the negative pressure, which obviously can be of brief duration only. It should, however, be added that many observers find the development of a negative pressure to be by no means of such constant occurrence, and not to reach such marked limits as might be inferred from the numbers given above, at least in the unopened chest. If so it cannot be an important factor in the work of the circulation. § 136. 'The duration of the several phases. We may first of all distinguish certain main phases : (1) The systole of the auricles. (2) The systole, proper, of the ventricles, during which their fibres are in a state of contraction. (3) The diastole of the ventricles, that is to say, the time intervening between their fibres ceasing to contract, and commencing to contract again. To these we may add; (4) The pause or rest of the whole heart, comprising the period from the end of the relaxation of the ventricles to the beginning of the systole of the auricles ; during this time the walls are undergoing no active changes, neither contracting nor relaxing, their cavities being simply passively filled by the influx of blood. The mere inspection of almost any series of cardiac curves however taken, those, for instance, which we have just discussed, will shew, apart from any accurate measurements, that the systole Chap. iv.J THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 263 of the auricles is always very brief, that the systole of the ven- tricles is always very prolonged, always occupying a considerable portion of the whole cycle, and that the diastole of the whole heart, reckoned from the end either of the systole, or of the relaxation of the ventricle, is very various, being in quickly beating hearts very short, and in slowly beating hearts decidedly longer. "When we desire to arrive at more complete measurements, we are obliged to make use of calculations based on various data ; and the value of some of these has been debated. Naturally, the most interest is attached to the duration of events in the human heart. A datum which has been very largely used is the interval between the beginning of the first and the occurrence of the second sound. This may be determined with approximative correctness, and is found to vary from "301 to "327 sec, occupying from 40 to 46 p. c. of the whole period, and being fairly constant for different rates of heart beat. That is to say, in a rapidly beating heart it is the pauses which are shortened, and not the duration of the actual beats. The observer, Usteninig to the sounds of the heart, makes a signal at each event on a recording surface, the diiference in time between the marks being measured by means of the vibrations of a tuning-fork recorded on the same surface. By practice it is found possible tO' reduce the errors of observation witliin very small limits. Now whatever be the exact causation of the first sound, it is undoubtedly coincident with the systole of the ventricles, though possibly the actual commencement of its becoming audible may be slightly behind the actual beginning of the muscular contractions. Similarly, the occurrence of the second sound, which, as we have seen, is certainly due to the closure of the semilunar valves, may in accordance with the view expounded a little while back, be taken to mark the close of the ventricular systole. And on this view the interval between the beginning of the first and the occurrence of the second sound may be regarded as indicating approximatively the duration of the ventricular systole, ie. the period during which the ventricular fibres are contracting. By an ingenious arrangement, a microphone attached to a stethoscope may be made to record the heart sounds through the stimulation of a muscle-nerve preparation : and the record so obtained may be compared with the various cardiac curves. When this is done, the first sound is found to begin somewhere on the systolic ascent of the ventricular curve, the exact point varying, and the second sound to occur just as the ventricular curve begins its diastolic descent. There has been, however, as we stated above, great divergence of opinion and much discussion as to the exact time of the closure of the semilunar valves ; the view given in the text above, though it seems to be supported by adequate arguments, is not the only one 264 DURATION OF CARDIAC PHASES. [Book i. which is held. And on the view that the ventricles still remain contracted for a brief period after the valves are shut, the second sound does not mark the end of the systole, and the duration of the systole is rather longer than the time given above. Accepting the view given in the text, we may make the following statement. In a heart beating 72 times a minute, which may be taken as the normal rate, each entire cardiac cycle would last about 0-8 sec, and taking 0"3 sec. as the duration of the ventricular systole, the deduction of this would leave 0'5 sec. for the whole diastole of the ventricle including its relaxation, the latter occupying less than -1 sec. At the end of the diastole of the ventricle there occurs the systole of the auricle, the exact duration of which it is difficult to determine, it being hard to say when it really begins, but which, if the contraction of the great veins be included, may perhaps be taken as lasting on an average •O'l sec. The 'passive interval,' therefore, during which neither auricle nor ventricle is undergoing contraction, lasts about 4 sec, and the absolute pause or rest, during which neither auricle nor ventricle is contracting or relaxing, about '3 sec. The systole of the ventricle follows so immediately upon that of the auricle, that practically no interval exists between the two events. In the systole of the ventricle we may distinguish the phase during which pressure is being got up before the semilunar valves are opened ; this is exceedingly short, probably from -02 to -03 sec During the rest of the -3 sec. of the systole, the contents of the ventricle are being pressed into the aorta. The duration of the several phases may for convenience sake be arranged in a tabular form as follows : Systole of ventricle before the open- ing of the semilunar valves, while ^ ■ pressure is still getting up "03 | Continued contraction of the ventricle, )- and I Escape of blood into aorta '27 J Total systole of the ventricle Diastole of both auricle and ventricle, neither contracting, or " passive in- terval " Systole of auricle (about or less than) Diastole of ventricle, including relaxa- tion and filling, up to the beginning of the ventricular systole Total Cardiac Cycle Chap. iv.J THE VASCULAK MECHANISM. 265 Summary. § 137. We may now briefly recapitulate the main facts con- nected with the passage of blood through the heart. The right auricle during its diastole, by the relaxation of its muscular fibres, and by the fact that all backward pressure from the ventricle is prevented by the closing of the tricuspid valves, offers but little resistance to the ingress of blood from the veins. On the other hand, the blood in the trunks of both the superior and inferior vena cava is under a pressure, which, though diminishing towards the heart, remains higher than the pressure obtaining in the interior of the auricle ; the blood in consequence flows into the empty auricle, its progress in the case of the superior vena cava being assisted by gravity. At each inspiration this flow (as we shall see in speaking of respiration) is favoured by the diminution of pressure in the heart and great vessels caused by the respiratory movements. Before this flow has gone on very long, the diastole of the ventricle begins, its cavity dilates, the flaps of the tricuspid valve fall back, and blood for some little time flows in an un- broken stream from the vense cavse into the ventricle. How far the entrance of blood from the auricle into the ventricle is, under ordinary circumstances, aided by the negative pressure in the ventricle following the close of the systole, must, as we have said, be left for the present uncertain. In a short time, probably before very much blood has had time to enter the ventricle, the auricle is full ; and forthwith its sharp, sudden systole takes place. Partly by reason of the backward pressure in the veins, which increases rapidly from the heart towards the capillaries, and which at some distance from the heart is assisted by the presence of valves in the venous trunks, but still more from the fact that the systole begins at the great veins themselves, and spreads thence over the auricle, the force of the auricular contraction is spent in driving the blood, not back into the veins, but into the ventricle, where the pressure is still exceedingly low. Whether there is any backward flow at all into the great veins, or whether by the progressive character of the systole, the flow of blood continues, so to speak, to follow up the systole without break, so that the stream from the veins into the auricle is really continuous, is at present doubtful ; though a slight positive wave of pressure synchronous with the auricular systole, travelling backward along the great veins, has been observed at least in cases where the heart is beating vigorously. The ventricle thus being filled by the auricular systole, the play of the tricuspid valves described above comes into action, the auricular systole is followed by that of the ventricle, and the pressure within the ventricle, cut off from the auricle by the tricuspid valves, is brought to bear on the pulmonary semilunar valves, and the column of blood on the other side of those valves. 266 SUMMARY OF HEAET BEAT. [Book i. As soon as by the rapidly increasing shortening of the ventricular fibres the pressure within the ventricle becomes greater than that in the pulmonary artery, the semilunar valves open, and the still continuing systole discharges the contents of the ventricle into that vessel. During the whole of this time the left side has with still greater energy been executing the same manoeuvre. At the same time that the vense cavse are tilling the right auricle, the pulmonary veins are tilling the left auricle. At the same time that the right auricle is contracting, the left auricle is contracting too. The systole of the left ventricle is synchronous with that of the right ventricle, but executed with greater force ; and the flow of blood is guided on the left side by the mitral and aortic valves in the same way that it is on the right by the tricuspid valves and the valves of the pulmonary artery. As the ventricles become filled with blood, and so increased in volume, the apex begins to press steadily on the chest-wall, as may be often seen in the cardiogram, the curve of the cardiac impulse. The fuller distension due to the auricular systole is more obvious in the same curve ; but both these changes are insignificant compared to the effect of the change of form, and of the position of the apex during the ventricular systole, by which the lever of the cardiograph is rapidly and forcibly moved. , With this systole of the ventricles the first sound is heard. We may more conveniently follow the remaining events in the left ventricle. The effect of the discharge of the contents of the left ventricle is to raise the pressure at the root of the aorta to nearly the same height as that in the ventricle itself. The ventricular pressure continues for some time, giving rise to the " systolic plateau " of the various cardiac curves. In some cases this pressure soon reaches a maximum, after which it gradually declines, the curve of pressure sloping, with some secondary undulations, gently down- wards. In other cases where there is great resistance to the outflow along the arterial system, the pressure may continue to rise during the whole of the ventricular systole. In both cases the curves of the ventricular pressure and of the aortic pressure are similar. Then comes the sudden cessation of contraction, the sudden relaxation of the ventricular fibres. The pressure in the ventricle becomes less than that which it itself has generated in the aorta, and the semilunar valves suddenly close as the blood flows back from the region of high pressure, the aorta, towards the region of low pressure, the ventricle. At this moment the second sound is heard. Owing to the semilunar valves being closed, the pressures in the ventricle and in the aorta, which before were following the Chap. iv.J THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 267 same course, now become different. While the pressure sinks rapidly in the ventricle, falling it may be below that of the atmos- sphere, and thus becoming a negative pressure, which in some cases may possibly be considerable, that in the aorta does not sink to a corresponding degree ; in fact, as we shall see, it is reinforced to a certain extent in a secondary rise, the so-called dicrotic rise. We have reason to believe not only that the quantity of blood ejected at the systole may vary from time to time, but also that at times at all events if not normally, the whole of the blood present in the ventricle at the systole may fail to leave the ventricle during the systole, more or less remaining behind at the close ; the ventricle in such cases does not completely empty itself. On the other hand, we may perhaps admit that, at least under cer- tain circumstances, when, for instance, the contents of the ventricle are small, and the ventricle vigorous or the systole prolonged, the whole of the contents may be discharged in the earlier part of the systole, the ventricle remaining contracted for some little time after it has emptied itself. Tlie Work done. § 138. We have already (§ 132) spoken of that most important factor in the determination of the work of the heart, the pulse- volume, or the quantity ejected from the ventricle into the aorta at each systole, and of the various methods by which it may be estimated. We have seen that it probably varies within very considerable limits. We may here repeat the remark that exactly the same quantity must issue at a beat from each ventricle ; for if the right ventricle at each beat gave out rather less than the left, after a certain number of beats the whole of the blood would be gathered in the systemic circulation. Similarly, if the left ventricle gave out less than the right, all the blood would soon be crowded into the lungs. The fact that the pressure in the right ventricle is so much less than that in the left (probably 30 or 40 mm. as compared with 200 mm. of mercury), is due, not to differences in the quantity of blood in the cavities, but to the fact that the peripheral resistance which has to be overcome in the lungs is so much less than that in the rest of the body. Not only does the amount ejected vary, but the pressure under which it is ejected also varies within very considerable limits. Moreover, the number of times the systole is repeated within a given period may also vary considerably. The work done, therefore, varies very much. But it may be interesting and instructive to note the results of calculating out a very high estimate. Thus if we take 180 grms. as the quantity, in man, ejected at each stroke at a pressure of 250 mm. of mercury, which is 268 THE WOEK DONE. [Book i. equivalent to 3 "21 meters of blood, this means that the left ventricle is capable at its systole of lifting 180 grms. 3-21 m. high, i. e. it does 578 gram-meters of work at each beat. Supposing the heart to beat 72 times a minute, this would give for the day's work of the left ventricle nearly 60,000 kilogram-meters. Calcu- lating the work of the right ventricle at one-fourth that of the left, the work of the whole heart during the day would amount to 75,000 kilogram-meters, which is just about the amount of work done in the ascent of Snowdon by a tolerably heavy man. SEC. 4. THE PULSE. § 139. We have seen that the arteries, though always dis- tended, undergo, each time that the systole of the ventricle drives the contents of the ventricle into the aorta, a temporary additional expansion so that when the finger is placed on an artery, such as the radial, an intermittent pressure on the finger, coming and going with the beat of the heart, is felt, and when a light lever is placed on the artery, the lever is raised at each beat, falling between. This intermittent expansion, which we call the pulse, cor- responding to the jerking outflow of blood from a severed artery, is present in the arteries only, being, except under particular circumstances, absent from the veins and capillaries. The expan- sion is frequently visible to the eye, and in some cases, as where an artery has a bend, may cause a certain amount of locomotion of the vessel. We may, by applying various instruments to the interior of an artery, study the temporary increase of pressure which is the cause of the temporary increase of expansion. This makes itself felt, as we have seen, in the curve of arterial pressure taken by the mercury manometer ; but the inertia of the mercury prevents the special characters of each increase becoming visible. In order to obtain an adequate record of these special characters we must have recourse to other instruments. The membrane-manometer, of which we have ah'eady spoken (§ 131), and on the results gained by which when appHeil to the root of the aorta by means of a catheter we have dwelt (§ 134), may also be applied to other arteries, the tube leading to the tambour of the manometer being connected with the artery by means of a cannula in the ordinary way. In Fick's spring-manometer, in its original form, Fig. 57, the artery is connected by means of a cannula and a rigid tube containing fluid with the interior of a curved spring ; an increase of pressure unfolds the curve of the spring, the movements of the end of which may be recorded by means of a lever. In Fick's improved form the membrane of a small air-tambour works against a horizontal slip of steel which acts as a spring ; this instrument, like Froy and Krehl's manometer 270 METHODS OF RECORDING PULSE. [Book i. which is only a modification of it (see § 131), can be applied to an artery by a cannula in the ordinary way. The " sphygmoscope " consists of a small elastic bag, the end of an india rubber finger, for instance, fitted on to a conical cork, through which passes a tube opening into the bag, and connected by a cannula with the artery ; both bag and tube are, before being connected with the artery, filled with fluid of a nature to hinder clotting. The bag, by means of the conical cork, is firmly fitted into the end of a small glass tube, the cavity of which filled with air is connected with a recording air tambour. The changes of pressure within the artery are transmitted to the elastic bag, and through this to the air of the glass tube and so to the recording tambour. The tambour-sphygmoscope of Hurthle is a combination of the membrane-manometer with a tambour. The membrane of the manometer works not directly on a lever, but on a recording air tambour, the move- ments of which are recorded in the usual way. In the sphygmotonometer of Roy, the artery is, by means of a cannula, and rigid tube filled with fluid, connected with a cylinder in which a light piston works by means of a delicate membrane. Fig. 57. Fick's Spring Manometer. The flattened tube in the form of a hoop is firmly fixed at one end, while the other free end is attached to a lever. The interior of the tube, filled with spirit, is brought, by means of a tube containing sodium carbonate solution, into connection with an' artery, in much the same way as in the case of the mercury manometer. The increase of pressure in the artery being transmitted to the hollow hoop, tends to straighten it, and correspondingly moves the attached lever. Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAK MECHANISM. 271 And there are still other instruments which may be used in a similar way. It is not necessary, however, to open the artery ; we may study indirectly the changes of pressure by recording the expansions and retractions of the artery, the changes in its diameter, which are produced by the changes of pressure. The most common method of registering the expansion of an artery and at the same time one of the simplest, is that of bringing a light lever to bear on the outside of the artery. A lever specially adapted to record a pulse tracing is called a sphygmograph, the instrument generally comprising a small travelling recording surface on which the lever writes. There are many different forms of sphygmograph, but the general plan of structure is the same. Eig, 58 represents in a diagrammatic form the essential parts of the sphj'-gmograph known as Dudgeon's, which we have chosen for reprn- sentation, not because it is best, but because it is one very largely employed in medical practice. The instrument is generally applied to the radial artery because the arm affords a convenient support to the fulcrum of the lever, and because the position of the artery, near to the Fig. 58. Di.vgram of a Sphygmograph (Dudgeon's). Certain supporting parts are omitted so that tlie multiplying levers may be displayed. a is a small metal ijlate which is kept pressed on the artery by the spring h. The vertical movements of a cause to-and-fro movements of the lever r about the fixed point d. These are communicated to and magiiifiod bv the lever e, wliich moves round the fixed ])oiiit f. 'I'he free end of this lover carries a liglit steel marker wliich rests on a strip of smoked paper r/. The ]ia])er is jdaced bcnoatli two small wheels, and rests on a roller which can be rotated by means of clock-work contained in the box h. The paper is thus caused to travel at a uniform rate. The screw graduated in ounces Troy is brought to bear on the spring /* by means of a camm, ami by this the pressure put on the artery can be regulated. The levers magnify the ])ulso inovomonts fifty times. 272 METHODS OF EECORDING PULSE. [Book t. surface and with the support of the radius below so that adequate pressure can be brought to bear by the lever on the artery, is favour- able for making observations. It can, of course, be applied to other arteries. The membrane-manometer of Hiirthle may also be applied directly to an unopened artery. The cannula is replaced by a small funnel, the mouth of which is covered by membrane bearing at its centre a small block of cork. If the cork be pressed lightly on an artery, the expansions of the artery move the membrane of the funnel, and the movements of this are transmitted along the fluid of a rigid tube to the recording tambour. A pulse tracing may also be indirectly obtained by the plethysmo- graphic method. If the arm be introduced into a plethysmograph (§ 122), a tracing may be obtained of the rhythmic expansions of the arm, that is, of the rhythmic expansions of the arteries of the arm, due to the heart beats. If the plethysmograph chamber be filled with air instead of fluid, the changes of pressure in the chamber may be brought to bear on a sensitive flame, the changes of which in turn may be photograplied. If the artery be laid bare, other methods may be adopted. In some cases, in that of the aorta, for instance, it is sufficient to attach a light hook into the outer coat of the artery, and to connect the hook by means of a thread with a carefully balanced lever. The movements of the coat of the artery are then recorded by the lever. The sphygmotonometer of Roy may also be used without opening the artery. For this purpose a length of the artery is enclosed in a tube with rigid walls, filled with fluid, which acts as a plethysmograph, the movements of the fluid around the artery being recorded by means of a piston working a lever. If the artery be ligatured and divided, one end may be drawn into the tube for the distance required. The tube may also be made of two halves, one of Avliich is slipped under the artery simply laid bare, the other placed above it, and the two halves are brought together round tlie artery, the two ends of the tube being closed with membrane. And still other methods may be employed. The several tracings obtained by these several methods differ of coarse in minor features, but they agree in general features ; and from a comparative study of the results obtained by different methods v^^e are able, in many cases at all events, to form conclu- sions as to which of the minor features of a curve are due to the in- strument itself, and which represent events actually taking place in the artery. On the whole, the curve obtained by directly record- ing the pressure within the artery is concordant with that obtained by recording the expansions of the artery ; the curve obtained by the manometer or by the sphygmoscope very closely resembles that obtained by the sphygmograph, and the more completely the incidental errors of each instrument are avoided, the more closely do the two curves agree. We may accordingly in treating of the pulse confine ourselves largely to the results obtained by the sphyg- mograph. Any of the various instruments applied to the radial Chap. iv.J THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 273 artery would give some such tracing as that shewn in Fig. 59 which is obtained by means of the sphygmograph. At each heart beat the Fig. 59. Pulse tracing from the Radial Artery of Man. The vertical curved line, L, gives the tracing which the recording lever made when the blackened paper was motionless. The curved interrupted lines shew the distance from one another in time of the chief phases of the pulse-wave, viz. X = commencement, and A end of expansion of artery, p, predicrotic notch, d, di- crotic notch. C, dicrotic crest. D, post-dicrotic crest, f, the post-dicrotic notch. These terms are explained in the text later on. curve rises rapidly, and then falls more gradually in a line which is more or less uneven. § 140. We have now to study the nature and characters of the pulse in greater detail. We may say at once, and, indeed, have already incidentally seen, that the pulse is essentially due to physical causes ; it is the physical result of the sudden injection of the contents of the ventricle into the elastic tubes called arteries. Its features depend on the one hand on the systole of the ventricle, on the quantity of blood which is thereby discharged into the aorta, and on the manner in which it is discharged, and on the other hand on the elasticity of the arterial walls. The more important of these features may be explained on physical principles, and may be illustrated by means of an artificial model, so far at least as we can imitate the action of the heart. We may confine ourselves, in the first instance, to the simple expansion of the arterial tube and its return to its previous condition, neglecting for the present all secondary events. If two levers be placed on the arterial tubes of an artificial model Fig. 31, S. a., S'. a., one near to the pump, and the other near to the peripheral resistance, with a considerable length of tubing between them, and both levers be made to write on a recording surface, one immediately below the other, so that their curves can be more easily compared, the following facts may be observed, when the pump is set to work regularly. They are 18 274. ARTIFICIAL PULSE. [Book i. perhaps still better seen if a number of levers be similarly- arranged at different distances from the pump as in Fig. 60. ^/\AyVVV\AAA/V\AAAA/ 50 v: Fig. 60. Pulse-curves described by a series of sphygmographic levers placed at intervals of 20 cm. from each other along an elastic tube, into which fluid is forced by the sudden stroke of a pump. The pulse-wave is travelling from left to right, as indicated by the arrows over the primary (a) and secondary (6, c) pulse-waves. The dotted- vertical lines drawn from the summit of the several primary waves to the tuning-fork curve below, each complete vibration of which occupies ^ sec, allow the time to be measured which is taken up by the wave in passing along 20 cm. of the tubing. The waves a' are waves reflected from the closed distal end of the tubing ; this is indicated by the direction of the arrows. It will be observed that in the more distant lever VI. the reflected wave, having but a slight distance to travel, becomes fused with the primary wave. (From Marey.) At each stroke of the pump, each lever rises until it reaches a maximum (Fig. 60, la, 2a, &c.), and then falls again, thus describing a curve. The rise is due to the expansion of the part of the tube under the lever, and the fall is due to that part of the (JiiAP. IV.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 275 tube returning after the expansion to its previous calibre. The curve is therefore the curve of the expansion (and return) of the tube at the point on which the lever rests. We may call it the pulse-curve. It is obvious that the expansion passes by the lever in the form of a wave. At one moment the lever is at rest: the tube beneath it is simply distended to the normal amount indicative of the mean pressure which at the time obtains in the arterial tubes of the model ; at the next moment the pulse expan- sion reaches the lever, and the lever begins to rise ; it continues to rise until the top of the wave reaches it, after which it falls again until finally it comes to rest, the wave having completely passed by. It may perhaps be as well at once to warn the reader that the figure which we call the pulse-curve is not a representation of the pulse-wave itself ; it is simply a representation of the movements, up and down, of the piece of the wall of the tubing at the spot on which the lever rests during the time that the wave is passing over that spot. We may roughly represent the wave by the diagram Fig. 61, in which the wave shewn by the dotted line is \^ H ^s— > z y X C / X Fig. 61. A rough diagrammatic Representation of a Pulse-Wave passing OVER AN Artery. passing over the tubs (shewn in a condition of rest by the thick double line) in the direction from H to C. It must, however, be remembered that the wave thus figured is a much shorter wave than is the pulse-wave in reality (that being, as we shall see, about 6 meters long), i.e. occupies a smaller length of the arterial system from the heart H towards the capillaries C. Moreover, the actual pulse-wave has secondary features, which we are neglecting for the present, and which, therefore, we do not attempt to shew in the figure. The curves below, X, Y, Z, represent, in a similarly diagram- matic fashion, the curves described, during the passage of the wave, 276 ARTIFICIAL PULSE. [Book i. by levers placed on the points x, y, z. At Z the greater part of the wave has already passed under the lever, which, during its passage, has already described the greater part of its curve, shewn by the thick line, and has only now to describe the small part, shewn by the dotted line, corresponding to the remainder of the wave from Z to H. At Fthe lever is at the summit of the wave. At X the lever has only described a small part of the beginning of the wave, viz. from G to x, the rest of the curve, as shewn by the dotted line, having yet to be described. But to return to the consideration of Fig. 60. § 141. The rise of each lever is somewhat sudden, but the fall is more gradual, and is generally marked with some irregularities which we shall study presently. The rise is sudden because the sharp stroke of the pump suddenly drives a quantity of fluid into the tubing, and so suddenly expands the tube ; the fall is more gradual because the elastic reaction of the walls of the tube, which, after the expanding power of the pump has ceased, brings about the return of the tube to its former calibre driving the fluid onwards to the periphery, is more gradual in its action. These features, the suddenness of the rise or up-stroke, and the more gradual slope of the fall or down-stroke, are seen also in natural pulse-curves taken from living arteries (Figs. 59, 62 &c.). We shall see, however, that under certain circumstances this contrast between the up-stroke and the down-stroke is not so marked. It may here be noted that the actual size of the curve, that is the amount of excursion of the lever, depends in part (as does also to a great extent the form of the curve) on the amount of pressure exerted by the lever on the tube. If the lever only just touches the tube in its expanded state, the rise will be insignificant. If, on the other hand, the lever be pressed down too firmly, the tube beneath will not be able to expand as it otherwise would, and the rise of the lever will be proportionately dimin- ished. There is a certain pressure which must be exerted by the lever on the tube, the exact amount depending on the expansive power of the tubing, and on the pressure exerted by the fluid in the tube, in order that the tracing may be best marked. This is shewn in Fig. 62, in which are given three tracings taken from the same Fig. 62. Pulse tracings from the same radial artery under die ferent pressures of the lever. The letters are explained iu a later part of the text. Taken with Dudgeon's sphygmograph. Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 277 radial artery with the same instrument , in the lower curve the pressure of the lever is too great, in the upper curve too small, to bring out the proper characters of the pulse ; these are seen more distinctly in the middle curve with a medium pressure. § 142. It will be observed that in Fig. 60, curve I., which is nearer the pump, rises more rapidly and rises higher than curve II., which is farther away from the pump ; that is to say, at the lever farther away from the pump the exiDansion is less and takes place more slowly than at the lever nearer the pump. Similarly in curve IV. the rise is still less, and takes place still less rapidly than in II., and the same change is seen still more marked in V. as compared with IV. In fact if a number of levers were placed at equal distances along the arterial tubing of the model, and the model were working properly, with an adequate peripheral resist- ance, we might trace out step by step how the expansion, as it travelled along the tube, got less and less in amount, and at the same time became more gradual in its development, the curve becoming lower and more flattened out, until, in the neighbourhood of the artificial capillaries, there was hardly any trace of it left. In other words, we might trace out step by step the gradual disappearance of the pulse. The same changes, the same gradual lowering and flattening of the curve, may be seen in natural pulse tracings ; compare, for instance, Fig. 63, which is a trac- ing from the dorsalis pedis artery, with the tracing from the radial artery Fig. 62, taken from the same individual with the same instrument on the same occasion. This feature is, of course, not ob- Fig- 63. Pulse tracixg from Dor- vious in all pulse-curves taken '^Dn'fo^J'.'LrsXl'er^"''''''^ from different individuals with different instruments and under varied circumstances ; but if a series of curves from different arteries were carefully taken under the same conditions, it would be found that the aortic tracing is higher and more sudden than the carotid tracing, which again is higher and more sudden than the radial tracing, the tibial tracing being in turn still lower and more flattened. The pulse-curve dies out by becoming lower and lower, and more and more flattened out. And a little consideration will shew us that this must be so. The systole of the ventricle drives a quantity of blood into the already full aorta. The sudden injection of this quantity of blood expands the portion of the aorta next to the heart, the part immediately adjacent to the semilunar valves beginning to expand first, and the expansion travelling thence on to the end of this portion. In the same way the expansion travels on from this portion through all the succeeding portions of the arterial system. 278 DISAPPEARAKCE OF PULSE. [Book i. For the total expansion required to make room for the new quantity of blood is not provided by that portion alone of the aorta into which the blood is actually received ; it is supplied by the whole arterial system : the old quantity of blood which is replaced by the new in this first portion has to find room for itself in the rest of the arterial space. As the expansion travels onward, however, the increase of pressure, which each portion transmits to the succeeding portion, will be less than that which it received from the preceding portion. For the whole increase of pressure due to the systole of the ventricle has to be distributed over the whole of the arterial system ; the general mean arterial pressure is, as we have seen, maintained by repeated systoles, and any one systole has to make its contribution to that mean pressure ; the increase of pressure which starts from the ventricle must there- fore leave behind at each stage of its progress a fraction of itself ; that is to say, the expansion is continually growing less, as the pulse travels from the heart to the capillaries. Moreover, while the expansion of the aorta next to the heart is, so to speak, the direct effect of the systole of the ventricle, the expansion of the more distant artery is the effect of the systole transmitted by the help of the elastic reaction of the arterial tract between the heart and the distant artery ; and since this elastic reaction is slower in development than the actual systole, the expansion of the more distant artery is slower than that of the aorta, the up-stroke of the pulse-curve is less sudden, and the whole pulse-curve is more flattened. The object of the systole is to supply a contribution to the mean pressure, and the pulse is an oscillation above and below that mean pressure, an oscillation which diminishes from the heart onwards, being damped by the elastic walls of the arteries, and so, little by little, converted into mean pressure until in the capillaries the mean pressure alone remains, the oscillations having dis- appeared. § 143. If in the model the points of the two levers at different distances from the pump be placed exactly one under the other on the recording surface, it is obvious that, the levers being alike except for their position on the tube, any difference in time between the movements of the two levers will be shewn by an interval between the beginnings of the curves they describe, the recording surface being made to travel sufficiently rapidly. If the movements of the two levers be thus compared, it will be seen that the far lever (Fig. 60, II.) commences later than the near one (Fig. 60, I.) ; the farther apart the two levers are, the greater is the interval in time between their curves. Compare the series I. to VI. (Fig. 60). In the same way it would be found that the rise of the near lever began some fraction of a second after the stroke of the pump. This means that the wave of expansion, the pulse-wave, takes some time to travel along the tube. Chap. iv.J THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 279 The velocity with which the pulse-wave travels depends chiefly on the amount of rigidity possessed by the tubing. The more extensible (with corresponding elastic reaction) the tube, the slower is the wave ; the more rigid the tube becomes, the faster the wave travels ; in a perfectly rigid tube, what in the elastic tube would be the pulse, becomes a mere shock travelling with very great rapidity. The width of the tube is of much less influence, though according to some observers the wave travels more slowly in the wider tubes. The rate at which the normal pulse-wave travels in the human body has been variously estimated at from 10 to 5 meters per second. In all probability we may take 6 meters as an average rate ; but it must be remembered that the rate may vary very considerably under different conditions. According to all observers the velocity of the wave in passing from the groin to the foot is greater than that in passing from the axilla to the wrist (6 m. against 5 m.). This is probably due to the fact that the femoral artery with its branches is more rigid than the axillary and its branches. So, also, the wave travels more slowly in the arteries of children than in the more rigid arteries of the adult. The velocity is also increased by circumstances which heighten, and decreased by those which lower the mean arterial pressure, since with increasing pressure the arterial walls become more, and with diminishing pressure less rigid. Probably also the velocity of the pulse-wave depends on conditions of the arterial walls, which we cannot adequately describe as mere differences in rigidity. In experimenting with artificial tubes it is found that different qualities of India rubber give rise to very different results. Care must be taken not to confound the progress of the pulse- wave, i.e. of the expansion of the arterial walls, with the actual onward movement of the blood itself. The pulse-wave travels over the moving blood somewhat as a rapidly moving natural wave travels along a sluggishly flowing river. Thus while the velocity of the pulse-wave is 6 or possibly even 10 meters per sec, that of the current of blood is not more than half a meter per sec, even in the large arteries, and is still less in the smaller ones. § 144. Referring again to the caution given above, not to regard the pulse-curve as a picture of the pulse-wave, we may now add that the pulse- wave is of very considerable length. If we know h ow long it takes for the pulse-wave to pass over any point in the arteries and how fast it is travelling, we can easily calculate the length of the wave. In an ordinary pulse-curve the artery, owing to the slow return, is seen not to regain the calibre which it had before the expansion, until just as the next expansion begins, that is to say, the pulse-wave takes the whole time of a cardiac cycle, viz. y^ths sec, to pass by the lever. Taking the velocity of the pulse- wave as 6 meters per sec, the length of the wave will be j^ths of 6 m., that is, nearly 5 metere And even if we took a smaller 280 VELOCITY OF PULSE WAVE. [Book i. estimate, by supposing that the real expansion and return of the artery at any point took much less time, say -^^th sec, the length of the pulse-wave would still be more than 2 meters. But even in the tallest man the capillaries farthest from the heart, those in the tips of the toes, are not 2 m. distant from the heart. In other words, the length of the pulse-wave is much greater than the whole length of the arterial system, so that the beginning of each wave has become lost in the small arteries and capillaries some time before the end of it has finally passed away from the beginning of the aorta. ■ We must now return to the consideration of certain special features in the pulse, which, from the indications they give or suggest of the condition of the vascular system, are often of great interest. § 145. Secondary waves. In nearly all pulse tracings, the curve of the expansion and recoil of the artery is broken by two, three, or several smaller elevations and depressions : secondary waves are imposed upon the fundamental or primary wave. In the sphygmographic tracing from the carotid, Fig. 64, and in many of the other tracings given, these secondary elevations are marked Fig. 64. Pulse tracing from carotid artery of healthy man (Moens). X, commencement of expansion of the artery. A, summit of the first rise. C, dicrotic secondary wave. B, predicrotic secondary wave ; p, notch preceding this. D, succeeding secondary wave. The curve above is that of a tuning-fork with ten double vibrations in a second. as B, C, D. When one such secondary elevation only is conspic- uous, so that the pulse-curve presents two notable crests only, the primary crest and a secondary one, the pulse is said to be " dicrotic " ; when two secondary crests are prominent, the pulse is often called " tricrotic " ; when several, " polycrotic." As a general rule, the secondary elevations appear only on the descending limb of the primary wave as in most of the curves given, and the curve is then spoken of as " katacrotic." Sometimes, however, the first elevation or crest is not the highest, but appears on the ascending portion of the main curve : such a curve is spoken of as " anacrotic " Fig. 65. As we have already seen (§ 134) the curve of pressure at the root of the aorta, and, indeed, that of endocardiac pressure may be in like manner " anacrotic " (Figs. 54, 55). Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 281 Of these secondary elevations, the most frequent, conspicuous, and important is the one which appears some way down on the descending limb, and is marked C on Fig. 64 and on most of the curves here given. It is more (jr less distinctly visible on all sphygmograms, and may be seen in those of the aorta as well as of other arteries. Sometimes it is so slight as to be hardly discernible ; at other times it may be so marked as Fig. 65 Anacrotic sphyg- to give rise to a really double pulse 'Z^^^:;;::;:!'' ^I^ (Fig. 66), i.e. a pulse which can be felt (Aneurism), as double by the finger : hence it has been called the dicrotic elevation or the dicrotic wave, the notch preceding the elevation being spoken of as the " dicrotic notch." f\ Fig. 66. Two grades of marked dicrotism in radial pulse of man. (Typhoid Fever.) Neither it nor any other secondary elevations can be recognized in the tracings of blood pressure taken with a mercury manometer. This may be explained, as we have said § 139, by the fact that the movements of the mercury column are too sluggish to repro- duce these finer variations. Moreover, when the normal pulse is felt by the finger, most persons find themselves unable to detect any dicrotism. But that it does really exist in the normal pulse is shewn by the fact that it appears, sometimes to a marked extent, sometimes to a less extent, not only in sphygmograms and in curves of arterial pressure taken by adequate instruments, but also and in a most unmistakeable manner in the tracing obtained by allowing the blood to spirt directly from an opened small artery, such as the dorsalis pedis, upon a recording surface. Less constant and conspicuous than the dicrotic wave, but yet appearing in most sphygmograms, is an elevation which appears higher up on the descending limb of the main wave; it is marked B in Fig. 64, and on several of the other curves, and is frequently called the predicrotic wave ; it may become very prominent. Some- times other secondary waves, often called ' post-dicrotic,' are seen following the dicrotic wave, as at D in Fig. 64, and some other curves ; but these are not often present, and usually even when present inconspicuous. When tracings are taken from several arteries, or from the same artery under different conditions of the body, these secondary waves are found to vary very considerably, giving rise to many 282 THE DICEOTIC WAVE. [Book i. characteristic forms of pulse-curve. Were we able with certainty to trace back the several features of the curves to their respective causes, an adequate examination of sphygmographic tracings would undoubtedly disclose much valuable information concerning the condition of the body presenting them. The problems, how- ever, of the origin of these secondary waves and of their variations are complex and difficult ; so much so that the detailed interpre- tation of a sphygmographic tracing is still in many cases and in many respects very uncertain. § 146. The Dicrotic Wave. The chief interest attaches to the nature and meaning of the dicrotic wave. In general the main conditions favouring the dicrotic wave are (1) a highly extensible and elastic arterial wall ; (2) a comparatively low mean pressure, leaving the extensible and elastic reaction of the arterial wall free scope to act ; and (3) a vigorous and rapid stroke of the ventricle, discharging into the aorta a considerable quantity of blood. The origin of this dicrotic wave has been and indeed still is much disputed. In the first place, observers are not agreed as to the part of the arterial system in which it first makes its appearance. In such a system as that of the arteries we have to deal with two kinds of waves. There are the waves which are generated at the pump, the heart, and travel thence onwards towards the periphery ; the primary pulse-wave due to the discharge of the contents of the ventricle is of this kind. But there may be other waves which, started somewhere in the periphery, travel backwards towards the central pump ; such are what are called ' reflected ' waves. For instance, when the tube of the artificial model, bear- ing two levers, is blocked just beyond the far lever, the primary wave is seen to be accompanied by a second wave, which at the far lever is seen close to, and often fused into, the primary wave (Fig. 60, VI. a'), but at the near lever is at some distance from it (Fig. 60, I. a'), being the farther from it the longer the interval between the lever and the block in the tube. The second wave is evidently the primary wave reflected at the block and travelling backwards towards the pump. It thus, of course, passes the far lever before the near one. And it has been argued that the dicrotic wave of the pulse is really such a reflected wave, started either at the minute arteries and capillaries, or at the several points of bifurcation of the arteries, and travelling backwards to the aorta. But if this were the case the distance between the primary crest and the dicrotic crest ought to be less in arteries more distant from, than in those nearer to the heart, just as in the artificial scheme the reflected wave is fused with a primary wave near the block (Fig. 60, VI. 6 a. a'), but becomes more and more separated from it the farther back towards the pump we trace it (Fig. 60, I. 1. a. a'). Now this is not the case with the dicrotic Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHxVNISM. 283 wave. Careful measurements shew that the distance between the primary and dicrotic crests is either the same or certainly not less in the smaller or more distant arteries than in the larger or nearer ones. This feature indeed proves that the dicrotic wave cannot be due to reflection at the periphery or, indeed, in any way a retrograde wave. Besides, the multitudinous peripheral division would probably render one large, peripherically reiiected wave im- possible. Again, the more rapidly the primary wave is obliterated or at least diminished on its way to the periphery, the less conspicuous should be the dicrotic wave. Hence, increased extensibility and increased elastic reaction of the arterial walls which tend to use up rapidly the primary wave, should also lessen the dicrotic wave. But, as a matter of fact, these conditions, as we have said, are favourable to the prominence of the dicrotic wave. We may conclude, then, that the dicrotic wave, like the primary wave, begins at the heart and travels thence towards the periph- ery. But even if this be admitted, observers are not agreed as to the mechanism of its production. As we stated (§ 134) there seemed to be evidence that the ventricle discharged its contents so rapidly that during the latter part of the systole it remained contracted though empty. In accordance with this view, the following explanation of the development of the dicrotic wave has been given. When a rapid flow of fluid through a tube is suddenly stopped, a negative pressure makes its appearance behind the column of fluid ; owing to its momentum the fluid tends to move onward, though there is now no following fluid to take its place. The sudden cessation of the flow from the ventricle, due to the ventricle being suddenly emptied, must, it is argued, lead to a similar negative pressure ; and, indeed, as we have said, the negative pressure which may be observed in the ventricle has, by some, been referred to this cause. In a rigid tube such a negative pressure simply leads to a reflux of fluid ; when the tap of a running water supply is suddenly turned off, the click which is heard is caused by the fluid being thus brought back against the tap. In a thin, collapsible tube, again, such a negative pressure simply leads to a collapse of the tube near the tap. But in an elastic tube, like the aorta, the effects of such a negative pressure are complicated by those of the elastic action and the inertia of the walls of the tube. Upon the sudden cessation of the flow from the ventricle, the expansion of the aorta ceases, the vessel begins to shrink. This shrinking is in part due to the elastic reaction of the walls of the aorta, but is increased by the " suction " action of the negative pressure. In thus shrinking, however, under these combined causes, the aorta, through the inertia of its walls, and of the contained blood is carried too far, it shrinks too much, and in consequence, the negative pressure moreover having by this time passed away, begins to expand again. 284 THE DICROTIC WAVE. [Book i. But this secondary expansion in turn gives place in a similar manner to another shrinking, and indeed may, in a similar manner, be followed by still other oscillations. And, though the predi- crotic wave, when it occurs, presents difficulties which we cannot now discuss, the dicrotic wave may on this view be regarded as the main secondary expansion so originating. As we urged, however, in § 134, the arguments which led to the view that the ventricle, in a normal beat, discharges the whole of its contents before it has finished its contraction do not appear to be valid. We saw reason to think that the flow from the ventricle into the aorta ceases because the contraction of the ventricle ceases, and not because there is no more blood to be discharged. Hence, there is no need to appeal to a suddenly developed negative pressure, such as that upon which the foregoing explanation is based, and that explanation in consequence falls to the ground. On the other hand, the simultaneous curves of endocardiac and aortic pressure (Fig. 55 and others) shew us that the end of the sys- tole is, in a normal beat, coincident with the dicrotic notch, as it is called, with the depression immediately preceding the dicrotic wave. The curve of the differential manometer further shews us that this is the point at which the pressure in the ventricle begins to become less than in the aorta. We may, therefore, adopt the following explanation of the dicrotic wave. The flow from the ventricle into the aorta ceases because the systole ceases ; the cessation takes place while the two cavities are still open to each other, and probably, in most cases at least, while there is still more or less blood in the ventricle. The pressure in the ventricle tends to become less than that in the aorta, and the blood in the aorta tends to flow back into the ventricle. But the first effect of this is to close firmly the semilunar valves. The expansion of the aorta (which in many cases had been lessening even during the systole, owing to the flow through the periphery of the arterial system being more rapid than the flow from the ventricle, but in some cases, in the anacrotic instances, had not) lessens with the cessation of the flow ; the aorta shrinks, pressing upon its con- tents. But part of this pressure is spent on the closed semilunar valves, and the resistance offered by these starts a new wave of expansion, the dicrotic wave, which travels thence onwards towards the periphery in the wake of the primary wave. If we admit that the blood is flowing from the ventricle during the whole of the systole, we must also admit that the semilunar valves do not close until the end of the systole, and this being, as shewn by the curves, just antecedent to the dicrotic wave, we may attribute this wave to the rebound from the closed valves. It is not necessary that the valves should act perfectly, and the dicrotic wave may occur in cases where the valves are more or less incompetent ; all that is required for its production is an adequate CiiAP. IV. J THE VASCULAK MECHANISM. 285 obstacle to the return of blood from the tujrta to the ventricle, and without such an obstacle the circulation could not be carried on. § 147. Moreover, it must be remembered that though we may thns regard the closed valves as so to speak the determining cause of the dicrotic wave, the wave itself is an oscillation of the arterial walls, and the remarks made a little while back concerning the inertia of the walls hold good for this explanation also. Hence the conditions which determine the prominence or otherwise of the dicrotic wave, are conditions relating to the elasticity of the arterial walls, and to the circumstances which call that elasticity into play. For instance, the dicrotic wave is less marked in rigid arteries (such as those of old people) than in healthy elastic ones ; the rigid wall neither expands so readily nor shrinks so readily, and hence does not so readily give rise to secondary waves. Again, the dicrotic wave is, other things being equal, more marked when the mean arterial pressure is low than when it is high ; indeed, it may be induced when absent, or increased when slightly marked, by diminishing, in one way or another, the mean pressure. Now when the pressure is high, the arteries are kept continually much expanded, and are therefore the less capable of further expansion, that is to say, are, so far, more rigid. Hence the additional expansion due to the systole is not very great ; there is a less tendency for the arterial walls to swing backwards and forwards, so to speak, and hence a less tendency to the development of secondary waves. When the mean pressure is low, the opposite state of things exists ; supposing, of course, that the ventricular stroke is adequately vigorous (the low pressure being due, not to a diminished cardiac stroke, but to diminished peripheral resistance), the relatively empty but highly distensible artery is rapidly expanded, and, falling rapidly back, enters upon a secondary (dicrotic) expansion, and may even exhibit a third. Moreover, the same principles may be applied to explain why sometimes dicrotism will appear marked in a particular artery while it remains little marked in the rest of the system. In experimenting with an artificial tubing such as the arterial model, the physical characters of which remain the same throughout, both the primary and the secondary waves retain the same characters as they travel along the tubing, save only that both gradually diminish towards the periphery ; and in the natural circulation, when the vascular conditions are fairly uniform throughout, the pulse-curve, as a rule, possesses the same general characters throughout, save that it is gradually ' damped off.' But suppose we were to substitute for the first section of the tubing a piece of perfectly rigid tubing ; this at the stroke of the pump, on account of its being rigid, would shew neither primary nor secondary expansion, but the expanding force of the pump's stroke would be transmitted throuQ-h it to the second, elastic 286 THE DICEOTIC WAVE. [Book i. section, and heie the primary and secondary waves would at once become evident This is an extreme case, but the same thing would be seen to a less degree in passing from a more rigid, that is, less extensible and elastic section, to a less rigid, more exten- sible and elastic section ; the primary and secondary expansions, in spite of the general damping effect, would suddenly increase. Similarly in the living body a pulse-curve which so long as it is travelling along arteries in which the mean pressure is high, and which are therefore practically somewhat rigid, is not markedly dicrotic, may become very markedly dicrotic when it comes to a particular artery, in which the mean pressure is low (we shall see presently that such a case may occur), and the walls of which are therefore for the time being relatively more distensible than the rest. Lastly, we may recall the observation made about § 141 that the curve of expansion of an elastic tube is modified by the pres- sure exerted by the lever employed to record it, and that hence, in the same artery, and with the same instrument, the size, form, and even the special features of the curve vary according to the amount of pressure with which the lever is pressed upon the artery. Accordingly the amount of dicrotism apparent in a pulse may be modified by the pressure exerted by the lever. In Fig. 62, for instance, the dicrotic wave is more evident in the middle than in the upper tracing. § 148. Concerning the other secondary waves on the pulse- curve, such as that which has been called the ' predicrotic ' wave {B on Fig. 64 and on some of the other pulse-curves), it will not be desirable to say much here. They have been the occasion of much discussion, especially when considered under the view that the ven- tricle rapidly emptied itself at the earlier part of the systole. We will content ourselves with the following remark. The predicrotic and the other secondary waves in question are, like the dicrotic wave, propagated from the heart towards the periphery, they are seen in sphygmograms taken from the root of the aorta as well as from more peripheral arteries, and some are also seen in the curves of ventricular pressure. Some of the features of these secondary waves may be due to imperfections in the instruments used, to inertia and the like, but the main features undoubtedly represent events taking place in the vascular system itself. When we com- pare the curve of pressure in the aorta with that in the ventricle, we observe that up to the dicrotic notch, (in what may be called the systolic part of the pulse-curve, the part which corresponds to the systole of the ventricle, in contrast to the diastolic part which follows and which includes the dicrotic wave), the variations seen in the aortic curve, the secondary waves of which we are speaking, are exactly reproduced in the ventricular curve. And it has, with considerable reason, been urged that both in the aorta (and so in the other arteries) and in the ventricle they are due to events taking Chap. iv.J THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 287 place in the ventricle, the systole, for instance, not being equally sustained. We may furtlier call once to mind the fact to which we have already called attention that, while sometimes the curve of ven- tricular pressure reaches its maximum at the very beginning of the systole, declining more or less slowly afterwards, at other times the maximum is reached at the end of the systole, the curve of pressure being anacrotic ; we may add that the maximum may also occur at any intermediate point. Further, and this is the matter to which we wish to call attention, the curve of aortic pressure follows that of the ventricular pressure, both being kata- crotic or anacrotic as the case may be. As we have urged, the anacrotic curve is seen when the peripheral resistance is such that, for some time during the systole, the flow from the aorta towards the periphery is slower than the flow from the ventricle into the aorta. Such a condition is apt to be met with when the arteries are more rigid than normal, and under these circumstances the anacrotic characters of the pulse may become prominent. § 149. Venous Pulse. Under certain circumstances the pulse may be carried on from the arteries through the capillaries into the veins. Thus, as we shall see later on, when the salivary gland is actively secreting, the blood may issue from the gland through the veins in a rapid, pulsating stream. The nervous events which give rise to the secretion of saliva, lead at the same time, by the agency of vaso-motor nerves, of which we shall presently speak, to a widen- ing of the small arteries of the gland. When the gland is at rest, the minute arteries are, as we shall see, somewhat constricted and narrowed, and thus contribute largely to the peripheral resistance in the part ; this peripheral resistance throws into action the elastic properties of the small arteries leading to the gland, and the remnant of the pulse reaching these arteries is, as we before explained, finally destroyed. When the minute arteries are dilated, their widened channels allow the blood to flow more easily through them and with less friction ; the peripheral resistance which they normally offer is thus lessened. In consequence of this, the elasti- city of the walls of the small arteries is brought into play to a less extent than before, and these small arteries cease to do their share in destroying the pulse which comes down to them from the larger arteries. As in the case of the artificial model, wiiere the ' peripheral ' tiibing is kept open, not enough elasticity is brought into play to convert the intermittent arterial flow into a con- tinuous one, and the pulse which reaches the arteries of the gland passes on through them and through the capillaries, and is con- tinued on into the veins. A similar venous pulse is also some- times seen in other organs. Careful tracings of the great veins in the neighbourhood of the heart shew elevations and depressions, which appear due to the variations of endocardiac pressure, and which may perhaps be 288 THE VENOUS PULSE. [Book i. spoken of as constituting a ' venous pulse,' though they have a quite different origin from the venous pulse just described in the salivary gland. In such a pulse it is the depression of the wave, not the elevation, which corresponds to the systole of the ventricle, the pulse-wave is the negative of the arterial pulse-wave ; the matter, however, needs further study. In cases again of insufficiency of the tricuspid valves, the systole of the ventricle makes itself distinctly felt in the great veins ; and an expansion travelling backwards from the heart becomes very visible in the veins of the neck. This, in which the elevation of the wave like that of the arterial pulse-wave corresponds to the ventricular systole, is also spoken of as a venous pulse. Variations of pressure in the great veins due to the respiratory movements are also sometimes spoken of as a venous pulse ; the nature of these variations will be explained in treating of respi- ration. SEC. 5. THE EEGULATION AND ADAPTATION OF THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. The Regulation of the Beat of the Heart. § 150. So far the facts with which we have had to deal, with the exception of the heart's beat itself, have been simply physical facts. All the essential phenomena which we have studied may be reproduced on a dead model. Such an unvarying mechanical vascular system would, however, be useless to a living body whose actions were at all complicated. The prominent feature of a living mechanism is the power of adapting itself to changes in its in- ternal and external circumstances. In such a system as we have sketched above there would be but scanty power of adaptation. The well-constructed machine might work with beautiful regu- larity ; but its regularity would be its destruction. The same quantity of blood would always flow in the same steady stream through each and every tissue and organ, irrespective of local and general wants. The brain and the stomach, whether at work and needing much, or at rest and needing little, would receive their ration of blood, allotted with a pernicious monotony. Just the same amount of blood would pass through the skin on the hottest as on the coldest day. The canon of the life of every part for the whole period of its existence would be furnished by the inborn diameter of its blood vessels, and by the unvarying motive power of the heart. Such a rigid system, however, does not exist in actual living beings. The vascular mechanism in all animals in which it is present is capable of local and general modifications, adapting it to local and general changes of circumstance. These modifications fall into two great classes : 1. Changes in the heart's beat. These, being central, have, of course, a general effect; they influence or may influence the whole body. ]9 290 HISTOLOGY OE THE HEART. [Book i. 2. Changes in the peripheral resistance, due to variations in the calibre of the minute arteries, brought about by the agency of their contractile muscular coats. These changes may be either local, affecting a particular vascular area only, or general, affecting all or nearly all the blood vessels of the body. These two classes of events are chieiiy governed by the nervous system. It is by means of the nervous system that the heart's beat and the calibre of the minute arteries are brought into relation with each other, and with almost every part of the body. It is by means of the nervous system acting either on the heart, or on the small arteries, or on both, that a change of circumstances affecting either the whole or a part of the body is met by compensating or regulative changes in the flow of blood. It is by means of the nervous system that the tide of blood through the skin rises and ebbs with the rise and fall of the temperature of the air, that the work of the heart is tempered to meet the strain of overfull arteries, and that the arterial gates open and shut as the force of the central pump waxes and wanes. And though, as we shall see, it is not clear that the central nervous system always intervenes in order that an organ may have a more full supply of blood when at work than when at rest, it undoubtedly does so in some cases. The study of these changes becomes, therefore, to a large extent a study of nervous actions. The circulation may also be modified by events not belonging to either of the above two classes. Thus, in this or that peripheral area, changes in the capillary walls and the walls of the minute arteries and veins may lead to an increase of the tendency of the blood corpuscles to adhere to the vascular walls, and so, quite apart from any change in the calibre of the blood vessels, may lead to increase of the peripheral resistance. This is seen in an extreme case in inflammation, but may possibly intervene to a less extent in the ordinary condition of the circulation, and may also be under the influence of the nervous system. Further, any decided change in the quantity of blood actually in circulation must also influence the working of the vascular mechanism. But both these changes are unimportant compared with the other two kinds of changes. Hence, the two most important problems for us to study are, 1, how the nervous system regulates the beat of the heart, and 2, how the nervous system regulates the calibre of the blood vessels. We will first consider the former problem. The Histology of the Heart. § 151. It will be necessary now to take up certain points concerning the minute structure of the heart, which we had previously postponed ; and since much of our knowledge of the Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 291 nervous mechanism of the beat of the heart is derived from ex- periments on the hearts of cold blooded animals, more particularly of the frofT, it will be desirable to consider these as well as the mammalian heart. Cardiac Muscular Tissue. The ventricle of the frog's heart is composed of minute, spindle-shaped tibres or fibre cells, each containing a nucleus in its middle, and tapering to a point at each end , sometimes, however, the end is forked or even branched. These fibres or fibre cells, in fact, resemble plain muscular fibres save that they are somewhat larger and that their substance is striated. The striation is due, like the striation of a skeletal muscle fibre, to alternate dim and bright bands, but is rarely so distinct as in a skeletal fibre ; it is very apt to be obscured by the presence of dispersed discrete granules, which, in many cases, at all events, are of a fatty nature. Like the plain muscular fibre, the cardiac muscular fibre has no distinct sarcolemma. A number of these fibres are joined by cement substance into small bundles, and these bundles are, by help of connective tissue which carries no blood vessels, woven into an intricate network or sponge work, which forms the greater part of the wall of the ventricle. Immediately under the pericardial coating, consisting of a layer of epithelioid plates resting on a connective tissue basis, the muscular tissue forms a thin, continuous sheet, but within this it spreads out into a sponge work, the meshes of which present a labyrinth of passages continuous with the cavity of the ventricle. The bars of this sponge work, varying in thickness and, though apparently irregular, arranged on a definite system, consist of bundles of muscular fibres united by connective tissue, and are coated with the same endocardial membrane (flat epithelioid plates resting on a connective tissue basis) that lines the cavity of the ventricle, and, indeed, the whole interior of the heart. The cavity of the ventricle, in other words, opens out into a labyrinth of passages reaching nearly to the surface of the ventricle. When the ventricle is relaxed, blood flows freely into and fills this labyrinth, bathing the bars of the sponge work, which, in the absence of capillaries, depend on this blood for their nourish- ment. When the ventricle contracts, the blood is driven out of this labyrinth as well as out of the central cavity. Hence the ventricle when dilated and full of blood is of a deep red colour, when contracted and empty is extremely pale, having little more than the colour of the muscular fibres themselves, which, like striated fibres, possess in their own substance a certain amount of haemoglobin or of myolu\nnatin. The much thinner walls of the auricle consist of a much thinner network of similar fibres, united by a relatively larger quantity of connective tissue into a thin sheet, with the pericardial mem- brane on the outside and the endocardial membrane on the inside. The fibres have in the auricle a much greater tendency to be 292 CARDIAC MUSCULAR TISSUE. [Book i. branched, and many, ceasing to be spindle-shaped, become almost stellate. Among the obscurely striated, but still striated fibres, are found ordinary, plain muscular fibres, which increase in relative number along the roots of the veins, venae cavse and pulmonales, until at some little distance from the heart plain muscular fibres only are found. Blood vessels are absent from the walls of the auricles also. In the bulbus arteriosus, mixed up with much connective and elastic tissue, are found fusiform fibres which close to the ventricle are striated and form a thick layer, but at a certain distance from the ventricle lose their striation, or rather become mixed with plain muscular fibres, and form a thinner layer. § 152. In the mammal, both the ventricles and the auricles are formed of bundles of muscular tissue, bound together by con- nective tissue, and arranged more especially in the ventricles in a very complex system of sheets or bands disposed as spirals, and in other ways, the details of which need not detain us. In the auricular appendices, and elsewhere, the bundles form irregular networks projecting into the cavities. The connective tissue binding the muscular fibres together, unlike the corresponding connective tissue in the frog's heart, is well supplied with blood vessels belonging to the coronary system. This connective tissue forms on the inner surface of the cavities a continuous sheet, the connective tissue basis of the flat epithelioid cells of the endocardium, and on the outside of the heart the visceral layer of the pericardium. The histological unit of these muscular bundles is neither a fibre nor a fusiform fibre cell, but a more or less columnar or prismatic nucleated cell generally provided with one or more short broad processes. The nucleus, which is oval and in general resembles one of the nuclei of a striated fibre, is placed at about the middle of the cell with its long axis in the line of the long diameter of the cell. The cell-body, which is not bounded by any definite sarcolemma, is striated, though obscurely so, across the long diameter of the cell, the striations as in a skeletal muscle fibre being due to the alternation of dim and bright bands. As in the frog's heart granules are frequently abundant, obscuring the striation, which, indeed, even in the absence of granules is never so distinct as in the fibres of skeletal muscles. Such a cell is at each end joined by cement substance to similar cells, and a row of such cells constitutes a cardiac elementary fibre. Hence a cardiac fibre is a fibre striated, but without sarcolemma, and divided by parti- tions of cement substance into somewhat elongated divisions or cells, each containing a nucleus. Many of the cells in a fibre have a short, broad, lateral process. Such a process is united by cement substance to a similar process of a cell belonging to an adjoining fibre ; and by the union of a number of these processes, a number of fibres lying side by side are formed into a somewhat close Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 293 network. Each bundle of the cardiac muscular tissue is thus itself a network. These bundles are further woven into networks by connective tissue in which run capillaries and larger blood vessels ; and sheets or bundles composed of such networks are arranged, as we have said, in a complex manner both in the auricle and ventricle Hence, the muscular substance of the mammalian heart is, at bottom, an exceedingly complex network, the element of which is a somewhat branched nucleated striated cell. It may be remarked that the ' musculi pectinati ' of the auricle and the ' columnie carnepe ' of the ventricle suggest the origin of the mammalian heart from a muscular labyrinth like that of the frog's ventricle. At the commencement of the great arteries this peculiar cardiac muscular tissue ceases abruptly, being replaced by the ordinary structures of an artery, but the striated muscular fibres of the auricle may be traced for some distance along both the vena3 cavpe and venae pulmonales. Under the endocardium are frequently present ordinary plain muscular fibres, and in some cases peculiar cells are found in this situation, the cells of Purkinjd, which are interesting morpho- logically, because the inner part of the cell round the nucleus is unstriated, undifferentiated material while the outside is striated substance. Plain muscular fibres are said also to spread from the endocardium for a certain distance into the auriculo-ventricular valves. § 153. The Nerves of the Heart. The distribution of nerves in the heart varies a good deal in different vertebrate animals, but nevertheless a general plan may be more or less distinctly recognised. The vertebrate heart may be regarded as a muscular tube (a single tube, if for the moment we disregard the complexity of a double circulation occurring in the higher animals) divided into a series of chambers, sinus venosus (or junction of great veins), auricle, ventricle and bulbus (or conus) arteriosus. The nerves as a rule enter the heart at the venous end of this tube, at the sinus venosus, and pass on towards the arterial end, diminish- ing in amount as they proceed, and disappearing at the aorta. Connected with the nerve fibres thus passing to the heart are groups, smaller or greater, of nerve cells. These, like the nerve fibres, are most abundant at the venous end (appearing on the nerve branches before these actually reach the heart), as a rule become fewer towards the arterial end, and finally disappear, so that (according to most observers) at the bulbus (conus) arteriosus they are entirely absent. These collections of nerve cells or ganglia may be arranged in groups according to their position. In many lower vertebrates there is a distinct ring or collar of ganglia at the junction of the sinus venosus with the auricle, where the primitive circular disposition of muscular fibres is maintained ; and there is a 294 THE NEEVES OF THE HEART. [Book i. similar ganglionic collar at the junction of the auricle with the ventricle, where also there is similarly retained a circular dis- position of the muscular fibres forming the so-called canahs auri- cularis. And, indeed, in all vertebrates two similar collections of ganglia are more or less distinctly present. There are ganglia at the junction of the sinus with the auricle and along the entering nerve branches ; these may be called the sinus ganglia. There are other ganglia at the junction of the auricle and ven- tricle ; these may be called the auriculo-ventricular ganglia. Besides these two groups there are also ganglia over the auricle in connection with nerves passing from the sinus to the ventricle. Lastly, as a general rule the main nerve branches and the ganglia are not plunged deep in the substance of the heart, but are placed superficially, immediately under the pericardial layer. From the cells and nerves so situated finer branches and fibres pass to the substance of the heart. Bearing this general plan in mind we may now turn to the special arrangements which obtain in the frog and in the mammal. In the Frog. The only nerves going to the heart are the two vagus nerves, right and left, which may be seen running along the two superior vense cavse, but become lost to view at the sinus where they pass from the surface to deeper parts. Each vagus is not, however, simply a vagus nerve, but, as we shall see, contains fibres derived from the sympathetic system. As the nerves approach the sinus, groups of nerve cells become abundant in connection with the fibres, and as the fibres spread out at the sinus many ganglia are scattered among them, forming what is called as a whole the sinus ganglion or the ganglion of Remak. From the sinus the two vagus nerves, leaving their position under the pericardium, plunge into the heart and run along the septum between the auricles, on the left side of the septum, one, the anterior nerve, passing nearer the front of the heart than the other, the posterior. Several groups of cells, or small ganglia, are connected with the two ' septal ' nerves thus passing along the septum. The nerves, reaching the auriculo-ventricular ring on the an- terior side of the heart, end in two ganglia lying at the base of the two large auriculo-ventricular valves. From these two ganglia, Bidder's ganglia- or the auriculo- ventricular ganglia, nerve fibres pass into the substance of the ventricle. Nerve cells may be traced on the fibres going to the ventricle for some little distance, but for a little distance only ; over the greater part of the ventricle, the lower two-thirds for instance, the nerve fibres are free from nerve cells. Thus in the frog there are two main ganglia, sinus or Eemak's ganglion, auriculo-ventricular or Bidder's ganglia. From the former there pass on the one hand scattered fibres, in connection Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 295 with which are small groups of cells, to the auricular walls, and to the sinus walls, and on the other hand the two main nerves running along the septum, in connection with which are small ganglia, which may be called ' septal ' ganglia. From the latter, Bidder's ganglia, filjres unaccompanied except for a short distance by nerve cells, pass to the substance of the ventricle, and possibly to the bulbus arteriosus. The fibres forming the vagus nerves as they run along the superior vense cav?e are composed of medullated and non-medul- lated fibres, the latter being chiefly if not wholly derived from the sympathetic system. Many of the medullated fibres lose their medulla in Remak's gan^rlion, for non-medullated fibres are found DO ' in much larger proportion in the septal nerves, running to Bidder's ganglia ; the fine fibres which pass from Bidder's ganglia . to the substance of the ventricle are exclusively non-medullated fibres. The nerve cells in the sinus ganglia and along the ends of the vagus nerves, as well as some of the cells of the ganglia scattered over the septum, are of the kind previously (§ 98) described as spiral cells. The cells composing Bidder's ganglia, as well as many of the cells in the septum, are said to be bipolar and fusiform. In the mammal, the nerves going to the heart are derived on the one hand from the vagus and on the other hand from the sympathetic chain. Thus in man the upper, middle and lower cervical ganglia (or the cord between them) give off the upper lower and middle sympathetic cardiac nerves respectively, while the trunk of the vagus gives off cervical cardiac branches in the neck and thoracic branches in the thorax ; the recurrent laryngeal also gives off branches especially on the left side, and there is as well a cardiac branch of the external division of the superior laryngeal. The nerves from these two sources, vagal and sym- pathetic, form near the roots of the aorta and pulmonary artery, the cardiac plexuses, superficial and deep, the two sources mingling largely here and also, to a certain extent, before the plexuses are reached. From the plexuses fibres are given off to all parts of the heart, venie cavte, pulmonary veins, auricles and ventri- cles, a large number of the fibres destined for the latter forming the coronary plexuses around the coronary arteries ; some of the fibres pass to the walls of the aorta and pulmonary artery. In other mammals we find the same double supply reaching the heart by means of the cardiac plexuses, the details differing in different animals ; we shall give, later on, some details concerning the dog, since much of our knowledge of the nervous working of the mammalian heart has been gained by experiments on this animal. Ganglia are abundant on the superior vena cava and are also found on the pulmonary veins, in the walls of the auricles, in the auriculo-ventricular groove and in the basal portion of the ventricles ; further, according to some observers, in contrast to 296 THE NERVES OF THE HEART. [Book i. the frog's heart, a number of small ganglia may be observed over a large part of the ventricle far down towards the apex. The auricular septum, at least in its central parts, is said to be free from ganglia. The nerves and ganglia lie for the most part superficial immediately under the pericardium. The fibres passing to the heart are, as in the frog, both medullated and non-medullated Some of the medullated fibres are of fine calibre, may be traced back to the vagus, and appear to be fibres of which we shall speak presently as inhibitory. Others of the medullated fibres are of larger calibre, and some of these, at all events, appear to be sensory or at least afferent in function. Of the non-medullated fibres, some may be traced back along the cardiac nerves to the sympathetic system ; of these some again are of the kind we shall speak of as augmenting, Though, as in the frog, the proportion of non-medullated to medullated fibres increases peripherally, yet in contrast to the frog many of the fibres in the ventricle (where they lie close under the peri- cardium), are medullated ; it is probable that these are afferent fibres. The cells forming the various ganglia scattered over the mammalian heart may perhaps be classed as unipolar, and multipolar, the former being especially connected with medullated fibres, the one class being prominent in one situation, the other in another. The Development of the Normal Beat. § 154. The heart of a mammal oi of a warm blooded animal generally ceases to beat within a few minutes after being removed from the body in the ordinary way, the hearts of newly-born animals continuing, however, to beat for a longer time than those of adults. Hence, though by special precautions and by means of an artificial circulation of blood, an isolated mammalian heart may be preserved in a pulsating condition for a much longer time, our knowledse of the exact nature and of the causes of the cardiac beat is as yet very largely based on the study of the hearts of cold blooded animals, which will continue to beat for hours, or, under favourable circumstances, even for days, after they have been removed from the body with only ordinary care. We have reason to think that the mechanism by which the beat is carried on varies in some of its secondary features in different kinds of animals : that the hearts, for instance, of the eel, the snake, the tortoise and the frog, differ in some minor details of behaviour, both from each other and from those of the bird and of the mammal ; but we may, at first at all events, take the heart of the frog as illustrating the main and important truths concerning the causes and mechanism of the beat. Chap. IV.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 297 In studying closely the phenomena of the beat of the heart it becomes necessary to obtain a graphic record of the A'arious movements. 1. In the frog, or other cold blooded animal, a light lever may be placed directly on the ventricle (or on an auricle, &c.), and changes of form, due either to distension by the influx of blood, or to the systole, will cause movements of the lover, which may be recorded on a travel- ling surface. The same method as we have seen may be applied to the mammalian heart. 2. Or, as in Gaskell's method, the heart may be fixed by a clamp carefully adjusted round the auriculo-ventricular groove, while the apex of the ventricle and some portion of one auricle are attached by threads to horizontal levers, placed respectively above and below the heart. The auricle and the ventricle each in its systole pulls at the lever attached to it ; and the times and extent of the contractions may thus be recorded. Or the thread may be attached to the apex of the ven- tricle only, the heart being fixed by the aorta or left in position in the body. 3. A record of endo-cardiac pressure may be taken in the frog or tortoise, as in the mammal, by means of an appropriate manometer. And in these animals, at all events, it is easy to keep up an artificial circulation. A cannula is introduced into the sinus venosus, and another into the ventricle through the aorta. Serum or dilute blood (or any other fluid which it may be desired to employ) is driven by moderate pressure through the former ; to the latter is attached a tube connected by means of a side piece with a small mercury or other manometer. So long as the exit-tube is open at the end, fluid flows freely through the heart and apparatus. Upon closing the exit-tube at its far end, the force of the ventricular systole is brought to bear on the manometer, the index of which registers in the usual way. Newell Martin has succeeded in applying a modification of this method to the mammalian heart. 4. The movements of the ventricle may be regis- tered by introducing into it, through the auriculo- ventricular orifice, a so-called ' perfusion ' cannula, Figs. 67 and 68 1., with a double tube, one inside the other, and tying the ventricle on to the cannula at the auriculo-ventricular groove, or at any level below that which may be desired. The blood or other fluid is driven at an adequate pressure through the- tube a, enters the ventricle, and returns by the tube h. If b be connected with a manometer, as in method 3, the movements of the ventricle may be registered. j-j^ ,-,- j^ p^.^. FLSiox Cannula. 5. In the apparatus of Eoy, Fig. 68 II., the exit- tube is free, but the ventricle (the same method may be adojited for the whole heart) is placed in an air-tight chamber, filled with oil, or partly with normal salijie solution and partly with oil. By means of the tube h the interior of the chamber a is continuous with that of a small cylinder c, in which a piston d, secured by thin, flexible, animal membrane, works 298 GRAPHIC EECORD OF HEART BEAT. [Book i. up and down. The piston again bears on a lever e by means of which its movements may be registered. When the ventricle contracts, and by contracting diminishes in volume, there is a lessening of pressure in Fig. 68. Purely diagrammatic figures of I. Perfusion cannula tied into frog's ventricle, a, entrance, h, exit-tube ; a, wall of ventricle ; )3, ligature, II. Roy's apparatus modified by Gaskell. a, chamber filled with saline solution and oil, containing the ventricle a tied on to the profusion cannula/; h, tube leading to cylinder c, in which moves piston d, working the lever e. the interior of the chamber ; this is transmitted to the cylinder, and the piston correspondingly rises, carrying with it the lever. As the ventricle subsequently becomes distended, the pressure in the chamber is increased, and the piston and lever sink. In this way variations in the volume of the ventricle may be recorded, without any great inter- ference with the flow of blood or fluid through it. The heart of the frog, as we have just said, will contiime to beat for hours after removal from the body, even though the cavi- ties have been cleared of blood, and, indeed, when they are almost empty of all fluid. The beats thus carried out are in all import- ant respects identical with the beats executed by the heart in its normal condition within the living body. Hence we may infer that the beat of the heart is an automatic action : the muscular contractions which constitute the beat are due to causes which arise spontaneously in the heart itself. In the frog's heart, as in that of the mammal, § 126, there is a distinct sequence of events which is the same whether the heart be removed from, or be still in its normal condition within the body. First comes the beat of the sinus venosus, preceded by a more or less peristaltic contraction of the large veins leading into it ; next follows the sharp beat of the two auricles together ; then comes the longer beat of the ventricle ; and lastly the cycle is completed by the Chap. ly.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 290 beat of the biilbus arteriosus, which does not, like the mamraaliaQ aorta, simply recoil by elastic reaction after distension by the ventricular stroke, but carries out a distinct muscular contraction passing in a wave from the ventricle outwards. When the heart in dying ceases to beat, the several movements cease, as a rule, in an order the inverse of the above. Omitting the bulbus arteriosus, which sometimes exhibits great rhythmical power, we may say that first the ventricle fails, then the auricles fail, and lastly the sinus venosus fails. The heart, after it has ceased to beat spontaneously, remains for some time irritable, that is, capable of executing a beat, or a short series of beats, when stimulated either mechanically, as by touching it with a blunt needle, or electrically, by an induction shock or in other ways. The artificial beat so called forth may be in its main features identical with the natural beat, all the divisions of the heart taking part in the beat, and the sequence of events being the same as in the natural beat. Thus, when the sinus is pricked, the beat of the sinus may be followed by a beat of the auricles and of the ventricle ; and even when the ventricle is stimulated, the directly following beat of the ventricle may be succeeded by a complete beat of the whole heart. Under certain circumstances, however, the division directly stimulated is the only one to beat ; when the ventricle is pricked, for instance, it alone may beat, or when the sinus is pricked it alone may beat. The results of stimulation, moreover, may differ according to the condition of the heart, and according to the particular spot to which the stimulus is applied. With an increasing loss of irritability, the response to stimula- tion ceases in the several divisions in the same order as that of the failure of the natural beat ; the ventricle ceases to respond first, then the auricles, and lastly the sinus venosus, which frequently responds to stimulation long after the other divisions have ceased to make any sign. It would appear as if the sinus venosus, auricles, and ventricle formed a descending series in respect to their irritability, and to the power they possess of carrying on spontaneous rhythmic beats, the sinus being the most potent. This is also seen in the following experiments. In order that the frog's heart may beat after removal from the body with the nearest approach in rapidity, regularity, and endur- ance to the normal condition, the removal must be carried out so that the excised heart still retains the sinus venosus intact. When the incision is carried through the auricles so as to leave the sinus venosus behind in the body, the result is different. The sinus venosus beats forcibly and regularly, having suffered hardly any interruption from the operation. The excised heart, however, remains, in the majority of cases, for some time motionless. Stimulated by a prick or an induction shock, it will give perhaps 300 ANALYSIS OF HEART BEAT. [Book i. one, two, or several beats, and then comes to rest. In the majority of cases, however, the animal having previously been in a vigorous condition, it will, after a while, recommence its spontaneous beat- ing, the systole of the ventricle following that of the auricles ; but the rhythm of beat will not be the same as that of the sinus venosus left in the body : it will be slower, and the beats will not continue to go on for so long a time as will those of a heart still retaining the sinus venosus. When the incision is carried through the auriculo-ventricular groove, so as to leave the auricles and sinus venosus within the body, and to isolate the ventricle only, the results are similar but more marked. The sinus and auricles beat regularly and vigor- ously, with their proper sequence, but the ventricle, after a few rapid contractions due to the incision acting as a stimulus, generally remains for a long time quiescent. When stimulated, however, the ventricle will give one, two, or several beats, and after a while, in many cases at least, will eventually set up a spontaneous pulsation with an independent rhythm ; and this may last for some consider- able time, but the beats are not so regular and will not go on for so long a time as will those of a ventricle to which the auricles are still attached. If a transverse incision be carried through the ventricle at about its upper third, leaving the base of the ventricle still attached to the auricles, the portion of the heart left in the body will go on pulsating regularly, with the ordinary sequence of sinus, auricles, ventricle, but the isolated lower two-thirds of the ventricle will not beat spontaneously at all, however long it be left. Moreover, in response to a single stimulus, such as an in- duction shock or a gentle prick, it gives, not as in the case of the entire ventricle when stimulated at the base or of the ventricle to which the auricles are attached, a series of beats, but a single beat. Lastly, to complete the story, we may add that when the heart is bisected longitudinally, each half continues to beat spon- taneously, with an independent rhythm, so that the beats of the two halves are not necessarily synchronous ; and this continuance of spontaneous pulsations after longitudinal bisection may be seen in the conjoined auricles and ventricle, or in the isolated auricles, or in the isolated ventricle. Moreover, the sinus or the auricles may be divided in many ways and yet many of the segments will continue beating ; small pieces even may be seen under the microscope pulsating, feebly, it is true, but distinctly and rhythmically. In these experiments, then, the various parts of the frog's heart also form, as regards the power of spontaneous pulsation, a descend- ing series : sinus venosus, auricles, entire ventricle, lower portion of ventricle, the last exhibiting under ordinary circumstances no spontaneous pulsations at all. § 155. Now we have seen (§ 153) that these parts form, Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 301 to a certain extent, a similar descending series as regards the presence of ganglia ; at least so far that the ganglia are very numerous in the sinus venosus, that they occur in the auricles, and that while Bidder's ganglia are present at the junction of the ventricle with the auricles, ganglia are wholly absent from the rest of the ventricle. Hence, on the assumption (which we have already, § 100, seen reason to doubt) that the nerve cells of ganglia are similar in general functions to the nerve cells of the central nervous system, the view very naturally presents itself that the rhythmic, spontaneous beat of the heart of the frog is due to the spontaneous generation in the ganglionic nerve cells of rhythmic motor impulses, which, passing down to the muscular fibres of the several parts, causes rhythmic contractions of these fibres, the sequence and coordination of the beating of the several divisions of the heart being the result of a coordination between the several ganglia in regard to the generation of impulses. Under this view, the cardiac muscular fibre simply responds to the motor impulses reaching it along its motor nerve fibre in the same way as the skeletal muscular fibre responds to the motor impulses reaching it along its motor nerve fibre ; in both cases the muscular fibre is, as it were, a passive instrument in the hands of the motor nerve, or rather of the nervous centre (ganglion or spinal cord) from which the motor nerve proceeds. And the view, thus based on the fact of the frog's heart, has been extended to the hearts of (vertebrate) animals generally. There are reasons, however, which shew that this view is not tenable. For instance, the lower two-thirds, or lower third, or even the mere tip of the frog's ventricle, that is to say, parts which are admitted not to contain nerve cells, may, by special means, be induced to carry on for a considerable time a rhythmic beat, which in its main features is identical with the spontaneous beat of the ventricle of the intact heart. If such a part of the frog's ventricle be tied on to the end of a perfusion cannula (Fig. 67), the portion of the ventricular cavity belonging to the part may be adequately distended, and the part may at the same time be 'fed' by making a suitable fiuid, such as blood, to fiow through the cannula. It will then be found that the portion of ventricle so treated will, after a preliminary period of quiescence, commence to beat, apparently spontaneously, and will continue so beating for a long period of time. It may be said that in this case the distention of the cavity and the supply of blood or other fiuid act as a stimulus ; but if so the stimulus is a continuous one, or at least not a rhythmic one, and yet the beat is most regularly rhythmic. Then again, the reluctance of the ventricle to execute spon- taneous rhythmic beats is, to a certain extent, peculiar to the frog. The ventricle of the tortoise, for instance, the greater part of the substance of which is as free from nerve cells as is that of the 302 FEATURES OF CARDIAC CONTRACTION. [Book i. frog, will beat spontaneously with great ease and for a long time when isolated from the auricles. Further, a mere strip of this ventricular muscular tissue if kept, gently extended and continually moistened with blood or other suitable lluid, will continue to beat spontaneously with very great regularity for hours or even days, especially if the series be started by the preliminary application of induction shocks rhythmically repeated. In connection with this question we may call attention to the fact that the cardiac muscular fibre is not wholly like the skeletal muscular fibre ; in many respects the contraction or beat of the former is in its very nature different from the contraction of the latter ; the former cannot be considered, like the latter, a mere instrument in the hands of the motor nerve fibre. The features of the beat or contraction of cardiac muscle may be studied on the isolated and quiescent ventricle, or part of the ventricle of the frog. When such a ventricle is stimulated by a single stimulus, such as a single induction shock or a single touch with a blunt needle, a beat may or may not result. If it follows, it resembles, in all its general features at least, a spontaneous beat. Between the application of the stimulus and the first appearance of any contraction is a very long, latent period, varying according to circumstances, but in a vigorous, fresh frog's ventricle being about •3 sec. The beat itself lasts a variable but considerable time, rising slowly to a maximum and declining slowly again. Of course when the beat of the whole ventricle is recorded by one or other of the methods given in § 154, what the tracing really shews is one of the results of the contraction of the cardiac fibres, and gives, in an indirect manner only, the extent of the contraction of the fibres themselves. We may, however, study in a more direct way the contraction of a few fibres by taking a slip of the ventricle (and for this purpose the tortoise is preferable to the frog) and suspending it to a lever, after the fashion of a muscle-nerve preparation. We then get upon stimulation a curve of contraction, characterised by a long latent period, a slow, long- continued rise, and a slow, long-continued fall, a contraction in fact more like that of plain muscular tissue than of skeletal muscular tissue. In the tortoise the contraction is particularly long, the contraction of even the skeletal muscles being long in that animal; it is less long, but still long in the frog, shorter still, but yet long as compared with that of the skeletal muscles, in the mammal. The beat of the ventricle, then, is a single but relatively slow, prolonged contraction wave sweeping over the peculiar cardiac muscle-cell, passing from cell to cell along the fibre, from fibre to fibre along the bundle, and from bundle to bundle over the labyrinth of the ventricular walls. Like the case of the skeletal muscle, this single contraction is accompanied by an electric change, a current of action. The CiiAP. IV.] THE VASCULAll MECHANISM. 303 intact ventricle at rest is, as we have already said (§ 66), isoelectric, but each part just as it is entering into a state of contraction becomes negative towards the rest. Hence when the electrodes of a galvanometer are placed on two points ^, ^ of tlie surface of the ventricle, a diphasic variation of the galvanometer needle is seen when a beat, natural or excited, occurs. Supposing that the wave of contraction reaches A first, this will become negative towards the rest of the ventricle, including B, but when the wave sometime afterwards reaches B, B will become negative towards the rest of the ventricle, including A. Compare § 67. Attempts have been made, by carefully observing the exact times at which the several parts of the ventricle become negative, to determine whether the contraction begins at one part before another, at the base for instance before the apex ; but the results as yet obtained are not decisive. The beat of the auricles, that of the sinus venosus and that of the bulbus arteriosus, are similar in their main features to that of the ventricle, so that the whole beat may be considered to be a wave of contraction sweeping through the heart from sinus to bulbus ; but the arrangement of parts is such that this beat is cut up into sections in such a way that the sinus, the auricles, the ventricle, and the bulbus have each a beat, so to speak, to themselves. In a normal state of things these several parts of the whole beat follow each other in the sequence we have described, but under abnormal conditions the sequence may be reversed, or one section may beat while the others are at rest, or the several sections may beat out of time with each other. So far the description of the contraction which is the founda- tion of the beat differs from that of a skeletal muscle in degree only ; but now comes an important difference. When we stimulate a skeletal muscle with a strong stimulus we get a large contraction, when we apply a weak stimulus we get a small contraction ; within certain limits (see § 79) the contraction is proportional to the stimulus. This is not the case with the quiescent ventricle or heart. When we apply a strong induction-shock we get a beat of a certain strength ; if we now apply a weak shock we get either no beat at all or quite as strong a beat as with a stronger stimulus. That is to say, the magnitude of the beat depends on the condition of the ventricle (or heart) and not on the magnitude of the stimulus. If the stimulus can stir the ventricle up to beat at all, the beat is the best which the ventricle can at the time accomplish ; the stimulus produces either its maximum effect or none at all. It would seem as if the stimulus does not produce a contraction in the same way that it does wdien it is brought to bear on a skeletal muscle, but rather stirs up the heart in such a way as to enable it to execute a spontaneous bea.t which, without the extra stimulus, it could not bring about. And we have reason to think that the normal beat of the heart within the body is the maximum beat of 304 FEATUEES OF CAEDIAC CONTKACTION. [Book i. which it is capable at the moment. This feature of the heart beat is further illustrated by the fact that when a ventricle is beating rhythmically either spontaneously, or as the result of rhythmic stimulation, the kind of effect produced by a new stimulus thrown in will depend upon the exact phase of the cycle of the beat at which it is thrown in. If it is thrown in just as a relaxation is taking place, a beat follows prematurely, before the next beat would naturally follow, this premature beat being obviously produced by the stimulus. But if it be thrown in just as a contraction is beginning, no premature beat follows : the ven- tricle does not seem to feel the stimulus at all. There is a period during which the ventricle is insensible to stimuli, and that how- ever strong ; this period is called the ' refractory ' period. (There is it may be mentioned a similar refractory period in skeletal muscle, but it is of exceedingly short duration). From this it results that, when a succession of stimuli repeated at a certain rate are sent into the ventricle, the number of beats does not correspond to the number of stimuli, some of the stimuli falling in refractory periods are ineffective and produce no beat. Hence, also, it is difficult if not impossible to produce a real tetanus of the ventricle, to fuse a number of beats into one. And there are other facts tending to shew that the contraction of a cardiac muscular fibre, even when induced by artificial stimulation, is of a peculiar nature, and that the analogy with the contraction of a skeletal muscular fibre, induced by motor impulses reaching it along its nerve, does not hold good. These and other considerations, taken together with the facts already mentioned that portions of cardiac muscular tissue in which no ganglionic cells can even with the best methods be dis- covered, may in various animals be induced, either easily or with difficulty, to execute rhythmic beats, which have all the appear- ance of being spontaneous in nature, lead us to conclude that the beat of the heart is not the result of rhythmic impulses proceeding from the cells of the ganglia to passive muscular fibres, but is mainly the result of changes taking place in the muscular tissue itself. And here we may call attention to the peculiar histological features of cardiac muscular tissue ; though so far differentiated as to be striated, its cellular constitution and its ' protoplasmic ' features, including the obscurity of the striation, shew that the differentiation is incomplete. Now one attribute of undifferen- tiated primordial protoplasm is the power of spontaneous move- ment. The further questions, by virtue of what internal molecular changes the cardiac tissue is thus endued with spontaneous rhythmic activity? why the several parts, sinus, auricle, and ventricle, are arranged in descending potency, so that the cardiac cycle beginning with the sinus follows the course it does ; why the contraction wave beginning at the sinus is broken up Crap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM, 305 into sinus beat, auricle beat, ventricle beat instead of sweeping over the whole heart as a continuous wave ? these and allied questions touch problems concerning which our knowledge is at present too imperfect to render any discussion profitable here. We may, however, venture to say that the phenomenon in question cannot be explained by an apjieal to the grosser features of the arrangement of ganglia and nerves which we described in § 153. § 156. In the above we have dealt chiefly with the heart of the cold blooded animal, but so far as we know the same general conclusions hold good for the mammalian heart also. There is, it is true, in the mammal, no prepotent sinus venosus, but as in the frog the auricles are dominant, and their beat determines the beat of the ventricles. Even more clearly than in the frog, however, the ventricles, though they normally follow the auricles in their beat, being initiated, as it were, by them, possess an independent rhythmic power of their own. By a mechanical contrivance all conduction of nervous or muscular impulses between the auricles and ventricles may be abolished, though the blood may continue to flow from the cavities of the former to those of the latter. When this is done the ventricles go on beating rhythmically, but at a rate which is quite independent of that of the auricular beats. In one respect, however, the mammalian heart seems at first sight quite different from the heart of the frog. In the latter, muscular continuity is provided between the sinus venosus and the auricles, between the auricles and the ventricle ; this muscular continuity, it may be argued, is, without the aid of any distinct nervous paths, sufficient for the propagation of the beat along the several parts. In the mammalian heart the connective tissue rings which separate the auricles from the ventricles seem to form complete breaks in the muscular continuity between the upper and lower chambers, and to necessitate nervous ties for carrying on the beat from the former to the latter. But it would appear that even in the highest mammals, the ring in question is broken by bundles of muscular fibres passing between the auricles and ventricles ; and it may be argued that these afford sufficient muscular continuity to justify the view that the beat of the mammalian heart is carried out in a manner not essentially different from that which obtains in the frog or the tortoise. ' We may now turn to the nervous mechanisms by which the beat of the heart, thus arising spontaneously within the tissues of the heart itself, is modified and regulated to meet the require- ments of the rest of the body. The Government of the Heart Beat hy the Nervous System. § 157. It will be convenient to begin with the heart of the frog, which as we have seen is connected with the central nervous 20 306 INHIBITION OF THE BEAT. [Book i. system through, and therefore governed by, the two vagus nerves, each of which though apparently a single nerve contains, as we shall see, fibres of different origin and nature. If while the beats of the heart of a frog are being carefully registered an interrupted current of moderate strength be sent through the vagus nerve, the heart is seen to stop beating. It remains for a time in diastole, perfectly motionless and flaccid ; all the muscular fibres of the several chambers are for the time being in a state of relaxation. The heart has been inhihited by the impulses descending the vagus from the part of the nerve stimulated. If the duration of the stimulation be short and the strength of the current great, the standstill may continue after the current has been shut off ; the beats, when they reappear, are generally at first feeble and infrequent, but soon reach or even go beyond their previous vigour and frequency. If the duration of the stimulation be very long, the heart may recommence beating while the stimula- tion is still going on, but the beats are feeble and infrequent though gradually increasing in strength and frequency. The effect of the stimulation is at its maximum at or soon after the com- mencement of the application of the stimulus, gradually declining afterwards ; but even at the end of a very prolonged stimulation the beats may still be less in force or in frequency, or in both, than they were before the nerve was stimulated, and on the removal of the current may shew signs of recovery by an increase in force and frequency. The effect is not produced instantaneously ; if on the curve the point be exactly marked when the current is thrown in, as at on Fig. 69, it will frequently be found that one beat at Fig. 69. Inhibition of Fkog's Heart by stimulation of Vagus Nerve. on marks the time at which the interrupted current was thrown into the vagus, ojT' when it was shut off. The time marker below marks seconds. The beats were registered by suspending the ventricle from a clamp attached to the aorta and attaching a light lever to the tip of the ventricle. least occurs after the current has passed into the nerve ; the development of that beat has taken place before the impulses descending the vagus have had time to affect the heart. Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 307 The stimulus need not necessarily be the interrupted current ; mechanical, chemical or thermal stimulation of the vagus will also produce inhibition ; but in order to get a marked effect it is desirable to make use of not a single nervous impulse but a series of nervous impulses ; thus it is difficult to obtain any recognisable result by employing a single induction shock of moderate intensity only. As we shall see later on ' natural ' nervous impulses descend- ing the vagus from the central nervous system, and started there, by afferent impulses or otherwise, as parts of a reflex act, may produce inhibition. The stimulus may be applied to any part of the course of the vagus from high up in the neck right down to the sinus ; indeed, very marked results are obtained by applying the electrodes directly to the sinus where as we have seen the two nerves plunge into the substance of the heart. The stimulus may also be applied to either vagus, though in the frog, and some other animals, one vagus is sometimes more powerful than the other. Thus it not unfrequently happens that even strong stimulation of the vagus on one side produces no change of the rhythm, while even moderate stimulation of the nerve on the other side of the neck brings the heart to a standstill at once. If during the inhibition the ventricle or other part of the heart be stimulated directly, for instance mechanically by the prick of a needle, a beat may follow ; that is to say, the impulses descending the vagus, while inhibiting the spontaneous beats, have not wholly abolished the actual irritability of the cardiac tissues. With a current of even moderate intensity, such a current for instance as would produce a marked tetanus of a muscle-nerve preparation, the standstill is complete, that is to say, a certain number of beats are entirely dropped ; but with a weak current the inhibition is partial only, the heart does not stand absolutely still but the beats are slowed, the intervals between them being prolonged, or weakened only without much slowing, or both slowed and weakened. Sometimes the slowing and sometimes the weakening is the more conspicuous resvilt. § 158. It sometimes happens that, when in the frog the vagus is stimulated in the neck, the effect is very different from that just described ; for the beats are increased in frequency, though they may be at first diminished in force. And, occasionally, the beats are increased both in force and in frequency : the result is augmentation, not inhibition. But this is due to the fact that in the frog the vagus along the greater part of its course is a mixed nerve and contains fibres other than those of the vagus proper. If we examine the vagus nerve closely, tracing it up to the brain, we find that just as the nerve has pierced the cranium, just where it passes through the ganglion (GV, Fig. 70), certain fibres pass into it from the sympathetic nerve of the neck, Sy, of the further connections of which we shall speak presently. 308 AUGMENTATION OF THE BEAT. [Book i. This being the case, we may expect that we should get different results according as we stimulated (1) the vagus in the cranium, Fig. 70. Diagrammatic Representation of the course of Cardiac AuGMEXTOR Fibres in the Frog. Vr. roots of vagus (and ixth) nerve. GV. ganglion of same. Cr. line of cranial wall. Vg. vagus trunk, ix. ninth, glosso-pharyngeal nerve. S.V.C. superior vena cava. Sy. sympathetic nerve in neck. G.C. junction of sympathetic ganglion with vagus ganglion, sending i.e. intracranial fibres passing to Gasserian ganglion. The rest of the fibres pass along the vagus trunk. G^ sympathetic ganglion connected with the first spinal nerve. G^^ sympathetic ganglion of the second spinal nerve. .(4n.F. annulus of Vieussens. A s6. subclavian artery. Cr-™' sympathetic ganglion of the third spinal nerve. ///. third spinal nerve, r.c. ramus communicans. The course of the augmentor fibres is shewn by the thick black line. They may be traced from the spinal cord by the anterior root of the third spinal nerve, through the ramus communicans to the corresponding sympathetic ganglion G-^^^and thence by the second ganglion G^^, the annulus of Vieussens, and the first ganglion G^ to the cervical sympathetic Sy, and so by the vagus trunk to the superior vena cava S.V.C. before it was joined by the sympathetic, (2) the sympathetic fibres before they join the vagus, and (3) the vagus trunk, containing both the real vagus and the sympathetic fibres. What we have pre- viously described are the ordinary results of stimulating the mixed Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 309 trunk, and these, as we have said, are not wholly constant, though, usually and in the main, most distinct inhibitory results follow. If we stimulate the sympathetic in the neck as at Sy, Fig. 70, cutting the nerve below so as to block all impulses from passing downwards, and only allow impulses to pass up to the vagus and thence down the mixed vagus trunk to the heart, we get very remarkable results. The beat of the heart instead of being inhib- ited is augmented, the beats are increased either in frequency or in force, or most generally both in frequency and in force. The effect is perhaps best seen when the heart before stimulation is beating slowly and feebly ; upon stimulation of the cervical sympathetic the beats at once improve in vigour and frequency ; indeed, a heart which for one reason or another has almost ceased to beat may, by proper stimulation of the sympathetic, be called back into vigorous activity. If, on the other hand, we stimulate the vagus before it has been joined by the sympathetic fibres (and to ensure the result not being marred by any escape of the stimulating current on to the syjupathetic fibres it is necessary to stimulate the vagus within the cranium) we get pure and constant inhibitory results, the beats are for a time wholly abolished, or are slowed, or are weakened, or are both slowed and weakened. Obviously, then, the heart of the frog is supplied through the vagus by two sets of fibres coming from the central nervous system, the one by the vagus proper and the other by the cervical sym- pathetic nerve, and these two sets have opposite and antagonistic effects upon the heart. The one set, those belonging to the vagus proper, are inhibitory; they weaken the systole and prolong the diastole, the effect with a strong stimulation being complete, so that the heart is for a time brought to a standstill. Sometimes the slowing, sometimes the weakening is the more prominent. When the nerve and the heart are in good condition, it needs only a slight stimulus, a weak current, to produce a marked effect, and it may be mentioned that the more vigorous the heart, the more rapidly it is beating, the easier is it to bring about inhibition. Although, as we have said, the effect is at its maximum soon after the beginning of stimula- tion, a very prolonged inhibition may be produced by prolonged stimulation ; indeed, by rhythmical stimulation of the vagus the heart may be kept perfectly quiescent for a very long time and yet beat vigorously upon the cessation of the stimulus. In other words, the instruments of inhibition, that is, the fibres of the vagus and the part or substance of the heart upon w^hich these act to produce inhibition, wdiatever that part or substance may be, are not readily exhausted. Further, the inhibition when it ceases is, frequently at all events, followed by a period of reaction, during which the heart for a while beats more vigorously and rapidly than before. Indeed the total effect of stimulating the vagus 310 REFLEX INHIBITION IN EROG. [Book i. fibres is not to exhaust the heart, but rather to strengthen it ; and by repeated inhibitions carefully administered, a feebly beating heart may be nursed into vigorous activity. The other set, those joining the vagus from the sympathetic, are 'augmentor' or 'accelerating' fibres; the latter name is the more common but the former is more accurate, since the effect of stimulating these fibres is to increase not only the rapidity but the force of the beat ; not only is the diastole shortened but the systole is strengthened, sometimes the one result and sometimes the other being the more prominent. These augmentor fibres need a somewhat strong stimulation to produce an effect, the time required for the maximum effect to be produced is long, and the effect, when produced, may be maintained for some time. A slowly or weakly beating heart is more easily augmented than is a strong one. Further, the augmentation is followed by a period of reaction in which the beats are feebler, by a stage of exhaustion ; and, indeed, by repeated stimulation of these sympathetic fibres a fairly vigorous heart, especially a bloodless one, may be reduced to a very feeble condition. By watching the effects of stimulating the sympathetic nerve at various points of its course we may trace these augmentor fibres from their junction with the vagus down the short sympa- thetic of the neck through the sympathetic ganglion connected with the first spinal nerve, G^, Fig. 70, through one or both the loops of the annulus of Vieussens, An. V, through the second ganglion, connected with the second spinal nerve, G'^, to the third ganglion connected with the third spinal nerve, G^^^, and thence through the ramus communicans or visceral branch of that ganglion, r.c, to the third spinal nerve, ///, by the anterior root of which they reach the spinal cord. § 159. Both sets of fibres, then, may be traced to the central nervous system ; and we find accordingly that the heart may be inhibited or augmented by nervous impulses which are started in the nervous system either by afferent impulses as part of a reflex act or otherwise, and which pass to the heart by the inhibitory or by the augmenting tract. Thus if the spinal bulb or a particular part of the spinal bulb which is specially connected with the vagus nerve be stimulated, the heart is inhibited ; if, for instance, a needle be thrust into this part the heart stands still. This nervous area may be stirred to action, in a 'reflex' manner, by afferent impulses reaching it from various parts of the body. Thus if the abdomen of a frog be laid bare, and the intestine be struck sharply with the handle of a scalpel, the heart will stand still in diastole with all the phenomena of vagus inhibition. If the nervi mesenterici or the connections of these nerves with the spinal cord be stimulated with the interrupted current, cardiac inhibition is similarly pro- duced. If in these two experiments both vagi are divided, or* the Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 311 spinal bulb is destroyed, inhibition is not produced, however much either the intestine or the mesenteric nerves be stimulated. This shews that the phenomena are caused by impulses ascending along the mesenteric nerves to the spinal bulb, and so affecting a portion of that organ as to give rise by reflex action to impulses which descend the vagus nerve or nerves as inhibitory impulses. The portion of the spinal bulb thus mediating between the afferent and efferent impulses may be spoken of as the cardio-inhihitory centre. This centre may be thrown into activity, and so inhibition produced, by afferent impulses reaching it along various nerves ; by means of it reflex inhibition through one vagus may be brought about by stimulation of the central end of the other. And we have reason to think that in a similar manner augmentor impulses are developed in the central nervous system either as part of a reflex chain or otherwise. § 160. So far we have been dealing with the heart of the frog, but the main facts which we have stated regarding inhi- bition and augmentation of the heart beat apply also to other vertebrate animals including mammals, and, indeed, we meet similar phenomena in the hearts of invertebrate animals. If in a mammal the heart be exposed to view by opening the thorax, and the vagus nerve be stimulated in the neck, the heart may be seen to stand still in diastole, with all the parts flaccid and at rest. If the current employed be too weak, the result, as in the frog, is not an actual arrest but a slowing or weakening of the beats. By placing a light lever on the heart or by other methods, a graphic record of the standstill, or of the slowing, of the complete or incomplete inhibition may be obtained. The result of stimulating the vagus is also well shewn on the blood Fig. 71. Tracing, shewing the influence op Carbiac Inhibition on Blood Pressure. From a EAiiinx. .r the marks on the signal line when tlie cnrrent is thrown into, and // shnt off from tlie vagus. The time murker below marks seconds, the heart, as is frequently the case in the rabbit, beating very rapidly. 312 INHIBITION IN THE MAMMAL. [Book i. pressure curve, the effect of complete cardiac inhibition on blood pressure being most striking. If, while a tracing of arterial pressure is being taken, the beat of the heart be suddenly arrested by vagus stimulation, some such curve as that represented in Fig. 71 will be obtained. It will be observed that two beats follow the application of the current marked by the point a, which corresponds to the signal x on the line below. Then for a space of time no beats at all are seen, the next beat h taking place almost immediately after the shutting off the current at y. Immediately after the last beat following a, there is a sudden fall of the blood pressure. At the pulse due to the last systole, the arterial system is at its maximum of distention; forthwith the elastic reaction of the arterial walls propels the blood forward into the veins, and, there being no fresh fluid injected from the heart, the fall of the mercury is unbroken, being rapid at first, but slower afterwards, as the elastic force of the arterial walls is more and more used up. With the returning beats the pressure correspondingly rises in successive leaps until the normal mean pressure is regained. The size of these returning leaps of the mercury may seem disproportionately large, but it must be re- membered that by far the greater part of the force of the first few strokes of the heart is expended in distending the arterial system, a small portion only of the blood which is ejected into the arteries passing on into the veins. As the arterial pressure rises, more and more blood passes at each beat through the capillaries, and the rise of the pressure at each beat becomes less and less, until at last the whole contents of the ventricle pass at each stroke into the veins, and the mean arterial pressure is established. To this it may be added, that, as we have seen, the force of the individual beats may be somewhat greater after than before inhi- bition. Besides, when the mercury manometer is used, the inertia of the mercury tends to magnify the effects of the initial beats. The above is an example of complete inhibition, of a total stand- still for a while of the whole heart, such as may be obtained by powerful stimulation of the vagus ; both auricles and ventricles remain for a period free from all contractions ; and as the previously existing arterial pressure drives the blood onward from the arteries through the capillaries and veins towards the heart, the cavities of the heart become distended with blood, especially on the right side. A weaker stimulation of the vagus produces an incomplete inhibition, the heart continues to beat but with a different rhythm and stroke, and by careful observation many interesting features may be observed. If a record be obtained, by one or other of the methods mentioned in § 131 or elsewhere, of the behaviour of the auricles and ventricles respectively, it will be observed that the inhibition tells much more on the auricles than on the ventricles. The extent of the auricular contractions is Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 313 especially affected, more so than that of the ventricles, and it may sometimes be observed that the auricles are brouf^ht to comyjlete quiescence while the ventricles still continue to beat ; the latter now exhibit that independent rhythm of wliich we spoke in § 15G. In a somewhat similar manner the stimulation of the vagus, by affecting the rhythm of the auricles more than that of the ventricles, may lead to a want of coordination between the two, the especially slowed auricles beating at one rate, the ventricles at another. It is indeed maintained by some that the vagus acts directly on the auricles only, the changes in the ventricles being of a secondary nature, caused by the changes in the auricles. When the output from the ventricles during vagus stimulation is measured, by the cardiometer or otherwise, it is found, as might be expected, that this is lessened. The diminution during a given period may be due to the mere slowing of the beat ; but the individual pulse volume is in some cases, at least, also lessened. It may by the same method be observed that the quantity remain- ing in the ventricle at the end of the systole is increased ; the ventricle appears to expand more during diastole. Of the effects thus produced on the circulation we shall speak later on. We may now turn to some further details concerning the course of these inhibitory fibres. They run in the trunk of the vagus ; this is clear not only in the case of an animal like the rabbit, in which the vagus runs separate from the cervical sym- pathetic but also in the case of the dog, in which the two nerves are more or less bound up together. Leaving the vagus by the cardiac branches, they reach the cardiac tissues by the cardiac plexuses. When we trace the fibres in the other direction to- wards the central nervous system, we have to bear in mind that the fibres which compose the trunk of the vagus have, as we shall see in studying the central nervous system, two distinct central origins. On the one hand, there are the fibres which are the proper vagus fibres which, leaving the spinal bulb, pass through i30th the jugular ganglion and trunk ganglion (Fig. 72 r. GJ. G. Tr. Vg.). On the other hand, there are fibres which, belonging to the spinal accessory nerve {Sp. Ac.) and to what we shall learn to speak of as the bulbar division of that nerve, pass after leaving the spinal bulb to the trunk ganglion of the vagus, and thence form part of the vagus trunk. Now, it is these fibres of the spinal accessory nerve and not the proper vagus fibres which supply the inhibitory fibres to the heart. Thus, if the bulbar roots of the spinal accessory be divided, those of the vagus proper being left intact, the spinal accessory fibres in the vagus trunk degenerate, and when this has taken place stimulation of the vagus fails to produce the ordinary inhibitory effect. Within the spinal bulb these inhibitory filtres are connected, in the mammal as in the frog, with a cardio-inhibitory centre ; and in the mammal as in the frog inhibition mav be brought about 314 AUGMENTOR FIBRES IN MAMMAL. [Book i. not only by artificial stimulation of the vagus, but by stimulation in a retiex manner or otherwise of the cardio-inhibitory centre. Thus the fainting which often follows upon a blow on the stomach is a repetition of the result mentioned a little while ago as obtained on the frog by striking the stomach or stimulating the nervi mesenterici. So also the fainting, complete or partial, which accompanies severe pain or mental emotion, is an illustration of cardiac inhibition by the vagus. These are familiar examples of more or less complete inhibition ; but simple slowing or weakening of the beat through the inhibitory mechanism is probably an event of much more common occurrence. For instance, a rise of general blood pressure, or, and perhaps more especially, a rise in the blood pressure of the vessels of the brain, sets going inhibitory impulses by which the work of the heart is lessened, and the high blood pressure lowered, the dangers of a too high pressure being thus averted. Again, the inhibition may be brought about in a reflex manner by impulses started in the heart itself and ascending to the central nervous system along afferent fibres which run in the vagus trunk from the heart to the spinal bulb. In this way the heart regulates its own action according to its condition and its needs. There is also some reason for thinking that, in some animals at least, the central nervous system by means of the cardiac inhibitory fibres keeps, as it were, a continual rein on the heart, for, in the dog for example, section of both vagi causes a quickening of the heart's beat. But we shall have to speak of these matters more than once later on. Meanwhile we may turn to the augmentor fibres. So much of our knowledge of the nervous work of the heart and especially of the action of the augmentor fibres has been gained by experiments on dogs that it may be desirable to give a few details con- cerning the nerves of the heart in this animal. In the dog the vagus soon after it issues from its trunk ganglion {G. Tr. Vg., Fig. 72) is joined by the sympathetic nerve proceeding from the superior cervical ganglion, the two forming the vago-sympathetic trunk. As this trunk enters the thorax, the sympathetic portion bears a ganglion (S.G.) usually called the lower cervical ganglion. To this ganglion there pass from the stellate ganglion (G.St.) of the thoracic sympathetic chain, two nerves, one running ventral to, the other dorsal to the subclavian artery, and thus forming with the two ganglia, the annulus of Vieussens (An.V.). A very large number of the cardiac nerves spring from the lower cervical ganglion and from the vagus trunk lying in contact with it, from the vagus trunk belovv this ganglion, from the annulus of Vieus- sens, chiefly at least from the ventral limb, and sometimes from the stellate ganglion. There are besides cardiac branches passing from the vago-sympathetic trunk between the levels of the superior and of the inferior cervical ganglia, cardiac branches of the recurrent laryngeal, a cardiac branch of the superior laryngeal, and a long Chap. IV.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 315 Fig. 72. Diagrammatic Representation^ of the Cardial Inhibitort and augmentor flbres in the dog. fibres The upper portion of the figure represents the inhibitory, the lower the auo-iueutor 316 AUGMENTOE FIBEES IN MAMMAL. [Book i. r. Vg. roots of the vagus . r.Sp.Ac. roots of the spinal accessory ; both drawn very diagrammatically. G.J. ganglion jugulare. G.Tr.Vg. ganglion trunci vagi. Sp.Ac. spinal accessory trunk. Ext.Sp.Ac. external spinal accessory, i.Sp.Ac. internal spinal accessory. Vg. trunk of vagus nerve, n.c. branches going to heart. C.Sy. cervical sympathetic. G.C. loAver cervical ganglion. A.sb. sub- clavian artery. An.V. Annulus of Vieussens. G.St, stellate ganglion, correspond- ing to the first, second, and third ganglia of the thoracic chain. G.Th.^, G.Th.^, fourth and fifth thoracic ganglia. iJ.i., D.u., D.ni., D.iv., D.v., first, second, third, fourth and fifth thoracic spinal nerves, r. c. ramus communicans. n. c. nerves (cardiac) passing to the heart from the cervical ganglion and from the annulus of Vieussens. The inhibitory fibres, shewn by black lines, run in the upper (bulbar) roots of the spinal accessory, by the internal branch of the spinal accessory, past the ganglion trunci vagi, along the trunk of the vagus, and so by branches to the heart. The augmentor fibres, also shewn by black lines, pass from the spinal cord by the anterior roots of the second and third thoracic nerves (possibly also from the first, fourth and fifth as indicated by broken black lines), pass the stellate ganglion by the annulus of Vieussens to the lower cervical ganglion, from whence, as also from the annulus itself, they pass along the cardiac nerves to the heart. An occasional tract from the stellate ganglion itself is not shewn in the figure. slender nerve from the superior cervical ganglion passing independently to the heart. The arrangement is not exactly the same on the two sides of the body, and the minor details differ in different individuals. As in other animals the various cardiac nerves mingle in the cardiac ^ plexuses. In the dog it has been ascertained by separate stimulation of these several cardiac nerves, that augmentor fibres are contained in some or other of the nerves passing from the lower cervical ganglion and the adjoining vagus trunk, from the annulus of Vieussens, especially the lower, ventral, limb, and sometimes from the stellate ganglion itself. The results differ a good deal in different in- dividuals, and there are reasons for thinking that the nerves in question may contain efferent fibres other than augmentor fibres, by reason of which stimulation of them may give rise to other than pure augmentor effects. Speaking broadly, however, we may say that we may trace the augmentor fibres back from the cardiac plexuses through the lower cervical ganglion and the annulus of Vieussens to the stellate ganglion. This ganglion is in reality several sympathetic ganglia fused together. It undoubtedly, in the dog, represents the first, second and third thoracic sympathetic ganglia, receiving, as it does, branches, rami communicantes, from the first, second and third thoracic spinal nerves. Since it also receives branches from the eighth and seventh cervical nerves, it has been argued that it represents not only the three thoracic sympathetic ganglia, but also what in man and other animals is called the lower cervical ganglion ; if so, what has been called above the lower cervical ganglion should be regarded as the middle cervical ganglion. From the stellate ganglion the sympathetic cord passes to the ganglion, which is connected by a ramus communicans with the Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 317 fourth thoracic spinal nerve, and which is therefore, in reality, the fourth thoracic ganglion, and so on to the rest of the thoracic chain. Now, when the several rami coniniunicantes, or the anterior roots, of the lower cervical and upper thoracic nerves are separately stimulated, it is found that augmentor efiects make their appear- ance with considerable constancy when the second and third thoracic nerves are stimulated ; the effects are less constant with the first and fourth thoracic nerves ; sometimes some effect may appear with the fifth thoracic nerve, but not with any other thoracic nerves, or with any of the cervical nerves. We may therefore say that, in the dog, augmentor impulses leave the spinal cord by the anterior roots of the second and third, to some extent the first and fourth, and possibly the fifth thoracic nerves, travel by the several rami communicantes to the stellate ganglion, and pass thence to the cardiac plexuses, and so to the heart, by nerves from the stellate ganglion itself, or from the annulus of Vieussens, or from the so-called lower cervical ganglion. In the cat the path of the augmentor impulses is very similar, and we may regard the statement just made as representing, in a broad way, the path of these impulses in the mammal generally. They leave the spinal cord by the upper thoracic nerves, and pass to the heart through the lower cervical and upper thoracic sympathetic ganglia. The effect of stimulating these augmentor fibres is, in some cases, to increase the rapidity of the rhythm. When the heart is beating very slowly this acceleration may be very conspicuous, but when the heart is beating quickly, or even at what may be called a normal rate, the acceleration observed may be very slight. A more constant and striking effect is the increase in the force of the beat. When tracings are taken of the movements of the auricles and ventricles separately, it is observed that in the case both of the auricles and of the ventricles, the extent of the systole is increased ; moreover, it would seem also that both cavities undergo a larger expansion : they are filled with a larger quantity of blood during the diastole. This means that the output of the heart is increased by the action of the augmentor nerves, and that such is the effect may be directly shewn by the cardiometer. Moreover, this increase of the output may take place in spite of a concomitant rise of arterial pressure, so that the effect of the action of the augmentor nerves is distinctly to increase the work of the heart ; and this may take place even though no marked acceleration occurs. In the mammal as in the case of the frog, when the augmentor fibres are stimulated, some time elapses before the maximum effect is witnessed and the influence of the stimulation may last some considerable time after the stimulation has ceased. When records are taken of the behaviour of the heart during the stimulation of afferent nerves, such as the sciatic or the splanchnic, the records shew that the heart may behave very much 318 INHIBITION AND AUGMENTATION. [Book i. in the same way as when the augmentor fibres are directly stimu- lated ; there is a marked increase in the force of the auricular and of the ventricular systole, and at times an obvious acceleration of the rhythm. We may infer that in such a case the augmentor fibres are thrown into activity through the afferent impulses as part of a reflex act. At the same time it must be remembered that afferent impulses may increase the beat of the heart not by exciting the augmentor mechanism, but by depressing, that is, by inhibiting a previously existing activity of the cardio-inhibitory centre ; to this point we shall again have to refer. We may, however, conclude that both the inhibitory and the augmentor mechanisms of the heart can be brought into action by means of the central nervous system. Speaking broadly, the effect of the former is to diminish the work of the heart, and so to lower the blood pressure, and that of the latter to increase the work of the heart, and so to heighten the blood pressure. § 161. The question, what is the exact nature of the change brought about by the inhibitory and augmenting impulses respect- ively on their arrival at the heart ? or, in other words, by virtue of what events produced in the heart itself do the impulses along the one set of fibres bring about inhibition, along the other set augmentation ? — is a very difficult one, which we cannot attempt to discuss fully here. We may, of course, suppose that the very impulses themselves as started at the point of stimulation are, owing to the very nature of the fibres, different in the one set and in the other. Many phenomena, however, of the nervous system lead us, by analogy, to the conclusion that this is not the case, but that stimulation of the fibres produces different effects on the heart by reason of the different ways in which the fibres end in the heart. We may, for instance, suppose that there exist in the heart what we may call an inhibitory and an augmenting mechanism with which the inhibitory and augmentor fibres are respectively connected. And a special action of atropin on the heart lends support to this view. If, either in a frog or a mammal, or other animal, after the vagus fibres have been proved, by trial, to produce, upon stimu- lation, the usual inhibitory effects, a small quantity of atropin be introduced into the circulation (when the experiment is con- ducted on a living animal, or be applied in a weak solution to the heart itself when the experiment is conducted, in the frog for instance, on an excised heart or after the circulation has ceased), it will after a short time be found, not only that the stimu- lation, the application of a current, for instance, which previously when applied to the vagus produced marked inhibition, now produces no inhibition, but even that the strongest stimulus, the strongest current applied to the vagus, will wholly fail to affect the heart, provided that there be no escape of current on to the cardiac tissues themselves ; under the influence of even a small Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 319 dose of atropin, the strongest stimulation of the vagus will not produce standstill or appreciable slowing or weakening of the beat. Further, this special action of atropin on the heart is, so to speak, complemented by the action of niuscarin, tlie active principle of many poisonous mushrooms. If a small quantity of muscarin be introduced into tlie circulation, or applied directly to the heart, the beats become slow and feeble, and if the dose be adequate the heart is brought to a complete standstill. The effect is in some respects like that of powerful stimulation of the vagus, but the standstill is much more complete, the effect is much more profound. Now if, in a frog, the heart be brouglit to a standstill by a dose of muscarin, the application of an adequate quantity of atropin will bring back the beats to quite their normal strength and rhythm. The one drug is, so far as the heart is concerned (and indeed in many other respects), the antidote of the other. We may interpret these results as indicating that there exists in the heart an inhibitory mechanism, which is excited, stimulated into activity by muscarin, but paralysed, rendered incapable of activity by atropin. And we may suppose that there is a corresponding augmenting mechanism. But what is the nature of such a mechanism ? It has been supposed that it is furnished by some or other of the ganglia within the heart. And this view seems at first sight tempting, especially as regards the vagus inhibitory fibres. In the dog the roots of the spinal accessory nerve, by which inhibitory fibres leave the central nervous system, consist entirely of medullated fibres. Among these are fibres of fine calibre, 3-5/jb or less in diameter, which may be traced down the trunk of the vagus, along the branches going to the heart, right down to the heart itself. There can be little doubt that these medullated fibres of fine calibre are the inhibitory fibres of the vagus, and indeed there is evidence which renders it probable that the inhibitory fibres of the heart are always medullated fibres of fine calibre, which continue as medullated fibres right down to the heart, but eventually lose their medulla in the heart itself by becoming connected with the cells of some or other of the ganglia. And we may suppose tliat the impulses passing down the vagus fibres so affect the cells with which the fibres are thus connected, that the impulses which pass away from the other side of the cell towards the mus- cular fibres assume a special character and become inhibitory, whatever might have been their nature before. In other words, these ganglionic cells are the inhiliitory mechanism of which we are in search ; but the connection of a fibre with a nerve cell and a change from a medullated to a non-medullated condition does not necessarily entail change of function. The augmentor fibres, as they leave the spinal cord by the anterior roots of the thoracic spinal nerves, are medullated fibres. But they lose their medulla (in the dog) in the stellate ganglion or the lower cervical ganglion ; from these 320 INHIBITION AND AUGMENTATION. [Book i. ganglia onwards they are non-medullated fibres. Now we cannot by experiment detect any difference between the augmentor action of the medullated fibres running from the spinal cord to the gan- glia and that of the non-medullated fibres running from the ganglia to the heart. By analogy we may infer that the inhibitory fibres are the same in action before and after they become connected with the ganglionic cells within the heart. These cells do not furnish the inhibitory mechanism. Moreover, there is evidence that atropin in preventing inhibition does so by producing some change either in the muscular fibres themselves or in the ultimate nerve endings. At present we can make no satisfactory statement as to exactly how either inhibition or augmentation is brought about. As to the part, however, played by the ganglionic cells within the heart in reference to inhibition or augmentation, we may call to mind the fact that stimulation of say one of the cardiac nerves, carrying augmentor or inhibitory fibres leads to augmentation or inhibition of the work not of any particular part of the heart, but of the whole heart ; and as we have already urged, the ganglia probably act as distributors of impulses. They may also, in addition, have an important work in maintaining the nutrition of the nerve fibres : they may have an important trophic function. We have seen that both inhibition and augmentation may affect on the one hand the rhythm, and on the other hand the force of the heart beat. We cannot at present explain this double event. It may be that there are in each case two sets of fibres, one bearing on the rhythm, the other on the force of the contrac- tions ; this is the simpler explanation, but we have as yet no adequate proof in support of it, and other explanations seem possible. One other point is worthy perhaps of attention. We have seen that inhibition may be followed by a phase of increased activity, and that on the whole the heart is strengthened rather than weakened by the process, while on the other hand augmentation is followed by depression, and the process is distinctly an exhausting one. Hence whatever be the exact mechanism of inhibition and of augmentation, whatever be the particular elements of the cardiac structures which furnish the one or the other, augmentation means increased expenditure, inhibition means a lessened expenditure, of energy on the part of the muscular tissue of the heart. Whatever the manner in which the respective fibres act, the effect of the activity of the augmentor fibres is to hurry on the downward, catabolic changes of the cardiac tissue, while that of the inhibitory fibres is an opposite one, and we may probably say that the latter assists the constructive, anabolic, changes. Other Influences regulating or modifying the Beat of the Heart. § 162. Important as is the regulation of the heart by the nervous system, it must be borne in mind that other influences CiiAr. IV.] THE VASCULAK MECHANISM. 321 are or may be at work. The beat of the heart may, for instance, be modified by inliuences bearing directly on the nutrition of the heart. The tissues of the heart, lilve all other tissues, need an adequate supply of blood of a proper quality ; if the blood vary in quality or quantity the beat of the heart is correspondingly affected. The excised frog's heart, as we have seen, continues to beat for some considerable time, though apparently empty of blood. After a while, however, the beats diminish and eventually disap- pear ; and their disappearance is greatly hastened by washing out the heart with normal saline solution, which, when allowed to How through the cavities of the heart, readily permeates the tissues on account of the peculiar construction (§ 151) of the ventricular walls. If such a ' washed out,' quiescent heart be fed with a perfusion cannula, in the manner described (§ 155), with diluted blood (of the rabbit, sheep, &c.), it may be restored to functional activity. A similar but less complete restoration may be wit- nessed if serum be used instead of blood ; and a heart fed regularly with fresh supplies of blood or even of serum may be kept beating for a very great length of time. Now, serum is, as we have seen, a very complex fluid containing several proteids, many ' extractives ' and various inorganic salts. Of the proteids, experiments have shewn that peptone and albumose, so far from being beneficial, are directly poisonous to the heart ; that paraglobulin is without effect ; but that serum-albumin will maintain the beats for a long time, and will restore the beats of a ' washed-out ' heart. We might infer from this that serum- albumin is directly concerned in the nutrition of the cardiac tissue ; but we are met with the striking fact that a frog's heart may be maintained in vigorous pulsation for many hours, and that a ' washed-out ' frog's heart may be restored to vigorous pulsation by being fed with normal saline fluid to which a calcium salt with a trace of a potassium salt has been added^. On the other hand, serum from which the calcium salts have been removed by precipitation with sodium oxalate is powerless to maintain or to restore cardiac pulsations. Obviously in the changes, whatever they may be, through which such fluids as serum, milk and the like (for milk and other fluids have been found efficient in this respect) maintain the beat of the heart, calcium salts play an important part ; and it is tempting to connect this with the relation of calcium salts to the clotting of blood (§ 20). We are not, however, justified in inferring because serum is ineffective in the absence of calcium salts, that the serum albumin is useless ; and, indeed, the beneficial effects of the calcic saline fluid are not so complete as those of serum or of blood ; moreover, the possible influences of the various extrac- ^ By Riuger's Ileart-Fluid, for in.stnnce, which is made by saturating iu the cold normal saliue solution (-(jS p.c. sodium chloride) with calcium phosphate, and adding to 100 c.c. of the mixture, 2 c.c. of a 1 p.c. solution of potassium chloride. 21 322 EEGULATION BY NUTEITION. [Book i. tives, such as sugar, for instance, present in the serum have to be considered. We may, in addition, call to mind what we said in treating of the skeletal muscles (§ 86), that fatigue or exhaustion may have a double nature, the using up of contractile material on the one hand, and on the other hand the accumulation of waste products ; and the nutritive or restorative influence over the heart of any material may bear on the one or the other of these. Thus the beneficial effect of alkalies is probably in part due to their antagonizing the acids which as we have seen are being constantly produced during muscular contraction. But we shall return to this subject in dealing at a later part of this work with the nutrition of the several tissues. In the various experiments which have been made in thus feeding hearts with nutritive and other fluids, two facts worthy of notice have been brought to light. One is that various substances have an effect on the muscular walls, apart from the direct modification of the contractions. The muscular fibres of the heart over and above their rhythmic contractions are capable of varying in length, so that at one time they are longer, and the chambers, when pressure is applied to them internally, are dilated beyond the normal, while at another time they are shorter, and the chambers, with the same internal pressure, are contracted beyond the normal. In other words, the heart possesses what we shall speak of in reference to arteries as tonicity or tonic contraction, and the amount of this tonic contrac- tion, and in consequence the capacity of the chambers, varies according to circumstances. Some of the substances appear to increase, others to diminish this tonicity and thus to diminish or increase the capacity of the chambers during diastole. This, of course, would have an effect, other things being equal, on the output from the heart, and so on its work ; and, indeed, there is some evidence that the augmentor and inhibitory impulses may also affect this tonicity, but observers are not agreed as to the manner in which and extent to which they may thus act. Another fact worthy of notice is when the heart is thus artifi- cially fed with serum, or other fluids, or even with blood, the beats, whether spontaneous or provoked by stimulation, are apt to become intermittent, and to arrange themselves into groups. This intermit- tence is possibly due to the fluid employed being unable to carry on nutrition in a completely normal manner, and to the consequent production of abnormal chemical substances ; and it is probable that cardiac intermittences seen during life are in certain cases thus brought about by some direct interference with the nutrition of the cardiac tissue, and not throiigh extrinsic nervous impulses descend- ing to the heart from the central nervous system. Various chemical substances in the blood, arising within the body, or introduced as drugs, may thus affect the heart's beat by acting on its muscular fibres, or its nervous elements, or both, and that probably in various €hap. iv.] the vascular MECHANISM. 323 ways, modifying in different directions the rliytlini, or the individual ■contractions, or both. Concerning the effect on the heart of blood which has not been adequately changed in the lungs we shall speak when we come to treat of respiration. The physical or mechanical circumstances of the heart also affect its beat ; of these perhaps the most important is the amount of the distension of its cavities. The contractions of cardiac muscle, like those of ordinary muscle (see § 81), are increased up to a certain limit by the resistance which they have to overcome ; a full ventricle will, other things being equal, contract more vigorously than one less full ; though, as in ordinary muscle, the limit at which resistance is beneficial may be passed, and an over- full ventricle will fail to beat at all. Hence an increase in the quantity of blood in the ventricle will augment the work done in two ways : the quantity thrown out will, unless antagonistic influences intervene, be greater, and the increased quantity will be •ejected with greater force. Further, since the distension of the ventricle, at the commencement of the systole, at all events, is ■dependent on the auricular systole, the work of the ventricle (and so of the heart as a whole) is in a measure governed by the auricle. An interesting combination of direct mechanical effects and indirect nervous effects is seen in the relation of the heart's beat to blood pressure. When the blood pressure is high, not only is the resistance to the ventricular systole increased, but, •other things being equal, more blood flows (in the mammalian heart) through the coronary arteries. Both these events would increase the activity of the heart, and we might expect that the increase would be manifest in the rate of. the rhythm as well as in the force of the individual beats. As a matter of fact, however, we do not find this. On the contrary, the relation of heart beat to pressure may be put almost in the form of a law, that " the rate of the beat is in inverse ratio to the arterial pressure ; " a rise of pressure being accompanied by a diminution, and fall of pressure Tjy an increase of the rate of the rhythm. This, however, only holds good if the vagus nerves be intact. If these be previously divided, then in whatever way the blood pressure be raised, — whether by injecting blood or clamping the aorta, or increasing the peripheral resistance, through an action of the vaso-motor nerves, which we shall have to describe directly, — or in whatever way it be lowered, no such clear and decided inverse relation between blood pressure and pulse-rate is observed. It is inferred, therefore, that increased blood pressure causes a slowing of the beat, when the vagus nerves are intact, because the cardio-inhibitory centre in the medulla is stimulated by the high pressure, either directly by the pressure obtaining in the blood vessels of the medulla, or in some indirect manner, and the heart in consequence more or less inliibited. SEC. 6. CHANGES IN THE CALIBEE OE THE MINUTE AKTEKIES. VASO-MOTOE ACTIONS. § 163. We have seen (§ 108) that all arteries contain plain muscular fibres, for the most part circularly disposed, and most abundant in, or sometimes almost entirely confined to the middle coat. We have further seen that, as the arteries become smaller, the muscular element as a rule becomes more and more prominent as compared with the other elements, until, in the minute arteries,, the middle coat consists almost entirely of a series of plain mus- cular fibres wrapped round the internal coat. Nerve fibres, of whose nature and course we shall presently speak, are distributed largely to the arteries, and appear to end chiefly in fine plexuses round the muscular fibres, but their exact terminations have not as yet been clearly made out. By mechanical, electrical, or other stimulation, this muscular coat may, in the living artery, be made to contract. During this contraction, which has the slow character belonging to the contractions of all plain muscle, the calibre of the vessel is diminished. The veins also, as we have seen, possess. muscular elements, but these vary in amount and distribution very much more in the veins than in the arteries. Most veins, however, are contractile, and may vary in calibre according to the condition of their muscular elements. Veins are also supplied with nerves. It will be of advantage, however, to consider separately the little we know concerning the changes in the veins and to confine ourselves at present to the changes in the arteries. If any individual small artery in the web of a frog's foot be watched under the microscope, it will be found to vary considerably in calibre from time to time, being sometimes narrowed and sometimes dilated; and these changes may take place without any obvious changes either in the heart beat or in the general circulation ; they are clearly changes of the artery itself. During the narrowing, which is obviously due to a contraction of the muscular coat of the artery, the capillaries fed by the artery and the veins into which these lead become less filled with blood, and Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 325 therefore paler. During the widening, which corresponds to the relaxation of the muscular coat, the same parts are fuller of blood, and redder. It is obvious that, the pressure at the entrance into any given artery remaining the same, more blood will enter the artery when relaxation takes place, and consequently the resistance offered by the artery is diminished, and less when contraction occurs, and the resistance is consequently increased ; the blood flows in the direction of least resistance. The extent and intensity of the narrowing or widening, of the constriction or dilation which may thus be observed in the frog's web, vary very largely. Variations of slight extent, either more or less regular and rhythmic or irregular, occur even when the animal is apparently subjected to no disturbing causes, and may be spoken ■of as spontaneous ; larger changes may follow events occurring in various parts of the body ; while as the result of experimental interference the arteries may become either constricted, in some cases almost to obliteration, or dilated until they acquire double or more than double their normal diameter. This constriction or dilation may be brought about not only by treatment applied directly to the web, but also by changes affecting the nerves of the leg or other parts of the body. Thus section of the nerves of the leg is generally followed by a widening which may be slight or which may be very marked, and which is sometimes preceded by a passing constriction ; while stimulation of the peripheral stump of a divided nerve by an interrupted current of moderate in- tensity gives rise to constriction, often so great as almost to obliterate some of the minute arteries. Obviously, then, the contractile muscular elements of the minute arteries of the web of the frog's foot are capable by contraction or relaxation of causing decrease or increase of the calibre of the arteries ; and this condition of constriction or dilation may be brought about through the agency of nerves. Indeed, not only in the frog, but also, and still more so, in warm blooded animals, have we evidence that in the case of a very large number of, if not all, the arteries of the body, the condition of the muscular coat, and so the calibre of the artery, is governed by means of nerves ; these nerves have received the general name of vaso-motor nerves. § 164. If the ear of a rabbit, preferably a light coloured one, be held up before the light, a fairly conspicuous artery will be seen running up the middle line of the ear, accompanied by its broader and more obvious veins. If this artery be carefully watched it will be found, in most instances, to be undergoing rhythmic changes of calibre, constriction alternating with dilation. At one moment the artery appears as a delicate, hardly visible pale streak, the whole €ar being at the same time pallid. After a while the artery slowly widens out, becomes broad and red, the whole ear blushing, and many small vessels previously invisible coming into view. Again the artery narrows and the blush fades away ; and this may l)e 326 CHANGES IN CALIBRE OF ARTERIES. [Book i. repeated at somewhat irregular intervals of a minute, more or less. The extent and regularity of the rhythm are usually markedly- increased if the rabbit be held up by the ears for a short time previous to the observation. Similar rhythmic variations in the calibre of the arteries have been observed in several regions of the body, ex. gr. in the vessels of the mesentery and elsewhere ; probably they are widely spread. Sometimes no such variations are seen, the artery remains constant in a condition intermediate between the more extreme widening and extreme narrowing just described. In fact, we may speak of an artery as being at any given time in one of three phases. It may be very constricted, in which case its muscular fibres are very much contracted ; or it may be very dilated, in which case its muscular fibres are relaxed ; or it may be mode- rately constricted, the muscular fibres being contracted to a certain extent, and remaining in such a condition that they may on the one hand pass into stronger contraction, leading to marked con- striction, or, on the other hand, into distinct relaxation, leading to dilation. We have reason to think, as we shall see, that many arteries of the body are kept habitually, or at least for long periods together, in this intermediate condition, which is fre- quently spoken of as tonic contraction or tonus, or arterial tone. § 165. If, now, in a vigorous rabbit, in which the heart is beating with adequate strength, and the whole circulation is in a satisfactory condition, the cervical sympathetic nerve be divided on one side of the neck, remarkable changes may be observed in the blood vessels of the ear of the same side. The arteries and veins widen, they, together with the small veins and the capillaries, become full of blood, many vessels previously invisible come into view, the whole ear blushes, and if the rhythmic changes described above were previously going on, these now cease ; in conse- quence of the extra supply of warm blood the whole ear becomes distinctly warmer. Now, these changes take place, or may take place, without any alteration in the heart beat or in the general circulation. Obviously the arteries of the ear have, in conse- quence of the section of the nerve, lost the tonic contraction which previously existed ; their muscular coats previously some- what contracted have become quite relaxed, and whatever rhythmic contractions were previously going on have ceased. The more marked the previous tonic contraction, and the more vigorous the heart beats, so that there is an adequate supply of blood to fill the widened channels, the more striking the result. Sometimes, as when the heart is feeble, or the pre-existing tonic contraction is slight, the section of the nerve produces no very obvious change. If now the upper segment of the divided cervical sympathetic nerve, that is the portion of the nerve passing upwards to the head and ear, be laid upon the electrodes of an induction machine, and a gentle interrupted current be sent through the nerve, fresh changes Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 327 take place in the blood vessels of the ear. A short time after the application of the current, for in this effect there is a latent period of very appreciable duration, the ear grows paler and cooler, many small vessels, previously conspicuous, become again invisible, the main artery shrinks to the thinnest thread, and the main veins become correspondingly small. When the current is shut off' from the nerve, these effects still last some time, but eventually pass off; the ear reddens, blushes once more, and, indeed, may become even redder and hotter, with the vessels more filled with blood than before. Obviously the current has generated in the cervical, sympathetic, nerve impulses which, passing upward to the ear and finding their way to the muscular coats of the arteries of the ear, have thrown the muscles of those coats into forcible contractions, and have thus brought about a forcible narrowing of the calibre of the arteries, a forcible constriction. Through the narrowed con- stricted arteries less blood finds its way, and hence the paleness and coldness of the ear. If the impulses thus generated be very strong, the constriction of the arteries may be so great that the smallest quantity only of blood can make its way through them, and the ear may become almost bloodless. If the impulses be weak the constriction induced may be slight only ; and, indeed, by careful manipulation the nerve may be induced to send up to the ear impulses only just sufficiently strong to restore the moderate tonic constriction which existed before the nerve was divided. We infer from these experiments that among the various nerve fibres making up the cervical sympathetic, there are certain fibres which, passing upwards to the head, become connected with the arteries of the ear, and that these fibres are of such a kind that impulses, generated in them and passing upwards to the ear, lead to marked contraction of the muscular fibres of the arteries, and thus produce constriction. These fibres are vaso-motor fibres for the blood vessels of the ear. From the loss of tone, so frequently following section of the cervical sympathetic, we may further infer, that, normally during life, impulses of a gentle kind are continually passing along these fibres, upwards through the cervical sympathe- tic, which impulses, reaching the arteries of the ear, maintain the normal tone of those arteries. But, as we said, the existence of this tone is not constant, and the effects of these tonic impulses are not so conspicuous as those of the artificial constrictor im- pulses generated by stimulation of the nerve. § 166. The above results are obtained whatever be the region of the cervical sympathetic which we divide or stimulate between the upper and the lower cervical ganglion. We may therefore describe these vaso-motor impulses as passing upwards from the lower cer- vical ganglion along the cervical sympathetic, to the upper cervical ganglion, from which they issue by branches which ultimately find their way to the ear. But these impulses do not start from the lower cervical ganglion ; on the contrary, by repeating the experi- 328 VASO-MOTOE, FIBRES OF THE EAR. [Book i. merits of division and stimulation in a series of animals, we may- trace the path of these impulses from the lower cervical ganglion, Fig. 73, through the annulus of Vieussens to the ganglion stellatum and upper part of the thoracic sympathetic chain, and thence along the rami communieantes of some or other of the upper thoracic spinal nerves to the anterior roots of those nerves, and so to the spinal cord. In the cat and the dog, and probably in other higher mammals, the chief path of the impulses lies in the second and third thoracic nerves, though some pass by the fourth, and a variable small number by the fifth and the first; in the rabbit the path is more widespread, and reaches lower down, for while the impulses pass chiefly by the fourth and fifth thoracic nerves, some pass by the second and third, and others by the sixth, seventh, and even eighth nerves. The exact path also differs in different indi- viduals of the same species. It will be observed that from the spinal cord up to the annulus of Vieussens, and the lower cervical ganglion, these vaso-motor impulses for the ear, and the augmentor impulses for the heart, (cf. Fig. 72) follow much the same path ; but there they part company. We Fig. 73. Diagram Illustrating the Paths of Vaso-constrictor Fibres along THE Cervical Sympathetic and (part of) the Abdominal Splanchnic. Aur. artery of ear. G.C.S. superior cervical ganglion. Abd. Spl. upper roots of and part of abdominal splanchnic nerve. VJf.C. vaso-motor centre in spinal bulb. The other references are the same as in Fig. 72, § 160. The paths of the constrictor fibres are shewn by the arrows. The dotted line along the middle of the spinal cord, Sp. C, is to "indicate the passage of constrictor impulses down the cord from the vaso-motor centre in the spinal bulb. can thus trace these vaso-motor impulses backwards along the cer- vical sympathetic to the anterior roots of certain thoracic nerves, and through these to the thoracic region of the spinal cord, where we will for the present leave them. We may, accordingly, speak of vaso-motor fibres for the ear as passing from the thoracic spinal cord to the ear along the track just marked out ; stimulation of these fibres at their origin from the spinal cord, or at any part of their course (along the anterior roots of the second, third or other upper thoracic nerves, visceral branches [rami communica,ntes] of those nerves, ganglion stellatum or upper part of thoracic sympathetic chain, annulus of Vieussens, &c. &c.), leads to constriction in the blood vessels of the ear of that side ; and section of these fibres at any part of the same course tends to abolish any previously Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 329 existing tonic constriction of the blood vessels of the ear, though the effect of section is not so constant or striking as that of stimulation. § 167. We must now turn to another case. In dealing with digestion we shall have to study the submaxillary salivary gland. We may for the present simply say that this is a glandular mass well supplied with blood vessels, and possessing a double nervous supply. On the one hand it receives fibres from the cervical sympathetic, Fig. 74 v. sym. (in the dog, in which the effects which we are about to describe are best seen, the vagus and cervical cTi.t" Fig. 74. Diagrammatic Representation of the Submaxillary Gland of THE Dog with its Nerve and Blood Vessels. (The dissection has been made on an animal lying on its back, but since all the parts shewn in the figure cannot be seen from any one point of view, the figure does not give the exact anatomical relations of the several structures.) sm. g\d. The submaxillary gland, into the duct (sm. d) of which a cannula has been tied. The sublingual gland and duct are not shewn. n.l.,n.l'. The lingual branch of the fifth nerve, the part n. I. is going to tlie tongue, ch. t., ch. t'., ch. t" . The chorda tympani The part ck. t" . is proceeding from tlie facial nerve ; at ch. t'. it becomes conjoined with the lingual ?( /' and afterwards diverging passes as ch. t. to tlie gland along the duct ; the continuation of the nerve in company with the lingual n. I. is not shewn, sm. (jl. Tlie submaxillary ganglion with its several roots, a. car. The carotid artery, two small liranches of wliicli, a. sm. a. and r. sm. p., pass to the anterior and posterior parts of the gland, r.s.m. The anterior and pos- terior veins from the gland, falling into v. J. the jugular vein, i: si/m. The con- joined vagus and sympatlietic trunks. //. cer. s. Tlie njijier cervical ganglion, two branches of which forming a plexus (n. f.) over the facial artery, are distributed (n. si/m. sm.) along the two glandular arteries to the anterior and posterior portions of the gland. The arrows indicate the direction taken by the nervous impulses during reflex stimulation of the gland. They ascend to the brain by the lingual and descend by the chorda tympani. 330 CONSTEICTOE AND DILATOR FIBRES. [Book i. sympathetic are enclosed in a common sheath so as to form v/hat appears to be a single trunk), which reach the gland in company with the arteries supplying the gland (n. sym. sm.). On the other hand it receives fibres from a small nerve called the clw7-da tympani (ch. t.), which, springing from the 7th cranial (facial) nerve, crosses the tympanum of the ear (hence the name), and, joining the lingual branch of the 5th nerve, runs for some distance in company with that nerve, and then ends partly in the tongue, and partly in a small nerve which, leaving the lingual nerve before reaching the tongue, runs along the duct of the submaxillary gland, and is lost in the substance of the gland ; a small branch is also given off to the sublingual gland. Now, when the chorda tympani is simply divided, no very remarkable changes take place in the blood vessels of the gland, but if the peripheral segment of the divided nerve, that still in connection with the gland, be stimulated, very marked results follow. The small arteries of the gland become very much dilated,, and the whole gland becomes flushed. (As we shall see later on the gland at the same time secretes saliva copiously, but this does- not concern us just now.) Changes in the calibre of the blood vessels are, of course, not so readily seen in a compact gland as in a thin extended ear ; but if a fine tube be placed in one of the small veins by w*hich the blood returns from the gland, the effects- on the blood flow of stimulating the chorda tympani become very obvious. Before stimulation the blood trickles out in a thin, slow stream of a dark venous colour ; during stimulation the blood rushes out in a rapid full stream, often with a distinct pulsation,, and frequently of a colour which is still scarlet and arterial in spite of the blood having traversed the capillaries of the gland ;. the blood rushes so rapidly through the widened bloodvessels that it has not time to undergo completely that change from arterial to venous which normally occurs while the blood is traversing the capillaries of the gland. This state of things may continue for some time after the stimulation has ceased, but before long the flow from the veins slackens, the issuing blood becomes darker and venous, and eventually the circulation becomes normal. We shall have occasion later on to speak of the nervi erigentes, the stimulation of which gives rise to the erection of the penis. The erection of the penis is partly due to a widening of the arteries supplying the peculiar erectile tissue of that organ, whereby that tissue becomes distended with blood, and the widening is brought about by impulses passing along the nerves in question. Obviously the chorda tympani and the nervi erigentes contain fibres which we may speak of as ' vaso-motor ' since stimulation of them produces a change in, brings about a movement in the blood vessels ; but the change produced is of a character the very opposite to that produced in the blood vessels of the ear by stimulation of the cervical sympathetic. There stimulation of the Chap, iv.] THE VASCULAR MECHANISM. 331 nerve caused contraction of the muscular fibres, constriction of the small arteries ; here stimulation of the nerve causes a widening of the arteries, which widening is undoubtedly due to relaxation of the muscular fibres. Hence we must distinguish between two kinds of vaso-motor fibres, fibres the stimulation of wliich produces constriction, vaso-constrictor fibres, and fibres the stimulation of which causes the arteries to dilate, vaso-dilator fibres, the one kind bein, „ „ by stimulation of sciatic, 344 „ „ „ by action of drugs, 361 „ „ „ by changes in amount of blood, 362, 363 Blood pressure, heart beat in inverse ratio to, 323 „ serum, constituents of, 19 ,, supply, its influence on muscular „ irritability, 149 „ ventricular ' out-put ' of, 247 „ vessels, their influence on fluidity of, 28 Blushing, its cause, 352, 371 Body, the, characteristics of in life and death, 1, 2 Bois-Reymond, du, key, 61 „ „ on muscle-currents, 111, 112 Brachial flexus, constrictor and dilator fibres in, 333 Bufty coat of clotted blood, 16 Bulbus arteriosus, absence of nerves in, 293 Calcium salts, their presence necessary in clotting of blood, 26 Canalis auricularis in lower vertebrates, 294 Capillaries described, 13 „ their permeability, 13, 193- 202 „ structure, 190 „ blood-interchanges effected in, 13, 188, 193 „ calibre, 194, 355 „ plasmatic layer in, 356 „ proportion of sectional area of, to aorta, 201, 212 „ measurements of blood pres- sure in, 210 „ disappearance of pulse in, 211 ,, peripheral resistance in, 210- 213, 216 Capillary circulation, normal phenomena of, 211, 355 „ „ as affected by inflam- mation, 357 Carbohydrates in white corpuscles, 41 „ „ in muscle-substance, 103 Cardiographic tracings, 250, 259 Cardio-iuhibitory centre, 310, 313 Cardiometer, Roy and Adami's, 249 Cells, ciliary', 164 „ „ action of chloroform on, 168 ,, connective tissue, 189 „ differentiation of, during develop- ment of ovum, 6 „ endocardial, 199 „ epithelioid, of capillaries, 193 „ ,, of arteries, 195 „ epithelium, 165 „ ganglionic, of heart, 294, 296 „ „ of spinal cord, 175-178 ,, nerve, of splanchnic ganglia, 178 „ „ of central nervous system, 179-181 „ of Purkinje', 293 INDEX. 379 Cells, spiral, 179, 295 „ uiiipular and multipolar, 296 Ceinent .sul)stance, 19.5, 194 Centre, cardio-inliiljitory, 'HO „ va^o-motur, 34.'J, '.M'l „ „ limits of, 345, .'Uf, Cerebri!], 123 Clianges, anabolic and kataliolic, in living sul)stance, 41 I'bauveau anil Lurtet, tlieir ha;niatacho- nu-ter, 224, 228 „ and ]\Iarey, tbeir mode of mea- suring endocardiac pressure, 240, 241 Chloral, its effect on action of depressor, 345 Chlorides, their presence in serum, 51 Chloroform, its effect ou ciliary action, 168 Cholesteriu, its presence in blood, 51 „ „ in red corpuscles, 52 „ „ in nerve substance, 123 „ „ iu gall-stones, 123 Chromatin, 47 Cilia, 164 Ciliary movements, 56, 164 „ ,, circumstances affecting, 165 Circulation of the blood, main facts of, 203 „ capillary, 212, 225, 355 „ hydraulic principles of the, 213, 214 „ aids to, 221 „ rate of flow, 222-228 „ time occupied by "ircuit, 228, 229 „ constant and variable factors of, 365 „ as affected by blood supplv, 367 Clotting of blood, 15-30 „ retarded by cold, 16 „ „ by addition of saline solutions, 16, 22 „ „ by oil, 21 „ „ bv carbonic acid in the ' blood, 21 „ „ by injection of albu- mose, 29 „ causes of, 26 „ in the living body, 28 „ favoured bv presence of foreign bodies, 21, 28, 49 „ of fluids other tlian lilood, 23 „ of muscle plasma in rigur mor- tis, 101 Coagulation of proteids by iieat, 18 Cohnheim's areas, 93 Cold, its influence on clotting, 16, 21 „ „ on irritability of muscle and nerve, 148 „ „ on vaso-constrictor action, 371 Connective tissue, structure of, 189 Connective tissue, 'loose,' 190 „ „ corpuscles, 191 Constant current, its action, 128 „ ,, as cornparcil with in- duction-shock, 130 Contour, double, of ncrvi^ tibrc, 1 16 Contractile tissues, the, 54-170 „ material of muscle tissue, 155 Contraction of muscle, movements of body due to, 55 ,, simple and tetanic, 59 „ grajihic method of reconl ing, 59 „ simjile, phenomena of, 69 „ tetanic, 79-85 „ of skeletal muscles, tetanic in character, 83 wave of, 88 „ microscopic ciiangcs during, 94 „ chemical changes due to, 105 „ tliermal changes due to, 106 „ electrical changes during, 115 „ ' making and breaking,' 128 „ influenceil by nature of sti- mulus, 138' „ isometric and isotonic. 138 „ prolonged, of red muscle, 142 „ as influenced by load, 143 „ idio-muscular, 145 „ exhausting effects of the products of, 1 52 „ result of chemical changes in, 153 „ of plain muscle, 161-164 „ peristaltic, 161, 162 „ spontaneous, 163 „ tonic, 164 „ relation of to amoeboid movements, 164 „ of heart, 266 „ features of, 302, 304 Cord, spinal, 171 „ „ diagrammatic nietamere of, 172 „ ganglia of the. 175-178 „ „ reflex actions manifested by the, 182 „ „ cornua anterior of, nerve- cells of, 179, 185 Corpus Arantii, 200 Corpuscles, blood, not an essential ])art of clot, 16 „ relations of, with the plasma, 27 „ connective tissue. 191 „ red and wiiite, relative pro- portions of, 38 „ „ „ capillary walls permeable by, 194 380 INDEX. Corpuscles, red, microscopic appearance, 31 „ „ structure, 32 „ „ chemical composition, 33 „ „ as oxygen bearers, 33, 35, 38 „ „ formed in red marrow of bones, 37 „ „ their passage through the capillaries, 356 „ ,, diapedesis of, 359 ,, white (see a/so Leucocytes) „ „ their connection with clotting, 29 „ „ appearance and struc- ture of, 38, 39 „ „ amoiboid movements of, 38, 42, 47, 168, 356, 358 „ „ chemistry of, 40, 52 „ „ type of all living tissue, 41, 44 „ „ origin of, 44 „ „ migration of, 45, 358 „ „ worli done by, 46 „ „ their action as phago- cytes, 46, 47 „ „ different forms of, 47 „ „ nuclear network in, 47 „ „ their behaviour in in- flammation, 336-338 Cramp abolished by electrotonus, 135 Crassamentnm or clot, 15 Currents of action in a muscle, 113 ,, in a nerve, 125 of rest m a muscle or nerve, 109, 125 „ in electrotonus, 133 electrical, constant and in- duced, 60, 61 interrupted or faradaic, 66 electrotonic, 132 Curves, mode of measuring, 236, note Cycle, cardiac, described, 232, 264 „ „ duration of phases, 262 Death, a gradual process, 1 „ slow clotting of blood after, 27 „ of blood corpuscles, 38, 46 „ from failure of heart's action, 369 Degeneration of severed nerve, 146, 147 „ of muscle after severance of nerve, 147 „ of constrictor prior to di- lator fibres in severed nerve, 333 Depressor nerve, 343, 375 Despretz signal, 74, 75 Diapedesis of red corpuscles, 359 Diastole of heart's action, 232, 235 Dicrotic wave, origin of, 282-287 Dicrotism in pulse tracings, 280 Dicrotism less marked in rigid arteries, 283 Differential manometer of Hiirthle, 254, 255 Distress from undue exertion, nature of, 374 Division of labor, physiological, 6 Dudgeon's sphygmograph, 271 Elastic fibres in connective tissue, 192 „ membrane of arteries, 195 Elasticity, diminished, in exhausted muscles, 152 „ of arteries, as affecting circulation, 214 „ „ as affecting dicro- tism, 285 Elastin in yellow elastic fibres. 1 92 Electric changes during muscle contrac- tion, 108 ,, „ in a nerve impulse, 125 „ stimuli described, 60 „ organs of certain animals, 122, 157 Electrotonic currents, 132 Electrotonus, features of, 130 Embrj'O of mammal, origin of red cor- puscles in, 36, 37 „ „ glvcogen in muscles of, 'l03 End-plates of nerves, probable action of virari on, 59 „ the two parts of, 121 „ their analogy with electric organs of animals, 122, 157 Endocardium, its structure, 199 Energy, potential, of living and dead bodies, 1 „ of living body expended in work, 2 „ of dead body shewn as heat, 3 „ renewed and set free by diffe- rent tissues, 6 ,, of muscle and nerve, 153-157 Eosinophile cells, 48 Epithelioid or eudothelioid cells of ca- pillaries, 193 Epithelium of arteries, 195 „ ciliated, 164 Eustachian valve in adult life, 232 Exercise, effect of, on the muscles, 150 „ ,, on vascular mecha- nism, 372, 373 Exhaustion of muscle and nerve tissue, 145, 151, 152 Fainting, a result of cardiac inhibition, 314, 368 Faradization, 67 Fatigue, its effect on muscular irrita- bility, 142, 151, 322 „ sense of, its nature, 151 Fats, in white corpuscles, 42 INDEX. 381 Fats, ill blociil, T)! „ in uervc tissue, 117, 123 Fear, inhibitory action of, 187 Fenestrated nieiiihranc of arteries, 196 Ferment, fibrin, eflieiciit eause of coagu- lation. 24 „ „ its action uii fihriiiogen, 26 Fibres, muscular, see Muscle ,, nerve, see Nerves elastic, in connective tissue, 192 Fihrilhe of nmsclc-snlistance, 93 gelatiniferous, 190 Fibrin, 15 ,, its development during clotting, 1 (i ,, its proteid nature, 17 „ structure, 18 „ causes of its appearance, 20 Fibrin-ferment, 24 Fibrinogen, its precipitation from plasma, 23 ,, its conversion into fibrin, 25, 26, 30 Fick, spring-manometer of, 269, 270 Fluid, serous, 23 Fluidity of living blood, 26 „ of blood in the vessels after death, 27 Food, amoeboid absorption of, 3 „ carried to the tissues by the blood, 8 „ its gradual change into living substance, 42 „ ingestion of, by white corpuscles, 42,46 „ its effect on vascular mt chauism, 374 Freezing, its effect on muscle, 100 Frey and Krehl, manometer of, 246, 247 Frog, rlieoscopic, 114 „ capillary circulation in, 211 ,, brainless, phenomena shewn by, 56, 182, 183 Gad, manometer of, 246 Galvanic battery described, 61 Ganglia, spinal, 173, 175 „ of splanchnic svstem, 178, 181, 186 „ cardiac, of lower vertebrates, 293 „ of frog, 294, 301 ., „ of maniinal, 295, 290 „ ,, relations of the, 301 Ganglion stellatum, 314-316 Ganglion cells, their structure, 175, 177, 178 Gaskell, his method of recording heart lieat, 297 Gelatin, composition and ]iro])erties of, 190 Gland, salivary, venous pulse in, 287 submaxillary, of dog, donlde nerve supply of, 329 Globulins, a group of proteids, 19 (iloimb'iis, tlieir clianges U) acid and alkali all)umin, 99 Glycogen, its presence in white cor- jmscles, 41 „ ,, in muscle-substance, 103 „ ,, in ])lain muscle, 161 Goltz and Gaule, maximum manometer of, 260 Granules in white corpuscles, 39, 42, 47 llaiiiacytometer describeil, 34 llii'inadroinometer of Volkniann, 222 ILeniatachometer of Vierordt, 223 „ of Chauveau and Lortet, 224 Ilajmatin, 33 „ its relations with bilirubin, 35 Htematoblasts descril)ed, 37 „ development of, 46 Htemoglobin, 33 „ an oxygen-bearer, 35, 38 ,, its proportion in red cor- puscles, 51 „ „ in red muscle, 100 Hcemorrhage, its effect on blood pressure, 362 Heart, 231-268 „ beat, normal, 231 ,, „ meclianism of, 250 „ „ summary of, 265, 266 » » regulation of, 289 „ ,, ilevelopment of, 296 „ „ analysis of, 300 „ „ government of, by ner\ous system, 305 „ „ augmentation of, in frog, 307-311 „ „ „ in mammal, 311 „ „ inhibition of, in frog, 306 „ „ „ in mammal, 311-314 „ ., regulation of, by nutrition, 320 „ „ relation of, to pressure, 323 „ ., intrinsic regulation of, 366 „ ,, sudden stoppage of, 370 „ cardiac cycle, 232-235 „ auricular .systole, 233 „ ventricular systole, 234 „ change of form, 235, 237 „ cardiac impulse, 237 ,, sounds of tiie, 238 ,, endocardiac jirossnro, 241-247 „ 'out-put ' of till', 247 „ ventricular pressure in the, 252- 262 „ negative pressure in the, 260. 261, 267 „ duration of cardiac phases, 262 „ Mork done bv. 267, 268 hi.stoloMjy of." 290 „ muscular tissue of. in frog's, 291, 302 „ „ „ in inamnnxls, 292 „ nerves of, 293 in frog, 294 382 INDEX. Heart, nerves of, in mammal, 295 „ contraction, features of, 300-305 Heat given out by contracting muscle, 106 Helmholtz's magnetic interruptor, 68 Henle's sheath of nerve fibre, 121, 177 Hermann on muscle currents, 112 Histohaematin in red muscle, 100 Htirthle, membrane manometer of, 244- 246 „ tracings of ventricular and aortic pressure by apparatus of, 253, 254, 258, 259, 284 ,, differential manometer of, 254 „ maximum and minimum mano- meter of, 261 „ tambour sphygmoscope of, 270 Impulses, nervous, 58, 125 „ „ nature of, 157 „ cardiac, 259 Induction coil, construction of, 63 Inflammation, phenomena of, 356 Infusoria, ciliary motions in, 167 Ingestion of matter by cells, 47, 48 Inhibition, cardiac, phenomena of, 306 et supra „ „ fainting a result of, 314, 368 „ „ effect of atropin on, 318-320 Inhibitory nerves, 186 ,, fibres in vagus of frog, 309 „ „ in vagus of mammal, 311 „ „ cardiac, continuous ac- tion of, 314 „ „ their analogy with vaso- dilator fibres, 331 Inogen, or ' contractile material of muscle,' 155, 156 Insect muscles, fibrillas of, 92 Interfibrillar substance of muscle, 92, 93 Intermediate line, in muscle fibre, 94 Intermittence, cardiac, 322, 368 Interruptor, magnetic, 67 Intrinsic tone of artery walls, 348 ,, regulation of the heart, 366 Irritability, muscular and nervous, 57- 85 „ „ „ their mutual indepen- dence, 58, 147 „ diminution and disappear- ance of, after death, 84 „ as affected by electrotonus, 130 „ circumstances determining, 145 „ centrifugal loss of, in severed nerve, 146 „ influence of temperature on, 148 „ „ of blood supply on, 149 Irritability, influence of functional ac- tivity on, 150 „ presence of oxygen a condi- tion of, 152, 156 „ prolonged, of heart, 299 Irritants, inflammatorj^ action of, on tissues, 357 Katabolic changes in living tissue, 41, 43 Katelectrotonus defined, 131 Kathode or negative electrode, 61 Key, galvanic, various forms of, 62 Krause's micmbrane, 92 Kreatin, its presence in the blood, 51 „ chemical composition, 104 „ in plain muscle, 161 Kymograph, Ludwig's, for recording blood pressure, 210 Labour, physiological division of, 6 Lactic acid, its presence in the blood, 52 „ „ isomeric variations of, 101, note Laky blood, how formed, 32 Lecithin, in stroma of red corpuscles, 33 „ in white corpuscles, 40 „ in the blood, 52 „ in muscle-substance, 103 „ in nerve tissue, 123 Leucocytes in the lymphatic system, 44 „ their origin, 45 „ different forms of, 189 „ in connective tissue, 191 Leucocythffimia, increase of white cor- puscles in, 46 Life, processes of, 1 Liver, destruction of red corpuscles in the, 36 Living substance, food and waste of, 3 Ludwig, stromuhr of, 223 Lymph, the, a medium of exchange between blood and tissues, 13, 14, 193 „ salts present in, 41 „ migration of white corpuscles into, 358 „ coagulable, in inflammation, 358 Magnetic interruptor, 67 Making and breaking currents, 61-69 ,, „ contractions with the constant current, 128 Manometer, for measuring blood pres- sure, 206 „ maximum and minimum, 260, 261 of Gad, 246 „ of Krehl, 246 of Fick, 270 Medulla of nerve-fibre, structure of, 118, 119 INDEX. 383 Medulla oblunguta, cardiac effect of stimulation of, 310. ., „ centre for nerves of taste in, 340 „ ,, ,, for constrictor iin- pulses ill, 342-350 Membrane, elastic, of arteries, 195 „ fenestrated, 196 Membraue-manonicter of lliirthle, 244- 240, 269 Metaiiolism defined, 41 ,, increased by exercise, 372 Metameres, hypothetical, of spinal cord, 171, 172 Micro-unit of heat defined, 107, note Migration of the white corpuscles, 45 „ „ in inflammation, 358 „ „ aided by changes in vascular walls, 360 Milieu's reagent for detection of proteid, 17 Morse key, 63 Movements of bodv, how accomplished, 55 " „ ciliary, 164 „ amoeboid, 168, 358 „ cardiac, visible, 231 Multipolar cells of splanchnic ganglia, 181 Muscarin, its action on cardiac tissue, 319 Muscle, irritability of, 57 et supra „ phenomena of contraction of, 69- 164 „ tetanic contraction of, 79-84, 141 „ gross structure of, 86 ,, wave of contraction, 88 „ minute structure of, 90 „ striated, 93 „ „ under polarized light, 95, 96 „ mol)ilitv of, 97 „ chemistry of, 97-106 „ living and dead, contrasted, 97 „ dead, cliemistry of, 98 „ rigid, acid reaction of, 101 „ living, reaction of, 102 „ chemical changes due to contrac- tion, 105 „ thermal changes due to contrac- tion, 108, 153, 163 „ electrical changes in, 108 ,, action of the constant current on, 128-134 ,, work done bv, as iiifluence